Linux Audio

Check our new training course

Loading...
v4.17
 
   1/*
   2 * mac80211 <-> driver interface
   3 *
   4 * Copyright 2002-2005, Devicescape Software, Inc.
   5 * Copyright 2006-2007	Jiri Benc <jbenc@suse.cz>
   6 * Copyright 2007-2010	Johannes Berg <johannes@sipsolutions.net>
   7 * Copyright 2013-2014  Intel Mobile Communications GmbH
   8 * Copyright (C) 2015 - 2017 Intel Deutschland GmbH
   9 * Copyright (C) 2018        Intel Corporation
  10 *
  11 * This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
  12 * it under the terms of the GNU General Public License version 2 as
  13 * published by the Free Software Foundation.
  14 */
  15
  16#ifndef MAC80211_H
  17#define MAC80211_H
  18
  19#include <linux/bug.h>
  20#include <linux/kernel.h>
  21#include <linux/if_ether.h>
  22#include <linux/skbuff.h>
  23#include <linux/ieee80211.h>
 
  24#include <net/cfg80211.h>
  25#include <net/codel.h>
 
  26#include <asm/unaligned.h>
  27
  28/**
  29 * DOC: Introduction
  30 *
  31 * mac80211 is the Linux stack for 802.11 hardware that implements
  32 * only partial functionality in hard- or firmware. This document
  33 * defines the interface between mac80211 and low-level hardware
  34 * drivers.
  35 */
  36
  37/**
  38 * DOC: Calling mac80211 from interrupts
  39 *
  40 * Only ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() can be
  41 * called in hardware interrupt context. The low-level driver must not call any
  42 * other functions in hardware interrupt context. If there is a need for such
  43 * call, the low-level driver should first ACK the interrupt and perform the
  44 * IEEE 802.11 code call after this, e.g. from a scheduled workqueue or even
  45 * tasklet function.
  46 *
  47 * NOTE: If the driver opts to use the _irqsafe() functions, it may not also
  48 *	 use the non-IRQ-safe functions!
  49 */
  50
  51/**
  52 * DOC: Warning
  53 *
  54 * If you're reading this document and not the header file itself, it will
  55 * be incomplete because not all documentation has been converted yet.
  56 */
  57
  58/**
  59 * DOC: Frame format
  60 *
  61 * As a general rule, when frames are passed between mac80211 and the driver,
  62 * they start with the IEEE 802.11 header and include the same octets that are
  63 * sent over the air except for the FCS which should be calculated by the
  64 * hardware.
  65 *
  66 * There are, however, various exceptions to this rule for advanced features:
  67 *
  68 * The first exception is for hardware encryption and decryption offload
  69 * where the IV/ICV may or may not be generated in hardware.
  70 *
  71 * Secondly, when the hardware handles fragmentation, the frame handed to
  72 * the driver from mac80211 is the MSDU, not the MPDU.
  73 */
  74
  75/**
  76 * DOC: mac80211 workqueue
  77 *
  78 * mac80211 provides its own workqueue for drivers and internal mac80211 use.
  79 * The workqueue is a single threaded workqueue and can only be accessed by
  80 * helpers for sanity checking. Drivers must ensure all work added onto the
  81 * mac80211 workqueue should be cancelled on the driver stop() callback.
  82 *
  83 * mac80211 will flushed the workqueue upon interface removal and during
  84 * suspend.
  85 *
  86 * All work performed on the mac80211 workqueue must not acquire the RTNL lock.
  87 *
  88 */
  89
  90/**
  91 * DOC: mac80211 software tx queueing
  92 *
  93 * mac80211 provides an optional intermediate queueing implementation designed
  94 * to allow the driver to keep hardware queues short and provide some fairness
  95 * between different stations/interfaces.
  96 * In this model, the driver pulls data frames from the mac80211 queue instead
  97 * of letting mac80211 push them via drv_tx().
  98 * Other frames (e.g. control or management) are still pushed using drv_tx().
  99 *
 100 * Drivers indicate that they use this model by implementing the .wake_tx_queue
 101 * driver operation.
 
 102 *
 103 * Intermediate queues (struct ieee80211_txq) are kept per-sta per-tid, with a
 104 * single per-vif queue for multicast data frames.
 
 105 *
 106 * The driver is expected to initialize its private per-queue data for stations
 107 * and interfaces in the .add_interface and .sta_add ops.
 108 *
 109 * The driver can't access the queue directly. To dequeue a frame, it calls
 110 * ieee80211_tx_dequeue(). Whenever mac80211 adds a new frame to a queue, it
 111 * calls the .wake_tx_queue driver op.
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 112 *
 113 * For AP powersave TIM handling, the driver only needs to indicate if it has
 114 * buffered packets in the driver specific data structures by calling
 115 * ieee80211_sta_set_buffered(). For frames buffered in the ieee80211_txq
 116 * struct, mac80211 sets the appropriate TIM PVB bits and calls
 117 * .release_buffered_frames().
 118 * In that callback the driver is therefore expected to release its own
 119 * buffered frames and afterwards also frames from the ieee80211_txq (obtained
 120 * via the usual ieee80211_tx_dequeue).
 121 */
 122
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 123struct device;
 124
 125/**
 126 * enum ieee80211_max_queues - maximum number of queues
 127 *
 128 * @IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUES: Maximum number of regular device queues.
 129 * @IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUE_MAP: bitmap with maximum queues set
 130 */
 131enum ieee80211_max_queues {
 132	IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUES =		16,
 133	IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUE_MAP =	BIT(IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUES) - 1,
 134};
 135
 136#define IEEE80211_INVAL_HW_QUEUE	0xff
 137
 138/**
 139 * enum ieee80211_ac_numbers - AC numbers as used in mac80211
 140 * @IEEE80211_AC_VO: voice
 141 * @IEEE80211_AC_VI: video
 142 * @IEEE80211_AC_BE: best effort
 143 * @IEEE80211_AC_BK: background
 144 */
 145enum ieee80211_ac_numbers {
 146	IEEE80211_AC_VO		= 0,
 147	IEEE80211_AC_VI		= 1,
 148	IEEE80211_AC_BE		= 2,
 149	IEEE80211_AC_BK		= 3,
 150};
 151
 152/**
 153 * struct ieee80211_tx_queue_params - transmit queue configuration
 154 *
 155 * The information provided in this structure is required for QoS
 156 * transmit queue configuration. Cf. IEEE 802.11 7.3.2.29.
 157 *
 158 * @aifs: arbitration interframe space [0..255]
 159 * @cw_min: minimum contention window [a value of the form
 160 *	2^n-1 in the range 1..32767]
 161 * @cw_max: maximum contention window [like @cw_min]
 162 * @txop: maximum burst time in units of 32 usecs, 0 meaning disabled
 163 * @acm: is mandatory admission control required for the access category
 164 * @uapsd: is U-APSD mode enabled for the queue
 
 
 165 */
 166struct ieee80211_tx_queue_params {
 167	u16 txop;
 168	u16 cw_min;
 169	u16 cw_max;
 170	u8 aifs;
 171	bool acm;
 172	bool uapsd;
 
 
 173};
 174
 175struct ieee80211_low_level_stats {
 176	unsigned int dot11ACKFailureCount;
 177	unsigned int dot11RTSFailureCount;
 178	unsigned int dot11FCSErrorCount;
 179	unsigned int dot11RTSSuccessCount;
 180};
 181
 182/**
 183 * enum ieee80211_chanctx_change - change flag for channel context
 184 * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_WIDTH: The channel width changed
 185 * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_RX_CHAINS: The number of RX chains changed
 186 * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_RADAR: radar detection flag changed
 187 * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_CHANNEL: switched to another operating channel,
 188 *	this is used only with channel switching with CSA
 189 * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_MIN_WIDTH: The min required channel width changed
 190 */
 191enum ieee80211_chanctx_change {
 192	IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_WIDTH		= BIT(0),
 193	IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_RX_CHAINS	= BIT(1),
 194	IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_RADAR		= BIT(2),
 195	IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_CHANNEL	= BIT(3),
 196	IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_MIN_WIDTH	= BIT(4),
 197};
 198
 199/**
 200 * struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf - channel context that vifs may be tuned to
 201 *
 202 * This is the driver-visible part. The ieee80211_chanctx
 203 * that contains it is visible in mac80211 only.
 204 *
 205 * @def: the channel definition
 206 * @min_def: the minimum channel definition currently required.
 207 * @rx_chains_static: The number of RX chains that must always be
 208 *	active on the channel to receive MIMO transmissions
 209 * @rx_chains_dynamic: The number of RX chains that must be enabled
 210 *	after RTS/CTS handshake to receive SMPS MIMO transmissions;
 211 *	this will always be >= @rx_chains_static.
 212 * @radar_enabled: whether radar detection is enabled on this channel.
 213 * @drv_priv: data area for driver use, will always be aligned to
 214 *	sizeof(void *), size is determined in hw information.
 215 */
 216struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf {
 217	struct cfg80211_chan_def def;
 218	struct cfg80211_chan_def min_def;
 219
 220	u8 rx_chains_static, rx_chains_dynamic;
 221
 222	bool radar_enabled;
 223
 224	u8 drv_priv[0] __aligned(sizeof(void *));
 225};
 226
 227/**
 228 * enum ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode - channel context switch mode
 229 * @CHANCTX_SWMODE_REASSIGN_VIF: Both old and new contexts already
 230 *	exist (and will continue to exist), but the virtual interface
 231 *	needs to be switched from one to the other.
 232 * @CHANCTX_SWMODE_SWAP_CONTEXTS: The old context exists but will stop
 233 *      to exist with this call, the new context doesn't exist but
 234 *      will be active after this call, the virtual interface switches
 235 *      from the old to the new (note that the driver may of course
 236 *      implement this as an on-the-fly chandef switch of the existing
 237 *      hardware context, but the mac80211 pointer for the old context
 238 *      will cease to exist and only the new one will later be used
 239 *      for changes/removal.)
 240 */
 241enum ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode {
 242	CHANCTX_SWMODE_REASSIGN_VIF,
 243	CHANCTX_SWMODE_SWAP_CONTEXTS,
 244};
 245
 246/**
 247 * struct ieee80211_vif_chanctx_switch - vif chanctx switch information
 248 *
 249 * This is structure is used to pass information about a vif that
 250 * needs to switch from one chanctx to another.  The
 251 * &ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode defines how the switch should be
 252 * done.
 253 *
 254 * @vif: the vif that should be switched from old_ctx to new_ctx
 
 255 * @old_ctx: the old context to which the vif was assigned
 256 * @new_ctx: the new context to which the vif must be assigned
 257 */
 258struct ieee80211_vif_chanctx_switch {
 259	struct ieee80211_vif *vif;
 
 260	struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *old_ctx;
 261	struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *new_ctx;
 262};
 263
 264/**
 265 * enum ieee80211_bss_change - BSS change notification flags
 266 *
 267 * These flags are used with the bss_info_changed() callback
 268 * to indicate which BSS parameter changed.
 269 *
 270 * @BSS_CHANGED_ASSOC: association status changed (associated/disassociated),
 271 *	also implies a change in the AID.
 272 * @BSS_CHANGED_ERP_CTS_PROT: CTS protection changed
 273 * @BSS_CHANGED_ERP_PREAMBLE: preamble changed
 274 * @BSS_CHANGED_ERP_SLOT: slot timing changed
 275 * @BSS_CHANGED_HT: 802.11n parameters changed
 276 * @BSS_CHANGED_BASIC_RATES: Basic rateset changed
 277 * @BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INT: Beacon interval changed
 278 * @BSS_CHANGED_BSSID: BSSID changed, for whatever
 279 *	reason (IBSS and managed mode)
 280 * @BSS_CHANGED_BEACON: Beacon data changed, retrieve
 281 *	new beacon (beaconing modes)
 282 * @BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_ENABLED: Beaconing should be
 283 *	enabled/disabled (beaconing modes)
 284 * @BSS_CHANGED_CQM: Connection quality monitor config changed
 285 * @BSS_CHANGED_IBSS: IBSS join status changed
 286 * @BSS_CHANGED_ARP_FILTER: Hardware ARP filter address list or state changed.
 287 * @BSS_CHANGED_QOS: QoS for this association was enabled/disabled. Note
 288 *	that it is only ever disabled for station mode.
 289 * @BSS_CHANGED_IDLE: Idle changed for this BSS/interface.
 290 * @BSS_CHANGED_SSID: SSID changed for this BSS (AP and IBSS mode)
 291 * @BSS_CHANGED_AP_PROBE_RESP: Probe Response changed for this BSS (AP mode)
 292 * @BSS_CHANGED_PS: PS changed for this BSS (STA mode)
 293 * @BSS_CHANGED_TXPOWER: TX power setting changed for this interface
 294 * @BSS_CHANGED_P2P_PS: P2P powersave settings (CTWindow, opportunistic PS)
 295 *	changed
 296 * @BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INFO: Data from the AP's beacon became available:
 297 *	currently dtim_period only is under consideration.
 298 * @BSS_CHANGED_BANDWIDTH: The bandwidth used by this interface changed,
 299 *	note that this is only called when it changes after the channel
 300 *	context had been assigned.
 301 * @BSS_CHANGED_OCB: OCB join status changed
 302 * @BSS_CHANGED_MU_GROUPS: VHT MU-MIMO group id or user position changed
 303 * @BSS_CHANGED_KEEP_ALIVE: keep alive options (idle period or protected
 304 *	keep alive) changed.
 305 * @BSS_CHANGED_MCAST_RATE: Multicast Rate setting changed for this interface
 306 *
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 307 */
 308enum ieee80211_bss_change {
 309	BSS_CHANGED_ASSOC		= 1<<0,
 310	BSS_CHANGED_ERP_CTS_PROT	= 1<<1,
 311	BSS_CHANGED_ERP_PREAMBLE	= 1<<2,
 312	BSS_CHANGED_ERP_SLOT		= 1<<3,
 313	BSS_CHANGED_HT			= 1<<4,
 314	BSS_CHANGED_BASIC_RATES		= 1<<5,
 315	BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INT		= 1<<6,
 316	BSS_CHANGED_BSSID		= 1<<7,
 317	BSS_CHANGED_BEACON		= 1<<8,
 318	BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_ENABLED	= 1<<9,
 319	BSS_CHANGED_CQM			= 1<<10,
 320	BSS_CHANGED_IBSS		= 1<<11,
 321	BSS_CHANGED_ARP_FILTER		= 1<<12,
 322	BSS_CHANGED_QOS			= 1<<13,
 323	BSS_CHANGED_IDLE		= 1<<14,
 324	BSS_CHANGED_SSID		= 1<<15,
 325	BSS_CHANGED_AP_PROBE_RESP	= 1<<16,
 326	BSS_CHANGED_PS			= 1<<17,
 327	BSS_CHANGED_TXPOWER		= 1<<18,
 328	BSS_CHANGED_P2P_PS		= 1<<19,
 329	BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INFO		= 1<<20,
 330	BSS_CHANGED_BANDWIDTH		= 1<<21,
 331	BSS_CHANGED_OCB                 = 1<<22,
 332	BSS_CHANGED_MU_GROUPS		= 1<<23,
 333	BSS_CHANGED_KEEP_ALIVE		= 1<<24,
 334	BSS_CHANGED_MCAST_RATE		= 1<<25,
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 335
 336	/* when adding here, make sure to change ieee80211_reconfig */
 337};
 338
 339/*
 340 * The maximum number of IPv4 addresses listed for ARP filtering. If the number
 341 * of addresses for an interface increase beyond this value, hardware ARP
 342 * filtering will be disabled.
 343 */
 344#define IEEE80211_BSS_ARP_ADDR_LIST_LEN 4
 345
 346/**
 347 * enum ieee80211_event_type - event to be notified to the low level driver
 348 * @RSSI_EVENT: AP's rssi crossed the a threshold set by the driver.
 349 * @MLME_EVENT: event related to MLME
 350 * @BAR_RX_EVENT: a BAR was received
 351 * @BA_FRAME_TIMEOUT: Frames were released from the reordering buffer because
 352 *	they timed out. This won't be called for each frame released, but only
 353 *	once each time the timeout triggers.
 354 */
 355enum ieee80211_event_type {
 356	RSSI_EVENT,
 357	MLME_EVENT,
 358	BAR_RX_EVENT,
 359	BA_FRAME_TIMEOUT,
 360};
 361
 362/**
 363 * enum ieee80211_rssi_event_data - relevant when event type is %RSSI_EVENT
 364 * @RSSI_EVENT_HIGH: AP's rssi went below the threshold set by the driver.
 365 * @RSSI_EVENT_LOW: AP's rssi went above the threshold set by the driver.
 366 */
 367enum ieee80211_rssi_event_data {
 368	RSSI_EVENT_HIGH,
 369	RSSI_EVENT_LOW,
 370};
 371
 372/**
 373 * struct ieee80211_rssi_event - data attached to an %RSSI_EVENT
 374 * @data: See &enum ieee80211_rssi_event_data
 375 */
 376struct ieee80211_rssi_event {
 377	enum ieee80211_rssi_event_data data;
 378};
 379
 380/**
 381 * enum ieee80211_mlme_event_data - relevant when event type is %MLME_EVENT
 382 * @AUTH_EVENT: the MLME operation is authentication
 383 * @ASSOC_EVENT: the MLME operation is association
 384 * @DEAUTH_RX_EVENT: deauth received..
 385 * @DEAUTH_TX_EVENT: deauth sent.
 386 */
 387enum ieee80211_mlme_event_data {
 388	AUTH_EVENT,
 389	ASSOC_EVENT,
 390	DEAUTH_RX_EVENT,
 391	DEAUTH_TX_EVENT,
 392};
 393
 394/**
 395 * enum ieee80211_mlme_event_status - relevant when event type is %MLME_EVENT
 396 * @MLME_SUCCESS: the MLME operation completed successfully.
 397 * @MLME_DENIED: the MLME operation was denied by the peer.
 398 * @MLME_TIMEOUT: the MLME operation timed out.
 399 */
 400enum ieee80211_mlme_event_status {
 401	MLME_SUCCESS,
 402	MLME_DENIED,
 403	MLME_TIMEOUT,
 404};
 405
 406/**
 407 * struct ieee80211_mlme_event - data attached to an %MLME_EVENT
 408 * @data: See &enum ieee80211_mlme_event_data
 409 * @status: See &enum ieee80211_mlme_event_status
 410 * @reason: the reason code if applicable
 411 */
 412struct ieee80211_mlme_event {
 413	enum ieee80211_mlme_event_data data;
 414	enum ieee80211_mlme_event_status status;
 415	u16 reason;
 416};
 417
 418/**
 419 * struct ieee80211_ba_event - data attached for BlockAck related events
 420 * @sta: pointer to the &ieee80211_sta to which this event relates
 421 * @tid: the tid
 422 * @ssn: the starting sequence number (for %BAR_RX_EVENT)
 423 */
 424struct ieee80211_ba_event {
 425	struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
 426	u16 tid;
 427	u16 ssn;
 428};
 429
 430/**
 431 * struct ieee80211_event - event to be sent to the driver
 432 * @type: The event itself. See &enum ieee80211_event_type.
 433 * @rssi: relevant if &type is %RSSI_EVENT
 434 * @mlme: relevant if &type is %AUTH_EVENT
 435 * @ba: relevant if &type is %BAR_RX_EVENT or %BA_FRAME_TIMEOUT
 436 * @u:union holding the fields above
 437 */
 438struct ieee80211_event {
 439	enum ieee80211_event_type type;
 440	union {
 441		struct ieee80211_rssi_event rssi;
 442		struct ieee80211_mlme_event mlme;
 443		struct ieee80211_ba_event ba;
 444	} u;
 445};
 446
 447/**
 448 * struct ieee80211_mu_group_data - STA's VHT MU-MIMO group data
 449 *
 450 * This structure describes the group id data of VHT MU-MIMO
 451 *
 452 * @membership: 64 bits array - a bit is set if station is member of the group
 453 * @position: 2 bits per group id indicating the position in the group
 454 */
 455struct ieee80211_mu_group_data {
 456	u8 membership[WLAN_MEMBERSHIP_LEN];
 457	u8 position[WLAN_USER_POSITION_LEN];
 458};
 459
 460/**
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 461 * struct ieee80211_bss_conf - holds the BSS's changing parameters
 462 *
 463 * This structure keeps information about a BSS (and an association
 464 * to that BSS) that can change during the lifetime of the BSS.
 465 *
 466 * @assoc: association status
 467 * @ibss_joined: indicates whether this station is part of an IBSS
 468 *	or not
 469 * @ibss_creator: indicates if a new IBSS network is being created
 470 * @aid: association ID number, valid only when @assoc is true
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 471 * @use_cts_prot: use CTS protection
 472 * @use_short_preamble: use 802.11b short preamble
 473 * @use_short_slot: use short slot time (only relevant for ERP)
 474 * @dtim_period: num of beacons before the next DTIM, for beaconing,
 475 *	valid in station mode only if after the driver was notified
 476 *	with the %BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INFO flag, will be non-zero then.
 477 * @sync_tsf: last beacon's/probe response's TSF timestamp (could be old
 478 *	as it may have been received during scanning long ago). If the
 479 *	HW flag %IEEE80211_HW_TIMING_BEACON_ONLY is set, then this can
 480 *	only come from a beacon, but might not become valid until after
 481 *	association when a beacon is received (which is notified with the
 482 *	%BSS_CHANGED_DTIM flag.). See also sync_dtim_count important notice.
 483 * @sync_device_ts: the device timestamp corresponding to the sync_tsf,
 484 *	the driver/device can use this to calculate synchronisation
 485 *	(see @sync_tsf). See also sync_dtim_count important notice.
 486 * @sync_dtim_count: Only valid when %IEEE80211_HW_TIMING_BEACON_ONLY
 487 *	is requested, see @sync_tsf/@sync_device_ts.
 488 *	IMPORTANT: These three sync_* parameters would possibly be out of sync
 489 *	by the time the driver will use them. The synchronized view is currently
 490 *	guaranteed only in certain callbacks.
 
 
 491 * @beacon_int: beacon interval
 492 * @assoc_capability: capabilities taken from assoc resp
 493 * @basic_rates: bitmap of basic rates, each bit stands for an
 494 *	index into the rate table configured by the driver in
 495 *	the current band.
 496 * @beacon_rate: associated AP's beacon TX rate
 497 * @mcast_rate: per-band multicast rate index + 1 (0: disabled)
 498 * @bssid: The BSSID for this BSS
 499 * @enable_beacon: whether beaconing should be enabled or not
 500 * @chandef: Channel definition for this BSS -- the hardware might be
 501 *	configured a higher bandwidth than this BSS uses, for example.
 502 * @mu_group: VHT MU-MIMO group membership data
 503 * @ht_operation_mode: HT operation mode like in &struct ieee80211_ht_operation.
 504 *	This field is only valid when the channel is a wide HT/VHT channel.
 505 *	Note that with TDLS this can be the case (channel is HT, protection must
 506 *	be used from this field) even when the BSS association isn't using HT.
 507 * @cqm_rssi_thold: Connection quality monitor RSSI threshold, a zero value
 508 *	implies disabled. As with the cfg80211 callback, a change here should
 509 *	cause an event to be sent indicating where the current value is in
 510 *	relation to the newly configured threshold.
 511 * @cqm_rssi_low: Connection quality monitor RSSI lower threshold, a zero value
 512 *	implies disabled.  This is an alternative mechanism to the single
 513 *	threshold event and can't be enabled simultaneously with it.
 514 * @cqm_rssi_high: Connection quality monitor RSSI upper threshold.
 515 * @cqm_rssi_hyst: Connection quality monitor RSSI hysteresis
 516 * @arp_addr_list: List of IPv4 addresses for hardware ARP filtering. The
 517 *	may filter ARP queries targeted for other addresses than listed here.
 518 *	The driver must allow ARP queries targeted for all address listed here
 519 *	to pass through. An empty list implies no ARP queries need to pass.
 520 * @arp_addr_cnt: Number of addresses currently on the list. Note that this
 521 *	may be larger than %IEEE80211_BSS_ARP_ADDR_LIST_LEN (the arp_addr_list
 522 *	array size), it's up to the driver what to do in that case.
 523 * @qos: This is a QoS-enabled BSS.
 524 * @idle: This interface is idle. There's also a global idle flag in the
 525 *	hardware config which may be more appropriate depending on what
 526 *	your driver/device needs to do.
 527 * @ps: power-save mode (STA only). This flag is NOT affected by
 528 *	offchannel/dynamic_ps operations.
 529 * @ssid: The SSID of the current vif. Valid in AP and IBSS mode.
 530 * @ssid_len: Length of SSID given in @ssid.
 531 * @hidden_ssid: The SSID of the current vif is hidden. Only valid in AP-mode.
 532 * @txpower: TX power in dBm
 533 * @txpower_type: TX power adjustment used to control per packet Transmit
 534 *	Power Control (TPC) in lower driver for the current vif. In particular
 535 *	TPC is enabled if value passed in %txpower_type is
 536 *	NL80211_TX_POWER_LIMITED (allow using less than specified from
 537 *	userspace), whereas TPC is disabled if %txpower_type is set to
 538 *	NL80211_TX_POWER_FIXED (use value configured from userspace)
 539 * @p2p_noa_attr: P2P NoA attribute for P2P powersave
 540 * @allow_p2p_go_ps: indication for AP or P2P GO interface, whether it's allowed
 541 *	to use P2P PS mechanism or not. AP/P2P GO is not allowed to use P2P PS
 542 *	if it has associated clients without P2P PS support.
 543 * @max_idle_period: the time period during which the station can refrain from
 544 *	transmitting frames to its associated AP without being disassociated.
 545 *	In units of 1000 TUs. Zero value indicates that the AP did not include
 546 *	a (valid) BSS Max Idle Period Element.
 547 * @protected_keep_alive: if set, indicates that the station should send an RSN
 548 *	protected frame to the AP to reset the idle timer at the AP for the
 549 *	station.
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 550 */
 551struct ieee80211_bss_conf {
 
 
 552	const u8 *bssid;
 553	/* association related data */
 554	bool assoc, ibss_joined;
 555	bool ibss_creator;
 556	u16 aid;
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 557	/* erp related data */
 558	bool use_cts_prot;
 559	bool use_short_preamble;
 560	bool use_short_slot;
 561	bool enable_beacon;
 562	u8 dtim_period;
 563	u16 beacon_int;
 564	u16 assoc_capability;
 565	u64 sync_tsf;
 566	u32 sync_device_ts;
 567	u8 sync_dtim_count;
 568	u32 basic_rates;
 569	struct ieee80211_rate *beacon_rate;
 570	int mcast_rate[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
 571	u16 ht_operation_mode;
 572	s32 cqm_rssi_thold;
 573	u32 cqm_rssi_hyst;
 574	s32 cqm_rssi_low;
 575	s32 cqm_rssi_high;
 576	struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
 577	struct ieee80211_mu_group_data mu_group;
 578	__be32 arp_addr_list[IEEE80211_BSS_ARP_ADDR_LIST_LEN];
 579	int arp_addr_cnt;
 580	bool qos;
 581	bool idle;
 582	bool ps;
 583	u8 ssid[IEEE80211_MAX_SSID_LEN];
 584	size_t ssid_len;
 585	bool hidden_ssid;
 586	int txpower;
 587	enum nl80211_tx_power_setting txpower_type;
 588	struct ieee80211_p2p_noa_attr p2p_noa_attr;
 589	bool allow_p2p_go_ps;
 590	u16 max_idle_period;
 591	bool protected_keep_alive;
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 592};
 593
 594/**
 595 * enum mac80211_tx_info_flags - flags to describe transmission information/status
 596 *
 597 * These flags are used with the @flags member of &ieee80211_tx_info.
 598 *
 599 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_REQ_TX_STATUS: require TX status callback for this frame.
 600 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_ASSIGN_SEQ: The driver has to assign a sequence
 601 *	number to this frame, taking care of not overwriting the fragment
 602 *	number and increasing the sequence number only when the
 603 *	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_FIRST_FRAGMENT flag is set. mac80211 will properly
 604 *	assign sequence numbers to QoS-data frames but cannot do so correctly
 605 *	for non-QoS-data and management frames because beacons need them from
 606 *	that counter as well and mac80211 cannot guarantee proper sequencing.
 607 *	If this flag is set, the driver should instruct the hardware to
 608 *	assign a sequence number to the frame or assign one itself. Cf. IEEE
 609 *	802.11-2007 7.1.3.4.1 paragraph 3. This flag will always be set for
 610 *	beacons and always be clear for frames without a sequence number field.
 611 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK: tell the low level not to wait for an ack
 612 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_CLEAR_PS_FILT: clear powersave filter for destination
 613 *	station
 614 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_FIRST_FRAGMENT: this is a first fragment of the frame
 615 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_SEND_AFTER_DTIM: send this frame after DTIM beacon
 616 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_AMPDU: this frame should be sent as part of an A-MPDU
 617 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_INJECTED: Frame was injected, internal to mac80211.
 618 * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_TX_FILTERED: The frame was not transmitted
 619 *	because the destination STA was in powersave mode. Note that to
 620 *	avoid race conditions, the filter must be set by the hardware or
 621 *	firmware upon receiving a frame that indicates that the station
 622 *	went to sleep (must be done on device to filter frames already on
 623 *	the queue) and may only be unset after mac80211 gives the OK for
 624 *	that by setting the IEEE80211_TX_CTL_CLEAR_PS_FILT (see above),
 625 *	since only then is it guaranteed that no more frames are in the
 626 *	hardware queue.
 627 * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_ACK: Frame was acknowledged
 628 * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU: The frame was aggregated, so status
 629 * 	is for the whole aggregation.
 630 * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU_NO_BACK: no block ack was returned,
 631 * 	so consider using block ack request (BAR).
 632 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_RATE_CTRL_PROBE: internal to mac80211, can be
 633 *	set by rate control algorithms to indicate probe rate, will
 634 *	be cleared for fragmented frames (except on the last fragment)
 635 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_OFFCHAN_TX_OK: Internal to mac80211. Used to indicate
 636 *	that a frame can be transmitted while the queues are stopped for
 637 *	off-channel operation.
 638 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_NEED_TXPROCESSING: completely internal to mac80211,
 639 *	used to indicate that a pending frame requires TX processing before
 640 *	it can be sent out.
 641 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_RETRIED: completely internal to mac80211,
 642 *	used to indicate that a frame was already retried due to PS
 643 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_DONT_ENCRYPT: completely internal to mac80211,
 644 *	used to indicate frame should not be encrypted
 645 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER: This frame is a response to a poll
 646 *	frame (PS-Poll or uAPSD) or a non-bufferable MMPDU and must
 647 *	be sent although the station is in powersave mode.
 648 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_MORE_FRAMES: More frames will be passed to the
 649 *	transmit function after the current frame, this can be used
 650 *	by drivers to kick the DMA queue only if unset or when the
 651 *	queue gets full.
 652 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_RETRANSMISSION: This frame is being retransmitted
 653 *	after TX status because the destination was asleep, it must not
 654 *	be modified again (no seqno assignment, crypto, etc.)
 655 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_MLME_CONN_TX: This frame was transmitted by the MLME
 656 *	code for connection establishment, this indicates that its status
 657 *	should kick the MLME state machine.
 658 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_NL80211_FRAME_TX: Frame was requested through nl80211
 659 *	MLME command (internal to mac80211 to figure out whether to send TX
 660 *	status to user space)
 661 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_LDPC: tells the driver to use LDPC for this frame
 662 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_STBC: Enables Space-Time Block Coding (STBC) for this
 663 *	frame and selects the maximum number of streams that it can use.
 664 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_TX_OFFCHAN: Marks this packet to be transmitted on
 665 *	the off-channel channel when a remain-on-channel offload is done
 666 *	in hardware -- normal packets still flow and are expected to be
 667 *	handled properly by the device.
 668 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_TKIP_MIC_FAILURE: Marks this packet to be used for TKIP
 669 *	testing. It will be sent out with incorrect Michael MIC key to allow
 670 *	TKIP countermeasures to be tested.
 671 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_CCK_RATE: This frame will be sent at non CCK rate.
 672 *	This flag is actually used for management frame especially for P2P
 673 *	frames not being sent at CCK rate in 2GHz band.
 674 * @IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP: This packet marks the end of service period,
 675 *	when its status is reported the service period ends. For frames in
 676 *	an SP that mac80211 transmits, it is already set; for driver frames
 677 *	the driver may set this flag. It is also used to do the same for
 678 *	PS-Poll responses.
 679 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_USE_MINRATE: This frame will be sent at lowest rate.
 680 *	This flag is used to send nullfunc frame at minimum rate when
 681 *	the nullfunc is used for connection monitoring purpose.
 682 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_DONTFRAG: Don't fragment this packet even if it
 683 *	would be fragmented by size (this is optional, only used for
 684 *	monitor injection).
 685 * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_NOACK_TRANSMITTED: A frame that was marked with
 686 *	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK has been successfully transmitted without
 687 *	any errors (like issues specific to the driver/HW).
 688 *	This flag must not be set for frames that don't request no-ack
 689 *	behaviour with IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK.
 690 *
 691 * Note: If you have to add new flags to the enumeration, then don't
 692 *	 forget to update %IEEE80211_TX_TEMPORARY_FLAGS when necessary.
 693 */
 694enum mac80211_tx_info_flags {
 695	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_REQ_TX_STATUS		= BIT(0),
 696	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_ASSIGN_SEQ		= BIT(1),
 697	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK			= BIT(2),
 698	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_CLEAR_PS_FILT		= BIT(3),
 699	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_FIRST_FRAGMENT		= BIT(4),
 700	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_SEND_AFTER_DTIM	= BIT(5),
 701	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_AMPDU			= BIT(6),
 702	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_INJECTED		= BIT(7),
 703	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_TX_FILTERED		= BIT(8),
 704	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_ACK			= BIT(9),
 705	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU			= BIT(10),
 706	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU_NO_BACK		= BIT(11),
 707	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_RATE_CTRL_PROBE	= BIT(12),
 708	IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_OFFCHAN_TX_OK	= BIT(13),
 709	IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_NEED_TXPROCESSING	= BIT(14),
 710	IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_RETRIED		= BIT(15),
 711	IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_DONT_ENCRYPT		= BIT(16),
 712	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER		= BIT(17),
 713	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_MORE_FRAMES		= BIT(18),
 714	IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_RETRANSMISSION	= BIT(19),
 715	IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_MLME_CONN_TX		= BIT(20),
 716	IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_NL80211_FRAME_TX	= BIT(21),
 717	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_LDPC			= BIT(22),
 718	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_STBC			= BIT(23) | BIT(24),
 719	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_TX_OFFCHAN		= BIT(25),
 720	IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_TKIP_MIC_FAILURE	= BIT(26),
 721	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_CCK_RATE		= BIT(27),
 722	IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP		= BIT(28),
 723	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_USE_MINRATE		= BIT(29),
 724	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_DONTFRAG		= BIT(30),
 725	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_NOACK_TRANSMITTED	= BIT(31),
 726};
 727
 728#define IEEE80211_TX_CTL_STBC_SHIFT		23
 729
 
 
 730/**
 731 * enum mac80211_tx_control_flags - flags to describe transmit control
 732 *
 733 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_PORT_CTRL_PROTO: this frame is a port control
 734 *	protocol frame (e.g. EAP)
 735 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_PS_RESPONSE: This frame is a response to a poll
 736 *	frame (PS-Poll or uAPSD).
 737 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_RATE_INJECT: This frame is injected with rate information
 738 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_AMSDU: This frame is an A-MSDU frame
 739 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_FAST_XMIT: This frame is going through the fast_xmit path
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 740 *
 741 * These flags are used in tx_info->control.flags.
 742 */
 743enum mac80211_tx_control_flags {
 744	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_PORT_CTRL_PROTO	= BIT(0),
 745	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_PS_RESPONSE		= BIT(1),
 746	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_RATE_INJECT		= BIT(2),
 747	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_AMSDU			= BIT(3),
 748	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_FAST_XMIT		= BIT(4),
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 749};
 750
 751/*
 752 * This definition is used as a mask to clear all temporary flags, which are
 753 * set by the tx handlers for each transmission attempt by the mac80211 stack.
 754 */
 755#define IEEE80211_TX_TEMPORARY_FLAGS (IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK |		      \
 756	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_CLEAR_PS_FILT | IEEE80211_TX_CTL_FIRST_FRAGMENT |    \
 757	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_SEND_AFTER_DTIM | IEEE80211_TX_CTL_AMPDU |	      \
 758	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_TX_FILTERED |	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_ACK |		      \
 759	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU | IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU_NO_BACK |	      \
 760	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_RATE_CTRL_PROBE | IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER |    \
 761	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_MORE_FRAMES | IEEE80211_TX_CTL_LDPC |		      \
 762	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_STBC | IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP)
 763
 764/**
 765 * enum mac80211_rate_control_flags - per-rate flags set by the
 766 *	Rate Control algorithm.
 767 *
 768 * These flags are set by the Rate control algorithm for each rate during tx,
 769 * in the @flags member of struct ieee80211_tx_rate.
 770 *
 771 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_RTS_CTS: Use RTS/CTS exchange for this rate.
 772 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_CTS_PROTECT: CTS-to-self protection is required.
 773 *	This is set if the current BSS requires ERP protection.
 774 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_SHORT_PREAMBLE: Use short preamble.
 775 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_MCS: HT rate.
 776 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_VHT_MCS: VHT MCS rate, in this case the idx field is split
 777 *	into a higher 4 bits (Nss) and lower 4 bits (MCS number)
 778 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_GREEN_FIELD: Indicates whether this rate should be used in
 779 *	Greenfield mode.
 780 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_40_MHZ_WIDTH: Indicates if the Channel Width should be 40 MHz.
 781 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_80_MHZ_WIDTH: Indicates 80 MHz transmission
 782 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_160_MHZ_WIDTH: Indicates 160 MHz transmission
 783 *	(80+80 isn't supported yet)
 784 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_DUP_DATA: The frame should be transmitted on both of the
 785 *	adjacent 20 MHz channels, if the current channel type is
 786 *	NL80211_CHAN_HT40MINUS or NL80211_CHAN_HT40PLUS.
 787 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_SHORT_GI: Short Guard interval should be used for this rate.
 788 */
 789enum mac80211_rate_control_flags {
 790	IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_RTS_CTS		= BIT(0),
 791	IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_CTS_PROTECT		= BIT(1),
 792	IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_SHORT_PREAMBLE	= BIT(2),
 793
 794	/* rate index is an HT/VHT MCS instead of an index */
 795	IEEE80211_TX_RC_MCS			= BIT(3),
 796	IEEE80211_TX_RC_GREEN_FIELD		= BIT(4),
 797	IEEE80211_TX_RC_40_MHZ_WIDTH		= BIT(5),
 798	IEEE80211_TX_RC_DUP_DATA		= BIT(6),
 799	IEEE80211_TX_RC_SHORT_GI		= BIT(7),
 800	IEEE80211_TX_RC_VHT_MCS			= BIT(8),
 801	IEEE80211_TX_RC_80_MHZ_WIDTH		= BIT(9),
 802	IEEE80211_TX_RC_160_MHZ_WIDTH		= BIT(10),
 803};
 804
 805
 806/* there are 40 bytes if you don't need the rateset to be kept */
 807#define IEEE80211_TX_INFO_DRIVER_DATA_SIZE 40
 808
 809/* if you do need the rateset, then you have less space */
 810#define IEEE80211_TX_INFO_RATE_DRIVER_DATA_SIZE 24
 811
 812/* maximum number of rate stages */
 813#define IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES	4
 814
 815/* maximum number of rate table entries */
 816#define IEEE80211_TX_RATE_TABLE_SIZE	4
 817
 818/**
 819 * struct ieee80211_tx_rate - rate selection/status
 820 *
 821 * @idx: rate index to attempt to send with
 822 * @flags: rate control flags (&enum mac80211_rate_control_flags)
 823 * @count: number of tries in this rate before going to the next rate
 824 *
 825 * A value of -1 for @idx indicates an invalid rate and, if used
 826 * in an array of retry rates, that no more rates should be tried.
 827 *
 828 * When used for transmit status reporting, the driver should
 829 * always report the rate along with the flags it used.
 830 *
 831 * &struct ieee80211_tx_info contains an array of these structs
 832 * in the control information, and it will be filled by the rate
 833 * control algorithm according to what should be sent. For example,
 834 * if this array contains, in the format { <idx>, <count> } the
 835 * information::
 836 *
 837 *    { 3, 2 }, { 2, 2 }, { 1, 4 }, { -1, 0 }, { -1, 0 }
 838 *
 839 * then this means that the frame should be transmitted
 840 * up to twice at rate 3, up to twice at rate 2, and up to four
 841 * times at rate 1 if it doesn't get acknowledged. Say it gets
 842 * acknowledged by the peer after the fifth attempt, the status
 843 * information should then contain::
 844 *
 845 *   { 3, 2 }, { 2, 2 }, { 1, 1 }, { -1, 0 } ...
 846 *
 847 * since it was transmitted twice at rate 3, twice at rate 2
 848 * and once at rate 1 after which we received an acknowledgement.
 849 */
 850struct ieee80211_tx_rate {
 851	s8 idx;
 852	u16 count:5,
 853	    flags:11;
 854} __packed;
 855
 856#define IEEE80211_MAX_TX_RETRY		31
 857
 
 
 
 
 
 858static inline void ieee80211_rate_set_vht(struct ieee80211_tx_rate *rate,
 859					  u8 mcs, u8 nss)
 860{
 861	WARN_ON(mcs & ~0xF);
 862	WARN_ON((nss - 1) & ~0x7);
 863	rate->idx = ((nss - 1) << 4) | mcs;
 864}
 865
 866static inline u8
 867ieee80211_rate_get_vht_mcs(const struct ieee80211_tx_rate *rate)
 868{
 869	return rate->idx & 0xF;
 870}
 871
 872static inline u8
 873ieee80211_rate_get_vht_nss(const struct ieee80211_tx_rate *rate)
 874{
 875	return (rate->idx >> 4) + 1;
 876}
 877
 878/**
 879 * struct ieee80211_tx_info - skb transmit information
 880 *
 881 * This structure is placed in skb->cb for three uses:
 882 *  (1) mac80211 TX control - mac80211 tells the driver what to do
 883 *  (2) driver internal use (if applicable)
 884 *  (3) TX status information - driver tells mac80211 what happened
 885 *
 886 * @flags: transmit info flags, defined above
 887 * @band: the band to transmit on (use for checking for races)
 
 
 888 * @hw_queue: HW queue to put the frame on, skb_get_queue_mapping() gives the AC
 889 * @ack_frame_id: internal frame ID for TX status, used internally
 890 * @control: union for control data
 891 * @status: union for status data
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 892 * @driver_data: array of driver_data pointers
 893 * @ampdu_ack_len: number of acked aggregated frames.
 894 * 	relevant only if IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU was set.
 895 * @ampdu_len: number of aggregated frames.
 896 * 	relevant only if IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU was set.
 897 * @ack_signal: signal strength of the ACK frame
 898 */
 899struct ieee80211_tx_info {
 900	/* common information */
 901	u32 flags;
 902	u8 band;
 903
 904	u8 hw_queue;
 905
 906	u16 ack_frame_id;
 
 907
 908	union {
 909		struct {
 910			union {
 911				/* rate control */
 912				struct {
 913					struct ieee80211_tx_rate rates[
 914						IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES];
 915					s8 rts_cts_rate_idx;
 916					u8 use_rts:1;
 917					u8 use_cts_prot:1;
 918					u8 short_preamble:1;
 919					u8 skip_table:1;
 920					/* 2 bytes free */
 
 
 
 
 921				};
 922				/* only needed before rate control */
 923				unsigned long jiffies;
 924			};
 925			/* NB: vif can be NULL for injected frames */
 926			struct ieee80211_vif *vif;
 927			struct ieee80211_key_conf *hw_key;
 928			u32 flags;
 929			codel_time_t enqueue_time;
 930		} control;
 931		struct {
 932			u64 cookie;
 933		} ack;
 934		struct {
 935			struct ieee80211_tx_rate rates[IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES];
 936			s32 ack_signal;
 937			u8 ampdu_ack_len;
 938			u8 ampdu_len;
 939			u8 antenna;
 
 940			u16 tx_time;
 941			bool is_valid_ack_signal;
 942			void *status_driver_data[19 / sizeof(void *)];
 
 943		} status;
 944		struct {
 945			struct ieee80211_tx_rate driver_rates[
 946				IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES];
 947			u8 pad[4];
 948
 949			void *rate_driver_data[
 950				IEEE80211_TX_INFO_RATE_DRIVER_DATA_SIZE / sizeof(void *)];
 951		};
 952		void *driver_data[
 953			IEEE80211_TX_INFO_DRIVER_DATA_SIZE / sizeof(void *)];
 954	};
 955};
 956
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 957/**
 958 * struct ieee80211_tx_status - extended tx staus info for rate control
 959 *
 960 * @sta: Station that the packet was transmitted for
 961 * @info: Basic tx status information
 962 * @skb: Packet skb (can be NULL if not provided by the driver)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 963 */
 964struct ieee80211_tx_status {
 965	struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
 966	struct ieee80211_tx_info *info;
 967	struct sk_buff *skb;
 
 
 
 
 
 968};
 969
 970/**
 971 * struct ieee80211_scan_ies - descriptors for different blocks of IEs
 972 *
 973 * This structure is used to point to different blocks of IEs in HW scan
 974 * and scheduled scan. These blocks contain the IEs passed by userspace
 975 * and the ones generated by mac80211.
 976 *
 977 * @ies: pointers to band specific IEs.
 978 * @len: lengths of band_specific IEs.
 979 * @common_ies: IEs for all bands (especially vendor specific ones)
 980 * @common_ie_len: length of the common_ies
 981 */
 982struct ieee80211_scan_ies {
 983	const u8 *ies[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
 984	size_t len[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
 985	const u8 *common_ies;
 986	size_t common_ie_len;
 987};
 988
 989
 990static inline struct ieee80211_tx_info *IEEE80211_SKB_CB(struct sk_buff *skb)
 991{
 992	return (struct ieee80211_tx_info *)skb->cb;
 993}
 994
 995static inline struct ieee80211_rx_status *IEEE80211_SKB_RXCB(struct sk_buff *skb)
 996{
 997	return (struct ieee80211_rx_status *)skb->cb;
 998}
 999
1000/**
1001 * ieee80211_tx_info_clear_status - clear TX status
1002 *
1003 * @info: The &struct ieee80211_tx_info to be cleared.
1004 *
1005 * When the driver passes an skb back to mac80211, it must report
1006 * a number of things in TX status. This function clears everything
1007 * in the TX status but the rate control information (it does clear
1008 * the count since you need to fill that in anyway).
1009 *
1010 * NOTE: You can only use this function if you do NOT use
1011 *	 info->driver_data! Use info->rate_driver_data
1012 *	 instead if you need only the less space that allows.
1013 */
1014static inline void
1015ieee80211_tx_info_clear_status(struct ieee80211_tx_info *info)
1016{
1017	int i;
1018
1019	BUILD_BUG_ON(offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, status.rates) !=
1020		     offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, control.rates));
1021	BUILD_BUG_ON(offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, status.rates) !=
1022		     offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, driver_rates));
1023	BUILD_BUG_ON(offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, status.rates) != 8);
1024	/* clear the rate counts */
1025	for (i = 0; i < IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES; i++)
1026		info->status.rates[i].count = 0;
1027
1028	BUILD_BUG_ON(
1029	    offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, status.ack_signal) != 20);
1030	memset(&info->status.ampdu_ack_len, 0,
1031	       sizeof(struct ieee80211_tx_info) -
1032	       offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, status.ampdu_ack_len));
1033}
1034
1035
1036/**
1037 * enum mac80211_rx_flags - receive flags
1038 *
1039 * These flags are used with the @flag member of &struct ieee80211_rx_status.
1040 * @RX_FLAG_MMIC_ERROR: Michael MIC error was reported on this frame.
1041 *	Use together with %RX_FLAG_MMIC_STRIPPED.
1042 * @RX_FLAG_DECRYPTED: This frame was decrypted in hardware.
1043 * @RX_FLAG_MMIC_STRIPPED: the Michael MIC is stripped off this frame,
1044 *	verification has been done by the hardware.
1045 * @RX_FLAG_IV_STRIPPED: The IV and ICV are stripped from this frame.
1046 *	If this flag is set, the stack cannot do any replay detection
1047 *	hence the driver or hardware will have to do that.
1048 * @RX_FLAG_PN_VALIDATED: Currently only valid for CCMP/GCMP frames, this
1049 *	flag indicates that the PN was verified for replay protection.
1050 *	Note that this flag is also currently only supported when a frame
1051 *	is also decrypted (ie. @RX_FLAG_DECRYPTED must be set)
1052 * @RX_FLAG_DUP_VALIDATED: The driver should set this flag if it did
1053 *	de-duplication by itself.
1054 * @RX_FLAG_FAILED_FCS_CRC: Set this flag if the FCS check failed on
1055 *	the frame.
1056 * @RX_FLAG_FAILED_PLCP_CRC: Set this flag if the PCLP check failed on
1057 *	the frame.
 
 
 
1058 * @RX_FLAG_MACTIME_START: The timestamp passed in the RX status (@mactime
1059 *	field) is valid and contains the time the first symbol of the MPDU
1060 *	was received. This is useful in monitor mode and for proper IBSS
1061 *	merging.
1062 * @RX_FLAG_MACTIME_END: The timestamp passed in the RX status (@mactime
1063 *	field) is valid and contains the time the last symbol of the MPDU
1064 *	(including FCS) was received.
1065 * @RX_FLAG_MACTIME_PLCP_START: The timestamp passed in the RX status (@mactime
1066 *	field) is valid and contains the time the SYNC preamble was received.
 
 
 
 
 
1067 * @RX_FLAG_NO_SIGNAL_VAL: The signal strength value is not present.
1068 *	Valid only for data frames (mainly A-MPDU)
1069 * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DETAILS: A-MPDU details are known, in particular the reference
1070 *	number (@ampdu_reference) must be populated and be a distinct number for
1071 *	each A-MPDU
1072 * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_LAST_KNOWN: last subframe is known, should be set on all
1073 *	subframes of a single A-MPDU
1074 * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_IS_LAST: this subframe is the last subframe of the A-MPDU
1075 * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DELIM_CRC_ERROR: A delimiter CRC error has been detected
1076 *	on this subframe
1077 * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DELIM_CRC_KNOWN: The delimiter CRC field is known (the CRC
1078 *	is stored in the @ampdu_delimiter_crc field)
1079 * @RX_FLAG_MIC_STRIPPED: The mic was stripped of this packet. Decryption was
1080 *	done by the hardware
1081 * @RX_FLAG_ONLY_MONITOR: Report frame only to monitor interfaces without
1082 *	processing it in any regular way.
1083 *	This is useful if drivers offload some frames but still want to report
1084 *	them for sniffing purposes.
1085 * @RX_FLAG_SKIP_MONITOR: Process and report frame to all interfaces except
1086 *	monitor interfaces.
1087 *	This is useful if drivers offload some frames but still want to report
1088 *	them for sniffing purposes.
1089 * @RX_FLAG_AMSDU_MORE: Some drivers may prefer to report separate A-MSDU
1090 *	subframes instead of a one huge frame for performance reasons.
1091 *	All, but the last MSDU from an A-MSDU should have this flag set. E.g.
1092 *	if an A-MSDU has 3 frames, the first 2 must have the flag set, while
1093 *	the 3rd (last) one must not have this flag set. The flag is used to
1094 *	deal with retransmission/duplication recovery properly since A-MSDU
1095 *	subframes share the same sequence number. Reported subframes can be
1096 *	either regular MSDU or singly A-MSDUs. Subframes must not be
1097 *	interleaved with other frames.
1098 * @RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_VENDOR_DATA: This frame contains vendor-specific
1099 *	radiotap data in the skb->data (before the frame) as described by
1100 *	the &struct ieee80211_vendor_radiotap.
 
 
 
1101 * @RX_FLAG_ALLOW_SAME_PN: Allow the same PN as same packet before.
1102 *	This is used for AMSDU subframes which can have the same PN as
1103 *	the first subframe.
1104 * @RX_FLAG_ICV_STRIPPED: The ICV is stripped from this frame. CRC checking must
1105 *	be done in the hardware.
1106 * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_EOF_BIT: Value of the EOF bit in the A-MPDU delimiter for this
1107 *	frame
1108 * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_EOF_BIT_KNOWN: The EOF value is known
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
1109 */
1110enum mac80211_rx_flags {
1111	RX_FLAG_MMIC_ERROR		= BIT(0),
1112	RX_FLAG_DECRYPTED		= BIT(1),
1113	RX_FLAG_MACTIME_PLCP_START	= BIT(2),
1114	RX_FLAG_MMIC_STRIPPED		= BIT(3),
1115	RX_FLAG_IV_STRIPPED		= BIT(4),
1116	RX_FLAG_FAILED_FCS_CRC		= BIT(5),
1117	RX_FLAG_FAILED_PLCP_CRC 	= BIT(6),
1118	RX_FLAG_MACTIME_START		= BIT(7),
1119	RX_FLAG_NO_SIGNAL_VAL		= BIT(8),
1120	RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DETAILS		= BIT(9),
1121	RX_FLAG_PN_VALIDATED		= BIT(10),
1122	RX_FLAG_DUP_VALIDATED		= BIT(11),
1123	RX_FLAG_AMPDU_LAST_KNOWN	= BIT(12),
1124	RX_FLAG_AMPDU_IS_LAST		= BIT(13),
1125	RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DELIM_CRC_ERROR	= BIT(14),
1126	RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DELIM_CRC_KNOWN	= BIT(15),
1127	RX_FLAG_MACTIME_END		= BIT(16),
1128	RX_FLAG_ONLY_MONITOR		= BIT(17),
 
 
1129	RX_FLAG_SKIP_MONITOR		= BIT(18),
1130	RX_FLAG_AMSDU_MORE		= BIT(19),
1131	RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_VENDOR_DATA	= BIT(20),
1132	RX_FLAG_MIC_STRIPPED		= BIT(21),
1133	RX_FLAG_ALLOW_SAME_PN		= BIT(22),
1134	RX_FLAG_ICV_STRIPPED		= BIT(23),
1135	RX_FLAG_AMPDU_EOF_BIT		= BIT(24),
1136	RX_FLAG_AMPDU_EOF_BIT_KNOWN	= BIT(25),
 
 
 
 
 
1137};
1138
1139/**
1140 * enum mac80211_rx_encoding_flags - MCS & bandwidth flags
1141 *
1142 * @RX_ENC_FLAG_SHORTPRE: Short preamble was used for this frame
1143 * @RX_ENC_FLAG_SHORT_GI: Short guard interval was used
1144 * @RX_ENC_FLAG_HT_GF: This frame was received in a HT-greenfield transmission,
1145 *	if the driver fills this value it should add
1146 *	%IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_MCS_HAVE_FMT
1147 *	to hw.radiotap_mcs_details to advertise that fact
1148 * @RX_ENC_FLAG_LDPC: LDPC was used
1149 * @RX_ENC_FLAG_STBC_MASK: STBC 2 bit bitmask. 1 - Nss=1, 2 - Nss=2, 3 - Nss=3
1150 * @RX_ENC_FLAG_BF: packet was beamformed
1151 */
1152enum mac80211_rx_encoding_flags {
1153	RX_ENC_FLAG_SHORTPRE		= BIT(0),
1154	RX_ENC_FLAG_SHORT_GI		= BIT(2),
1155	RX_ENC_FLAG_HT_GF		= BIT(3),
1156	RX_ENC_FLAG_STBC_MASK		= BIT(4) | BIT(5),
1157	RX_ENC_FLAG_LDPC		= BIT(6),
1158	RX_ENC_FLAG_BF			= BIT(7),
1159};
1160
1161#define RX_ENC_FLAG_STBC_SHIFT		4
1162
1163enum mac80211_rx_encoding {
1164	RX_ENC_LEGACY = 0,
1165	RX_ENC_HT,
1166	RX_ENC_VHT,
 
 
1167};
1168
1169/**
1170 * struct ieee80211_rx_status - receive status
1171 *
1172 * The low-level driver should provide this information (the subset
1173 * supported by hardware) to the 802.11 code with each received
1174 * frame, in the skb's control buffer (cb).
1175 *
1176 * @mactime: value in microseconds of the 64-bit Time Synchronization Function
1177 * 	(TSF) timer when the first data symbol (MPDU) arrived at the hardware.
1178 * @boottime_ns: CLOCK_BOOTTIME timestamp the frame was received at, this is
1179 *	needed only for beacons and probe responses that update the scan cache.
 
 
 
1180 * @device_timestamp: arbitrary timestamp for the device, mac80211 doesn't use
1181 *	it but can store it and pass it back to the driver for synchronisation
1182 * @band: the active band when this frame was received
1183 * @freq: frequency the radio was tuned to when receiving this frame, in MHz
1184 *	This field must be set for management frames, but isn't strictly needed
1185 *	for data (other) frames - for those it only affects radiotap reporting.
 
1186 * @signal: signal strength when receiving this frame, either in dBm, in dB or
1187 *	unspecified depending on the hardware capabilities flags
1188 *	@IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_*
1189 * @chains: bitmask of receive chains for which separate signal strength
1190 *	values were filled.
1191 * @chain_signal: per-chain signal strength, in dBm (unlike @signal, doesn't
1192 *	support dB or unspecified units)
1193 * @antenna: antenna used
1194 * @rate_idx: index of data rate into band's supported rates or MCS index if
1195 *	HT or VHT is used (%RX_FLAG_HT/%RX_FLAG_VHT)
1196 * @nss: number of streams (VHT and HE only)
1197 * @flag: %RX_FLAG_\*
1198 * @encoding: &enum mac80211_rx_encoding
1199 * @bw: &enum rate_info_bw
1200 * @enc_flags: uses bits from &enum mac80211_rx_encoding_flags
 
 
 
 
 
 
1201 * @rx_flags: internal RX flags for mac80211
1202 * @ampdu_reference: A-MPDU reference number, must be a different value for
1203 *	each A-MPDU but the same for each subframe within one A-MPDU
1204 * @ampdu_delimiter_crc: A-MPDU delimiter CRC
 
 
 
 
 
1205 */
1206struct ieee80211_rx_status {
1207	u64 mactime;
1208	u64 boottime_ns;
 
 
 
1209	u32 device_timestamp;
1210	u32 ampdu_reference;
1211	u32 flag;
1212	u16 freq;
1213	u8 enc_flags;
1214	u8 encoding:2, bw:3;
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
1215	u8 rate_idx;
1216	u8 nss;
1217	u8 rx_flags;
1218	u8 band;
1219	u8 antenna;
1220	s8 signal;
1221	u8 chains;
1222	s8 chain_signal[IEEE80211_MAX_CHAINS];
1223	u8 ampdu_delimiter_crc;
 
 
1224};
1225
1226/**
1227 * struct ieee80211_vendor_radiotap - vendor radiotap data information
1228 * @present: presence bitmap for this vendor namespace
1229 *	(this could be extended in the future if any vendor needs more
1230 *	 bits, the radiotap spec does allow for that)
1231 * @align: radiotap vendor namespace alignment. This defines the needed
1232 *	alignment for the @data field below, not for the vendor namespace
1233 *	description itself (which has a fixed 2-byte alignment)
1234 *	Must be a power of two, and be set to at least 1!
1235 * @oui: radiotap vendor namespace OUI
1236 * @subns: radiotap vendor sub namespace
1237 * @len: radiotap vendor sub namespace skip length, if alignment is done
1238 *	then that's added to this, i.e. this is only the length of the
1239 *	@data field.
1240 * @pad: number of bytes of padding after the @data, this exists so that
1241 *	the skb data alignment can be preserved even if the data has odd
1242 *	length
1243 * @data: the actual vendor namespace data
1244 *
1245 * This struct, including the vendor data, goes into the skb->data before
1246 * the 802.11 header. It's split up in mac80211 using the align/oui/subns
1247 * data.
1248 */
1249struct ieee80211_vendor_radiotap {
1250	u32 present;
1251	u8 align;
1252	u8 oui[3];
1253	u8 subns;
1254	u8 pad;
1255	u16 len;
1256	u8 data[];
1257} __packed;
1258
1259/**
1260 * enum ieee80211_conf_flags - configuration flags
1261 *
1262 * Flags to define PHY configuration options
1263 *
1264 * @IEEE80211_CONF_MONITOR: there's a monitor interface present -- use this
1265 *	to determine for example whether to calculate timestamps for packets
1266 *	or not, do not use instead of filter flags!
1267 * @IEEE80211_CONF_PS: Enable 802.11 power save mode (managed mode only).
1268 *	This is the power save mode defined by IEEE 802.11-2007 section 11.2,
1269 *	meaning that the hardware still wakes up for beacons, is able to
1270 *	transmit frames and receive the possible acknowledgment frames.
1271 *	Not to be confused with hardware specific wakeup/sleep states,
1272 *	driver is responsible for that. See the section "Powersave support"
1273 *	for more.
1274 * @IEEE80211_CONF_IDLE: The device is running, but idle; if the flag is set
1275 *	the driver should be prepared to handle configuration requests but
1276 *	may turn the device off as much as possible. Typically, this flag will
1277 *	be set when an interface is set UP but not associated or scanning, but
1278 *	it can also be unset in that case when monitor interfaces are active.
1279 * @IEEE80211_CONF_OFFCHANNEL: The device is currently not on its main
1280 *	operating channel.
1281 */
1282enum ieee80211_conf_flags {
1283	IEEE80211_CONF_MONITOR		= (1<<0),
1284	IEEE80211_CONF_PS		= (1<<1),
1285	IEEE80211_CONF_IDLE		= (1<<2),
1286	IEEE80211_CONF_OFFCHANNEL	= (1<<3),
1287};
1288
1289
1290/**
1291 * enum ieee80211_conf_changed - denotes which configuration changed
1292 *
1293 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_LISTEN_INTERVAL: the listen interval changed
1294 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_MONITOR: the monitor flag changed
1295 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_PS: the PS flag or dynamic PS timeout changed
1296 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_POWER: the TX power changed
1297 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_CHANNEL: the channel/channel_type changed
1298 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_RETRY_LIMITS: retry limits changed
1299 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_IDLE: Idle flag changed
1300 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_SMPS: Spatial multiplexing powersave mode changed
1301 *	Note that this is only valid if channel contexts are not used,
1302 *	otherwise each channel context has the number of chains listed.
1303 */
1304enum ieee80211_conf_changed {
1305	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_SMPS		= BIT(1),
1306	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_LISTEN_INTERVAL	= BIT(2),
1307	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_MONITOR		= BIT(3),
1308	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_PS		= BIT(4),
1309	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_POWER		= BIT(5),
1310	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_CHANNEL		= BIT(6),
1311	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_RETRY_LIMITS	= BIT(7),
1312	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_IDLE		= BIT(8),
1313};
1314
1315/**
1316 * enum ieee80211_smps_mode - spatial multiplexing power save mode
1317 *
1318 * @IEEE80211_SMPS_AUTOMATIC: automatic
1319 * @IEEE80211_SMPS_OFF: off
1320 * @IEEE80211_SMPS_STATIC: static
1321 * @IEEE80211_SMPS_DYNAMIC: dynamic
1322 * @IEEE80211_SMPS_NUM_MODES: internal, don't use
1323 */
1324enum ieee80211_smps_mode {
1325	IEEE80211_SMPS_AUTOMATIC,
1326	IEEE80211_SMPS_OFF,
1327	IEEE80211_SMPS_STATIC,
1328	IEEE80211_SMPS_DYNAMIC,
1329
1330	/* keep last */
1331	IEEE80211_SMPS_NUM_MODES,
1332};
1333
1334/**
1335 * struct ieee80211_conf - configuration of the device
1336 *
1337 * This struct indicates how the driver shall configure the hardware.
1338 *
1339 * @flags: configuration flags defined above
1340 *
1341 * @listen_interval: listen interval in units of beacon interval
1342 * @ps_dtim_period: The DTIM period of the AP we're connected to, for use
1343 *	in power saving. Power saving will not be enabled until a beacon
1344 *	has been received and the DTIM period is known.
1345 * @dynamic_ps_timeout: The dynamic powersave timeout (in ms), see the
1346 *	powersave documentation below. This variable is valid only when
1347 *	the CONF_PS flag is set.
1348 *
1349 * @power_level: requested transmit power (in dBm), backward compatibility
1350 *	value only that is set to the minimum of all interfaces
1351 *
1352 * @chandef: the channel definition to tune to
1353 * @radar_enabled: whether radar detection is enabled
1354 *
1355 * @long_frame_max_tx_count: Maximum number of transmissions for a "long" frame
1356 *	(a frame not RTS protected), called "dot11LongRetryLimit" in 802.11,
1357 *	but actually means the number of transmissions not the number of retries
1358 * @short_frame_max_tx_count: Maximum number of transmissions for a "short"
1359 *	frame, called "dot11ShortRetryLimit" in 802.11, but actually means the
1360 *	number of transmissions not the number of retries
1361 *
1362 * @smps_mode: spatial multiplexing powersave mode; note that
1363 *	%IEEE80211_SMPS_STATIC is used when the device is not
1364 *	configured for an HT channel.
1365 *	Note that this is only valid if channel contexts are not used,
1366 *	otherwise each channel context has the number of chains listed.
1367 */
1368struct ieee80211_conf {
1369	u32 flags;
1370	int power_level, dynamic_ps_timeout;
1371
1372	u16 listen_interval;
1373	u8 ps_dtim_period;
1374
1375	u8 long_frame_max_tx_count, short_frame_max_tx_count;
1376
1377	struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
1378	bool radar_enabled;
1379	enum ieee80211_smps_mode smps_mode;
1380};
1381
1382/**
1383 * struct ieee80211_channel_switch - holds the channel switch data
1384 *
1385 * The information provided in this structure is required for channel switch
1386 * operation.
1387 *
1388 * @timestamp: value in microseconds of the 64-bit Time Synchronization
1389 *	Function (TSF) timer when the frame containing the channel switch
1390 *	announcement was received. This is simply the rx.mactime parameter
1391 *	the driver passed into mac80211.
1392 * @device_timestamp: arbitrary timestamp for the device, this is the
1393 *	rx.device_timestamp parameter the driver passed to mac80211.
1394 * @block_tx: Indicates whether transmission must be blocked before the
1395 *	scheduled channel switch, as indicated by the AP.
1396 * @chandef: the new channel to switch to
1397 * @count: the number of TBTT's until the channel switch event
 
 
 
1398 */
1399struct ieee80211_channel_switch {
1400	u64 timestamp;
1401	u32 device_timestamp;
1402	bool block_tx;
1403	struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
1404	u8 count;
 
1405};
1406
1407/**
1408 * enum ieee80211_vif_flags - virtual interface flags
1409 *
1410 * @IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER: the device performs beacon filtering
1411 *	on this virtual interface to avoid unnecessary CPU wakeups
1412 * @IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_CQM_RSSI: the device can do connection quality
1413 *	monitoring on this virtual interface -- i.e. it can monitor
1414 *	connection quality related parameters, such as the RSSI level and
1415 *	provide notifications if configured trigger levels are reached.
1416 * @IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_UAPSD: The device can do U-APSD for this
1417 *	interface. This flag should be set during interface addition,
1418 *	but may be set/cleared as late as authentication to an AP. It is
1419 *	only valid for managed/station mode interfaces.
1420 * @IEEE80211_VIF_GET_NOA_UPDATE: request to handle NOA attributes
1421 *	and send P2P_PS notification to the driver if NOA changed, even
1422 *	this is not pure P2P vif.
 
 
1423 */
1424enum ieee80211_vif_flags {
1425	IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER		= BIT(0),
1426	IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_CQM_RSSI		= BIT(1),
1427	IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_UAPSD		= BIT(2),
1428	IEEE80211_VIF_GET_NOA_UPDATE		= BIT(3),
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
1429};
1430
1431/**
1432 * struct ieee80211_vif - per-interface data
1433 *
1434 * Data in this structure is continually present for driver
1435 * use during the life of a virtual interface.
1436 *
1437 * @type: type of this virtual interface
 
1438 * @bss_conf: BSS configuration for this interface, either our own
1439 *	or the BSS we're associated to
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
1440 * @addr: address of this interface
1441 * @p2p: indicates whether this AP or STA interface is a p2p
1442 *	interface, i.e. a GO or p2p-sta respectively
1443 * @csa_active: marks whether a channel switch is going on. Internally it is
1444 *	write-protected by sdata_lock and local->mtx so holding either is fine
1445 *	for read access.
1446 * @mu_mimo_owner: indicates interface owns MU-MIMO capability
1447 * @driver_flags: flags/capabilities the driver has for this interface,
1448 *	these need to be set (or cleared) when the interface is added
1449 *	or, if supported by the driver, the interface type is changed
1450 *	at runtime, mac80211 will never touch this field
 
 
 
 
 
1451 * @hw_queue: hardware queue for each AC
1452 * @cab_queue: content-after-beacon (DTIM beacon really) queue, AP mode only
1453 * @chanctx_conf: The channel context this interface is assigned to, or %NULL
1454 *	when it is not assigned. This pointer is RCU-protected due to the TX
1455 *	path needing to access it; even though the netdev carrier will always
1456 *	be off when it is %NULL there can still be races and packets could be
1457 *	processed after it switches back to %NULL.
1458 * @debugfs_dir: debugfs dentry, can be used by drivers to create own per
1459 *	interface debug files. Note that it will be NULL for the virtual
1460 *	monitor interface (if that is requested.)
1461 * @probe_req_reg: probe requests should be reported to mac80211 for this
1462 *	interface.
 
 
1463 * @drv_priv: data area for driver use, will always be aligned to
1464 *	sizeof(void \*).
1465 * @txq: the multicast data TX queue (if driver uses the TXQ abstraction)
 
 
 
1466 */
1467struct ieee80211_vif {
1468	enum nl80211_iftype type;
 
1469	struct ieee80211_bss_conf bss_conf;
 
 
1470	u8 addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
1471	bool p2p;
1472	bool csa_active;
1473	bool mu_mimo_owner;
1474
1475	u8 cab_queue;
1476	u8 hw_queue[IEEE80211_NUM_ACS];
1477
1478	struct ieee80211_txq *txq;
1479
1480	struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf __rcu *chanctx_conf;
1481
1482	u32 driver_flags;
 
1483
1484#ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS
1485	struct dentry *debugfs_dir;
1486#endif
1487
1488	unsigned int probe_req_reg;
 
 
 
1489
1490	/* must be last */
1491	u8 drv_priv[0] __aligned(sizeof(void *));
1492};
1493
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
1494static inline bool ieee80211_vif_is_mesh(struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
1495{
1496#ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_MESH
1497	return vif->type == NL80211_IFTYPE_MESH_POINT;
1498#endif
1499	return false;
1500}
1501
1502/**
1503 * wdev_to_ieee80211_vif - return a vif struct from a wdev
1504 * @wdev: the wdev to get the vif for
1505 *
1506 * This can be used by mac80211 drivers with direct cfg80211 APIs
1507 * (like the vendor commands) that get a wdev.
1508 *
1509 * Note that this function may return %NULL if the given wdev isn't
1510 * associated with a vif that the driver knows about (e.g. monitor
1511 * or AP_VLAN interfaces.)
1512 */
1513struct ieee80211_vif *wdev_to_ieee80211_vif(struct wireless_dev *wdev);
1514
1515/**
1516 * ieee80211_vif_to_wdev - return a wdev struct from a vif
1517 * @vif: the vif to get the wdev for
1518 *
1519 * This can be used by mac80211 drivers with direct cfg80211 APIs
1520 * (like the vendor commands) that needs to get the wdev for a vif.
1521 *
1522 * Note that this function may return %NULL if the given wdev isn't
1523 * associated with a vif that the driver knows about (e.g. monitor
1524 * or AP_VLAN interfaces.)
1525 */
1526struct wireless_dev *ieee80211_vif_to_wdev(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
1527
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
1528/**
1529 * enum ieee80211_key_flags - key flags
1530 *
1531 * These flags are used for communication about keys between the driver
1532 * and mac80211, with the @flags parameter of &struct ieee80211_key_conf.
1533 *
1534 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV: This flag should be set by the
1535 *	driver to indicate that it requires IV generation for this
1536 *	particular key. Setting this flag does not necessarily mean that SKBs
1537 *	will have sufficient tailroom for ICV or MIC.
1538 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIC: This flag should be set by
1539 *	the driver for a TKIP key if it requires Michael MIC
1540 *	generation in software.
1541 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PAIRWISE: Set by mac80211, this flag indicates
1542 *	that the key is pairwise rather then a shared key.
1543 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_SW_MGMT_TX: This flag should be set by the driver for a
1544 *	CCMP/GCMP key if it requires CCMP/GCMP encryption of management frames
1545 *	(MFP) to be done in software.
1546 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PUT_IV_SPACE: This flag should be set by the driver
1547 *	if space should be prepared for the IV, but the IV
1548 *	itself should not be generated. Do not set together with
1549 *	@IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV on the same key. Setting this flag does
1550 *	not necessarily mean that SKBs will have sufficient tailroom for ICV or
1551 *	MIC.
1552 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_RX_MGMT: This key will be used to decrypt received
1553 *	management frames. The flag can help drivers that have a hardware
1554 *	crypto implementation that doesn't deal with management frames
1555 *	properly by allowing them to not upload the keys to hardware and
1556 *	fall back to software crypto. Note that this flag deals only with
1557 *	RX, if your crypto engine can't deal with TX you can also set the
1558 *	%IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_SW_MGMT_TX flag to encrypt such frames in SW.
1559 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV_MGMT: This flag should be set by the
1560 *	driver for a CCMP/GCMP key to indicate that is requires IV generation
1561 *	only for managment frames (MFP).
1562 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_RESERVE_TAILROOM: This flag should be set by the
1563 *	driver for a key to indicate that sufficient tailroom must always
1564 *	be reserved for ICV or MIC, even when HW encryption is enabled.
1565 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PUT_MIC_SPACE: This flag should be set by the driver for
1566 *	a TKIP key if it only requires MIC space. Do not set together with
1567 *	@IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIC on the same key.
 
 
 
 
1568 */
1569enum ieee80211_key_flags {
1570	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV_MGMT	= BIT(0),
1571	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV		= BIT(1),
1572	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIC	= BIT(2),
1573	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PAIRWISE		= BIT(3),
1574	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_SW_MGMT_TX		= BIT(4),
1575	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PUT_IV_SPACE		= BIT(5),
1576	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_RX_MGMT		= BIT(6),
1577	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_RESERVE_TAILROOM	= BIT(7),
1578	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PUT_MIC_SPACE	= BIT(8),
 
 
1579};
1580
1581/**
1582 * struct ieee80211_key_conf - key information
1583 *
1584 * This key information is given by mac80211 to the driver by
1585 * the set_key() callback in &struct ieee80211_ops.
1586 *
1587 * @hw_key_idx: To be set by the driver, this is the key index the driver
1588 *	wants to be given when a frame is transmitted and needs to be
1589 *	encrypted in hardware.
1590 * @cipher: The key's cipher suite selector.
1591 * @tx_pn: PN used for TX keys, may be used by the driver as well if it
1592 *	needs to do software PN assignment by itself (e.g. due to TSO)
1593 * @flags: key flags, see &enum ieee80211_key_flags.
1594 * @keyidx: the key index (0-3)
1595 * @keylen: key material length
1596 * @key: key material. For ALG_TKIP the key is encoded as a 256-bit (32 byte)
1597 * 	data block:
1598 * 	- Temporal Encryption Key (128 bits)
1599 * 	- Temporal Authenticator Tx MIC Key (64 bits)
1600 * 	- Temporal Authenticator Rx MIC Key (64 bits)
1601 * @icv_len: The ICV length for this key type
1602 * @iv_len: The IV length for this key type
 
1603 */
1604struct ieee80211_key_conf {
1605	atomic64_t tx_pn;
1606	u32 cipher;
1607	u8 icv_len;
1608	u8 iv_len;
1609	u8 hw_key_idx;
1610	s8 keyidx;
1611	u16 flags;
 
1612	u8 keylen;
1613	u8 key[0];
1614};
1615
1616#define IEEE80211_MAX_PN_LEN	16
1617
1618#define TKIP_PN_TO_IV16(pn) ((u16)(pn & 0xffff))
1619#define TKIP_PN_TO_IV32(pn) ((u32)((pn >> 16) & 0xffffffff))
1620
1621/**
1622 * struct ieee80211_key_seq - key sequence counter
1623 *
1624 * @tkip: TKIP data, containing IV32 and IV16 in host byte order
1625 * @ccmp: PN data, most significant byte first (big endian,
1626 *	reverse order than in packet)
1627 * @aes_cmac: PN data, most significant byte first (big endian,
1628 *	reverse order than in packet)
1629 * @aes_gmac: PN data, most significant byte first (big endian,
1630 *	reverse order than in packet)
1631 * @gcmp: PN data, most significant byte first (big endian,
1632 *	reverse order than in packet)
1633 * @hw: data for HW-only (e.g. cipher scheme) keys
1634 */
1635struct ieee80211_key_seq {
1636	union {
1637		struct {
1638			u32 iv32;
1639			u16 iv16;
1640		} tkip;
1641		struct {
1642			u8 pn[6];
1643		} ccmp;
1644		struct {
1645			u8 pn[6];
1646		} aes_cmac;
1647		struct {
1648			u8 pn[6];
1649		} aes_gmac;
1650		struct {
1651			u8 pn[6];
1652		} gcmp;
1653		struct {
1654			u8 seq[IEEE80211_MAX_PN_LEN];
1655			u8 seq_len;
1656		} hw;
1657	};
1658};
1659
1660/**
1661 * struct ieee80211_cipher_scheme - cipher scheme
1662 *
1663 * This structure contains a cipher scheme information defining
1664 * the secure packet crypto handling.
1665 *
1666 * @cipher: a cipher suite selector
1667 * @iftype: a cipher iftype bit mask indicating an allowed cipher usage
1668 * @hdr_len: a length of a security header used the cipher
1669 * @pn_len: a length of a packet number in the security header
1670 * @pn_off: an offset of pn from the beginning of the security header
1671 * @key_idx_off: an offset of key index byte in the security header
1672 * @key_idx_mask: a bit mask of key_idx bits
1673 * @key_idx_shift: a bit shift needed to get key_idx
1674 *     key_idx value calculation:
1675 *      (sec_header_base[key_idx_off] & key_idx_mask) >> key_idx_shift
1676 * @mic_len: a mic length in bytes
1677 */
1678struct ieee80211_cipher_scheme {
1679	u32 cipher;
1680	u16 iftype;
1681	u8 hdr_len;
1682	u8 pn_len;
1683	u8 pn_off;
1684	u8 key_idx_off;
1685	u8 key_idx_mask;
1686	u8 key_idx_shift;
1687	u8 mic_len;
1688};
1689
1690/**
1691 * enum set_key_cmd - key command
1692 *
1693 * Used with the set_key() callback in &struct ieee80211_ops, this
1694 * indicates whether a key is being removed or added.
1695 *
1696 * @SET_KEY: a key is set
1697 * @DISABLE_KEY: a key must be disabled
1698 */
1699enum set_key_cmd {
1700	SET_KEY, DISABLE_KEY,
1701};
1702
1703/**
1704 * enum ieee80211_sta_state - station state
1705 *
1706 * @IEEE80211_STA_NOTEXIST: station doesn't exist at all,
1707 *	this is a special state for add/remove transitions
1708 * @IEEE80211_STA_NONE: station exists without special state
1709 * @IEEE80211_STA_AUTH: station is authenticated
1710 * @IEEE80211_STA_ASSOC: station is associated
1711 * @IEEE80211_STA_AUTHORIZED: station is authorized (802.1X)
1712 */
1713enum ieee80211_sta_state {
1714	/* NOTE: These need to be ordered correctly! */
1715	IEEE80211_STA_NOTEXIST,
1716	IEEE80211_STA_NONE,
1717	IEEE80211_STA_AUTH,
1718	IEEE80211_STA_ASSOC,
1719	IEEE80211_STA_AUTHORIZED,
1720};
1721
1722/**
1723 * enum ieee80211_sta_rx_bandwidth - station RX bandwidth
1724 * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_20: station can only receive 20 MHz
1725 * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_40: station can receive up to 40 MHz
1726 * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_80: station can receive up to 80 MHz
1727 * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_160: station can receive up to 160 MHz
1728 *	(including 80+80 MHz)
 
1729 *
1730 * Implementation note: 20 must be zero to be initialized
1731 *	correctly, the values must be sorted.
1732 */
1733enum ieee80211_sta_rx_bandwidth {
1734	IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_20 = 0,
1735	IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_40,
1736	IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_80,
1737	IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_160,
 
1738};
1739
1740/**
1741 * struct ieee80211_sta_rates - station rate selection table
1742 *
1743 * @rcu_head: RCU head used for freeing the table on update
1744 * @rate: transmit rates/flags to be used by default.
1745 *	Overriding entries per-packet is possible by using cb tx control.
1746 */
1747struct ieee80211_sta_rates {
1748	struct rcu_head rcu_head;
1749	struct {
1750		s8 idx;
1751		u8 count;
1752		u8 count_cts;
1753		u8 count_rts;
1754		u16 flags;
1755	} rate[IEEE80211_TX_RATE_TABLE_SIZE];
1756};
1757
1758/**
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
1759 * struct ieee80211_sta - station table entry
1760 *
1761 * A station table entry represents a station we are possibly
1762 * communicating with. Since stations are RCU-managed in
1763 * mac80211, any ieee80211_sta pointer you get access to must
1764 * either be protected by rcu_read_lock() explicitly or implicitly,
1765 * or you must take good care to not use such a pointer after a
1766 * call to your sta_remove callback that removed it.
 
 
1767 *
1768 * @addr: MAC address
1769 * @aid: AID we assigned to the station if we're an AP
1770 * @supp_rates: Bitmap of supported rates (per band)
1771 * @ht_cap: HT capabilities of this STA; restricted to our own capabilities
1772 * @vht_cap: VHT capabilities of this STA; restricted to our own capabilities
1773 * @max_rx_aggregation_subframes: maximal amount of frames in a single AMPDU
1774 *	that this station is allowed to transmit to us.
1775 *	Can be modified by driver.
1776 * @wme: indicates whether the STA supports QoS/WME (if local devices does,
1777 *	otherwise always false)
1778 * @drv_priv: data area for driver use, will always be aligned to
1779 *	sizeof(void \*), size is determined in hw information.
1780 * @uapsd_queues: bitmap of queues configured for uapsd. Only valid
1781 *	if wme is supported. The bits order is like in
1782 *	IEEE80211_WMM_IE_STA_QOSINFO_AC_*.
1783 * @max_sp: max Service Period. Only valid if wme is supported.
1784 * @bandwidth: current bandwidth the station can receive with
1785 * @rx_nss: in HT/VHT, the maximum number of spatial streams the
1786 *	station can receive at the moment, changed by operating mode
1787 *	notifications and capabilities. The value is only valid after
1788 *	the station moves to associated state.
1789 * @smps_mode: current SMPS mode (off, static or dynamic)
1790 * @rates: rate control selection table
1791 * @tdls: indicates whether the STA is a TDLS peer
1792 * @tdls_initiator: indicates the STA is an initiator of the TDLS link. Only
1793 *	valid if the STA is a TDLS peer in the first place.
1794 * @mfp: indicates whether the STA uses management frame protection or not.
 
1795 * @max_amsdu_subframes: indicates the maximal number of MSDUs in a single
1796 *	A-MSDU. Taken from the Extended Capabilities element. 0 means
1797 *	unlimited.
 
 
 
1798 * @support_p2p_ps: indicates whether the STA supports P2P PS mechanism or not.
1799 * @max_rc_amsdu_len: Maximum A-MSDU size in bytes recommended by rate control.
1800 * @txq: per-TID data TX queues (if driver uses the TXQ abstraction)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
1801 */
1802struct ieee80211_sta {
1803	u32 supp_rates[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
1804	u8 addr[ETH_ALEN];
1805	u16 aid;
1806	struct ieee80211_sta_ht_cap ht_cap;
1807	struct ieee80211_sta_vht_cap vht_cap;
1808	u8 max_rx_aggregation_subframes;
1809	bool wme;
1810	u8 uapsd_queues;
1811	u8 max_sp;
1812	u8 rx_nss;
1813	enum ieee80211_sta_rx_bandwidth bandwidth;
1814	enum ieee80211_smps_mode smps_mode;
1815	struct ieee80211_sta_rates __rcu *rates;
1816	bool tdls;
1817	bool tdls_initiator;
1818	bool mfp;
 
1819	u8 max_amsdu_subframes;
1820
1821	/**
1822	 * @max_amsdu_len:
1823	 * indicates the maximal length of an A-MSDU in bytes.
1824	 * This field is always valid for packets with a VHT preamble.
1825	 * For packets with a HT preamble, additional limits apply:
1826	 *
1827	 * * If the skb is transmitted as part of a BA agreement, the
1828	 *   A-MSDU maximal size is min(max_amsdu_len, 4065) bytes.
1829	 * * If the skb is not part of a BA aggreement, the A-MSDU maximal
1830	 *   size is min(max_amsdu_len, 7935) bytes.
1831	 *
1832	 * Both additional HT limits must be enforced by the low level
1833	 * driver. This is defined by the spec (IEEE 802.11-2012 section
1834	 * 8.3.2.2 NOTE 2).
1835	 */
1836	u16 max_amsdu_len;
1837	bool support_p2p_ps;
1838	u16 max_rc_amsdu_len;
1839
1840	struct ieee80211_txq *txq[IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS];
 
 
 
 
1841
1842	/* must be last */
1843	u8 drv_priv[0] __aligned(sizeof(void *));
1844};
1845
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
1846/**
1847 * enum sta_notify_cmd - sta notify command
1848 *
1849 * Used with the sta_notify() callback in &struct ieee80211_ops, this
1850 * indicates if an associated station made a power state transition.
1851 *
1852 * @STA_NOTIFY_SLEEP: a station is now sleeping
1853 * @STA_NOTIFY_AWAKE: a sleeping station woke up
1854 */
1855enum sta_notify_cmd {
1856	STA_NOTIFY_SLEEP, STA_NOTIFY_AWAKE,
1857};
1858
1859/**
1860 * struct ieee80211_tx_control - TX control data
1861 *
1862 * @sta: station table entry, this sta pointer may be NULL and
1863 * 	it is not allowed to copy the pointer, due to RCU.
1864 */
1865struct ieee80211_tx_control {
1866	struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
1867};
1868
1869/**
1870 * struct ieee80211_txq - Software intermediate tx queue
1871 *
1872 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
1873 * @sta: station table entry, %NULL for per-vif queue
1874 * @tid: the TID for this queue (unused for per-vif queue)
 
1875 * @ac: the AC for this queue
1876 * @drv_priv: driver private area, sized by hw->txq_data_size
1877 *
1878 * The driver can obtain packets from this queue by calling
1879 * ieee80211_tx_dequeue().
1880 */
1881struct ieee80211_txq {
1882	struct ieee80211_vif *vif;
1883	struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
1884	u8 tid;
1885	u8 ac;
1886
1887	/* must be last */
1888	u8 drv_priv[0] __aligned(sizeof(void *));
1889};
1890
1891/**
1892 * enum ieee80211_hw_flags - hardware flags
1893 *
1894 * These flags are used to indicate hardware capabilities to
1895 * the stack. Generally, flags here should have their meaning
1896 * done in a way that the simplest hardware doesn't need setting
1897 * any particular flags. There are some exceptions to this rule,
1898 * however, so you are advised to review these flags carefully.
1899 *
1900 * @IEEE80211_HW_HAS_RATE_CONTROL:
1901 *	The hardware or firmware includes rate control, and cannot be
1902 *	controlled by the stack. As such, no rate control algorithm
1903 *	should be instantiated, and the TX rate reported to userspace
1904 *	will be taken from the TX status instead of the rate control
1905 *	algorithm.
1906 *	Note that this requires that the driver implement a number of
1907 *	callbacks so it has the correct information, it needs to have
1908 *	the @set_rts_threshold callback and must look at the BSS config
1909 *	@use_cts_prot for G/N protection, @use_short_slot for slot
1910 *	timing in 2.4 GHz and @use_short_preamble for preambles for
1911 *	CCK frames.
1912 *
1913 * @IEEE80211_HW_RX_INCLUDES_FCS:
1914 *	Indicates that received frames passed to the stack include
1915 *	the FCS at the end.
1916 *
1917 * @IEEE80211_HW_HOST_BROADCAST_PS_BUFFERING:
1918 *	Some wireless LAN chipsets buffer broadcast/multicast frames
1919 *	for power saving stations in the hardware/firmware and others
1920 *	rely on the host system for such buffering. This option is used
1921 *	to configure the IEEE 802.11 upper layer to buffer broadcast and
1922 *	multicast frames when there are power saving stations so that
1923 *	the driver can fetch them with ieee80211_get_buffered_bc().
1924 *
1925 * @IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_UNSPEC:
1926 *	Hardware can provide signal values but we don't know its units. We
1927 *	expect values between 0 and @max_signal.
1928 *	If possible please provide dB or dBm instead.
1929 *
1930 * @IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_DBM:
1931 *	Hardware gives signal values in dBm, decibel difference from
1932 *	one milliwatt. This is the preferred method since it is standardized
1933 *	between different devices. @max_signal does not need to be set.
1934 *
1935 * @IEEE80211_HW_SPECTRUM_MGMT:
1936 * 	Hardware supports spectrum management defined in 802.11h
1937 * 	Measurement, Channel Switch, Quieting, TPC
1938 *
1939 * @IEEE80211_HW_AMPDU_AGGREGATION:
1940 *	Hardware supports 11n A-MPDU aggregation.
1941 *
1942 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS:
1943 *	Hardware has power save support (i.e. can go to sleep).
1944 *
1945 * @IEEE80211_HW_PS_NULLFUNC_STACK:
1946 *	Hardware requires nullfunc frame handling in stack, implies
1947 *	stack support for dynamic PS.
1948 *
1949 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_DYNAMIC_PS:
1950 *	Hardware has support for dynamic PS.
1951 *
1952 * @IEEE80211_HW_MFP_CAPABLE:
1953 *	Hardware supports management frame protection (MFP, IEEE 802.11w).
1954 *
1955 * @IEEE80211_HW_REPORTS_TX_ACK_STATUS:
1956 *	Hardware can provide ack status reports of Tx frames to
1957 *	the stack.
1958 *
1959 * @IEEE80211_HW_CONNECTION_MONITOR:
1960 *	The hardware performs its own connection monitoring, including
1961 *	periodic keep-alives to the AP and probing the AP on beacon loss.
1962 *
1963 * @IEEE80211_HW_NEED_DTIM_BEFORE_ASSOC:
1964 *	This device needs to get data from beacon before association (i.e.
1965 *	dtim_period).
1966 *
1967 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PER_STA_GTK: The device's crypto engine supports
1968 *	per-station GTKs as used by IBSS RSN or during fast transition. If
1969 *	the device doesn't support per-station GTKs, but can be asked not
1970 *	to decrypt group addressed frames, then IBSS RSN support is still
1971 *	possible but software crypto will be used. Advertise the wiphy flag
1972 *	only in that case.
1973 *
1974 * @IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS: When operating in AP mode the device
1975 *	autonomously manages the PS status of connected stations. When
1976 *	this flag is set mac80211 will not trigger PS mode for connected
1977 *	stations based on the PM bit of incoming frames.
1978 *	Use ieee80211_start_ps()/ieee8021_end_ps() to manually configure
1979 *	the PS mode of connected stations.
1980 *
1981 * @IEEE80211_HW_TX_AMPDU_SETUP_IN_HW: The device handles TX A-MPDU session
1982 *	setup strictly in HW. mac80211 should not attempt to do this in
1983 *	software.
1984 *
1985 * @IEEE80211_HW_WANT_MONITOR_VIF: The driver would like to be informed of
1986 *	a virtual monitor interface when monitor interfaces are the only
1987 *	active interfaces.
1988 *
1989 * @IEEE80211_HW_NO_AUTO_VIF: The driver would like for no wlanX to
1990 *	be created.  It is expected user-space will create vifs as
1991 *	desired (and thus have them named as desired).
1992 *
1993 * @IEEE80211_HW_SW_CRYPTO_CONTROL: The driver wants to control which of the
1994 *	crypto algorithms can be done in software - so don't automatically
1995 *	try to fall back to it if hardware crypto fails, but do so only if
1996 *	the driver returns 1. This also forces the driver to advertise its
1997 *	supported cipher suites.
1998 *
1999 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORT_FAST_XMIT: The driver/hardware supports fast-xmit,
2000 *	this currently requires only the ability to calculate the duration
2001 *	for frames.
2002 *
2003 * @IEEE80211_HW_QUEUE_CONTROL: The driver wants to control per-interface
2004 *	queue mapping in order to use different queues (not just one per AC)
2005 *	for different virtual interfaces. See the doc section on HW queue
2006 *	control for more details.
2007 *
2008 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_RC_TABLE: The driver supports using a rate
2009 *	selection table provided by the rate control algorithm.
2010 *
2011 * @IEEE80211_HW_P2P_DEV_ADDR_FOR_INTF: Use the P2P Device address for any
2012 *	P2P Interface. This will be honoured even if more than one interface
2013 *	is supported.
2014 *
2015 * @IEEE80211_HW_TIMING_BEACON_ONLY: Use sync timing from beacon frames
2016 *	only, to allow getting TBTT of a DTIM beacon.
2017 *
2018 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_HT_CCK_RATES: Hardware supports mixing HT/CCK rates
2019 *	and can cope with CCK rates in an aggregation session (e.g. by not
2020 *	using aggregation for such frames.)
2021 *
2022 * @IEEE80211_HW_CHANCTX_STA_CSA: Support 802.11h based channel-switch (CSA)
2023 *	for a single active channel while using channel contexts. When support
2024 *	is not enabled the default action is to disconnect when getting the
2025 *	CSA frame.
2026 *
2027 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_CLONED_SKBS: The driver will never modify the payload
2028 *	or tailroom of TX skbs without copying them first.
2029 *
2030 * @IEEE80211_HW_SINGLE_SCAN_ON_ALL_BANDS: The HW supports scanning on all bands
2031 *	in one command, mac80211 doesn't have to run separate scans per band.
2032 *
2033 * @IEEE80211_HW_TDLS_WIDER_BW: The device/driver supports wider bandwidth
2034 *	than then BSS bandwidth for a TDLS link on the base channel.
2035 *
2036 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_AMSDU_IN_AMPDU: The driver supports receiving A-MSDUs
2037 *	within A-MPDU.
2038 *
2039 * @IEEE80211_HW_BEACON_TX_STATUS: The device/driver provides TX status
2040 *	for sent beacons.
2041 *
2042 * @IEEE80211_HW_NEEDS_UNIQUE_STA_ADDR: Hardware (or driver) requires that each
2043 *	station has a unique address, i.e. each station entry can be identified
2044 *	by just its MAC address; this prevents, for example, the same station
2045 *	from connecting to two virtual AP interfaces at the same time.
2046 *
2047 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_REORDERING_BUFFER: Hardware (or driver) manages the
2048 *	reordering buffer internally, guaranteeing mac80211 receives frames in
2049 *	order and does not need to manage its own reorder buffer or BA session
2050 *	timeout.
2051 *
2052 * @IEEE80211_HW_USES_RSS: The device uses RSS and thus requires parallel RX,
2053 *	which implies using per-CPU station statistics.
2054 *
2055 * @IEEE80211_HW_TX_AMSDU: Hardware (or driver) supports software aggregated
2056 *	A-MSDU frames. Requires software tx queueing and fast-xmit support.
2057 *	When not using minstrel/minstrel_ht rate control, the driver must
2058 *	limit the maximum A-MSDU size based on the current tx rate by setting
2059 *	max_rc_amsdu_len in struct ieee80211_sta.
2060 *
2061 * @IEEE80211_HW_TX_FRAG_LIST: Hardware (or driver) supports sending frag_list
2062 *	skbs, needed for zero-copy software A-MSDU.
2063 *
2064 * @IEEE80211_HW_REPORTS_LOW_ACK: The driver (or firmware) reports low ack event
2065 *	by ieee80211_report_low_ack() based on its own algorithm. For such
2066 *	drivers, mac80211 packet loss mechanism will not be triggered and driver
2067 *	is completely depending on firmware event for station kickout.
2068 *
2069 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TX_FRAG: Hardware does fragmentation by itself.
2070 *	The stack will not do fragmentation.
2071 *	The callback for @set_frag_threshold should be set as well.
2072 *
2073 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TDLS_BUFFER_STA: Hardware supports buffer STA on
2074 *	TDLS links.
2075 *
2076 * @IEEE80211_HW_DEAUTH_NEED_MGD_TX_PREP: The driver requires the
2077 *	mgd_prepare_tx() callback to be called before transmission of a
2078 *	deauthentication frame in case the association was completed but no
2079 *	beacon was heard. This is required in multi-channel scenarios, where the
2080 *	virtual interface might not be given air time for the transmission of
2081 *	the frame, as it is not synced with the AP/P2P GO yet, and thus the
2082 *	deauthentication frame might not be transmitted.
2083 *
2084 * @IEEE80211_HW_DOESNT_SUPPORT_QOS_NDP: The driver (or firmware) doesn't
2085 *	support QoS NDP for AP probing - that's most likely a driver bug.
2086 *
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
2087 * @NUM_IEEE80211_HW_FLAGS: number of hardware flags, used for sizing arrays
2088 */
2089enum ieee80211_hw_flags {
2090	IEEE80211_HW_HAS_RATE_CONTROL,
2091	IEEE80211_HW_RX_INCLUDES_FCS,
2092	IEEE80211_HW_HOST_BROADCAST_PS_BUFFERING,
2093	IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_UNSPEC,
2094	IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_DBM,
2095	IEEE80211_HW_NEED_DTIM_BEFORE_ASSOC,
2096	IEEE80211_HW_SPECTRUM_MGMT,
2097	IEEE80211_HW_AMPDU_AGGREGATION,
2098	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS,
2099	IEEE80211_HW_PS_NULLFUNC_STACK,
2100	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_DYNAMIC_PS,
2101	IEEE80211_HW_MFP_CAPABLE,
2102	IEEE80211_HW_WANT_MONITOR_VIF,
2103	IEEE80211_HW_NO_AUTO_VIF,
2104	IEEE80211_HW_SW_CRYPTO_CONTROL,
2105	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORT_FAST_XMIT,
2106	IEEE80211_HW_REPORTS_TX_ACK_STATUS,
2107	IEEE80211_HW_CONNECTION_MONITOR,
2108	IEEE80211_HW_QUEUE_CONTROL,
2109	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PER_STA_GTK,
2110	IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS,
2111	IEEE80211_HW_TX_AMPDU_SETUP_IN_HW,
2112	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_RC_TABLE,
2113	IEEE80211_HW_P2P_DEV_ADDR_FOR_INTF,
2114	IEEE80211_HW_TIMING_BEACON_ONLY,
2115	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_HT_CCK_RATES,
2116	IEEE80211_HW_CHANCTX_STA_CSA,
2117	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_CLONED_SKBS,
2118	IEEE80211_HW_SINGLE_SCAN_ON_ALL_BANDS,
2119	IEEE80211_HW_TDLS_WIDER_BW,
2120	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_AMSDU_IN_AMPDU,
2121	IEEE80211_HW_BEACON_TX_STATUS,
2122	IEEE80211_HW_NEEDS_UNIQUE_STA_ADDR,
2123	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_REORDERING_BUFFER,
2124	IEEE80211_HW_USES_RSS,
2125	IEEE80211_HW_TX_AMSDU,
2126	IEEE80211_HW_TX_FRAG_LIST,
2127	IEEE80211_HW_REPORTS_LOW_ACK,
2128	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TX_FRAG,
2129	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TDLS_BUFFER_STA,
2130	IEEE80211_HW_DEAUTH_NEED_MGD_TX_PREP,
2131	IEEE80211_HW_DOESNT_SUPPORT_QOS_NDP,
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
2132
2133	/* keep last, obviously */
2134	NUM_IEEE80211_HW_FLAGS
2135};
2136
2137/**
2138 * struct ieee80211_hw - hardware information and state
2139 *
2140 * This structure contains the configuration and hardware
2141 * information for an 802.11 PHY.
2142 *
2143 * @wiphy: This points to the &struct wiphy allocated for this
2144 *	802.11 PHY. You must fill in the @perm_addr and @dev
2145 *	members of this structure using SET_IEEE80211_DEV()
2146 *	and SET_IEEE80211_PERM_ADDR(). Additionally, all supported
2147 *	bands (with channels, bitrates) are registered here.
2148 *
2149 * @conf: &struct ieee80211_conf, device configuration, don't use.
2150 *
2151 * @priv: pointer to private area that was allocated for driver use
2152 *	along with this structure.
2153 *
2154 * @flags: hardware flags, see &enum ieee80211_hw_flags.
2155 *
2156 * @extra_tx_headroom: headroom to reserve in each transmit skb
2157 *	for use by the driver (e.g. for transmit headers.)
2158 *
2159 * @extra_beacon_tailroom: tailroom to reserve in each beacon tx skb.
2160 *	Can be used by drivers to add extra IEs.
2161 *
2162 * @max_signal: Maximum value for signal (rssi) in RX information, used
2163 *	only when @IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_UNSPEC or @IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_DB
2164 *
2165 * @max_listen_interval: max listen interval in units of beacon interval
2166 *	that HW supports
2167 *
2168 * @queues: number of available hardware transmit queues for
2169 *	data packets. WMM/QoS requires at least four, these
2170 *	queues need to have configurable access parameters.
2171 *
2172 * @rate_control_algorithm: rate control algorithm for this hardware.
2173 *	If unset (NULL), the default algorithm will be used. Must be
2174 *	set before calling ieee80211_register_hw().
2175 *
2176 * @vif_data_size: size (in bytes) of the drv_priv data area
2177 *	within &struct ieee80211_vif.
2178 * @sta_data_size: size (in bytes) of the drv_priv data area
2179 *	within &struct ieee80211_sta.
2180 * @chanctx_data_size: size (in bytes) of the drv_priv data area
2181 *	within &struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf.
2182 * @txq_data_size: size (in bytes) of the drv_priv data area
2183 *	within @struct ieee80211_txq.
2184 *
2185 * @max_rates: maximum number of alternate rate retry stages the hw
2186 *	can handle.
2187 * @max_report_rates: maximum number of alternate rate retry stages
2188 *	the hw can report back.
2189 * @max_rate_tries: maximum number of tries for each stage
2190 *
2191 * @max_rx_aggregation_subframes: maximum buffer size (number of
2192 *	sub-frames) to be used for A-MPDU block ack receiver
2193 *	aggregation.
2194 *	This is only relevant if the device has restrictions on the
2195 *	number of subframes, if it relies on mac80211 to do reordering
2196 *	it shouldn't be set.
2197 *
2198 * @max_tx_aggregation_subframes: maximum number of subframes in an
2199 *	aggregate an HT driver will transmit. Though ADDBA will advertise
2200 *	a constant value of 64 as some older APs can crash if the window
2201 *	size is smaller (an example is LinkSys WRT120N with FW v1.0.07
2202 *	build 002 Jun 18 2012).
 
2203 *
2204 * @max_tx_fragments: maximum number of tx buffers per (A)-MSDU, sum
2205 *	of 1 + skb_shinfo(skb)->nr_frags for each skb in the frag_list.
2206 *
2207 * @offchannel_tx_hw_queue: HW queue ID to use for offchannel TX
2208 *	(if %IEEE80211_HW_QUEUE_CONTROL is set)
2209 *
2210 * @radiotap_mcs_details: lists which MCS information can the HW
2211 *	reports, by default it is set to _MCS, _GI and _BW but doesn't
2212 *	include _FMT. Use %IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_MCS_HAVE_\* values, only
2213 *	adding _BW is supported today.
2214 *
2215 * @radiotap_vht_details: lists which VHT MCS information the HW reports,
2216 *	the default is _GI | _BANDWIDTH.
2217 *	Use the %IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_VHT_KNOWN_\* values.
2218 *
2219 * @radiotap_timestamp: Information for the radiotap timestamp field; if the
2220 *	'units_pos' member is set to a non-negative value it must be set to
2221 *	a combination of a IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_TIMESTAMP_UNIT_* and a
2222 *	IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_TIMESTAMP_SPOS_* value, and then the timestamp
2223 *	field will be added and populated from the &struct ieee80211_rx_status
2224 *	device_timestamp. If the 'accuracy' member is non-negative, it's put
2225 *	into the accuracy radiotap field and the accuracy known flag is set.
 
 
 
 
2226 *
2227 * @netdev_features: netdev features to be set in each netdev created
2228 *	from this HW. Note that not all features are usable with mac80211,
2229 *	other features will be rejected during HW registration.
2230 *
2231 * @uapsd_queues: This bitmap is included in (re)association frame to indicate
2232 *	for each access category if it is uAPSD trigger-enabled and delivery-
2233 *	enabled. Use IEEE80211_WMM_IE_STA_QOSINFO_AC_* to set this bitmap.
2234 *	Each bit corresponds to different AC. Value '1' in specific bit means
2235 *	that corresponding AC is both trigger- and delivery-enabled. '0' means
2236 *	neither enabled.
2237 *
2238 * @uapsd_max_sp_len: maximum number of total buffered frames the WMM AP may
2239 *	deliver to a WMM STA during any Service Period triggered by the WMM STA.
2240 *	Use IEEE80211_WMM_IE_STA_QOSINFO_SP_* for correct values.
2241 *
2242 * @n_cipher_schemes: a size of an array of cipher schemes definitions.
2243 * @cipher_schemes: a pointer to an array of cipher scheme definitions
2244 *	supported by HW.
2245 * @max_nan_de_entries: maximum number of NAN DE functions supported by the
2246 *	device.
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
2247 */
2248struct ieee80211_hw {
2249	struct ieee80211_conf conf;
2250	struct wiphy *wiphy;
2251	const char *rate_control_algorithm;
2252	void *priv;
2253	unsigned long flags[BITS_TO_LONGS(NUM_IEEE80211_HW_FLAGS)];
2254	unsigned int extra_tx_headroom;
2255	unsigned int extra_beacon_tailroom;
2256	int vif_data_size;
2257	int sta_data_size;
2258	int chanctx_data_size;
2259	int txq_data_size;
2260	u16 queues;
2261	u16 max_listen_interval;
2262	s8 max_signal;
2263	u8 max_rates;
2264	u8 max_report_rates;
2265	u8 max_rate_tries;
2266	u8 max_rx_aggregation_subframes;
2267	u8 max_tx_aggregation_subframes;
2268	u8 max_tx_fragments;
2269	u8 offchannel_tx_hw_queue;
2270	u8 radiotap_mcs_details;
2271	u16 radiotap_vht_details;
2272	struct {
2273		int units_pos;
2274		s16 accuracy;
2275	} radiotap_timestamp;
2276	netdev_features_t netdev_features;
2277	u8 uapsd_queues;
2278	u8 uapsd_max_sp_len;
2279	u8 n_cipher_schemes;
2280	const struct ieee80211_cipher_scheme *cipher_schemes;
2281	u8 max_nan_de_entries;
 
 
 
 
 
2282};
2283
2284static inline bool _ieee80211_hw_check(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
2285				       enum ieee80211_hw_flags flg)
2286{
2287	return test_bit(flg, hw->flags);
2288}
2289#define ieee80211_hw_check(hw, flg)	_ieee80211_hw_check(hw, IEEE80211_HW_##flg)
2290
2291static inline void _ieee80211_hw_set(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
2292				     enum ieee80211_hw_flags flg)
2293{
2294	return __set_bit(flg, hw->flags);
2295}
2296#define ieee80211_hw_set(hw, flg)	_ieee80211_hw_set(hw, IEEE80211_HW_##flg)
2297
2298/**
2299 * struct ieee80211_scan_request - hw scan request
2300 *
2301 * @ies: pointers different parts of IEs (in req.ie)
2302 * @req: cfg80211 request.
2303 */
2304struct ieee80211_scan_request {
2305	struct ieee80211_scan_ies ies;
2306
2307	/* Keep last */
2308	struct cfg80211_scan_request req;
2309};
2310
2311/**
2312 * struct ieee80211_tdls_ch_sw_params - TDLS channel switch parameters
2313 *
2314 * @sta: peer this TDLS channel-switch request/response came from
2315 * @chandef: channel referenced in a TDLS channel-switch request
2316 * @action_code: see &enum ieee80211_tdls_actioncode
2317 * @status: channel-switch response status
2318 * @timestamp: time at which the frame was received
2319 * @switch_time: switch-timing parameter received in the frame
2320 * @switch_timeout: switch-timing parameter received in the frame
2321 * @tmpl_skb: TDLS switch-channel response template
2322 * @ch_sw_tm_ie: offset of the channel-switch timing IE inside @tmpl_skb
2323 */
2324struct ieee80211_tdls_ch_sw_params {
2325	struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
2326	struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef;
2327	u8 action_code;
2328	u32 status;
2329	u32 timestamp;
2330	u16 switch_time;
2331	u16 switch_timeout;
2332	struct sk_buff *tmpl_skb;
2333	u32 ch_sw_tm_ie;
2334};
2335
2336/**
2337 * wiphy_to_ieee80211_hw - return a mac80211 driver hw struct from a wiphy
2338 *
2339 * @wiphy: the &struct wiphy which we want to query
2340 *
2341 * mac80211 drivers can use this to get to their respective
2342 * &struct ieee80211_hw. Drivers wishing to get to their own private
2343 * structure can then access it via hw->priv. Note that mac802111 drivers should
2344 * not use wiphy_priv() to try to get their private driver structure as this
2345 * is already used internally by mac80211.
2346 *
2347 * Return: The mac80211 driver hw struct of @wiphy.
2348 */
2349struct ieee80211_hw *wiphy_to_ieee80211_hw(struct wiphy *wiphy);
2350
2351/**
2352 * SET_IEEE80211_DEV - set device for 802.11 hardware
2353 *
2354 * @hw: the &struct ieee80211_hw to set the device for
2355 * @dev: the &struct device of this 802.11 device
2356 */
2357static inline void SET_IEEE80211_DEV(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct device *dev)
2358{
2359	set_wiphy_dev(hw->wiphy, dev);
2360}
2361
2362/**
2363 * SET_IEEE80211_PERM_ADDR - set the permanent MAC address for 802.11 hardware
2364 *
2365 * @hw: the &struct ieee80211_hw to set the MAC address for
2366 * @addr: the address to set
2367 */
2368static inline void SET_IEEE80211_PERM_ADDR(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, const u8 *addr)
2369{
2370	memcpy(hw->wiphy->perm_addr, addr, ETH_ALEN);
2371}
2372
2373static inline struct ieee80211_rate *
2374ieee80211_get_tx_rate(const struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
2375		      const struct ieee80211_tx_info *c)
2376{
2377	if (WARN_ON_ONCE(c->control.rates[0].idx < 0))
2378		return NULL;
2379	return &hw->wiphy->bands[c->band]->bitrates[c->control.rates[0].idx];
2380}
2381
2382static inline struct ieee80211_rate *
2383ieee80211_get_rts_cts_rate(const struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
2384			   const struct ieee80211_tx_info *c)
2385{
2386	if (c->control.rts_cts_rate_idx < 0)
2387		return NULL;
2388	return &hw->wiphy->bands[c->band]->bitrates[c->control.rts_cts_rate_idx];
2389}
2390
2391static inline struct ieee80211_rate *
2392ieee80211_get_alt_retry_rate(const struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
2393			     const struct ieee80211_tx_info *c, int idx)
2394{
2395	if (c->control.rates[idx + 1].idx < 0)
2396		return NULL;
2397	return &hw->wiphy->bands[c->band]->bitrates[c->control.rates[idx + 1].idx];
2398}
2399
2400/**
2401 * ieee80211_free_txskb - free TX skb
2402 * @hw: the hardware
2403 * @skb: the skb
2404 *
2405 * Free a transmit skb. Use this funtion when some failure
2406 * to transmit happened and thus status cannot be reported.
2407 */
2408void ieee80211_free_txskb(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct sk_buff *skb);
2409
2410/**
2411 * DOC: Hardware crypto acceleration
2412 *
2413 * mac80211 is capable of taking advantage of many hardware
2414 * acceleration designs for encryption and decryption operations.
2415 *
2416 * The set_key() callback in the &struct ieee80211_ops for a given
2417 * device is called to enable hardware acceleration of encryption and
2418 * decryption. The callback takes a @sta parameter that will be NULL
2419 * for default keys or keys used for transmission only, or point to
2420 * the station information for the peer for individual keys.
2421 * Multiple transmission keys with the same key index may be used when
2422 * VLANs are configured for an access point.
2423 *
2424 * When transmitting, the TX control data will use the @hw_key_idx
2425 * selected by the driver by modifying the &struct ieee80211_key_conf
2426 * pointed to by the @key parameter to the set_key() function.
2427 *
2428 * The set_key() call for the %SET_KEY command should return 0 if
2429 * the key is now in use, -%EOPNOTSUPP or -%ENOSPC if it couldn't be
2430 * added; if you return 0 then hw_key_idx must be assigned to the
2431 * hardware key index, you are free to use the full u8 range.
2432 *
2433 * Note that in the case that the @IEEE80211_HW_SW_CRYPTO_CONTROL flag is
2434 * set, mac80211 will not automatically fall back to software crypto if
2435 * enabling hardware crypto failed. The set_key() call may also return the
2436 * value 1 to permit this specific key/algorithm to be done in software.
2437 *
2438 * When the cmd is %DISABLE_KEY then it must succeed.
2439 *
2440 * Note that it is permissible to not decrypt a frame even if a key
2441 * for it has been uploaded to hardware, the stack will not make any
2442 * decision based on whether a key has been uploaded or not but rather
2443 * based on the receive flags.
2444 *
2445 * The &struct ieee80211_key_conf structure pointed to by the @key
2446 * parameter is guaranteed to be valid until another call to set_key()
2447 * removes it, but it can only be used as a cookie to differentiate
2448 * keys.
2449 *
2450 * In TKIP some HW need to be provided a phase 1 key, for RX decryption
2451 * acceleration (i.e. iwlwifi). Those drivers should provide update_tkip_key
2452 * handler.
2453 * The update_tkip_key() call updates the driver with the new phase 1 key.
2454 * This happens every time the iv16 wraps around (every 65536 packets). The
2455 * set_key() call will happen only once for each key (unless the AP did
2456 * rekeying), it will not include a valid phase 1 key. The valid phase 1 key is
2457 * provided by update_tkip_key only. The trigger that makes mac80211 call this
2458 * handler is software decryption with wrap around of iv16.
2459 *
2460 * The set_default_unicast_key() call updates the default WEP key index
2461 * configured to the hardware for WEP encryption type. This is required
2462 * for devices that support offload of data packets (e.g. ARP responses).
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
2463 */
2464
2465/**
2466 * DOC: Powersave support
2467 *
2468 * mac80211 has support for various powersave implementations.
2469 *
2470 * First, it can support hardware that handles all powersaving by itself,
2471 * such hardware should simply set the %IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS hardware
2472 * flag. In that case, it will be told about the desired powersave mode
2473 * with the %IEEE80211_CONF_PS flag depending on the association status.
2474 * The hardware must take care of sending nullfunc frames when necessary,
2475 * i.e. when entering and leaving powersave mode. The hardware is required
2476 * to look at the AID in beacons and signal to the AP that it woke up when
2477 * it finds traffic directed to it.
2478 *
2479 * %IEEE80211_CONF_PS flag enabled means that the powersave mode defined in
2480 * IEEE 802.11-2007 section 11.2 is enabled. This is not to be confused
2481 * with hardware wakeup and sleep states. Driver is responsible for waking
2482 * up the hardware before issuing commands to the hardware and putting it
2483 * back to sleep at appropriate times.
2484 *
2485 * When PS is enabled, hardware needs to wakeup for beacons and receive the
2486 * buffered multicast/broadcast frames after the beacon. Also it must be
2487 * possible to send frames and receive the acknowledment frame.
2488 *
2489 * Other hardware designs cannot send nullfunc frames by themselves and also
2490 * need software support for parsing the TIM bitmap. This is also supported
2491 * by mac80211 by combining the %IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS and
2492 * %IEEE80211_HW_PS_NULLFUNC_STACK flags. The hardware is of course still
2493 * required to pass up beacons. The hardware is still required to handle
2494 * waking up for multicast traffic; if it cannot the driver must handle that
2495 * as best as it can, mac80211 is too slow to do that.
2496 *
2497 * Dynamic powersave is an extension to normal powersave in which the
2498 * hardware stays awake for a user-specified period of time after sending a
2499 * frame so that reply frames need not be buffered and therefore delayed to
2500 * the next wakeup. It's compromise of getting good enough latency when
2501 * there's data traffic and still saving significantly power in idle
2502 * periods.
2503 *
2504 * Dynamic powersave is simply supported by mac80211 enabling and disabling
2505 * PS based on traffic. Driver needs to only set %IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS
2506 * flag and mac80211 will handle everything automatically. Additionally,
2507 * hardware having support for the dynamic PS feature may set the
2508 * %IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_DYNAMIC_PS flag to indicate that it can support
2509 * dynamic PS mode itself. The driver needs to look at the
2510 * @dynamic_ps_timeout hardware configuration value and use it that value
2511 * whenever %IEEE80211_CONF_PS is set. In this case mac80211 will disable
2512 * dynamic PS feature in stack and will just keep %IEEE80211_CONF_PS
2513 * enabled whenever user has enabled powersave.
2514 *
2515 * Driver informs U-APSD client support by enabling
2516 * %IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_UAPSD flag. The mode is configured through the
2517 * uapsd parameter in conf_tx() operation. Hardware needs to send the QoS
2518 * Nullfunc frames and stay awake until the service period has ended. To
2519 * utilize U-APSD, dynamic powersave is disabled for voip AC and all frames
2520 * from that AC are transmitted with powersave enabled.
2521 *
2522 * Note: U-APSD client mode is not yet supported with
2523 * %IEEE80211_HW_PS_NULLFUNC_STACK.
2524 */
2525
2526/**
2527 * DOC: Beacon filter support
2528 *
2529 * Some hardware have beacon filter support to reduce host cpu wakeups
2530 * which will reduce system power consumption. It usually works so that
2531 * the firmware creates a checksum of the beacon but omits all constantly
2532 * changing elements (TSF, TIM etc). Whenever the checksum changes the
2533 * beacon is forwarded to the host, otherwise it will be just dropped. That
2534 * way the host will only receive beacons where some relevant information
2535 * (for example ERP protection or WMM settings) have changed.
2536 *
2537 * Beacon filter support is advertised with the %IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER
2538 * interface capability. The driver needs to enable beacon filter support
2539 * whenever power save is enabled, that is %IEEE80211_CONF_PS is set. When
2540 * power save is enabled, the stack will not check for beacon loss and the
2541 * driver needs to notify about loss of beacons with ieee80211_beacon_loss().
2542 *
2543 * The time (or number of beacons missed) until the firmware notifies the
2544 * driver of a beacon loss event (which in turn causes the driver to call
2545 * ieee80211_beacon_loss()) should be configurable and will be controlled
2546 * by mac80211 and the roaming algorithm in the future.
2547 *
2548 * Since there may be constantly changing information elements that nothing
2549 * in the software stack cares about, we will, in the future, have mac80211
2550 * tell the driver which information elements are interesting in the sense
2551 * that we want to see changes in them. This will include
2552 *
2553 *  - a list of information element IDs
2554 *  - a list of OUIs for the vendor information element
2555 *
2556 * Ideally, the hardware would filter out any beacons without changes in the
2557 * requested elements, but if it cannot support that it may, at the expense
2558 * of some efficiency, filter out only a subset. For example, if the device
2559 * doesn't support checking for OUIs it should pass up all changes in all
2560 * vendor information elements.
2561 *
2562 * Note that change, for the sake of simplification, also includes information
2563 * elements appearing or disappearing from the beacon.
2564 *
2565 * Some hardware supports an "ignore list" instead, just make sure nothing
2566 * that was requested is on the ignore list, and include commonly changing
2567 * information element IDs in the ignore list, for example 11 (BSS load) and
2568 * the various vendor-assigned IEs with unknown contents (128, 129, 133-136,
2569 * 149, 150, 155, 156, 173, 176, 178, 179, 219); for forward compatibility
2570 * it could also include some currently unused IDs.
2571 *
2572 *
2573 * In addition to these capabilities, hardware should support notifying the
2574 * host of changes in the beacon RSSI. This is relevant to implement roaming
2575 * when no traffic is flowing (when traffic is flowing we see the RSSI of
2576 * the received data packets). This can consist in notifying the host when
2577 * the RSSI changes significantly or when it drops below or rises above
2578 * configurable thresholds. In the future these thresholds will also be
2579 * configured by mac80211 (which gets them from userspace) to implement
2580 * them as the roaming algorithm requires.
2581 *
2582 * If the hardware cannot implement this, the driver should ask it to
2583 * periodically pass beacon frames to the host so that software can do the
2584 * signal strength threshold checking.
2585 */
2586
2587/**
2588 * DOC: Spatial multiplexing power save
2589 *
2590 * SMPS (Spatial multiplexing power save) is a mechanism to conserve
2591 * power in an 802.11n implementation. For details on the mechanism
2592 * and rationale, please refer to 802.11 (as amended by 802.11n-2009)
2593 * "11.2.3 SM power save".
2594 *
2595 * The mac80211 implementation is capable of sending action frames
2596 * to update the AP about the station's SMPS mode, and will instruct
2597 * the driver to enter the specific mode. It will also announce the
2598 * requested SMPS mode during the association handshake. Hardware
2599 * support for this feature is required, and can be indicated by
2600 * hardware flags.
2601 *
2602 * The default mode will be "automatic", which nl80211/cfg80211
2603 * defines to be dynamic SMPS in (regular) powersave, and SMPS
2604 * turned off otherwise.
2605 *
2606 * To support this feature, the driver must set the appropriate
2607 * hardware support flags, and handle the SMPS flag to the config()
2608 * operation. It will then with this mechanism be instructed to
2609 * enter the requested SMPS mode while associated to an HT AP.
2610 */
2611
2612/**
2613 * DOC: Frame filtering
2614 *
2615 * mac80211 requires to see many management frames for proper
2616 * operation, and users may want to see many more frames when
2617 * in monitor mode. However, for best CPU usage and power consumption,
2618 * having as few frames as possible percolate through the stack is
2619 * desirable. Hence, the hardware should filter as much as possible.
2620 *
2621 * To achieve this, mac80211 uses filter flags (see below) to tell
2622 * the driver's configure_filter() function which frames should be
2623 * passed to mac80211 and which should be filtered out.
2624 *
2625 * Before configure_filter() is invoked, the prepare_multicast()
2626 * callback is invoked with the parameters @mc_count and @mc_list
2627 * for the combined multicast address list of all virtual interfaces.
2628 * It's use is optional, and it returns a u64 that is passed to
2629 * configure_filter(). Additionally, configure_filter() has the
2630 * arguments @changed_flags telling which flags were changed and
2631 * @total_flags with the new flag states.
2632 *
2633 * If your device has no multicast address filters your driver will
2634 * need to check both the %FIF_ALLMULTI flag and the @mc_count
2635 * parameter to see whether multicast frames should be accepted
2636 * or dropped.
2637 *
2638 * All unsupported flags in @total_flags must be cleared.
2639 * Hardware does not support a flag if it is incapable of _passing_
2640 * the frame to the stack. Otherwise the driver must ignore
2641 * the flag, but not clear it.
2642 * You must _only_ clear the flag (announce no support for the
2643 * flag to mac80211) if you are not able to pass the packet type
2644 * to the stack (so the hardware always filters it).
2645 * So for example, you should clear @FIF_CONTROL, if your hardware
2646 * always filters control frames. If your hardware always passes
2647 * control frames to the kernel and is incapable of filtering them,
2648 * you do _not_ clear the @FIF_CONTROL flag.
2649 * This rule applies to all other FIF flags as well.
2650 */
2651
2652/**
2653 * DOC: AP support for powersaving clients
2654 *
2655 * In order to implement AP and P2P GO modes, mac80211 has support for
2656 * client powersaving, both "legacy" PS (PS-Poll/null data) and uAPSD.
2657 * There currently is no support for sAPSD.
2658 *
2659 * There is one assumption that mac80211 makes, namely that a client
2660 * will not poll with PS-Poll and trigger with uAPSD at the same time.
2661 * Both are supported, and both can be used by the same client, but
2662 * they can't be used concurrently by the same client. This simplifies
2663 * the driver code.
2664 *
2665 * The first thing to keep in mind is that there is a flag for complete
2666 * driver implementation: %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS. If this flag is set,
2667 * mac80211 expects the driver to handle most of the state machine for
2668 * powersaving clients and will ignore the PM bit in incoming frames.
2669 * Drivers then use ieee80211_sta_ps_transition() to inform mac80211 of
2670 * stations' powersave transitions. In this mode, mac80211 also doesn't
2671 * handle PS-Poll/uAPSD.
2672 *
2673 * In the mode without %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS, mac80211 will check the
2674 * PM bit in incoming frames for client powersave transitions. When a
2675 * station goes to sleep, we will stop transmitting to it. There is,
2676 * however, a race condition: a station might go to sleep while there is
2677 * data buffered on hardware queues. If the device has support for this
2678 * it will reject frames, and the driver should give the frames back to
2679 * mac80211 with the %IEEE80211_TX_STAT_TX_FILTERED flag set which will
2680 * cause mac80211 to retry the frame when the station wakes up. The
2681 * driver is also notified of powersave transitions by calling its
2682 * @sta_notify callback.
2683 *
2684 * When the station is asleep, it has three choices: it can wake up,
2685 * it can PS-Poll, or it can possibly start a uAPSD service period.
2686 * Waking up is implemented by simply transmitting all buffered (and
2687 * filtered) frames to the station. This is the easiest case. When
2688 * the station sends a PS-Poll or a uAPSD trigger frame, mac80211
2689 * will inform the driver of this with the @allow_buffered_frames
2690 * callback; this callback is optional. mac80211 will then transmit
2691 * the frames as usual and set the %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER
2692 * on each frame. The last frame in the service period (or the only
2693 * response to a PS-Poll) also has %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP set to
2694 * indicate that it ends the service period; as this frame must have
2695 * TX status report it also sets %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_REQ_TX_STATUS.
2696 * When TX status is reported for this frame, the service period is
2697 * marked has having ended and a new one can be started by the peer.
2698 *
2699 * Additionally, non-bufferable MMPDUs can also be transmitted by
2700 * mac80211 with the %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER set in them.
2701 *
2702 * Another race condition can happen on some devices like iwlwifi
2703 * when there are frames queued for the station and it wakes up
2704 * or polls; the frames that are already queued could end up being
2705 * transmitted first instead, causing reordering and/or wrong
2706 * processing of the EOSP. The cause is that allowing frames to be
2707 * transmitted to a certain station is out-of-band communication to
2708 * the device. To allow this problem to be solved, the driver can
2709 * call ieee80211_sta_block_awake() if frames are buffered when it
2710 * is notified that the station went to sleep. When all these frames
2711 * have been filtered (see above), it must call the function again
2712 * to indicate that the station is no longer blocked.
2713 *
2714 * If the driver buffers frames in the driver for aggregation in any
2715 * way, it must use the ieee80211_sta_set_buffered() call when it is
2716 * notified of the station going to sleep to inform mac80211 of any
2717 * TIDs that have frames buffered. Note that when a station wakes up
2718 * this information is reset (hence the requirement to call it when
2719 * informed of the station going to sleep). Then, when a service
2720 * period starts for any reason, @release_buffered_frames is called
2721 * with the number of frames to be released and which TIDs they are
2722 * to come from. In this case, the driver is responsible for setting
2723 * the EOSP (for uAPSD) and MORE_DATA bits in the released frames,
2724 * to help the @more_data parameter is passed to tell the driver if
2725 * there is more data on other TIDs -- the TIDs to release frames
2726 * from are ignored since mac80211 doesn't know how many frames the
2727 * buffers for those TIDs contain.
2728 *
2729 * If the driver also implement GO mode, where absence periods may
2730 * shorten service periods (or abort PS-Poll responses), it must
2731 * filter those response frames except in the case of frames that
2732 * are buffered in the driver -- those must remain buffered to avoid
2733 * reordering. Because it is possible that no frames are released
2734 * in this case, the driver must call ieee80211_sta_eosp()
2735 * to indicate to mac80211 that the service period ended anyway.
2736 *
2737 * Finally, if frames from multiple TIDs are released from mac80211
2738 * but the driver might reorder them, it must clear & set the flags
2739 * appropriately (only the last frame may have %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP)
2740 * and also take care of the EOSP and MORE_DATA bits in the frame.
2741 * The driver may also use ieee80211_sta_eosp() in this case.
2742 *
2743 * Note that if the driver ever buffers frames other than QoS-data
2744 * frames, it must take care to never send a non-QoS-data frame as
2745 * the last frame in a service period, adding a QoS-nulldata frame
2746 * after a non-QoS-data frame if needed.
2747 */
2748
2749/**
2750 * DOC: HW queue control
2751 *
2752 * Before HW queue control was introduced, mac80211 only had a single static
2753 * assignment of per-interface AC software queues to hardware queues. This
2754 * was problematic for a few reasons:
2755 * 1) off-channel transmissions might get stuck behind other frames
2756 * 2) multiple virtual interfaces couldn't be handled correctly
2757 * 3) after-DTIM frames could get stuck behind other frames
2758 *
2759 * To solve this, hardware typically uses multiple different queues for all
2760 * the different usages, and this needs to be propagated into mac80211 so it
2761 * won't have the same problem with the software queues.
2762 *
2763 * Therefore, mac80211 now offers the %IEEE80211_HW_QUEUE_CONTROL capability
2764 * flag that tells it that the driver implements its own queue control. To do
2765 * so, the driver will set up the various queues in each &struct ieee80211_vif
2766 * and the offchannel queue in &struct ieee80211_hw. In response, mac80211 will
2767 * use those queue IDs in the hw_queue field of &struct ieee80211_tx_info and
2768 * if necessary will queue the frame on the right software queue that mirrors
2769 * the hardware queue.
2770 * Additionally, the driver has to then use these HW queue IDs for the queue
2771 * management functions (ieee80211_stop_queue() et al.)
2772 *
2773 * The driver is free to set up the queue mappings as needed, multiple virtual
2774 * interfaces may map to the same hardware queues if needed. The setup has to
2775 * happen during add_interface or change_interface callbacks. For example, a
2776 * driver supporting station+station and station+AP modes might decide to have
2777 * 10 hardware queues to handle different scenarios:
2778 *
2779 * 4 AC HW queues for 1st vif: 0, 1, 2, 3
2780 * 4 AC HW queues for 2nd vif: 4, 5, 6, 7
2781 * after-DTIM queue for AP:   8
2782 * off-channel queue:         9
2783 *
2784 * It would then set up the hardware like this:
2785 *   hw.offchannel_tx_hw_queue = 9
2786 *
2787 * and the first virtual interface that is added as follows:
2788 *   vif.hw_queue[IEEE80211_AC_VO] = 0
2789 *   vif.hw_queue[IEEE80211_AC_VI] = 1
2790 *   vif.hw_queue[IEEE80211_AC_BE] = 2
2791 *   vif.hw_queue[IEEE80211_AC_BK] = 3
2792 *   vif.cab_queue = 8 // if AP mode, otherwise %IEEE80211_INVAL_HW_QUEUE
2793 * and the second virtual interface with 4-7.
2794 *
2795 * If queue 6 gets full, for example, mac80211 would only stop the second
2796 * virtual interface's BE queue since virtual interface queues are per AC.
2797 *
2798 * Note that the vif.cab_queue value should be set to %IEEE80211_INVAL_HW_QUEUE
2799 * whenever the queue is not used (i.e. the interface is not in AP mode) if the
2800 * queue could potentially be shared since mac80211 will look at cab_queue when
2801 * a queue is stopped/woken even if the interface is not in AP mode.
2802 */
2803
2804/**
2805 * enum ieee80211_filter_flags - hardware filter flags
2806 *
2807 * These flags determine what the filter in hardware should be
2808 * programmed to let through and what should not be passed to the
2809 * stack. It is always safe to pass more frames than requested,
2810 * but this has negative impact on power consumption.
2811 *
2812 * @FIF_ALLMULTI: pass all multicast frames, this is used if requested
2813 *	by the user or if the hardware is not capable of filtering by
2814 *	multicast address.
2815 *
2816 * @FIF_FCSFAIL: pass frames with failed FCS (but you need to set the
2817 *	%RX_FLAG_FAILED_FCS_CRC for them)
2818 *
2819 * @FIF_PLCPFAIL: pass frames with failed PLCP CRC (but you need to set
2820 *	the %RX_FLAG_FAILED_PLCP_CRC for them
2821 *
2822 * @FIF_BCN_PRBRESP_PROMISC: This flag is set during scanning to indicate
2823 *	to the hardware that it should not filter beacons or probe responses
2824 *	by BSSID. Filtering them can greatly reduce the amount of processing
2825 *	mac80211 needs to do and the amount of CPU wakeups, so you should
2826 *	honour this flag if possible.
2827 *
2828 * @FIF_CONTROL: pass control frames (except for PS Poll) addressed to this
2829 *	station
2830 *
2831 * @FIF_OTHER_BSS: pass frames destined to other BSSes
2832 *
2833 * @FIF_PSPOLL: pass PS Poll frames
2834 *
2835 * @FIF_PROBE_REQ: pass probe request frames
 
 
2836 */
2837enum ieee80211_filter_flags {
2838	FIF_ALLMULTI		= 1<<1,
2839	FIF_FCSFAIL		= 1<<2,
2840	FIF_PLCPFAIL		= 1<<3,
2841	FIF_BCN_PRBRESP_PROMISC	= 1<<4,
2842	FIF_CONTROL		= 1<<5,
2843	FIF_OTHER_BSS		= 1<<6,
2844	FIF_PSPOLL		= 1<<7,
2845	FIF_PROBE_REQ		= 1<<8,
 
2846};
2847
2848/**
2849 * enum ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action - A-MPDU actions
2850 *
2851 * These flags are used with the ampdu_action() callback in
2852 * &struct ieee80211_ops to indicate which action is needed.
2853 *
2854 * Note that drivers MUST be able to deal with a TX aggregation
2855 * session being stopped even before they OK'ed starting it by
2856 * calling ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe, because the peer
2857 * might receive the addBA frame and send a delBA right away!
2858 *
2859 * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START: start RX aggregation
2860 * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_STOP: stop RX aggregation
2861 * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START: start TX aggregation
 
 
 
 
 
2862 * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL: TX aggregation has become operational
2863 * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_CONT: stop TX aggregation but continue transmitting
2864 *	queued packets, now unaggregated. After all packets are transmitted the
2865 *	driver has to call ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe().
2866 * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_FLUSH: stop TX aggregation and flush all packets,
2867 *	called when the station is removed. There's no need or reason to call
2868 *	ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe() in this case as mac80211 assumes the
2869 *	session is gone and removes the station.
2870 * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_FLUSH_CONT: called when TX aggregation is stopped
2871 *	but the driver hasn't called ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe() yet and
2872 *	now the connection is dropped and the station will be removed. Drivers
2873 *	should clean up and drop remaining packets when this is called.
2874 */
2875enum ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action {
2876	IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START,
2877	IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_STOP,
2878	IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START,
2879	IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_CONT,
2880	IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_FLUSH,
2881	IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_FLUSH_CONT,
2882	IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL,
2883};
2884
 
 
 
2885/**
2886 * struct ieee80211_ampdu_params - AMPDU action parameters
2887 *
2888 * @action: the ampdu action, value from %ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action.
2889 * @sta: peer of this AMPDU session
2890 * @tid: tid of the BA session
2891 * @ssn: start sequence number of the session. TX/RX_STOP can pass 0. When
2892 *	action is set to %IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START the driver passes back the
2893 *	actual ssn value used to start the session and writes the value here.
2894 * @buf_size: reorder buffer size  (number of subframes). Valid only when the
2895 *	action is set to %IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START or
2896 *	%IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL
2897 * @amsdu: indicates the peer's ability to receive A-MSDU within A-MPDU.
2898 *	valid when the action is set to %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL
2899 * @timeout: BA session timeout. Valid only when the action is set to
2900 *	%IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START
2901 */
2902struct ieee80211_ampdu_params {
2903	enum ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action action;
2904	struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
2905	u16 tid;
2906	u16 ssn;
2907	u8 buf_size;
2908	bool amsdu;
2909	u16 timeout;
2910};
2911
2912/**
2913 * enum ieee80211_frame_release_type - frame release reason
2914 * @IEEE80211_FRAME_RELEASE_PSPOLL: frame released for PS-Poll
2915 * @IEEE80211_FRAME_RELEASE_UAPSD: frame(s) released due to
2916 *	frame received on trigger-enabled AC
2917 */
2918enum ieee80211_frame_release_type {
2919	IEEE80211_FRAME_RELEASE_PSPOLL,
2920	IEEE80211_FRAME_RELEASE_UAPSD,
2921};
2922
2923/**
2924 * enum ieee80211_rate_control_changed - flags to indicate what changed
2925 *
2926 * @IEEE80211_RC_BW_CHANGED: The bandwidth that can be used to transmit
2927 *	to this station changed. The actual bandwidth is in the station
2928 *	information -- for HT20/40 the IEEE80211_HT_CAP_SUP_WIDTH_20_40
2929 *	flag changes, for HT and VHT the bandwidth field changes.
2930 * @IEEE80211_RC_SMPS_CHANGED: The SMPS state of the station changed.
2931 * @IEEE80211_RC_SUPP_RATES_CHANGED: The supported rate set of this peer
2932 *	changed (in IBSS mode) due to discovering more information about
2933 *	the peer.
2934 * @IEEE80211_RC_NSS_CHANGED: N_SS (number of spatial streams) was changed
2935 *	by the peer
2936 */
2937enum ieee80211_rate_control_changed {
2938	IEEE80211_RC_BW_CHANGED		= BIT(0),
2939	IEEE80211_RC_SMPS_CHANGED	= BIT(1),
2940	IEEE80211_RC_SUPP_RATES_CHANGED	= BIT(2),
2941	IEEE80211_RC_NSS_CHANGED	= BIT(3),
2942};
2943
2944/**
2945 * enum ieee80211_roc_type - remain on channel type
2946 *
2947 * With the support for multi channel contexts and multi channel operations,
2948 * remain on channel operations might be limited/deferred/aborted by other
2949 * flows/operations which have higher priority (and vise versa).
2950 * Specifying the ROC type can be used by devices to prioritize the ROC
2951 * operations compared to other operations/flows.
2952 *
2953 * @IEEE80211_ROC_TYPE_NORMAL: There are no special requirements for this ROC.
2954 * @IEEE80211_ROC_TYPE_MGMT_TX: The remain on channel request is required
2955 *	for sending managment frames offchannel.
2956 */
2957enum ieee80211_roc_type {
2958	IEEE80211_ROC_TYPE_NORMAL = 0,
2959	IEEE80211_ROC_TYPE_MGMT_TX,
2960};
2961
2962/**
2963 * enum ieee80211_reconfig_complete_type - reconfig type
2964 *
2965 * This enum is used by the reconfig_complete() callback to indicate what
2966 * reconfiguration type was completed.
2967 *
2968 * @IEEE80211_RECONFIG_TYPE_RESTART: hw restart type
2969 *	(also due to resume() callback returning 1)
2970 * @IEEE80211_RECONFIG_TYPE_SUSPEND: suspend type (regardless
2971 *	of wowlan configuration)
2972 */
2973enum ieee80211_reconfig_type {
2974	IEEE80211_RECONFIG_TYPE_RESTART,
2975	IEEE80211_RECONFIG_TYPE_SUSPEND,
2976};
2977
2978/**
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
2979 * struct ieee80211_ops - callbacks from mac80211 to the driver
2980 *
2981 * This structure contains various callbacks that the driver may
2982 * handle or, in some cases, must handle, for example to configure
2983 * the hardware to a new channel or to transmit a frame.
2984 *
2985 * @tx: Handler that 802.11 module calls for each transmitted frame.
2986 *	skb contains the buffer starting from the IEEE 802.11 header.
2987 *	The low-level driver should send the frame out based on
2988 *	configuration in the TX control data. This handler should,
2989 *	preferably, never fail and stop queues appropriately.
2990 *	Must be atomic.
2991 *
2992 * @start: Called before the first netdevice attached to the hardware
2993 *	is enabled. This should turn on the hardware and must turn on
2994 *	frame reception (for possibly enabled monitor interfaces.)
2995 *	Returns negative error codes, these may be seen in userspace,
2996 *	or zero.
2997 *	When the device is started it should not have a MAC address
2998 *	to avoid acknowledging frames before a non-monitor device
2999 *	is added.
3000 *	Must be implemented and can sleep.
3001 *
3002 * @stop: Called after last netdevice attached to the hardware
3003 *	is disabled. This should turn off the hardware (at least
3004 *	it must turn off frame reception.)
3005 *	May be called right after add_interface if that rejects
3006 *	an interface. If you added any work onto the mac80211 workqueue
3007 *	you should ensure to cancel it on this callback.
3008 *	Must be implemented and can sleep.
3009 *
3010 * @suspend: Suspend the device; mac80211 itself will quiesce before and
3011 *	stop transmitting and doing any other configuration, and then
3012 *	ask the device to suspend. This is only invoked when WoWLAN is
3013 *	configured, otherwise the device is deconfigured completely and
3014 *	reconfigured at resume time.
3015 *	The driver may also impose special conditions under which it
3016 *	wants to use the "normal" suspend (deconfigure), say if it only
3017 *	supports WoWLAN when the device is associated. In this case, it
3018 *	must return 1 from this function.
3019 *
3020 * @resume: If WoWLAN was configured, this indicates that mac80211 is
3021 *	now resuming its operation, after this the device must be fully
3022 *	functional again. If this returns an error, the only way out is
3023 *	to also unregister the device. If it returns 1, then mac80211
3024 *	will also go through the regular complete restart on resume.
3025 *
3026 * @set_wakeup: Enable or disable wakeup when WoWLAN configuration is
3027 *	modified. The reason is that device_set_wakeup_enable() is
3028 *	supposed to be called when the configuration changes, not only
3029 *	in suspend().
3030 *
3031 * @add_interface: Called when a netdevice attached to the hardware is
3032 *	enabled. Because it is not called for monitor mode devices, @start
3033 *	and @stop must be implemented.
3034 *	The driver should perform any initialization it needs before
3035 *	the device can be enabled. The initial configuration for the
3036 *	interface is given in the conf parameter.
3037 *	The callback may refuse to add an interface by returning a
3038 *	negative error code (which will be seen in userspace.)
3039 *	Must be implemented and can sleep.
3040 *
3041 * @change_interface: Called when a netdevice changes type. This callback
3042 *	is optional, but only if it is supported can interface types be
3043 *	switched while the interface is UP. The callback may sleep.
3044 *	Note that while an interface is being switched, it will not be
3045 *	found by the interface iteration callbacks.
3046 *
3047 * @remove_interface: Notifies a driver that an interface is going down.
3048 *	The @stop callback is called after this if it is the last interface
3049 *	and no monitor interfaces are present.
3050 *	When all interfaces are removed, the MAC address in the hardware
3051 *	must be cleared so the device no longer acknowledges packets,
3052 *	the mac_addr member of the conf structure is, however, set to the
3053 *	MAC address of the device going away.
3054 *	Hence, this callback must be implemented. It can sleep.
3055 *
3056 * @config: Handler for configuration requests. IEEE 802.11 code calls this
3057 *	function to change hardware configuration, e.g., channel.
3058 *	This function should never fail but returns a negative error code
3059 *	if it does. The callback can sleep.
3060 *
3061 * @bss_info_changed: Handler for configuration requests related to BSS
3062 *	parameters that may vary during BSS's lifespan, and may affect low
3063 *	level driver (e.g. assoc/disassoc status, erp parameters).
3064 *	This function should not be used if no BSS has been set, unless
3065 *	for association indication. The @changed parameter indicates which
3066 *	of the bss parameters has changed when a call is made. The callback
3067 *	can sleep.
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
3068 *
3069 * @prepare_multicast: Prepare for multicast filter configuration.
3070 *	This callback is optional, and its return value is passed
3071 *	to configure_filter(). This callback must be atomic.
3072 *
3073 * @configure_filter: Configure the device's RX filter.
3074 *	See the section "Frame filtering" for more information.
3075 *	This callback must be implemented and can sleep.
3076 *
3077 * @config_iface_filter: Configure the interface's RX filter.
3078 *	This callback is optional and is used to configure which frames
3079 *	should be passed to mac80211. The filter_flags is the combination
3080 *	of FIF_* flags. The changed_flags is a bit mask that indicates
3081 *	which flags are changed.
3082 *	This callback can sleep.
3083 *
3084 * @set_tim: Set TIM bit. mac80211 calls this function when a TIM bit
3085 * 	must be set or cleared for a given STA. Must be atomic.
3086 *
3087 * @set_key: See the section "Hardware crypto acceleration"
3088 *	This callback is only called between add_interface and
3089 *	remove_interface calls, i.e. while the given virtual interface
3090 *	is enabled.
3091 *	Returns a negative error code if the key can't be added.
3092 *	The callback can sleep.
3093 *
3094 * @update_tkip_key: See the section "Hardware crypto acceleration"
3095 * 	This callback will be called in the context of Rx. Called for drivers
3096 * 	which set IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_TKIP_REQ_RX_P1_KEY.
3097 *	The callback must be atomic.
3098 *
3099 * @set_rekey_data: If the device supports GTK rekeying, for example while the
3100 *	host is suspended, it can assign this callback to retrieve the data
3101 *	necessary to do GTK rekeying, this is the KEK, KCK and replay counter.
3102 *	After rekeying was done it should (for example during resume) notify
3103 *	userspace of the new replay counter using ieee80211_gtk_rekey_notify().
3104 *
3105 * @set_default_unicast_key: Set the default (unicast) key index, useful for
3106 *	WEP when the device sends data packets autonomously, e.g. for ARP
3107 *	offloading. The index can be 0-3, or -1 for unsetting it.
3108 *
3109 * @hw_scan: Ask the hardware to service the scan request, no need to start
3110 *	the scan state machine in stack. The scan must honour the channel
3111 *	configuration done by the regulatory agent in the wiphy's
3112 *	registered bands. The hardware (or the driver) needs to make sure
3113 *	that power save is disabled.
3114 *	The @req ie/ie_len members are rewritten by mac80211 to contain the
3115 *	entire IEs after the SSID, so that drivers need not look at these
3116 *	at all but just send them after the SSID -- mac80211 includes the
3117 *	(extended) supported rates and HT information (where applicable).
3118 *	When the scan finishes, ieee80211_scan_completed() must be called;
3119 *	note that it also must be called when the scan cannot finish due to
3120 *	any error unless this callback returned a negative error code.
 
 
 
 
 
3121 *	The callback can sleep.
3122 *
3123 * @cancel_hw_scan: Ask the low-level tp cancel the active hw scan.
3124 *	The driver should ask the hardware to cancel the scan (if possible),
3125 *	but the scan will be completed only after the driver will call
3126 *	ieee80211_scan_completed().
3127 *	This callback is needed for wowlan, to prevent enqueueing a new
3128 *	scan_work after the low-level driver was already suspended.
3129 *	The callback can sleep.
3130 *
3131 * @sched_scan_start: Ask the hardware to start scanning repeatedly at
3132 *	specific intervals.  The driver must call the
3133 *	ieee80211_sched_scan_results() function whenever it finds results.
3134 *	This process will continue until sched_scan_stop is called.
3135 *
3136 * @sched_scan_stop: Tell the hardware to stop an ongoing scheduled scan.
3137 *	In this case, ieee80211_sched_scan_stopped() must not be called.
3138 *
3139 * @sw_scan_start: Notifier function that is called just before a software scan
3140 *	is started. Can be NULL, if the driver doesn't need this notification.
3141 *	The mac_addr parameter allows supporting NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_RANDOM_ADDR,
3142 *	the driver may set the NL80211_FEATURE_SCAN_RANDOM_MAC_ADDR flag if it
3143 *	can use this parameter. The callback can sleep.
3144 *
3145 * @sw_scan_complete: Notifier function that is called just after a
3146 *	software scan finished. Can be NULL, if the driver doesn't need
3147 *	this notification.
3148 *	The callback can sleep.
3149 *
3150 * @get_stats: Return low-level statistics.
3151 * 	Returns zero if statistics are available.
3152 *	The callback can sleep.
3153 *
3154 * @get_key_seq: If your device implements encryption in hardware and does
3155 *	IV/PN assignment then this callback should be provided to read the
3156 *	IV/PN for the given key from hardware.
3157 *	The callback must be atomic.
3158 *
3159 * @set_frag_threshold: Configuration of fragmentation threshold. Assign this
3160 *	if the device does fragmentation by itself. Note that to prevent the
3161 *	stack from doing fragmentation IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TX_FRAG
3162 *	should be set as well.
3163 *	The callback can sleep.
3164 *
3165 * @set_rts_threshold: Configuration of RTS threshold (if device needs it)
3166 *	The callback can sleep.
3167 *
3168 * @sta_add: Notifies low level driver about addition of an associated station,
3169 *	AP, IBSS/WDS/mesh peer etc. This callback can sleep.
3170 *
3171 * @sta_remove: Notifies low level driver about removal of an associated
3172 *	station, AP, IBSS/WDS/mesh peer etc. Note that after the callback
3173 *	returns it isn't safe to use the pointer, not even RCU protected;
3174 *	no RCU grace period is guaranteed between returning here and freeing
3175 *	the station. See @sta_pre_rcu_remove if needed.
3176 *	This callback can sleep.
3177 *
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
3178 * @sta_add_debugfs: Drivers can use this callback to add debugfs files
3179 *	when a station is added to mac80211's station list. This callback
3180 *	should be within a CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS conditional. This
3181 *	callback can sleep.
3182 *
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
3183 * @sta_notify: Notifies low level driver about power state transition of an
3184 *	associated station, AP,  IBSS/WDS/mesh peer etc. For a VIF operating
3185 *	in AP mode, this callback will not be called when the flag
3186 *	%IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS is set. Must be atomic.
3187 *
 
 
 
 
3188 * @sta_state: Notifies low level driver about state transition of a
3189 *	station (which can be the AP, a client, IBSS/WDS/mesh peer etc.)
3190 *	This callback is mutually exclusive with @sta_add/@sta_remove.
3191 *	It must not fail for down transitions but may fail for transitions
3192 *	up the list of states. Also note that after the callback returns it
3193 *	isn't safe to use the pointer, not even RCU protected - no RCU grace
3194 *	period is guaranteed between returning here and freeing the station.
3195 *	See @sta_pre_rcu_remove if needed.
3196 *	The callback can sleep.
3197 *
3198 * @sta_pre_rcu_remove: Notify driver about station removal before RCU
3199 *	synchronisation. This is useful if a driver needs to have station
3200 *	pointers protected using RCU, it can then use this call to clear
3201 *	the pointers instead of waiting for an RCU grace period to elapse
3202 *	in @sta_state.
3203 *	The callback can sleep.
3204 *
3205 * @sta_rc_update: Notifies the driver of changes to the bitrates that can be
3206 *	used to transmit to the station. The changes are advertised with bits
3207 *	from &enum ieee80211_rate_control_changed and the values are reflected
3208 *	in the station data. This callback should only be used when the driver
3209 *	uses hardware rate control (%IEEE80211_HW_HAS_RATE_CONTROL) since
3210 *	otherwise the rate control algorithm is notified directly.
3211 *	Must be atomic.
3212 * @sta_rate_tbl_update: Notifies the driver that the rate table changed. This
3213 *	is only used if the configured rate control algorithm actually uses
3214 *	the new rate table API, and is therefore optional. Must be atomic.
3215 *
3216 * @sta_statistics: Get statistics for this station. For example with beacon
3217 *	filtering, the statistics kept by mac80211 might not be accurate, so
3218 *	let the driver pre-fill the statistics. The driver can fill most of
3219 *	the values (indicating which by setting the filled bitmap), but not
3220 *	all of them make sense - see the source for which ones are possible.
3221 *	Statistics that the driver doesn't fill will be filled by mac80211.
3222 *	The callback can sleep.
3223 *
3224 * @conf_tx: Configure TX queue parameters (EDCF (aifs, cw_min, cw_max),
3225 *	bursting) for a hardware TX queue.
3226 *	Returns a negative error code on failure.
3227 *	The callback can sleep.
3228 *
3229 * @get_tsf: Get the current TSF timer value from firmware/hardware. Currently,
3230 *	this is only used for IBSS mode BSSID merging and debugging. Is not a
3231 *	required function.
3232 *	The callback can sleep.
3233 *
3234 * @set_tsf: Set the TSF timer to the specified value in the firmware/hardware.
3235 *	Currently, this is only used for IBSS mode debugging. Is not a
3236 *	required function.
3237 *	The callback can sleep.
3238 *
3239 * @offset_tsf: Offset the TSF timer by the specified value in the
3240 *	firmware/hardware.  Preferred to set_tsf as it avoids delay between
3241 *	calling set_tsf() and hardware getting programmed, which will show up
3242 *	as TSF delay. Is not a required function.
3243 *	The callback can sleep.
3244 *
3245 * @reset_tsf: Reset the TSF timer and allow firmware/hardware to synchronize
3246 *	with other STAs in the IBSS. This is only used in IBSS mode. This
3247 *	function is optional if the firmware/hardware takes full care of
3248 *	TSF synchronization.
3249 *	The callback can sleep.
3250 *
3251 * @tx_last_beacon: Determine whether the last IBSS beacon was sent by us.
3252 *	This is needed only for IBSS mode and the result of this function is
3253 *	used to determine whether to reply to Probe Requests.
3254 *	Returns non-zero if this device sent the last beacon.
3255 *	The callback can sleep.
3256 *
3257 * @get_survey: Return per-channel survey information
3258 *
3259 * @rfkill_poll: Poll rfkill hardware state. If you need this, you also
3260 *	need to set wiphy->rfkill_poll to %true before registration,
3261 *	and need to call wiphy_rfkill_set_hw_state() in the callback.
3262 *	The callback can sleep.
3263 *
3264 * @set_coverage_class: Set slot time for given coverage class as specified
3265 *	in IEEE 802.11-2007 section 17.3.8.6 and modify ACK timeout
3266 *	accordingly; coverage class equals to -1 to enable ACK timeout
3267 *	estimation algorithm (dynack). To disable dynack set valid value for
3268 *	coverage class. This callback is not required and may sleep.
3269 *
3270 * @testmode_cmd: Implement a cfg80211 test mode command. The passed @vif may
3271 *	be %NULL. The callback can sleep.
3272 * @testmode_dump: Implement a cfg80211 test mode dump. The callback can sleep.
3273 *
3274 * @flush: Flush all pending frames from the hardware queue, making sure
3275 *	that the hardware queues are empty. The @queues parameter is a bitmap
3276 *	of queues to flush, which is useful if different virtual interfaces
3277 *	use different hardware queues; it may also indicate all queues.
3278 *	If the parameter @drop is set to %true, pending frames may be dropped.
3279 *	Note that vif can be NULL.
3280 *	The callback can sleep.
3281 *
 
 
 
 
3282 * @channel_switch: Drivers that need (or want) to offload the channel
3283 *	switch operation for CSAs received from the AP may implement this
3284 *	callback. They must then call ieee80211_chswitch_done() to indicate
3285 *	completion of the channel switch.
3286 *
3287 * @set_antenna: Set antenna configuration (tx_ant, rx_ant) on the device.
3288 *	Parameters are bitmaps of allowed antennas to use for TX/RX. Drivers may
3289 *	reject TX/RX mask combinations they cannot support by returning -EINVAL
3290 *	(also see nl80211.h @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_TX).
3291 *
3292 * @get_antenna: Get current antenna configuration from device (tx_ant, rx_ant).
3293 *
3294 * @remain_on_channel: Starts an off-channel period on the given channel, must
3295 *	call back to ieee80211_ready_on_channel() when on that channel. Note
3296 *	that normal channel traffic is not stopped as this is intended for hw
3297 *	offload. Frames to transmit on the off-channel channel are transmitted
3298 *	normally except for the %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_TX_OFFCHAN flag. When the
3299 *	duration (which will always be non-zero) expires, the driver must call
3300 *	ieee80211_remain_on_channel_expired().
3301 *	Note that this callback may be called while the device is in IDLE and
3302 *	must be accepted in this case.
3303 *	This callback may sleep.
3304 * @cancel_remain_on_channel: Requests that an ongoing off-channel period is
3305 *	aborted before it expires. This callback may sleep.
3306 *
3307 * @set_ringparam: Set tx and rx ring sizes.
3308 *
3309 * @get_ringparam: Get tx and rx ring current and maximum sizes.
3310 *
3311 * @tx_frames_pending: Check if there is any pending frame in the hardware
3312 *	queues before entering power save.
3313 *
3314 * @set_bitrate_mask: Set a mask of rates to be used for rate control selection
3315 *	when transmitting a frame. Currently only legacy rates are handled.
3316 *	The callback can sleep.
3317 * @event_callback: Notify driver about any event in mac80211. See
3318 *	&enum ieee80211_event_type for the different types.
3319 *	The callback must be atomic.
3320 *
3321 * @release_buffered_frames: Release buffered frames according to the given
3322 *	parameters. In the case where the driver buffers some frames for
3323 *	sleeping stations mac80211 will use this callback to tell the driver
3324 *	to release some frames, either for PS-poll or uAPSD.
3325 *	Note that if the @more_data parameter is %false the driver must check
3326 *	if there are more frames on the given TIDs, and if there are more than
3327 *	the frames being released then it must still set the more-data bit in
3328 *	the frame. If the @more_data parameter is %true, then of course the
3329 *	more-data bit must always be set.
3330 *	The @tids parameter tells the driver which TIDs to release frames
3331 *	from, for PS-poll it will always have only a single bit set.
3332 *	In the case this is used for a PS-poll initiated release, the
3333 *	@num_frames parameter will always be 1 so code can be shared. In
3334 *	this case the driver must also set %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP flag
3335 *	on the TX status (and must report TX status) so that the PS-poll
3336 *	period is properly ended. This is used to avoid sending multiple
3337 *	responses for a retried PS-poll frame.
3338 *	In the case this is used for uAPSD, the @num_frames parameter may be
3339 *	bigger than one, but the driver may send fewer frames (it must send
3340 *	at least one, however). In this case it is also responsible for
3341 *	setting the EOSP flag in the QoS header of the frames. Also, when the
3342 *	service period ends, the driver must set %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP
3343 *	on the last frame in the SP. Alternatively, it may call the function
3344 *	ieee80211_sta_eosp() to inform mac80211 of the end of the SP.
3345 *	This callback must be atomic.
3346 * @allow_buffered_frames: Prepare device to allow the given number of frames
3347 *	to go out to the given station. The frames will be sent by mac80211
3348 *	via the usual TX path after this call. The TX information for frames
3349 *	released will also have the %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER flag set
3350 *	and the last one will also have %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP set. In case
3351 *	frames from multiple TIDs are released and the driver might reorder
3352 *	them between the TIDs, it must set the %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP flag
3353 *	on the last frame and clear it on all others and also handle the EOSP
3354 *	bit in the QoS header correctly. Alternatively, it can also call the
3355 *	ieee80211_sta_eosp() function.
3356 *	The @tids parameter is a bitmap and tells the driver which TIDs the
3357 *	frames will be on; it will at most have two bits set.
3358 *	This callback must be atomic.
3359 *
3360 * @get_et_sset_count:  Ethtool API to get string-set count.
 
 
3361 *
3362 * @get_et_stats:  Ethtool API to get a set of u64 stats.
3363 *
3364 * @get_et_strings:  Ethtool API to get a set of strings to describe stats
3365 *	and perhaps other supported types of ethtool data-sets.
 
 
3366 *
3367 * @mgd_prepare_tx: Prepare for transmitting a management frame for association
3368 *	before associated. In multi-channel scenarios, a virtual interface is
3369 *	bound to a channel before it is associated, but as it isn't associated
3370 *	yet it need not necessarily be given airtime, in particular since any
3371 *	transmission to a P2P GO needs to be synchronized against the GO's
3372 *	powersave state. mac80211 will call this function before transmitting a
3373 *	management frame prior to having successfully associated to allow the
3374 *	driver to give it channel time for the transmission, to get a response
3375 *	and to be able to synchronize with the GO.
3376 *	For drivers that set %IEEE80211_HW_DEAUTH_NEED_MGD_TX_PREP, mac80211
3377 *	would also call this function before transmitting a deauthentication
3378 *	frame in case that no beacon was heard from the AP/P2P GO.
3379 *	The callback will be called before each transmission and upon return
3380 *	mac80211 will transmit the frame right away.
 
 
 
3381 *	The callback is optional and can (should!) sleep.
 
 
 
3382 *
3383 * @mgd_protect_tdls_discover: Protect a TDLS discovery session. After sending
3384 *	a TDLS discovery-request, we expect a reply to arrive on the AP's
3385 *	channel. We must stay on the channel (no PSM, scan, etc.), since a TDLS
3386 *	setup-response is a direct packet not buffered by the AP.
3387 *	mac80211 will call this function just before the transmission of a TDLS
3388 *	discovery-request. The recommended period of protection is at least
3389 *	2 * (DTIM period).
3390 *	The callback is optional and can sleep.
3391 *
3392 * @add_chanctx: Notifies device driver about new channel context creation.
3393 *	This callback may sleep.
3394 * @remove_chanctx: Notifies device driver about channel context destruction.
3395 *	This callback may sleep.
3396 * @change_chanctx: Notifies device driver about channel context changes that
3397 *	may happen when combining different virtual interfaces on the same
3398 *	channel context with different settings
3399 *	This callback may sleep.
3400 * @assign_vif_chanctx: Notifies device driver about channel context being bound
3401 *	to vif. Possible use is for hw queue remapping.
3402 *	This callback may sleep.
3403 * @unassign_vif_chanctx: Notifies device driver about channel context being
3404 *	unbound from vif.
3405 *	This callback may sleep.
3406 * @switch_vif_chanctx: switch a number of vifs from one chanctx to
3407 *	another, as specified in the list of
3408 *	@ieee80211_vif_chanctx_switch passed to the driver, according
3409 *	to the mode defined in &ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode.
3410 *	This callback may sleep.
3411 *
3412 * @start_ap: Start operation on the AP interface, this is called after all the
3413 *	information in bss_conf is set and beacon can be retrieved. A channel
3414 *	context is bound before this is called. Note that if the driver uses
3415 *	software scan or ROC, this (and @stop_ap) isn't called when the AP is
3416 *	just "paused" for scanning/ROC, which is indicated by the beacon being
3417 *	disabled/enabled via @bss_info_changed.
3418 * @stop_ap: Stop operation on the AP interface.
3419 *
3420 * @reconfig_complete: Called after a call to ieee80211_restart_hw() and
3421 *	during resume, when the reconfiguration has completed.
3422 *	This can help the driver implement the reconfiguration step (and
3423 *	indicate mac80211 is ready to receive frames).
3424 *	This callback may sleep.
3425 *
3426 * @ipv6_addr_change: IPv6 address assignment on the given interface changed.
3427 *	Currently, this is only called for managed or P2P client interfaces.
3428 *	This callback is optional; it must not sleep.
3429 *
3430 * @channel_switch_beacon: Starts a channel switch to a new channel.
3431 *	Beacons are modified to include CSA or ECSA IEs before calling this
3432 *	function. The corresponding count fields in these IEs must be
3433 *	decremented, and when they reach 1 the driver must call
3434 *	ieee80211_csa_finish(). Drivers which use ieee80211_beacon_get()
3435 *	get the csa counter decremented by mac80211, but must check if it is
3436 *	1 using ieee80211_csa_is_complete() after the beacon has been
3437 *	transmitted and then call ieee80211_csa_finish().
3438 *	If the CSA count starts as zero or 1, this function will not be called,
3439 *	since there won't be any time to beacon before the switch anyway.
3440 * @pre_channel_switch: This is an optional callback that is called
3441 *	before a channel switch procedure is started (ie. when a STA
3442 *	gets a CSA or a userspace initiated channel-switch), allowing
3443 *	the driver to prepare for the channel switch.
3444 * @post_channel_switch: This is an optional callback that is called
3445 *	after a channel switch procedure is completed, allowing the
3446 *	driver to go back to a normal configuration.
3447 *
 
 
 
 
 
3448 * @join_ibss: Join an IBSS (on an IBSS interface); this is called after all
3449 *	information in bss_conf is set up and the beacon can be retrieved. A
3450 *	channel context is bound before this is called.
3451 * @leave_ibss: Leave the IBSS again.
3452 *
3453 * @get_expected_throughput: extract the expected throughput towards the
3454 *	specified station. The returned value is expressed in Kbps. It returns 0
3455 *	if the RC algorithm does not have proper data to provide.
3456 *
3457 * @get_txpower: get current maximum tx power (in dBm) based on configuration
3458 *	and hardware limits.
3459 *
3460 * @tdls_channel_switch: Start channel-switching with a TDLS peer. The driver
3461 *	is responsible for continually initiating channel-switching operations
3462 *	and returning to the base channel for communication with the AP. The
3463 *	driver receives a channel-switch request template and the location of
3464 *	the switch-timing IE within the template as part of the invocation.
3465 *	The template is valid only within the call, and the driver can
3466 *	optionally copy the skb for further re-use.
3467 * @tdls_cancel_channel_switch: Stop channel-switching with a TDLS peer. Both
3468 *	peers must be on the base channel when the call completes.
3469 * @tdls_recv_channel_switch: a TDLS channel-switch related frame (request or
3470 *	response) has been received from a remote peer. The driver gets
3471 *	parameters parsed from the incoming frame and may use them to continue
3472 *	an ongoing channel-switch operation. In addition, a channel-switch
3473 *	response template is provided, together with the location of the
3474 *	switch-timing IE within the template. The skb can only be used within
3475 *	the function call.
3476 *
3477 * @wake_tx_queue: Called when new packets have been added to the queue.
3478 * @sync_rx_queues: Process all pending frames in RSS queues. This is a
3479 *	synchronization which is needed in case driver has in its RSS queues
3480 *	pending frames that were received prior to the control path action
3481 *	currently taken (e.g. disassociation) but are not processed yet.
3482 *
3483 * @start_nan: join an existing NAN cluster, or create a new one.
3484 * @stop_nan: leave the NAN cluster.
3485 * @nan_change_conf: change NAN configuration. The data in cfg80211_nan_conf
3486 *	contains full new configuration and changes specify which parameters
3487 *	are changed with respect to the last NAN config.
3488 *	The driver gets both full configuration and the changed parameters since
3489 *	some devices may need the full configuration while others need only the
3490 *	changed parameters.
3491 * @add_nan_func: Add a NAN function. Returns 0 on success. The data in
3492 *	cfg80211_nan_func must not be referenced outside the scope of
3493 *	this call.
3494 * @del_nan_func: Remove a NAN function. The driver must call
3495 *	ieee80211_nan_func_terminated() with
3496 *	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_USER_REQUEST reason code upon removal.
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
3497 */
3498struct ieee80211_ops {
3499	void (*tx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3500		   struct ieee80211_tx_control *control,
3501		   struct sk_buff *skb);
3502	int (*start)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
3503	void (*stop)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
3504#ifdef CONFIG_PM
3505	int (*suspend)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct cfg80211_wowlan *wowlan);
3506	int (*resume)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
3507	void (*set_wakeup)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, bool enabled);
3508#endif
3509	int (*add_interface)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3510			     struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
3511	int (*change_interface)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3512				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
3513				enum nl80211_iftype new_type, bool p2p);
3514	void (*remove_interface)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3515				 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
3516	int (*config)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 changed);
3517	void (*bss_info_changed)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3518				 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
3519				 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *info,
3520				 u32 changed);
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
3521
3522	int (*start_ap)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
3523	void (*stop_ap)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
 
 
3524
3525	u64 (*prepare_multicast)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3526				 struct netdev_hw_addr_list *mc_list);
3527	void (*configure_filter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3528				 unsigned int changed_flags,
3529				 unsigned int *total_flags,
3530				 u64 multicast);
3531	void (*config_iface_filter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3532				    struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
3533				    unsigned int filter_flags,
3534				    unsigned int changed_flags);
3535	int (*set_tim)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
3536		       bool set);
3537	int (*set_key)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, enum set_key_cmd cmd,
3538		       struct ieee80211_vif *vif, struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
3539		       struct ieee80211_key_conf *key);
3540	void (*update_tkip_key)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3541				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
3542				struct ieee80211_key_conf *conf,
3543				struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
3544				u32 iv32, u16 *phase1key);
3545	void (*set_rekey_data)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3546			       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
3547			       struct cfg80211_gtk_rekey_data *data);
3548	void (*set_default_unicast_key)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3549					struct ieee80211_vif *vif, int idx);
3550	int (*hw_scan)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
3551		       struct ieee80211_scan_request *req);
3552	void (*cancel_hw_scan)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3553			       struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
3554	int (*sched_scan_start)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3555				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
3556				struct cfg80211_sched_scan_request *req,
3557				struct ieee80211_scan_ies *ies);
3558	int (*sched_scan_stop)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3559			       struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
3560	void (*sw_scan_start)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3561			      struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
3562			      const u8 *mac_addr);
3563	void (*sw_scan_complete)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3564				 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
3565	int (*get_stats)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3566			 struct ieee80211_low_level_stats *stats);
3567	void (*get_key_seq)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3568			    struct ieee80211_key_conf *key,
3569			    struct ieee80211_key_seq *seq);
3570	int (*set_frag_threshold)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 value);
3571	int (*set_rts_threshold)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 value);
3572	int (*sta_add)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
3573		       struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
3574	int (*sta_remove)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
3575			  struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
3576#ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS
 
 
 
 
 
 
3577	void (*sta_add_debugfs)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3578				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
3579				struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
3580				struct dentry *dir);
 
 
 
 
3581#endif
3582	void (*sta_notify)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
3583			enum sta_notify_cmd, struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
 
 
 
3584	int (*sta_state)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
3585			 struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
3586			 enum ieee80211_sta_state old_state,
3587			 enum ieee80211_sta_state new_state);
3588	void (*sta_pre_rcu_remove)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3589				   struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
3590				   struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
3591	void (*sta_rc_update)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3592			      struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
3593			      struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
3594			      u32 changed);
3595	void (*sta_rate_tbl_update)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3596				    struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
3597				    struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
3598	void (*sta_statistics)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3599			       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
3600			       struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
3601			       struct station_info *sinfo);
3602	int (*conf_tx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3603		       struct ieee80211_vif *vif, u16 ac,
 
3604		       const struct ieee80211_tx_queue_params *params);
3605	u64 (*get_tsf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
3606	void (*set_tsf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
3607			u64 tsf);
3608	void (*offset_tsf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
3609			   s64 offset);
3610	void (*reset_tsf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
3611	int (*tx_last_beacon)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
3612
3613	/**
3614	 * @ampdu_action:
3615	 * Perform a certain A-MPDU action.
3616	 * The RA/TID combination determines the destination and TID we want
3617	 * the ampdu action to be performed for. The action is defined through
3618	 * ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action.
3619	 * When the action is set to %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL the driver
3620	 * may neither send aggregates containing more subframes than @buf_size
3621	 * nor send aggregates in a way that lost frames would exceed the
3622	 * buffer size. If just limiting the aggregate size, this would be
3623	 * possible with a buf_size of 8:
3624	 *
3625	 * - ``TX: 1.....7``
3626	 * - ``RX:  2....7`` (lost frame #1)
3627	 * - ``TX:        8..1...``
3628	 *
3629	 * which is invalid since #1 was now re-transmitted well past the
3630	 * buffer size of 8. Correct ways to retransmit #1 would be:
3631	 *
3632	 * - ``TX:        1   or``
3633	 * - ``TX:        18  or``
3634	 * - ``TX:        81``
3635	 *
3636	 * Even ``189`` would be wrong since 1 could be lost again.
3637	 *
3638	 * Returns a negative error code on failure.
 
 
 
3639	 * The callback can sleep.
3640	 */
3641	int (*ampdu_action)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3642			    struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
3643			    struct ieee80211_ampdu_params *params);
3644	int (*get_survey)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int idx,
3645		struct survey_info *survey);
3646	void (*rfkill_poll)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
3647	void (*set_coverage_class)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, s16 coverage_class);
3648#ifdef CONFIG_NL80211_TESTMODE
3649	int (*testmode_cmd)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
3650			    void *data, int len);
3651	int (*testmode_dump)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct sk_buff *skb,
3652			     struct netlink_callback *cb,
3653			     void *data, int len);
3654#endif
3655	void (*flush)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
3656		      u32 queues, bool drop);
 
 
3657	void (*channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3658			       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
3659			       struct ieee80211_channel_switch *ch_switch);
3660	int (*set_antenna)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 tx_ant, u32 rx_ant);
3661	int (*get_antenna)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 *tx_ant, u32 *rx_ant);
3662
3663	int (*remain_on_channel)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3664				 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
3665				 struct ieee80211_channel *chan,
3666				 int duration,
3667				 enum ieee80211_roc_type type);
3668	int (*cancel_remain_on_channel)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
 
3669	int (*set_ringparam)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 tx, u32 rx);
3670	void (*get_ringparam)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3671			      u32 *tx, u32 *tx_max, u32 *rx, u32 *rx_max);
3672	bool (*tx_frames_pending)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
3673	int (*set_bitrate_mask)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
3674				const struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask *mask);
3675	void (*event_callback)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3676			       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
3677			       const struct ieee80211_event *event);
3678
3679	void (*allow_buffered_frames)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3680				      struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
3681				      u16 tids, int num_frames,
3682				      enum ieee80211_frame_release_type reason,
3683				      bool more_data);
3684	void (*release_buffered_frames)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3685					struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
3686					u16 tids, int num_frames,
3687					enum ieee80211_frame_release_type reason,
3688					bool more_data);
3689
3690	int	(*get_et_sset_count)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3691				     struct ieee80211_vif *vif, int sset);
3692	void	(*get_et_stats)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3693				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
3694				struct ethtool_stats *stats, u64 *data);
3695	void	(*get_et_strings)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3696				  struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
3697				  u32 sset, u8 *data);
3698
3699	void	(*mgd_prepare_tx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3700				  struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
 
 
 
 
3701
3702	void	(*mgd_protect_tdls_discover)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3703					     struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
 
3704
3705	int (*add_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3706			   struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx);
3707	void (*remove_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3708			       struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx);
3709	void (*change_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3710			       struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx,
3711			       u32 changed);
3712	int (*assign_vif_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3713				  struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
 
3714				  struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx);
3715	void (*unassign_vif_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3716				     struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
 
3717				     struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx);
3718	int (*switch_vif_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3719				  struct ieee80211_vif_chanctx_switch *vifs,
3720				  int n_vifs,
3721				  enum ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode mode);
3722
3723	void (*reconfig_complete)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3724				  enum ieee80211_reconfig_type reconfig_type);
3725
3726#if IS_ENABLED(CONFIG_IPV6)
3727	void (*ipv6_addr_change)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3728				 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
3729				 struct inet6_dev *idev);
3730#endif
3731	void (*channel_switch_beacon)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3732				      struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
3733				      struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
3734	int (*pre_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3735				  struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
3736				  struct ieee80211_channel_switch *ch_switch);
3737
3738	int (*post_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3739				   struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
 
 
 
 
 
 
3740
3741	int (*join_ibss)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
3742	void (*leave_ibss)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
3743	u32 (*get_expected_throughput)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3744				       struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
3745	int (*get_txpower)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
3746			   int *dbm);
3747
3748	int (*tdls_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3749				   struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
3750				   struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 oper_class,
3751				   struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
3752				   struct sk_buff *tmpl_skb, u32 ch_sw_tm_ie);
3753	void (*tdls_cancel_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3754					   struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
3755					   struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
3756	void (*tdls_recv_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3757					 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
3758					 struct ieee80211_tdls_ch_sw_params *params);
3759
3760	void (*wake_tx_queue)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3761			      struct ieee80211_txq *txq);
3762	void (*sync_rx_queues)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
3763
3764	int (*start_nan)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3765			 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
3766			 struct cfg80211_nan_conf *conf);
3767	int (*stop_nan)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3768			struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
3769	int (*nan_change_conf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3770			       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
3771			       struct cfg80211_nan_conf *conf, u32 changes);
3772	int (*add_nan_func)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3773			    struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
3774			    const struct cfg80211_nan_func *nan_func);
3775	void (*del_nan_func)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3776			    struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
3777			    u8 instance_id);
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
3778};
3779
3780/**
3781 * ieee80211_alloc_hw_nm - Allocate a new hardware device
3782 *
3783 * This must be called once for each hardware device. The returned pointer
3784 * must be used to refer to this device when calling other functions.
3785 * mac80211 allocates a private data area for the driver pointed to by
3786 * @priv in &struct ieee80211_hw, the size of this area is given as
3787 * @priv_data_len.
3788 *
3789 * @priv_data_len: length of private data
3790 * @ops: callbacks for this device
3791 * @requested_name: Requested name for this device.
3792 *	NULL is valid value, and means use the default naming (phy%d)
3793 *
3794 * Return: A pointer to the new hardware device, or %NULL on error.
3795 */
3796struct ieee80211_hw *ieee80211_alloc_hw_nm(size_t priv_data_len,
3797					   const struct ieee80211_ops *ops,
3798					   const char *requested_name);
3799
3800/**
3801 * ieee80211_alloc_hw - Allocate a new hardware device
3802 *
3803 * This must be called once for each hardware device. The returned pointer
3804 * must be used to refer to this device when calling other functions.
3805 * mac80211 allocates a private data area for the driver pointed to by
3806 * @priv in &struct ieee80211_hw, the size of this area is given as
3807 * @priv_data_len.
3808 *
3809 * @priv_data_len: length of private data
3810 * @ops: callbacks for this device
3811 *
3812 * Return: A pointer to the new hardware device, or %NULL on error.
3813 */
3814static inline
3815struct ieee80211_hw *ieee80211_alloc_hw(size_t priv_data_len,
3816					const struct ieee80211_ops *ops)
3817{
3818	return ieee80211_alloc_hw_nm(priv_data_len, ops, NULL);
3819}
3820
3821/**
3822 * ieee80211_register_hw - Register hardware device
3823 *
3824 * You must call this function before any other functions in
3825 * mac80211. Note that before a hardware can be registered, you
3826 * need to fill the contained wiphy's information.
3827 *
3828 * @hw: the device to register as returned by ieee80211_alloc_hw()
3829 *
3830 * Return: 0 on success. An error code otherwise.
3831 */
3832int ieee80211_register_hw(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
3833
3834/**
3835 * struct ieee80211_tpt_blink - throughput blink description
3836 * @throughput: throughput in Kbit/sec
3837 * @blink_time: blink time in milliseconds
3838 *	(full cycle, ie. one off + one on period)
3839 */
3840struct ieee80211_tpt_blink {
3841	int throughput;
3842	int blink_time;
3843};
3844
3845/**
3846 * enum ieee80211_tpt_led_trigger_flags - throughput trigger flags
3847 * @IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_RADIO: enable blinking with radio
3848 * @IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_WORK: enable blinking when working
3849 * @IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_CONNECTED: enable blinking when at least one
3850 *	interface is connected in some way, including being an AP
3851 */
3852enum ieee80211_tpt_led_trigger_flags {
3853	IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_RADIO		= BIT(0),
3854	IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_WORK		= BIT(1),
3855	IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_CONNECTED	= BIT(2),
3856};
3857
3858#ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
3859const char *__ieee80211_get_tx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
3860const char *__ieee80211_get_rx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
3861const char *__ieee80211_get_assoc_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
3862const char *__ieee80211_get_radio_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
3863const char *
3864__ieee80211_create_tpt_led_trigger(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3865				   unsigned int flags,
3866				   const struct ieee80211_tpt_blink *blink_table,
3867				   unsigned int blink_table_len);
3868#endif
3869/**
3870 * ieee80211_get_tx_led_name - get name of TX LED
3871 *
3872 * mac80211 creates a transmit LED trigger for each wireless hardware
3873 * that can be used to drive LEDs if your driver registers a LED device.
3874 * This function returns the name (or %NULL if not configured for LEDs)
3875 * of the trigger so you can automatically link the LED device.
3876 *
3877 * @hw: the hardware to get the LED trigger name for
3878 *
3879 * Return: The name of the LED trigger. %NULL if not configured for LEDs.
3880 */
3881static inline const char *ieee80211_get_tx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw)
3882{
3883#ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
3884	return __ieee80211_get_tx_led_name(hw);
3885#else
3886	return NULL;
3887#endif
3888}
3889
3890/**
3891 * ieee80211_get_rx_led_name - get name of RX LED
3892 *
3893 * mac80211 creates a receive LED trigger for each wireless hardware
3894 * that can be used to drive LEDs if your driver registers a LED device.
3895 * This function returns the name (or %NULL if not configured for LEDs)
3896 * of the trigger so you can automatically link the LED device.
3897 *
3898 * @hw: the hardware to get the LED trigger name for
3899 *
3900 * Return: The name of the LED trigger. %NULL if not configured for LEDs.
3901 */
3902static inline const char *ieee80211_get_rx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw)
3903{
3904#ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
3905	return __ieee80211_get_rx_led_name(hw);
3906#else
3907	return NULL;
3908#endif
3909}
3910
3911/**
3912 * ieee80211_get_assoc_led_name - get name of association LED
3913 *
3914 * mac80211 creates a association LED trigger for each wireless hardware
3915 * that can be used to drive LEDs if your driver registers a LED device.
3916 * This function returns the name (or %NULL if not configured for LEDs)
3917 * of the trigger so you can automatically link the LED device.
3918 *
3919 * @hw: the hardware to get the LED trigger name for
3920 *
3921 * Return: The name of the LED trigger. %NULL if not configured for LEDs.
3922 */
3923static inline const char *ieee80211_get_assoc_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw)
3924{
3925#ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
3926	return __ieee80211_get_assoc_led_name(hw);
3927#else
3928	return NULL;
3929#endif
3930}
3931
3932/**
3933 * ieee80211_get_radio_led_name - get name of radio LED
3934 *
3935 * mac80211 creates a radio change LED trigger for each wireless hardware
3936 * that can be used to drive LEDs if your driver registers a LED device.
3937 * This function returns the name (or %NULL if not configured for LEDs)
3938 * of the trigger so you can automatically link the LED device.
3939 *
3940 * @hw: the hardware to get the LED trigger name for
3941 *
3942 * Return: The name of the LED trigger. %NULL if not configured for LEDs.
3943 */
3944static inline const char *ieee80211_get_radio_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw)
3945{
3946#ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
3947	return __ieee80211_get_radio_led_name(hw);
3948#else
3949	return NULL;
3950#endif
3951}
3952
3953/**
3954 * ieee80211_create_tpt_led_trigger - create throughput LED trigger
3955 * @hw: the hardware to create the trigger for
3956 * @flags: trigger flags, see &enum ieee80211_tpt_led_trigger_flags
3957 * @blink_table: the blink table -- needs to be ordered by throughput
3958 * @blink_table_len: size of the blink table
3959 *
3960 * Return: %NULL (in case of error, or if no LED triggers are
3961 * configured) or the name of the new trigger.
3962 *
3963 * Note: This function must be called before ieee80211_register_hw().
3964 */
3965static inline const char *
3966ieee80211_create_tpt_led_trigger(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, unsigned int flags,
3967				 const struct ieee80211_tpt_blink *blink_table,
3968				 unsigned int blink_table_len)
3969{
3970#ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
3971	return __ieee80211_create_tpt_led_trigger(hw, flags, blink_table,
3972						  blink_table_len);
3973#else
3974	return NULL;
3975#endif
3976}
3977
3978/**
3979 * ieee80211_unregister_hw - Unregister a hardware device
3980 *
3981 * This function instructs mac80211 to free allocated resources
3982 * and unregister netdevices from the networking subsystem.
3983 *
3984 * @hw: the hardware to unregister
3985 */
3986void ieee80211_unregister_hw(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
3987
3988/**
3989 * ieee80211_free_hw - free hardware descriptor
3990 *
3991 * This function frees everything that was allocated, including the
3992 * private data for the driver. You must call ieee80211_unregister_hw()
3993 * before calling this function.
3994 *
3995 * @hw: the hardware to free
3996 */
3997void ieee80211_free_hw(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
3998
3999/**
4000 * ieee80211_restart_hw - restart hardware completely
4001 *
4002 * Call this function when the hardware was restarted for some reason
4003 * (hardware error, ...) and the driver is unable to restore its state
4004 * by itself. mac80211 assumes that at this point the driver/hardware
4005 * is completely uninitialised and stopped, it starts the process by
4006 * calling the ->start() operation. The driver will need to reset all
4007 * internal state that it has prior to calling this function.
4008 *
4009 * @hw: the hardware to restart
4010 */
4011void ieee80211_restart_hw(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4012
4013/**
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
4014 * ieee80211_rx_napi - receive frame from NAPI context
4015 *
4016 * Use this function to hand received frames to mac80211. The receive
4017 * buffer in @skb must start with an IEEE 802.11 header. In case of a
4018 * paged @skb is used, the driver is recommended to put the ieee80211
4019 * header of the frame on the linear part of the @skb to avoid memory
4020 * allocation and/or memcpy by the stack.
4021 *
4022 * This function may not be called in IRQ context. Calls to this function
4023 * for a single hardware must be synchronized against each other. Calls to
4024 * this function, ieee80211_rx_ni() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() may not be
4025 * mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with
4026 * ieee80211_tx_status() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni().
4027 *
4028 * This function must be called with BHs disabled.
4029 *
4030 * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on
4031 * @sta: the station the frame was received from, or %NULL
4032 * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call
4033 * @napi: the NAPI context
4034 */
4035void ieee80211_rx_napi(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4036		       struct sk_buff *skb, struct napi_struct *napi);
4037
4038/**
4039 * ieee80211_rx - receive frame
4040 *
4041 * Use this function to hand received frames to mac80211. The receive
4042 * buffer in @skb must start with an IEEE 802.11 header. In case of a
4043 * paged @skb is used, the driver is recommended to put the ieee80211
4044 * header of the frame on the linear part of the @skb to avoid memory
4045 * allocation and/or memcpy by the stack.
4046 *
4047 * This function may not be called in IRQ context. Calls to this function
4048 * for a single hardware must be synchronized against each other. Calls to
4049 * this function, ieee80211_rx_ni() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() may not be
4050 * mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with
4051 * ieee80211_tx_status() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni().
4052 *
4053 * In process context use instead ieee80211_rx_ni().
4054 *
4055 * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on
4056 * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call
4057 */
4058static inline void ieee80211_rx(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct sk_buff *skb)
4059{
4060	ieee80211_rx_napi(hw, NULL, skb, NULL);
4061}
4062
4063/**
4064 * ieee80211_rx_irqsafe - receive frame
4065 *
4066 * Like ieee80211_rx() but can be called in IRQ context
4067 * (internally defers to a tasklet.)
4068 *
4069 * Calls to this function, ieee80211_rx() or ieee80211_rx_ni() may not
4070 * be mixed for a single hardware.Must not run concurrently with
4071 * ieee80211_tx_status() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni().
4072 *
4073 * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on
4074 * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call
4075 */
4076void ieee80211_rx_irqsafe(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct sk_buff *skb);
4077
4078/**
4079 * ieee80211_rx_ni - receive frame (in process context)
4080 *
4081 * Like ieee80211_rx() but can be called in process context
4082 * (internally disables bottom halves).
4083 *
4084 * Calls to this function, ieee80211_rx() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() may
4085 * not be mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with
4086 * ieee80211_tx_status() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni().
4087 *
4088 * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on
4089 * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call
4090 */
4091static inline void ieee80211_rx_ni(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4092				   struct sk_buff *skb)
4093{
4094	local_bh_disable();
4095	ieee80211_rx(hw, skb);
4096	local_bh_enable();
4097}
4098
4099/**
4100 * ieee80211_sta_ps_transition - PS transition for connected sta
4101 *
4102 * When operating in AP mode with the %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS
4103 * flag set, use this function to inform mac80211 about a connected station
4104 * entering/leaving PS mode.
4105 *
4106 * This function may not be called in IRQ context or with softirqs enabled.
4107 *
4108 * Calls to this function for a single hardware must be synchronized against
4109 * each other.
4110 *
4111 * @sta: currently connected sta
4112 * @start: start or stop PS
4113 *
4114 * Return: 0 on success. -EINVAL when the requested PS mode is already set.
4115 */
4116int ieee80211_sta_ps_transition(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, bool start);
4117
4118/**
4119 * ieee80211_sta_ps_transition_ni - PS transition for connected sta
4120 *                                  (in process context)
4121 *
4122 * Like ieee80211_sta_ps_transition() but can be called in process context
4123 * (internally disables bottom halves). Concurrent call restriction still
4124 * applies.
4125 *
4126 * @sta: currently connected sta
4127 * @start: start or stop PS
4128 *
4129 * Return: Like ieee80211_sta_ps_transition().
4130 */
4131static inline int ieee80211_sta_ps_transition_ni(struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4132						  bool start)
4133{
4134	int ret;
4135
4136	local_bh_disable();
4137	ret = ieee80211_sta_ps_transition(sta, start);
4138	local_bh_enable();
4139
4140	return ret;
4141}
4142
4143/**
4144 * ieee80211_sta_pspoll - PS-Poll frame received
4145 * @sta: currently connected station
4146 *
4147 * When operating in AP mode with the %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS flag set,
4148 * use this function to inform mac80211 that a PS-Poll frame from a
4149 * connected station was received.
4150 * This must be used in conjunction with ieee80211_sta_ps_transition()
4151 * and possibly ieee80211_sta_uapsd_trigger(); calls to all three must
4152 * be serialized.
4153 */
4154void ieee80211_sta_pspoll(struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4155
4156/**
4157 * ieee80211_sta_uapsd_trigger - (potential) U-APSD trigger frame received
4158 * @sta: currently connected station
4159 * @tid: TID of the received (potential) trigger frame
4160 *
4161 * When operating in AP mode with the %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS flag set,
4162 * use this function to inform mac80211 that a (potential) trigger frame
4163 * from a connected station was received.
4164 * This must be used in conjunction with ieee80211_sta_ps_transition()
4165 * and possibly ieee80211_sta_pspoll(); calls to all three must be
4166 * serialized.
4167 * %IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS can be passed as the tid if the tid is unknown.
4168 * In this case, mac80211 will not check that this tid maps to an AC
4169 * that is trigger enabled and assume that the caller did the proper
4170 * checks.
4171 */
4172void ieee80211_sta_uapsd_trigger(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 tid);
4173
4174/*
4175 * The TX headroom reserved by mac80211 for its own tx_status functions.
4176 * This is enough for the radiotap header.
4177 */
4178#define IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_HEADROOM	ALIGN(14, 4)
4179
4180/**
4181 * ieee80211_sta_set_buffered - inform mac80211 about driver-buffered frames
4182 * @sta: &struct ieee80211_sta pointer for the sleeping station
4183 * @tid: the TID that has buffered frames
4184 * @buffered: indicates whether or not frames are buffered for this TID
4185 *
4186 * If a driver buffers frames for a powersave station instead of passing
4187 * them back to mac80211 for retransmission, the station may still need
4188 * to be told that there are buffered frames via the TIM bit.
4189 *
4190 * This function informs mac80211 whether or not there are frames that are
4191 * buffered in the driver for a given TID; mac80211 can then use this data
4192 * to set the TIM bit (NOTE: This may call back into the driver's set_tim
4193 * call! Beware of the locking!)
4194 *
4195 * If all frames are released to the station (due to PS-poll or uAPSD)
4196 * then the driver needs to inform mac80211 that there no longer are
4197 * frames buffered. However, when the station wakes up mac80211 assumes
4198 * that all buffered frames will be transmitted and clears this data,
4199 * drivers need to make sure they inform mac80211 about all buffered
4200 * frames on the sleep transition (sta_notify() with %STA_NOTIFY_SLEEP).
4201 *
4202 * Note that technically mac80211 only needs to know this per AC, not per
4203 * TID, but since driver buffering will inevitably happen per TID (since
4204 * it is related to aggregation) it is easier to make mac80211 map the
4205 * TID to the AC as required instead of keeping track in all drivers that
4206 * use this API.
4207 */
4208void ieee80211_sta_set_buffered(struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4209				u8 tid, bool buffered);
4210
4211/**
4212 * ieee80211_get_tx_rates - get the selected transmit rates for a packet
4213 *
4214 * Call this function in a driver with per-packet rate selection support
4215 * to combine the rate info in the packet tx info with the most recent
4216 * rate selection table for the station entry.
4217 *
4218 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
4219 * @sta: the receiver station to which this packet is sent.
4220 * @skb: the frame to be transmitted.
4221 * @dest: buffer for extracted rate/retry information
4222 * @max_rates: maximum number of rates to fetch
4223 */
4224void ieee80211_get_tx_rates(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4225			    struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4226			    struct sk_buff *skb,
4227			    struct ieee80211_tx_rate *dest,
4228			    int max_rates);
4229
4230/**
4231 * ieee80211_sta_set_expected_throughput - set the expected tpt for a station
4232 *
4233 * Call this function to notify mac80211 about a change in expected throughput
4234 * to a station. A driver for a device that does rate control in firmware can
4235 * call this function when the expected throughput estimate towards a station
4236 * changes. The information is used to tune the CoDel AQM applied to traffic
4237 * going towards that station (which can otherwise be too aggressive and cause
4238 * slow stations to starve).
4239 *
4240 * @pubsta: the station to set throughput for.
4241 * @thr: the current expected throughput in kbps.
4242 */
4243void ieee80211_sta_set_expected_throughput(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta,
4244					   u32 thr);
4245
4246/**
4247 * ieee80211_tx_status - transmit status callback
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
4248 *
4249 * Call this function for all transmitted frames after they have been
4250 * transmitted. It is permissible to not call this function for
4251 * multicast frames but this can affect statistics.
4252 *
4253 * This function may not be called in IRQ context. Calls to this function
4254 * for a single hardware must be synchronized against each other. Calls
4255 * to this function, ieee80211_tx_status_ni() and ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe()
4256 * may not be mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with
4257 * ieee80211_rx() or ieee80211_rx_ni().
4258 *
4259 * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
4260 * @skb: the frame that was transmitted, owned by mac80211 after this call
4261 */
4262void ieee80211_tx_status(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4263			 struct sk_buff *skb);
4264
4265/**
4266 * ieee80211_tx_status_ext - extended transmit status callback
4267 *
4268 * This function can be used as a replacement for ieee80211_tx_status
4269 * in drivers that may want to provide extra information that does not
4270 * fit into &struct ieee80211_tx_info.
4271 *
4272 * Calls to this function for a single hardware must be synchronized
4273 * against each other. Calls to this function, ieee80211_tx_status_ni()
4274 * and ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe() may not be mixed for a single hardware.
4275 *
4276 * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
4277 * @status: tx status information
4278 */
4279void ieee80211_tx_status_ext(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4280			     struct ieee80211_tx_status *status);
4281
4282/**
4283 * ieee80211_tx_status_noskb - transmit status callback without skb
4284 *
4285 * This function can be used as a replacement for ieee80211_tx_status
4286 * in drivers that cannot reliably map tx status information back to
4287 * specific skbs.
4288 *
4289 * Calls to this function for a single hardware must be synchronized
4290 * against each other. Calls to this function, ieee80211_tx_status_ni()
4291 * and ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe() may not be mixed for a single hardware.
4292 *
4293 * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
4294 * @sta: the receiver station to which this packet is sent
4295 *	(NULL for multicast packets)
4296 * @info: tx status information
4297 */
4298static inline void ieee80211_tx_status_noskb(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4299					     struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4300					     struct ieee80211_tx_info *info)
4301{
4302	struct ieee80211_tx_status status = {
4303		.sta = sta,
4304		.info = info,
4305	};
4306
4307	ieee80211_tx_status_ext(hw, &status);
4308}
4309
4310/**
4311 * ieee80211_tx_status_ni - transmit status callback (in process context)
4312 *
4313 * Like ieee80211_tx_status() but can be called in process context.
4314 *
4315 * Calls to this function, ieee80211_tx_status() and
4316 * ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe() may not be mixed
4317 * for a single hardware.
4318 *
4319 * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
4320 * @skb: the frame that was transmitted, owned by mac80211 after this call
4321 */
4322static inline void ieee80211_tx_status_ni(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4323					  struct sk_buff *skb)
4324{
4325	local_bh_disable();
4326	ieee80211_tx_status(hw, skb);
4327	local_bh_enable();
4328}
4329
4330/**
4331 * ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe - IRQ-safe transmit status callback
4332 *
4333 * Like ieee80211_tx_status() but can be called in IRQ context
4334 * (internally defers to a tasklet.)
4335 *
4336 * Calls to this function, ieee80211_tx_status() and
4337 * ieee80211_tx_status_ni() may not be mixed for a single hardware.
4338 *
4339 * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
4340 * @skb: the frame that was transmitted, owned by mac80211 after this call
4341 */
4342void ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4343				 struct sk_buff *skb);
4344
4345/**
4346 * ieee80211_report_low_ack - report non-responding station
4347 *
4348 * When operating in AP-mode, call this function to report a non-responding
4349 * connected STA.
4350 *
4351 * @sta: the non-responding connected sta
4352 * @num_packets: number of packets sent to @sta without a response
4353 */
4354void ieee80211_report_low_ack(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u32 num_packets);
4355
4356#define IEEE80211_MAX_CSA_COUNTERS_NUM 2
4357
4358/**
4359 * struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets - mutable beacon offsets
4360 * @tim_offset: position of TIM element
4361 * @tim_length: size of TIM element
4362 * @csa_counter_offs: array of IEEE80211_MAX_CSA_COUNTERS_NUM offsets
4363 *	to CSA counters.  This array can contain zero values which
4364 *	should be ignored.
 
4365 */
4366struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets {
4367	u16 tim_offset;
4368	u16 tim_length;
4369
4370	u16 csa_counter_offs[IEEE80211_MAX_CSA_COUNTERS_NUM];
 
4371};
4372
4373/**
4374 * ieee80211_beacon_get_template - beacon template generation function
4375 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
4376 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
4377 * @offs: &struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets pointer to struct that will
4378 *	receive the offsets that may be updated by the driver.
 
 
4379 *
4380 * If the driver implements beaconing modes, it must use this function to
4381 * obtain the beacon template.
4382 *
4383 * This function should be used if the beacon frames are generated by the
4384 * device, and then the driver must use the returned beacon as the template
4385 * The driver or the device are responsible to update the DTIM and, when
4386 * applicable, the CSA count.
4387 *
4388 * The driver is responsible for freeing the returned skb.
4389 *
4390 * Return: The beacon template. %NULL on error.
4391 */
4392struct sk_buff *
4393ieee80211_beacon_get_template(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4394			      struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4395			      struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets *offs);
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
4396
4397/**
4398 * ieee80211_beacon_get_tim - beacon generation function
4399 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
4400 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
4401 * @tim_offset: pointer to variable that will receive the TIM IE offset.
4402 *	Set to 0 if invalid (in non-AP modes).
4403 * @tim_length: pointer to variable that will receive the TIM IE length,
4404 *	(including the ID and length bytes!).
4405 *	Set to 0 if invalid (in non-AP modes).
 
 
4406 *
4407 * If the driver implements beaconing modes, it must use this function to
4408 * obtain the beacon frame.
4409 *
4410 * If the beacon frames are generated by the host system (i.e., not in
4411 * hardware/firmware), the driver uses this function to get each beacon
4412 * frame from mac80211 -- it is responsible for calling this function exactly
4413 * once before the beacon is needed (e.g. based on hardware interrupt).
4414 *
4415 * The driver is responsible for freeing the returned skb.
4416 *
4417 * Return: The beacon template. %NULL on error.
4418 */
4419struct sk_buff *ieee80211_beacon_get_tim(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4420					 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4421					 u16 *tim_offset, u16 *tim_length);
 
4422
4423/**
4424 * ieee80211_beacon_get - beacon generation function
4425 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
4426 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
 
 
4427 *
4428 * See ieee80211_beacon_get_tim().
4429 *
4430 * Return: See ieee80211_beacon_get_tim().
4431 */
4432static inline struct sk_buff *ieee80211_beacon_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4433						   struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
 
4434{
4435	return ieee80211_beacon_get_tim(hw, vif, NULL, NULL);
4436}
4437
4438/**
4439 * ieee80211_csa_update_counter - request mac80211 to decrement the csa counter
4440 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
4441 *
4442 * The csa counter should be updated after each beacon transmission.
4443 * This function is called implicitly when
4444 * ieee80211_beacon_get/ieee80211_beacon_get_tim are called, however if the
4445 * beacon frames are generated by the device, the driver should call this
4446 * function after each beacon transmission to sync mac80211's csa counters.
4447 *
4448 * Return: new csa counter value
4449 */
4450u8 ieee80211_csa_update_counter(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
4451
4452/**
4453 * ieee80211_csa_finish - notify mac80211 about channel switch
4454 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
4455 *
4456 * After a channel switch announcement was scheduled and the counter in this
4457 * announcement hits 1, this function must be called by the driver to
4458 * notify mac80211 that the channel can be changed.
4459 */
4460void ieee80211_csa_finish(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4461
4462/**
4463 * ieee80211_csa_is_complete - find out if counters reached 1
4464 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
4465 *
4466 * This function returns whether the channel switch counters reached zero.
4467 */
4468bool ieee80211_csa_is_complete(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4469
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
4470
4471/**
4472 * ieee80211_proberesp_get - retrieve a Probe Response template
4473 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
4474 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
4475 *
4476 * Creates a Probe Response template which can, for example, be uploaded to
4477 * hardware. The destination address should be set by the caller.
4478 *
4479 * Can only be called in AP mode.
4480 *
4481 * Return: The Probe Response template. %NULL on error.
4482 */
4483struct sk_buff *ieee80211_proberesp_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4484					struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4485
4486/**
4487 * ieee80211_pspoll_get - retrieve a PS Poll template
4488 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
4489 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
4490 *
4491 * Creates a PS Poll a template which can, for example, uploaded to
4492 * hardware. The template must be updated after association so that correct
4493 * AID, BSSID and MAC address is used.
4494 *
4495 * Note: Caller (or hardware) is responsible for setting the
4496 * &IEEE80211_FCTL_PM bit.
4497 *
4498 * Return: The PS Poll template. %NULL on error.
4499 */
4500struct sk_buff *ieee80211_pspoll_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4501				     struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4502
4503/**
4504 * ieee80211_nullfunc_get - retrieve a nullfunc template
4505 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
4506 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
 
 
 
4507 * @qos_ok: QoS NDP is acceptable to the caller, this should be set
4508 *	if at all possible
4509 *
4510 * Creates a Nullfunc template which can, for example, uploaded to
4511 * hardware. The template must be updated after association so that correct
4512 * BSSID and address is used.
4513 *
4514 * If @qos_ndp is set and the association is to an AP with QoS/WMM, the
4515 * returned packet will be QoS NDP.
4516 *
4517 * Note: Caller (or hardware) is responsible for setting the
4518 * &IEEE80211_FCTL_PM bit as well as Duration and Sequence Control fields.
4519 *
4520 * Return: The nullfunc template. %NULL on error.
4521 */
4522struct sk_buff *ieee80211_nullfunc_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4523				       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4524				       bool qos_ok);
4525
4526/**
4527 * ieee80211_probereq_get - retrieve a Probe Request template
4528 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
4529 * @src_addr: source MAC address
4530 * @ssid: SSID buffer
4531 * @ssid_len: length of SSID
4532 * @tailroom: tailroom to reserve at end of SKB for IEs
4533 *
4534 * Creates a Probe Request template which can, for example, be uploaded to
4535 * hardware.
4536 *
4537 * Return: The Probe Request template. %NULL on error.
4538 */
4539struct sk_buff *ieee80211_probereq_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4540				       const u8 *src_addr,
4541				       const u8 *ssid, size_t ssid_len,
4542				       size_t tailroom);
4543
4544/**
4545 * ieee80211_rts_get - RTS frame generation function
4546 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
4547 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
4548 * @frame: pointer to the frame that is going to be protected by the RTS.
4549 * @frame_len: the frame length (in octets).
4550 * @frame_txctl: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame.
4551 * @rts: The buffer where to store the RTS frame.
4552 *
4553 * If the RTS frames are generated by the host system (i.e., not in
4554 * hardware/firmware), the low-level driver uses this function to receive
4555 * the next RTS frame from the 802.11 code. The low-level is responsible
4556 * for calling this function before and RTS frame is needed.
4557 */
4558void ieee80211_rts_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4559		       const void *frame, size_t frame_len,
4560		       const struct ieee80211_tx_info *frame_txctl,
4561		       struct ieee80211_rts *rts);
4562
4563/**
4564 * ieee80211_rts_duration - Get the duration field for an RTS frame
4565 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
4566 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
4567 * @frame_len: the length of the frame that is going to be protected by the RTS.
4568 * @frame_txctl: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame.
4569 *
4570 * If the RTS is generated in firmware, but the host system must provide
4571 * the duration field, the low-level driver uses this function to receive
4572 * the duration field value in little-endian byteorder.
4573 *
4574 * Return: The duration.
4575 */
4576__le16 ieee80211_rts_duration(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4577			      struct ieee80211_vif *vif, size_t frame_len,
4578			      const struct ieee80211_tx_info *frame_txctl);
4579
4580/**
4581 * ieee80211_ctstoself_get - CTS-to-self frame generation function
4582 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
4583 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
4584 * @frame: pointer to the frame that is going to be protected by the CTS-to-self.
4585 * @frame_len: the frame length (in octets).
4586 * @frame_txctl: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame.
4587 * @cts: The buffer where to store the CTS-to-self frame.
4588 *
4589 * If the CTS-to-self frames are generated by the host system (i.e., not in
4590 * hardware/firmware), the low-level driver uses this function to receive
4591 * the next CTS-to-self frame from the 802.11 code. The low-level is responsible
4592 * for calling this function before and CTS-to-self frame is needed.
4593 */
4594void ieee80211_ctstoself_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4595			     struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4596			     const void *frame, size_t frame_len,
4597			     const struct ieee80211_tx_info *frame_txctl,
4598			     struct ieee80211_cts *cts);
4599
4600/**
4601 * ieee80211_ctstoself_duration - Get the duration field for a CTS-to-self frame
4602 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
4603 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
4604 * @frame_len: the length of the frame that is going to be protected by the CTS-to-self.
4605 * @frame_txctl: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame.
4606 *
4607 * If the CTS-to-self is generated in firmware, but the host system must provide
4608 * the duration field, the low-level driver uses this function to receive
4609 * the duration field value in little-endian byteorder.
4610 *
4611 * Return: The duration.
4612 */
4613__le16 ieee80211_ctstoself_duration(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4614				    struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4615				    size_t frame_len,
4616				    const struct ieee80211_tx_info *frame_txctl);
4617
4618/**
4619 * ieee80211_generic_frame_duration - Calculate the duration field for a frame
4620 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
4621 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
4622 * @band: the band to calculate the frame duration on
4623 * @frame_len: the length of the frame.
4624 * @rate: the rate at which the frame is going to be transmitted.
4625 *
4626 * Calculate the duration field of some generic frame, given its
4627 * length and transmission rate (in 100kbps).
4628 *
4629 * Return: The duration.
4630 */
4631__le16 ieee80211_generic_frame_duration(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4632					struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4633					enum nl80211_band band,
4634					size_t frame_len,
4635					struct ieee80211_rate *rate);
4636
4637/**
4638 * ieee80211_get_buffered_bc - accessing buffered broadcast and multicast frames
4639 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
4640 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
4641 *
4642 * Function for accessing buffered broadcast and multicast frames. If
4643 * hardware/firmware does not implement buffering of broadcast/multicast
4644 * frames when power saving is used, 802.11 code buffers them in the host
4645 * memory. The low-level driver uses this function to fetch next buffered
4646 * frame. In most cases, this is used when generating beacon frame.
4647 *
4648 * Return: A pointer to the next buffered skb or NULL if no more buffered
4649 * frames are available.
4650 *
4651 * Note: buffered frames are returned only after DTIM beacon frame was
4652 * generated with ieee80211_beacon_get() and the low-level driver must thus
4653 * call ieee80211_beacon_get() first. ieee80211_get_buffered_bc() returns
4654 * NULL if the previous generated beacon was not DTIM, so the low-level driver
4655 * does not need to check for DTIM beacons separately and should be able to
4656 * use common code for all beacons.
4657 */
4658struct sk_buff *
4659ieee80211_get_buffered_bc(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4660
4661/**
4662 * ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k_iv - get a TKIP phase 1 key for IV32
4663 *
4664 * This function returns the TKIP phase 1 key for the given IV32.
4665 *
4666 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
4667 * @iv32: IV32 to get the P1K for
4668 * @p1k: a buffer to which the key will be written, as 5 u16 values
4669 */
4670void ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k_iv(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
4671			       u32 iv32, u16 *p1k);
4672
4673/**
4674 * ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k - get a TKIP phase 1 key
4675 *
4676 * This function returns the TKIP phase 1 key for the IV32 taken
4677 * from the given packet.
4678 *
4679 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
4680 * @skb: the packet to take the IV32 value from that will be encrypted
4681 *	with this P1K
4682 * @p1k: a buffer to which the key will be written, as 5 u16 values
4683 */
4684static inline void ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
4685					  struct sk_buff *skb, u16 *p1k)
4686{
4687	struct ieee80211_hdr *hdr = (struct ieee80211_hdr *)skb->data;
4688	const u8 *data = (u8 *)hdr + ieee80211_hdrlen(hdr->frame_control);
4689	u32 iv32 = get_unaligned_le32(&data[4]);
4690
4691	ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k_iv(keyconf, iv32, p1k);
4692}
4693
4694/**
4695 * ieee80211_get_tkip_rx_p1k - get a TKIP phase 1 key for RX
4696 *
4697 * This function returns the TKIP phase 1 key for the given IV32
4698 * and transmitter address.
4699 *
4700 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
4701 * @ta: TA that will be used with the key
4702 * @iv32: IV32 to get the P1K for
4703 * @p1k: a buffer to which the key will be written, as 5 u16 values
4704 */
4705void ieee80211_get_tkip_rx_p1k(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
4706			       const u8 *ta, u32 iv32, u16 *p1k);
4707
4708/**
4709 * ieee80211_get_tkip_p2k - get a TKIP phase 2 key
4710 *
4711 * This function computes the TKIP RC4 key for the IV values
4712 * in the packet.
4713 *
4714 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
4715 * @skb: the packet to take the IV32/IV16 values from that will be
4716 *	encrypted with this key
4717 * @p2k: a buffer to which the key will be written, 16 bytes
4718 */
4719void ieee80211_get_tkip_p2k(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
4720			    struct sk_buff *skb, u8 *p2k);
4721
4722/**
4723 * ieee80211_tkip_add_iv - write TKIP IV and Ext. IV to pos
4724 *
4725 * @pos: start of crypto header
4726 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
4727 * @pn: PN to add
4728 *
4729 * Returns: pointer to the octet following IVs (i.e. beginning of
4730 * the packet payload)
4731 *
4732 * This function writes the tkip IV value to pos (which should
4733 * point to the crypto header)
4734 */
4735u8 *ieee80211_tkip_add_iv(u8 *pos, struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf, u64 pn);
4736
4737/**
4738 * ieee80211_get_key_rx_seq - get key RX sequence counter
4739 *
4740 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
4741 * @tid: The TID, or -1 for the management frame value (CCMP/GCMP only);
4742 *	the value on TID 0 is also used for non-QoS frames. For
4743 *	CMAC, only TID 0 is valid.
4744 * @seq: buffer to receive the sequence data
4745 *
4746 * This function allows a driver to retrieve the current RX IV/PNs
4747 * for the given key. It must not be called if IV checking is done
4748 * by the device and not by mac80211.
4749 *
4750 * Note that this function may only be called when no RX processing
4751 * can be done concurrently.
4752 */
4753void ieee80211_get_key_rx_seq(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
4754			      int tid, struct ieee80211_key_seq *seq);
4755
4756/**
4757 * ieee80211_set_key_rx_seq - set key RX sequence counter
4758 *
4759 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
4760 * @tid: The TID, or -1 for the management frame value (CCMP/GCMP only);
4761 *	the value on TID 0 is also used for non-QoS frames. For
4762 *	CMAC, only TID 0 is valid.
4763 * @seq: new sequence data
4764 *
4765 * This function allows a driver to set the current RX IV/PNs for the
4766 * given key. This is useful when resuming from WoWLAN sleep and GTK
4767 * rekey may have been done while suspended. It should not be called
4768 * if IV checking is done by the device and not by mac80211.
4769 *
4770 * Note that this function may only be called when no RX processing
4771 * can be done concurrently.
4772 */
4773void ieee80211_set_key_rx_seq(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
4774			      int tid, struct ieee80211_key_seq *seq);
4775
4776/**
4777 * ieee80211_remove_key - remove the given key
4778 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
4779 *
 
 
4780 * Remove the given key. If the key was uploaded to the hardware at the
4781 * time this function is called, it is not deleted in the hardware but
4782 * instead assumed to have been removed already.
4783 *
4784 * Note that due to locking considerations this function can (currently)
4785 * only be called during key iteration (ieee80211_iter_keys().)
4786 */
4787void ieee80211_remove_key(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf);
4788
4789/**
4790 * ieee80211_gtk_rekey_add - add a GTK key from rekeying during WoWLAN
4791 * @vif: the virtual interface to add the key on
4792 * @keyconf: new key data
4793 *
4794 * When GTK rekeying was done while the system was suspended, (a) new
4795 * key(s) will be available. These will be needed by mac80211 for proper
4796 * RX processing, so this function allows setting them.
4797 *
4798 * The function returns the newly allocated key structure, which will
4799 * have similar contents to the passed key configuration but point to
4800 * mac80211-owned memory. In case of errors, the function returns an
4801 * ERR_PTR(), use IS_ERR() etc.
4802 *
4803 * Note that this function assumes the key isn't added to hardware
4804 * acceleration, so no TX will be done with the key. Since it's a GTK
4805 * on managed (station) networks, this is true anyway. If the driver
4806 * calls this function from the resume callback and subsequently uses
4807 * the return code 1 to reconfigure the device, this key will be part
4808 * of the reconfiguration.
4809 *
4810 * Note that the driver should also call ieee80211_set_key_rx_seq()
4811 * for the new key for each TID to set up sequence counters properly.
4812 *
4813 * IMPORTANT: If this replaces a key that is present in the hardware,
4814 * then it will attempt to remove it during this call. In many cases
4815 * this isn't what you want, so call ieee80211_remove_key() first for
4816 * the key that's being replaced.
4817 */
4818struct ieee80211_key_conf *
4819ieee80211_gtk_rekey_add(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4820			struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf);
4821
4822/**
4823 * ieee80211_gtk_rekey_notify - notify userspace supplicant of rekeying
4824 * @vif: virtual interface the rekeying was done on
4825 * @bssid: The BSSID of the AP, for checking association
4826 * @replay_ctr: the new replay counter after GTK rekeying
4827 * @gfp: allocation flags
4828 */
4829void ieee80211_gtk_rekey_notify(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *bssid,
4830				const u8 *replay_ctr, gfp_t gfp);
4831
4832/**
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
4833 * ieee80211_wake_queue - wake specific queue
4834 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
4835 * @queue: queue number (counted from zero).
4836 *
4837 * Drivers should use this function instead of netif_wake_queue.
4838 */
4839void ieee80211_wake_queue(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int queue);
4840
4841/**
4842 * ieee80211_stop_queue - stop specific queue
4843 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
4844 * @queue: queue number (counted from zero).
4845 *
4846 * Drivers should use this function instead of netif_stop_queue.
4847 */
4848void ieee80211_stop_queue(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int queue);
4849
4850/**
4851 * ieee80211_queue_stopped - test status of the queue
4852 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
4853 * @queue: queue number (counted from zero).
4854 *
4855 * Drivers should use this function instead of netif_stop_queue.
4856 *
4857 * Return: %true if the queue is stopped. %false otherwise.
4858 */
4859
4860int ieee80211_queue_stopped(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int queue);
4861
4862/**
4863 * ieee80211_stop_queues - stop all queues
4864 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
4865 *
4866 * Drivers should use this function instead of netif_stop_queue.
4867 */
4868void ieee80211_stop_queues(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4869
4870/**
4871 * ieee80211_wake_queues - wake all queues
4872 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
4873 *
4874 * Drivers should use this function instead of netif_wake_queue.
4875 */
4876void ieee80211_wake_queues(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4877
4878/**
4879 * ieee80211_scan_completed - completed hardware scan
4880 *
4881 * When hardware scan offload is used (i.e. the hw_scan() callback is
4882 * assigned) this function needs to be called by the driver to notify
4883 * mac80211 that the scan finished. This function can be called from
4884 * any context, including hardirq context.
4885 *
4886 * @hw: the hardware that finished the scan
4887 * @info: information about the completed scan
4888 */
4889void ieee80211_scan_completed(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4890			      struct cfg80211_scan_info *info);
4891
4892/**
4893 * ieee80211_sched_scan_results - got results from scheduled scan
4894 *
4895 * When a scheduled scan is running, this function needs to be called by the
4896 * driver whenever there are new scan results available.
4897 *
4898 * @hw: the hardware that is performing scheduled scans
4899 */
4900void ieee80211_sched_scan_results(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4901
4902/**
4903 * ieee80211_sched_scan_stopped - inform that the scheduled scan has stopped
4904 *
4905 * When a scheduled scan is running, this function can be called by
4906 * the driver if it needs to stop the scan to perform another task.
4907 * Usual scenarios are drivers that cannot continue the scheduled scan
4908 * while associating, for instance.
4909 *
4910 * @hw: the hardware that is performing scheduled scans
4911 */
4912void ieee80211_sched_scan_stopped(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4913
4914/**
4915 * enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags - interface iteration flags
4916 * @IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_NORMAL: Iterate over all interfaces that have
4917 *	been added to the driver; However, note that during hardware
4918 *	reconfiguration (after restart_hw) it will iterate over a new
4919 *	interface and over all the existing interfaces even if they
4920 *	haven't been re-added to the driver yet.
4921 * @IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_RESUME_ALL: During resume, iterate over all
4922 *	interfaces, even if they haven't been re-added to the driver yet.
4923 * @IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_ACTIVE: Iterate only active interfaces (netdev is up).
 
 
 
4924 */
4925enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags {
4926	IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_NORMAL	= 0,
4927	IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_RESUME_ALL	= BIT(0),
4928	IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_ACTIVE	= BIT(1),
 
4929};
4930
4931/**
4932 * ieee80211_iterate_interfaces - iterate interfaces
4933 *
4934 * This function iterates over the interfaces associated with a given
4935 * hardware and calls the callback for them. This includes active as well as
4936 * inactive interfaces. This function allows the iterator function to sleep.
4937 * Will iterate over a new interface during add_interface().
4938 *
4939 * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over
4940 * @iter_flags: iteration flags, see &enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags
4941 * @iterator: the iterator function to call
4942 * @data: first argument of the iterator function
4943 */
4944void ieee80211_iterate_interfaces(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 iter_flags,
4945				  void (*iterator)(void *data, u8 *mac,
4946						   struct ieee80211_vif *vif),
4947				  void *data);
4948
4949/**
4950 * ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces - iterate active interfaces
4951 *
4952 * This function iterates over the interfaces associated with a given
4953 * hardware that are currently active and calls the callback for them.
4954 * This function allows the iterator function to sleep, when the iterator
4955 * function is atomic @ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_atomic can
4956 * be used.
4957 * Does not iterate over a new interface during add_interface().
4958 *
4959 * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over
4960 * @iter_flags: iteration flags, see &enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags
4961 * @iterator: the iterator function to call
4962 * @data: first argument of the iterator function
4963 */
4964static inline void
4965ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 iter_flags,
4966				    void (*iterator)(void *data, u8 *mac,
4967						     struct ieee80211_vif *vif),
4968				    void *data)
4969{
4970	ieee80211_iterate_interfaces(hw,
4971				     iter_flags | IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_ACTIVE,
4972				     iterator, data);
4973}
4974
4975/**
4976 * ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_atomic - iterate active interfaces
4977 *
4978 * This function iterates over the interfaces associated with a given
4979 * hardware that are currently active and calls the callback for them.
4980 * This function requires the iterator callback function to be atomic,
4981 * if that is not desired, use @ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces instead.
4982 * Does not iterate over a new interface during add_interface().
4983 *
4984 * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over
4985 * @iter_flags: iteration flags, see &enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags
4986 * @iterator: the iterator function to call, cannot sleep
4987 * @data: first argument of the iterator function
4988 */
4989void ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_atomic(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4990						u32 iter_flags,
4991						void (*iterator)(void *data,
4992						    u8 *mac,
4993						    struct ieee80211_vif *vif),
4994						void *data);
4995
4996/**
4997 * ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_rtnl - iterate active interfaces
4998 *
4999 * This function iterates over the interfaces associated with a given
5000 * hardware that are currently active and calls the callback for them.
5001 * This version can only be used while holding the RTNL.
5002 *
5003 * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over
5004 * @iter_flags: iteration flags, see &enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags
5005 * @iterator: the iterator function to call, cannot sleep
5006 * @data: first argument of the iterator function
5007 */
5008void ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_rtnl(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5009					      u32 iter_flags,
5010					      void (*iterator)(void *data,
5011						u8 *mac,
5012						struct ieee80211_vif *vif),
5013					      void *data);
5014
5015/**
5016 * ieee80211_iterate_stations_atomic - iterate stations
5017 *
5018 * This function iterates over all stations associated with a given
5019 * hardware that are currently uploaded to the driver and calls the callback
5020 * function for them.
5021 * This function requires the iterator callback function to be atomic,
5022 *
5023 * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over
5024 * @iterator: the iterator function to call, cannot sleep
5025 * @data: first argument of the iterator function
5026 */
5027void ieee80211_iterate_stations_atomic(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5028				       void (*iterator)(void *data,
5029						struct ieee80211_sta *sta),
5030				       void *data);
5031/**
5032 * ieee80211_queue_work - add work onto the mac80211 workqueue
5033 *
5034 * Drivers and mac80211 use this to add work onto the mac80211 workqueue.
5035 * This helper ensures drivers are not queueing work when they should not be.
5036 *
5037 * @hw: the hardware struct for the interface we are adding work for
5038 * @work: the work we want to add onto the mac80211 workqueue
5039 */
5040void ieee80211_queue_work(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct work_struct *work);
5041
5042/**
5043 * ieee80211_queue_delayed_work - add work onto the mac80211 workqueue
5044 *
5045 * Drivers and mac80211 use this to queue delayed work onto the mac80211
5046 * workqueue.
5047 *
5048 * @hw: the hardware struct for the interface we are adding work for
5049 * @dwork: delayable work to queue onto the mac80211 workqueue
5050 * @delay: number of jiffies to wait before queueing
5051 */
5052void ieee80211_queue_delayed_work(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5053				  struct delayed_work *dwork,
5054				  unsigned long delay);
5055
5056/**
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
5057 * ieee80211_start_tx_ba_session - Start a tx Block Ack session.
5058 * @sta: the station for which to start a BA session
5059 * @tid: the TID to BA on.
5060 * @timeout: session timeout value (in TUs)
5061 *
5062 * Return: success if addBA request was sent, failure otherwise
5063 *
5064 * Although mac80211/low level driver/user space application can estimate
5065 * the need to start aggregation on a certain RA/TID, the session level
5066 * will be managed by the mac80211.
5067 */
5068int ieee80211_start_tx_ba_session(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u16 tid,
5069				  u16 timeout);
5070
5071/**
5072 * ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe - low level driver ready to aggregate.
5073 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
5074 * @ra: receiver address of the BA session recipient.
5075 * @tid: the TID to BA on.
5076 *
5077 * This function must be called by low level driver once it has
5078 * finished with preparations for the BA session. It can be called
5079 * from any context.
5080 */
5081void ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *ra,
5082				      u16 tid);
5083
5084/**
5085 * ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_session - Stop a Block Ack session.
5086 * @sta: the station whose BA session to stop
5087 * @tid: the TID to stop BA.
5088 *
5089 * Return: negative error if the TID is invalid, or no aggregation active
5090 *
5091 * Although mac80211/low level driver/user space application can estimate
5092 * the need to stop aggregation on a certain RA/TID, the session level
5093 * will be managed by the mac80211.
5094 */
5095int ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_session(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u16 tid);
5096
5097/**
5098 * ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe - low level driver ready to stop aggregate.
5099 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
5100 * @ra: receiver address of the BA session recipient.
5101 * @tid: the desired TID to BA on.
5102 *
5103 * This function must be called by low level driver once it has
5104 * finished with preparations for the BA session tear down. It
5105 * can be called from any context.
5106 */
5107void ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *ra,
5108				     u16 tid);
5109
5110/**
5111 * ieee80211_find_sta - find a station
5112 *
5113 * @vif: virtual interface to look for station on
5114 * @addr: station's address
5115 *
5116 * Return: The station, if found. %NULL otherwise.
5117 *
5118 * Note: This function must be called under RCU lock and the
5119 * resulting pointer is only valid under RCU lock as well.
5120 */
5121struct ieee80211_sta *ieee80211_find_sta(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5122					 const u8 *addr);
5123
5124/**
5125 * ieee80211_find_sta_by_ifaddr - find a station on hardware
5126 *
5127 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
5128 * @addr: remote station's address
5129 * @localaddr: local address (vif->sdata->vif.addr). Use NULL for 'any'.
5130 *
5131 * Return: The station, if found. %NULL otherwise.
5132 *
5133 * Note: This function must be called under RCU lock and the
5134 * resulting pointer is only valid under RCU lock as well.
5135 *
5136 * NOTE: You may pass NULL for localaddr, but then you will just get
5137 *      the first STA that matches the remote address 'addr'.
5138 *      We can have multiple STA associated with multiple
5139 *      logical stations (e.g. consider a station connecting to another
5140 *      BSSID on the same AP hardware without disconnecting first).
5141 *      In this case, the result of this method with localaddr NULL
5142 *      is not reliable.
5143 *
5144 * DO NOT USE THIS FUNCTION with localaddr NULL if at all possible.
5145 */
5146struct ieee80211_sta *ieee80211_find_sta_by_ifaddr(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5147					       const u8 *addr,
5148					       const u8 *localaddr);
5149
5150/**
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
5151 * ieee80211_sta_block_awake - block station from waking up
5152 * @hw: the hardware
5153 * @pubsta: the station
5154 * @block: whether to block or unblock
5155 *
5156 * Some devices require that all frames that are on the queues
5157 * for a specific station that went to sleep are flushed before
5158 * a poll response or frames after the station woke up can be
5159 * delivered to that it. Note that such frames must be rejected
5160 * by the driver as filtered, with the appropriate status flag.
5161 *
5162 * This function allows implementing this mode in a race-free
5163 * manner.
5164 *
5165 * To do this, a driver must keep track of the number of frames
5166 * still enqueued for a specific station. If this number is not
5167 * zero when the station goes to sleep, the driver must call
5168 * this function to force mac80211 to consider the station to
5169 * be asleep regardless of the station's actual state. Once the
5170 * number of outstanding frames reaches zero, the driver must
5171 * call this function again to unblock the station. That will
5172 * cause mac80211 to be able to send ps-poll responses, and if
5173 * the station queried in the meantime then frames will also
5174 * be sent out as a result of this. Additionally, the driver
5175 * will be notified that the station woke up some time after
5176 * it is unblocked, regardless of whether the station actually
5177 * woke up while blocked or not.
5178 */
5179void ieee80211_sta_block_awake(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5180			       struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta, bool block);
5181
5182/**
5183 * ieee80211_sta_eosp - notify mac80211 about end of SP
5184 * @pubsta: the station
5185 *
5186 * When a device transmits frames in a way that it can't tell
5187 * mac80211 in the TX status about the EOSP, it must clear the
5188 * %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP bit and call this function instead.
5189 * This applies for PS-Poll as well as uAPSD.
5190 *
5191 * Note that just like with _tx_status() and _rx() drivers must
5192 * not mix calls to irqsafe/non-irqsafe versions, this function
5193 * must not be mixed with those either. Use the all irqsafe, or
5194 * all non-irqsafe, don't mix!
5195 *
5196 * NB: the _irqsafe version of this function doesn't exist, no
5197 *     driver needs it right now. Don't call this function if
5198 *     you'd need the _irqsafe version, look at the git history
5199 *     and restore the _irqsafe version!
5200 */
5201void ieee80211_sta_eosp(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta);
5202
5203/**
5204 * ieee80211_send_eosp_nullfunc - ask mac80211 to send NDP with EOSP
5205 * @pubsta: the station
5206 * @tid: the tid of the NDP
5207 *
5208 * Sometimes the device understands that it needs to close
5209 * the Service Period unexpectedly. This can happen when
5210 * sending frames that are filling holes in the BA window.
5211 * In this case, the device can ask mac80211 to send a
5212 * Nullfunc frame with EOSP set. When that happens, the
5213 * driver must have called ieee80211_sta_set_buffered() to
5214 * let mac80211 know that there are no buffered frames any
5215 * more, otherwise mac80211 will get the more_data bit wrong.
5216 * The low level driver must have made sure that the frame
5217 * will be sent despite the station being in power-save.
5218 * Mac80211 won't call allow_buffered_frames().
5219 * Note that calling this function, doesn't exempt the driver
5220 * from closing the EOSP properly, it will still have to call
5221 * ieee80211_sta_eosp when the NDP is sent.
5222 */
5223void ieee80211_send_eosp_nullfunc(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta, int tid);
5224
5225/**
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
5226 * ieee80211_iter_keys - iterate keys programmed into the device
5227 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
5228 * @vif: virtual interface to iterate, may be %NULL for all
5229 * @iter: iterator function that will be called for each key
5230 * @iter_data: custom data to pass to the iterator function
5231 *
 
 
5232 * This function can be used to iterate all the keys known to
5233 * mac80211, even those that weren't previously programmed into
5234 * the device. This is intended for use in WoWLAN if the device
5235 * needs reprogramming of the keys during suspend. Note that due
5236 * to locking reasons, it is also only safe to call this at few
5237 * spots since it must hold the RTNL and be able to sleep.
5238 *
5239 * The order in which the keys are iterated matches the order
5240 * in which they were originally installed and handed to the
5241 * set_key callback.
5242 */
5243void ieee80211_iter_keys(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5244			 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5245			 void (*iter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5246				      struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5247				      struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
5248				      struct ieee80211_key_conf *key,
5249				      void *data),
5250			 void *iter_data);
5251
5252/**
5253 * ieee80211_iter_keys_rcu - iterate keys programmed into the device
5254 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
5255 * @vif: virtual interface to iterate, may be %NULL for all
5256 * @iter: iterator function that will be called for each key
5257 * @iter_data: custom data to pass to the iterator function
5258 *
5259 * This function can be used to iterate all the keys known to
5260 * mac80211, even those that weren't previously programmed into
5261 * the device. Note that due to locking reasons, keys of station
5262 * in removal process will be skipped.
5263 *
5264 * This function requires being called in an RCU critical section,
5265 * and thus iter must be atomic.
5266 */
5267void ieee80211_iter_keys_rcu(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5268			     struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5269			     void (*iter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5270					  struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5271					  struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
5272					  struct ieee80211_key_conf *key,
5273					  void *data),
5274			     void *iter_data);
5275
5276/**
5277 * ieee80211_iter_chan_contexts_atomic - iterate channel contexts
5278 * @hw: pointre obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5279 * @iter: iterator function
5280 * @iter_data: data passed to iterator function
5281 *
5282 * Iterate all active channel contexts. This function is atomic and
5283 * doesn't acquire any locks internally that might be held in other
5284 * places while calling into the driver.
5285 *
5286 * The iterator will not find a context that's being added (during
5287 * the driver callback to add it) but will find it while it's being
5288 * removed.
5289 *
5290 * Note that during hardware restart, all contexts that existed
5291 * before the restart are considered already present so will be
5292 * found while iterating, whether they've been re-added already
5293 * or not.
5294 */
5295void ieee80211_iter_chan_contexts_atomic(
5296	struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5297	void (*iter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5298		     struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *chanctx_conf,
5299		     void *data),
5300	void *iter_data);
5301
5302/**
5303 * ieee80211_ap_probereq_get - retrieve a Probe Request template
5304 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5305 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5306 *
5307 * Creates a Probe Request template which can, for example, be uploaded to
5308 * hardware. The template is filled with bssid, ssid and supported rate
5309 * information. This function must only be called from within the
5310 * .bss_info_changed callback function and only in managed mode. The function
5311 * is only useful when the interface is associated, otherwise it will return
5312 * %NULL.
5313 *
5314 * Return: The Probe Request template. %NULL on error.
5315 */
5316struct sk_buff *ieee80211_ap_probereq_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5317					  struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
5318
5319/**
5320 * ieee80211_beacon_loss - inform hardware does not receive beacons
5321 *
5322 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5323 *
5324 * When beacon filtering is enabled with %IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER and
5325 * %IEEE80211_CONF_PS is set, the driver needs to inform whenever the
5326 * hardware is not receiving beacons with this function.
5327 */
5328void ieee80211_beacon_loss(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
5329
5330/**
5331 * ieee80211_connection_loss - inform hardware has lost connection to the AP
5332 *
5333 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5334 *
5335 * When beacon filtering is enabled with %IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER, and
5336 * %IEEE80211_CONF_PS and %IEEE80211_HW_CONNECTION_MONITOR are set, the driver
5337 * needs to inform if the connection to the AP has been lost.
5338 * The function may also be called if the connection needs to be terminated
5339 * for some other reason, even if %IEEE80211_HW_CONNECTION_MONITOR isn't set.
5340 *
5341 * This function will cause immediate change to disassociated state,
5342 * without connection recovery attempts.
5343 */
5344void ieee80211_connection_loss(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
5345
5346/**
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
5347 * ieee80211_resume_disconnect - disconnect from AP after resume
5348 *
5349 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5350 *
5351 * Instructs mac80211 to disconnect from the AP after resume.
5352 * Drivers can use this after WoWLAN if they know that the
5353 * connection cannot be kept up, for example because keys were
5354 * used while the device was asleep but the replay counters or
5355 * similar cannot be retrieved from the device during resume.
5356 *
5357 * Note that due to implementation issues, if the driver uses
5358 * the reconfiguration functionality during resume the interface
5359 * will still be added as associated first during resume and then
5360 * disconnect normally later.
5361 *
5362 * This function can only be called from the resume callback and
5363 * the driver must not be holding any of its own locks while it
5364 * calls this function, or at least not any locks it needs in the
5365 * key configuration paths (if it supports HW crypto).
5366 */
5367void ieee80211_resume_disconnect(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
5368
5369/**
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
5370 * ieee80211_cqm_rssi_notify - inform a configured connection quality monitoring
5371 *	rssi threshold triggered
5372 *
5373 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5374 * @rssi_event: the RSSI trigger event type
5375 * @rssi_level: new RSSI level value or 0 if not available
5376 * @gfp: context flags
5377 *
5378 * When the %IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_CQM_RSSI is set, and a connection quality
5379 * monitoring is configured with an rssi threshold, the driver will inform
5380 * whenever the rssi level reaches the threshold.
5381 */
5382void ieee80211_cqm_rssi_notify(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5383			       enum nl80211_cqm_rssi_threshold_event rssi_event,
5384			       s32 rssi_level,
5385			       gfp_t gfp);
5386
5387/**
5388 * ieee80211_cqm_beacon_loss_notify - inform CQM of beacon loss
5389 *
5390 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5391 * @gfp: context flags
5392 */
5393void ieee80211_cqm_beacon_loss_notify(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, gfp_t gfp);
5394
5395/**
5396 * ieee80211_radar_detected - inform that a radar was detected
5397 *
5398 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
5399 */
5400void ieee80211_radar_detected(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
5401
5402/**
5403 * ieee80211_chswitch_done - Complete channel switch process
5404 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5405 * @success: make the channel switch successful or not
 
 
5406 *
5407 * Complete the channel switch post-process: set the new operational channel
5408 * and wake up the suspended queues.
5409 */
5410void ieee80211_chswitch_done(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, bool success);
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
5411
5412/**
5413 * ieee80211_request_smps - request SM PS transition
5414 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
 
5415 * @smps_mode: new SM PS mode
5416 *
5417 * This allows the driver to request an SM PS transition in managed
5418 * mode. This is useful when the driver has more information than
5419 * the stack about possible interference, for example by bluetooth.
5420 */
5421void ieee80211_request_smps(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5422			    enum ieee80211_smps_mode smps_mode);
5423
5424/**
5425 * ieee80211_ready_on_channel - notification of remain-on-channel start
5426 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
5427 */
5428void ieee80211_ready_on_channel(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
5429
5430/**
5431 * ieee80211_remain_on_channel_expired - remain_on_channel duration expired
5432 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
5433 */
5434void ieee80211_remain_on_channel_expired(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
5435
5436/**
5437 * ieee80211_stop_rx_ba_session - callback to stop existing BA sessions
5438 *
5439 * in order not to harm the system performance and user experience, the device
5440 * may request not to allow any rx ba session and tear down existing rx ba
5441 * sessions based on system constraints such as periodic BT activity that needs
5442 * to limit wlan activity (eg.sco or a2dp)."
5443 * in such cases, the intention is to limit the duration of the rx ppdu and
5444 * therefore prevent the peer device to use a-mpdu aggregation.
5445 *
5446 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5447 * @ba_rx_bitmap: Bit map of open rx ba per tid
5448 * @addr: & to bssid mac address
5449 */
5450void ieee80211_stop_rx_ba_session(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, u16 ba_rx_bitmap,
5451				  const u8 *addr);
5452
5453/**
5454 * ieee80211_mark_rx_ba_filtered_frames - move RX BA window and mark filtered
5455 * @pubsta: station struct
5456 * @tid: the session's TID
5457 * @ssn: starting sequence number of the bitmap, all frames before this are
5458 *	assumed to be out of the window after the call
5459 * @filtered: bitmap of filtered frames, BIT(0) is the @ssn entry etc.
5460 * @received_mpdus: number of received mpdus in firmware
5461 *
5462 * This function moves the BA window and releases all frames before @ssn, and
5463 * marks frames marked in the bitmap as having been filtered. Afterwards, it
5464 * checks if any frames in the window starting from @ssn can now be released
5465 * (in case they were only waiting for frames that were filtered.)
 
5466 */
5467void ieee80211_mark_rx_ba_filtered_frames(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta, u8 tid,
5468					  u16 ssn, u64 filtered,
5469					  u16 received_mpdus);
5470
5471/**
5472 * ieee80211_send_bar - send a BlockAckReq frame
5473 *
5474 * can be used to flush pending frames from the peer's aggregation reorder
5475 * buffer.
5476 *
5477 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5478 * @ra: the peer's destination address
5479 * @tid: the TID of the aggregation session
5480 * @ssn: the new starting sequence number for the receiver
5481 */
5482void ieee80211_send_bar(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, u8 *ra, u16 tid, u16 ssn);
5483
5484/**
5485 * ieee80211_manage_rx_ba_offl - helper to queue an RX BA work
5486 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
5487 * @addr: station mac address
5488 * @tid: the rx tid
5489 */
5490void ieee80211_manage_rx_ba_offl(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *addr,
5491				 unsigned int tid);
5492
5493/**
5494 * ieee80211_start_rx_ba_session_offl - start a Rx BA session
5495 *
5496 * Some device drivers may offload part of the Rx aggregation flow including
5497 * AddBa/DelBa negotiation but may otherwise be incapable of full Rx
5498 * reordering.
5499 *
5500 * Create structures responsible for reordering so device drivers may call here
5501 * when they complete AddBa negotiation.
5502 *
5503 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
5504 * @addr: station mac address
5505 * @tid: the rx tid
5506 */
5507static inline void ieee80211_start_rx_ba_session_offl(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5508						      const u8 *addr, u16 tid)
5509{
5510	if (WARN_ON(tid >= IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS))
5511		return;
5512	ieee80211_manage_rx_ba_offl(vif, addr, tid);
5513}
5514
5515/**
5516 * ieee80211_stop_rx_ba_session_offl - stop a Rx BA session
5517 *
5518 * Some device drivers may offload part of the Rx aggregation flow including
5519 * AddBa/DelBa negotiation but may otherwise be incapable of full Rx
5520 * reordering.
5521 *
5522 * Destroy structures responsible for reordering so device drivers may call here
5523 * when they complete DelBa negotiation.
5524 *
5525 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
5526 * @addr: station mac address
5527 * @tid: the rx tid
5528 */
5529static inline void ieee80211_stop_rx_ba_session_offl(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5530						     const u8 *addr, u16 tid)
5531{
5532	if (WARN_ON(tid >= IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS))
5533		return;
5534	ieee80211_manage_rx_ba_offl(vif, addr, tid + IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS);
5535}
5536
5537/**
5538 * ieee80211_rx_ba_timer_expired - stop a Rx BA session due to timeout
5539 *
5540 * Some device drivers do not offload AddBa/DelBa negotiation, but handle rx
5541 * buffer reording internally, and therefore also handle the session timer.
5542 *
5543 * Trigger the timeout flow, which sends a DelBa.
5544 *
5545 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
5546 * @addr: station mac address
5547 * @tid: the rx tid
5548 */
5549void ieee80211_rx_ba_timer_expired(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5550				   const u8 *addr, unsigned int tid);
5551
5552/* Rate control API */
5553
5554/**
5555 * struct ieee80211_tx_rate_control - rate control information for/from RC algo
5556 *
5557 * @hw: The hardware the algorithm is invoked for.
5558 * @sband: The band this frame is being transmitted on.
5559 * @bss_conf: the current BSS configuration
5560 * @skb: the skb that will be transmitted, the control information in it needs
5561 *	to be filled in
5562 * @reported_rate: The rate control algorithm can fill this in to indicate
5563 *	which rate should be reported to userspace as the current rate and
5564 *	used for rate calculations in the mesh network.
5565 * @rts: whether RTS will be used for this frame because it is longer than the
5566 *	RTS threshold
5567 * @short_preamble: whether mac80211 will request short-preamble transmission
5568 *	if the selected rate supports it
5569 * @rate_idx_mask: user-requested (legacy) rate mask
5570 * @rate_idx_mcs_mask: user-requested MCS rate mask (NULL if not in use)
5571 * @bss: whether this frame is sent out in AP or IBSS mode
5572 */
5573struct ieee80211_tx_rate_control {
5574	struct ieee80211_hw *hw;
5575	struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband;
5576	struct ieee80211_bss_conf *bss_conf;
5577	struct sk_buff *skb;
5578	struct ieee80211_tx_rate reported_rate;
5579	bool rts, short_preamble;
5580	u32 rate_idx_mask;
5581	u8 *rate_idx_mcs_mask;
5582	bool bss;
5583};
5584
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
5585struct rate_control_ops {
 
5586	const char *name;
5587	void *(*alloc)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct dentry *debugfsdir);
 
 
5588	void (*free)(void *priv);
5589
5590	void *(*alloc_sta)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_sta *sta, gfp_t gfp);
5591	void (*rate_init)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
5592			  struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
5593			  struct ieee80211_sta *sta, void *priv_sta);
5594	void (*rate_update)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
5595			    struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
5596			    struct ieee80211_sta *sta, void *priv_sta,
5597			    u32 changed);
5598	void (*free_sta)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
5599			 void *priv_sta);
5600
5601	void (*tx_status_ext)(void *priv,
5602			      struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
5603			      void *priv_sta, struct ieee80211_tx_status *st);
5604	void (*tx_status)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
5605			  struct ieee80211_sta *sta, void *priv_sta,
5606			  struct sk_buff *skb);
5607	void (*get_rate)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_sta *sta, void *priv_sta,
5608			 struct ieee80211_tx_rate_control *txrc);
5609
5610	void (*add_sta_debugfs)(void *priv, void *priv_sta,
5611				struct dentry *dir);
5612	void (*remove_sta_debugfs)(void *priv, void *priv_sta);
5613
5614	u32 (*get_expected_throughput)(void *priv_sta);
5615};
5616
5617static inline int rate_supported(struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
5618				 enum nl80211_band band,
5619				 int index)
5620{
5621	return (sta == NULL || sta->supp_rates[band] & BIT(index));
5622}
5623
5624/**
5625 * rate_control_send_low - helper for drivers for management/no-ack frames
5626 *
5627 * Rate control algorithms that agree to use the lowest rate to
5628 * send management frames and NO_ACK data with the respective hw
5629 * retries should use this in the beginning of their mac80211 get_rate
5630 * callback. If true is returned the rate control can simply return.
5631 * If false is returned we guarantee that sta and sta and priv_sta is
5632 * not null.
5633 *
5634 * Rate control algorithms wishing to do more intelligent selection of
5635 * rate for multicast/broadcast frames may choose to not use this.
5636 *
5637 * @sta: &struct ieee80211_sta pointer to the target destination. Note
5638 * 	that this may be null.
5639 * @priv_sta: private rate control structure. This may be null.
5640 * @txrc: rate control information we sholud populate for mac80211.
5641 */
5642bool rate_control_send_low(struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
5643			   void *priv_sta,
5644			   struct ieee80211_tx_rate_control *txrc);
5645
5646
5647static inline s8
5648rate_lowest_index(struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
5649		  struct ieee80211_sta *sta)
5650{
5651	int i;
5652
5653	for (i = 0; i < sband->n_bitrates; i++)
5654		if (rate_supported(sta, sband->band, i))
5655			return i;
5656
5657	/* warn when we cannot find a rate. */
5658	WARN_ON_ONCE(1);
5659
5660	/* and return 0 (the lowest index) */
5661	return 0;
5662}
5663
5664static inline
5665bool rate_usable_index_exists(struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
5666			      struct ieee80211_sta *sta)
5667{
5668	unsigned int i;
5669
5670	for (i = 0; i < sband->n_bitrates; i++)
5671		if (rate_supported(sta, sband->band, i))
5672			return true;
5673	return false;
5674}
5675
5676/**
5677 * rate_control_set_rates - pass the sta rate selection to mac80211/driver
5678 *
5679 * When not doing a rate control probe to test rates, rate control should pass
5680 * its rate selection to mac80211. If the driver supports receiving a station
5681 * rate table, it will use it to ensure that frames are always sent based on
5682 * the most recent rate control module decision.
5683 *
5684 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
5685 * @pubsta: &struct ieee80211_sta pointer to the target destination.
5686 * @rates: new tx rate set to be used for this station.
5687 */
5688int rate_control_set_rates(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5689			   struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta,
5690			   struct ieee80211_sta_rates *rates);
5691
5692int ieee80211_rate_control_register(const struct rate_control_ops *ops);
5693void ieee80211_rate_control_unregister(const struct rate_control_ops *ops);
5694
5695static inline bool
5696conf_is_ht20(struct ieee80211_conf *conf)
5697{
5698	return conf->chandef.width == NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20;
5699}
5700
5701static inline bool
5702conf_is_ht40_minus(struct ieee80211_conf *conf)
5703{
5704	return conf->chandef.width == NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_40 &&
5705	       conf->chandef.center_freq1 < conf->chandef.chan->center_freq;
5706}
5707
5708static inline bool
5709conf_is_ht40_plus(struct ieee80211_conf *conf)
5710{
5711	return conf->chandef.width == NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_40 &&
5712	       conf->chandef.center_freq1 > conf->chandef.chan->center_freq;
5713}
5714
5715static inline bool
5716conf_is_ht40(struct ieee80211_conf *conf)
5717{
5718	return conf->chandef.width == NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_40;
5719}
5720
5721static inline bool
5722conf_is_ht(struct ieee80211_conf *conf)
5723{
5724	return (conf->chandef.width != NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_5) &&
5725		(conf->chandef.width != NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_10) &&
5726		(conf->chandef.width != NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20_NOHT);
5727}
5728
5729static inline enum nl80211_iftype
5730ieee80211_iftype_p2p(enum nl80211_iftype type, bool p2p)
5731{
5732	if (p2p) {
5733		switch (type) {
5734		case NL80211_IFTYPE_STATION:
5735			return NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_CLIENT;
5736		case NL80211_IFTYPE_AP:
5737			return NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_GO;
5738		default:
5739			break;
5740		}
5741	}
5742	return type;
5743}
5744
5745static inline enum nl80211_iftype
5746ieee80211_vif_type_p2p(struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
5747{
5748	return ieee80211_iftype_p2p(vif->type, vif->p2p);
5749}
5750
5751/**
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
5752 * ieee80211_update_mu_groups - set the VHT MU-MIMO groud data
5753 *
5754 * @vif: the specified virtual interface
 
5755 * @membership: 64 bits array - a bit is set if station is member of the group
5756 * @position: 2 bits per group id indicating the position in the group
5757 *
5758 * Note: This function assumes that the given vif is valid and the position and
5759 * membership data is of the correct size and are in the same byte order as the
5760 * matching GroupId management frame.
5761 * Calls to this function need to be serialized with RX path.
5762 */
5763void ieee80211_update_mu_groups(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5764				const u8 *membership, const u8 *position);
5765
5766void ieee80211_enable_rssi_reports(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5767				   int rssi_min_thold,
5768				   int rssi_max_thold);
5769
5770void ieee80211_disable_rssi_reports(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
5771
5772/**
5773 * ieee80211_ave_rssi - report the average RSSI for the specified interface
5774 *
5775 * @vif: the specified virtual interface
5776 *
5777 * Note: This function assumes that the given vif is valid.
5778 *
5779 * Return: The average RSSI value for the requested interface, or 0 if not
5780 * applicable.
5781 */
5782int ieee80211_ave_rssi(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
5783
5784/**
5785 * ieee80211_report_wowlan_wakeup - report WoWLAN wakeup
5786 * @vif: virtual interface
5787 * @wakeup: wakeup reason(s)
5788 * @gfp: allocation flags
5789 *
5790 * See cfg80211_report_wowlan_wakeup().
5791 */
5792void ieee80211_report_wowlan_wakeup(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5793				    struct cfg80211_wowlan_wakeup *wakeup,
5794				    gfp_t gfp);
5795
5796/**
5797 * ieee80211_tx_prepare_skb - prepare an 802.11 skb for transmission
5798 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
5799 * @vif: virtual interface
5800 * @skb: frame to be sent from within the driver
5801 * @band: the band to transmit on
5802 * @sta: optional pointer to get the station to send the frame to
5803 *
5804 * Note: must be called under RCU lock
5805 */
5806bool ieee80211_tx_prepare_skb(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5807			      struct ieee80211_vif *vif, struct sk_buff *skb,
5808			      int band, struct ieee80211_sta **sta);
5809
5810/**
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
5811 * struct ieee80211_noa_data - holds temporary data for tracking P2P NoA state
5812 *
5813 * @next_tsf: TSF timestamp of the next absent state change
5814 * @has_next_tsf: next absent state change event pending
5815 *
5816 * @absent: descriptor bitmask, set if GO is currently absent
5817 *
5818 * private:
5819 *
5820 * @count: count fields from the NoA descriptors
5821 * @desc: adjusted data from the NoA
5822 */
5823struct ieee80211_noa_data {
5824	u32 next_tsf;
5825	bool has_next_tsf;
5826
5827	u8 absent;
5828
5829	u8 count[IEEE80211_P2P_NOA_DESC_MAX];
5830	struct {
5831		u32 start;
5832		u32 duration;
5833		u32 interval;
5834	} desc[IEEE80211_P2P_NOA_DESC_MAX];
5835};
5836
5837/**
5838 * ieee80211_parse_p2p_noa - initialize NoA tracking data from P2P IE
5839 *
5840 * @attr: P2P NoA IE
5841 * @data: NoA tracking data
5842 * @tsf: current TSF timestamp
5843 *
5844 * Return: number of successfully parsed descriptors
5845 */
5846int ieee80211_parse_p2p_noa(const struct ieee80211_p2p_noa_attr *attr,
5847			    struct ieee80211_noa_data *data, u32 tsf);
5848
5849/**
5850 * ieee80211_update_p2p_noa - get next pending P2P GO absent state change
5851 *
5852 * @data: NoA tracking data
5853 * @tsf: current TSF timestamp
5854 */
5855void ieee80211_update_p2p_noa(struct ieee80211_noa_data *data, u32 tsf);
5856
5857/**
5858 * ieee80211_tdls_oper - request userspace to perform a TDLS operation
5859 * @vif: virtual interface
5860 * @peer: the peer's destination address
5861 * @oper: the requested TDLS operation
5862 * @reason_code: reason code for the operation, valid for TDLS teardown
5863 * @gfp: allocation flags
5864 *
5865 * See cfg80211_tdls_oper_request().
5866 */
5867void ieee80211_tdls_oper_request(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *peer,
5868				 enum nl80211_tdls_operation oper,
5869				 u16 reason_code, gfp_t gfp);
5870
5871/**
5872 * ieee80211_reserve_tid - request to reserve a specific TID
5873 *
5874 * There is sometimes a need (such as in TDLS) for blocking the driver from
5875 * using a specific TID so that the FW can use it for certain operations such
5876 * as sending PTI requests. To make sure that the driver doesn't use that TID,
5877 * this function must be called as it flushes out packets on this TID and marks
5878 * it as blocked, so that any transmit for the station on this TID will be
5879 * redirected to the alternative TID in the same AC.
5880 *
5881 * Note that this function blocks and may call back into the driver, so it
5882 * should be called without driver locks held. Also note this function should
5883 * only be called from the driver's @sta_state callback.
5884 *
5885 * @sta: the station to reserve the TID for
5886 * @tid: the TID to reserve
5887 *
5888 * Returns: 0 on success, else on failure
5889 */
5890int ieee80211_reserve_tid(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 tid);
5891
5892/**
5893 * ieee80211_unreserve_tid - request to unreserve a specific TID
5894 *
5895 * Once there is no longer any need for reserving a certain TID, this function
5896 * should be called, and no longer will packets have their TID modified for
5897 * preventing use of this TID in the driver.
5898 *
5899 * Note that this function blocks and acquires a lock, so it should be called
5900 * without driver locks held. Also note this function should only be called
5901 * from the driver's @sta_state callback.
5902 *
5903 * @sta: the station
5904 * @tid: the TID to unreserve
5905 */
5906void ieee80211_unreserve_tid(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 tid);
5907
5908/**
5909 * ieee80211_tx_dequeue - dequeue a packet from a software tx queue
5910 *
5911 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
5912 * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface
 
5913 *
5914 * Returns the skb if successful, %NULL if no frame was available.
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
5915 */
5916struct sk_buff *ieee80211_tx_dequeue(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5917				     struct ieee80211_txq *txq);
5918
5919/**
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
5920 * ieee80211_txq_get_depth - get pending frame/byte count of given txq
5921 *
5922 * The values are not guaranteed to be coherent with regard to each other, i.e.
5923 * txq state can change half-way of this function and the caller may end up
5924 * with "new" frame_cnt and "old" byte_cnt or vice-versa.
5925 *
5926 * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface
5927 * @frame_cnt: pointer to store frame count
5928 * @byte_cnt: pointer to store byte count
5929 */
5930void ieee80211_txq_get_depth(struct ieee80211_txq *txq,
5931			     unsigned long *frame_cnt,
5932			     unsigned long *byte_cnt);
5933
5934/**
5935 * ieee80211_nan_func_terminated - notify about NAN function termination.
5936 *
5937 * This function is used to notify mac80211 about NAN function termination.
5938 * Note that this function can't be called from hard irq.
5939 *
5940 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5941 * @inst_id: the local instance id
5942 * @reason: termination reason (one of the NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_*)
5943 * @gfp: allocation flags
5944 */
5945void ieee80211_nan_func_terminated(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5946				   u8 inst_id,
5947				   enum nl80211_nan_func_term_reason reason,
5948				   gfp_t gfp);
5949
5950/**
5951 * ieee80211_nan_func_match - notify about NAN function match event.
5952 *
5953 * This function is used to notify mac80211 about NAN function match. The
5954 * cookie inside the match struct will be assigned by mac80211.
5955 * Note that this function can't be called from hard irq.
5956 *
5957 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5958 * @match: match event information
5959 * @gfp: allocation flags
5960 */
5961void ieee80211_nan_func_match(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5962			      struct cfg80211_nan_match_params *match,
5963			      gfp_t gfp);
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
5964
5965#endif /* MAC80211_H */
v6.8
   1/* SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-2.0-only */
   2/*
   3 * mac80211 <-> driver interface
   4 *
   5 * Copyright 2002-2005, Devicescape Software, Inc.
   6 * Copyright 2006-2007	Jiri Benc <jbenc@suse.cz>
   7 * Copyright 2007-2010	Johannes Berg <johannes@sipsolutions.net>
   8 * Copyright 2013-2014  Intel Mobile Communications GmbH
   9 * Copyright (C) 2015 - 2017 Intel Deutschland GmbH
  10 * Copyright (C) 2018 - 2023 Intel Corporation
 
 
 
 
  11 */
  12
  13#ifndef MAC80211_H
  14#define MAC80211_H
  15
  16#include <linux/bug.h>
  17#include <linux/kernel.h>
  18#include <linux/if_ether.h>
  19#include <linux/skbuff.h>
  20#include <linux/ieee80211.h>
  21#include <linux/lockdep.h>
  22#include <net/cfg80211.h>
  23#include <net/codel.h>
  24#include <net/ieee80211_radiotap.h>
  25#include <asm/unaligned.h>
  26
  27/**
  28 * DOC: Introduction
  29 *
  30 * mac80211 is the Linux stack for 802.11 hardware that implements
  31 * only partial functionality in hard- or firmware. This document
  32 * defines the interface between mac80211 and low-level hardware
  33 * drivers.
  34 */
  35
  36/**
  37 * DOC: Calling mac80211 from interrupts
  38 *
  39 * Only ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() can be
  40 * called in hardware interrupt context. The low-level driver must not call any
  41 * other functions in hardware interrupt context. If there is a need for such
  42 * call, the low-level driver should first ACK the interrupt and perform the
  43 * IEEE 802.11 code call after this, e.g. from a scheduled workqueue or even
  44 * tasklet function.
  45 *
  46 * NOTE: If the driver opts to use the _irqsafe() functions, it may not also
  47 *	 use the non-IRQ-safe functions!
  48 */
  49
  50/**
  51 * DOC: Warning
  52 *
  53 * If you're reading this document and not the header file itself, it will
  54 * be incomplete because not all documentation has been converted yet.
  55 */
  56
  57/**
  58 * DOC: Frame format
  59 *
  60 * As a general rule, when frames are passed between mac80211 and the driver,
  61 * they start with the IEEE 802.11 header and include the same octets that are
  62 * sent over the air except for the FCS which should be calculated by the
  63 * hardware.
  64 *
  65 * There are, however, various exceptions to this rule for advanced features:
  66 *
  67 * The first exception is for hardware encryption and decryption offload
  68 * where the IV/ICV may or may not be generated in hardware.
  69 *
  70 * Secondly, when the hardware handles fragmentation, the frame handed to
  71 * the driver from mac80211 is the MSDU, not the MPDU.
  72 */
  73
  74/**
  75 * DOC: mac80211 workqueue
  76 *
  77 * mac80211 provides its own workqueue for drivers and internal mac80211 use.
  78 * The workqueue is a single threaded workqueue and can only be accessed by
  79 * helpers for sanity checking. Drivers must ensure all work added onto the
  80 * mac80211 workqueue should be cancelled on the driver stop() callback.
  81 *
  82 * mac80211 will flush the workqueue upon interface removal and during
  83 * suspend.
  84 *
  85 * All work performed on the mac80211 workqueue must not acquire the RTNL lock.
  86 *
  87 */
  88
  89/**
  90 * DOC: mac80211 software tx queueing
  91 *
  92 * mac80211 uses an intermediate queueing implementation, designed to allow the
  93 * driver to keep hardware queues short and to provide some fairness between
  94 * different stations/interfaces.
 
 
 
  95 *
  96 * Drivers must provide the .wake_tx_queue driver operation by either
  97 * linking it to ieee80211_handle_wake_tx_queue() or implementing a custom
  98 * handler.
  99 *
 100 * Intermediate queues (struct ieee80211_txq) are kept per-sta per-tid, with
 101 * another per-sta for non-data/non-mgmt and bufferable management frames, and
 102 * a single per-vif queue for multicast data frames.
 103 *
 104 * The driver is expected to initialize its private per-queue data for stations
 105 * and interfaces in the .add_interface and .sta_add ops.
 106 *
 107 * The driver can't access the internal TX queues (iTXQs) directly.
 108 * Whenever mac80211 adds a new frame to a queue, it calls the .wake_tx_queue
 109 * driver op.
 110 * Drivers implementing a custom .wake_tx_queue op can get them by calling
 111 * ieee80211_tx_dequeue(). Drivers using ieee80211_handle_wake_tx_queue() will
 112 * simply get the individual frames pushed via the .tx driver operation.
 113 *
 114 * Drivers can optionally delegate responsibility for scheduling queues to
 115 * mac80211, to take advantage of airtime fairness accounting. In this case, to
 116 * obtain the next queue to pull frames from, the driver calls
 117 * ieee80211_next_txq(). The driver is then expected to return the txq using
 118 * ieee80211_return_txq().
 119 *
 120 * For AP powersave TIM handling, the driver only needs to indicate if it has
 121 * buffered packets in the driver specific data structures by calling
 122 * ieee80211_sta_set_buffered(). For frames buffered in the ieee80211_txq
 123 * struct, mac80211 sets the appropriate TIM PVB bits and calls
 124 * .release_buffered_frames().
 125 * In that callback the driver is therefore expected to release its own
 126 * buffered frames and afterwards also frames from the ieee80211_txq (obtained
 127 * via the usual ieee80211_tx_dequeue).
 128 */
 129
 130/**
 131 * DOC: HW timestamping
 132 *
 133 * Timing Measurement and Fine Timing Measurement require accurate timestamps
 134 * of the action frames TX/RX and their respective acks.
 135 *
 136 * To report hardware timestamps for Timing Measurement or Fine Timing
 137 * Measurement frame RX, the low level driver should set the SKB's hwtstamp
 138 * field to the frame RX timestamp and report the ack TX timestamp in the
 139 * ieee80211_rx_status struct.
 140 *
 141 * Similarly, to report hardware timestamps for Timing Measurement or Fine
 142 * Timing Measurement frame TX, the driver should set the SKB's hwtstamp field
 143 * to the frame TX timestamp and report the ack RX timestamp in the
 144 * ieee80211_tx_status struct.
 145 */
 146struct device;
 147
 148/**
 149 * enum ieee80211_max_queues - maximum number of queues
 150 *
 151 * @IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUES: Maximum number of regular device queues.
 152 * @IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUE_MAP: bitmap with maximum queues set
 153 */
 154enum ieee80211_max_queues {
 155	IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUES =		16,
 156	IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUE_MAP =	BIT(IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUES) - 1,
 157};
 158
 159#define IEEE80211_INVAL_HW_QUEUE	0xff
 160
 161/**
 162 * enum ieee80211_ac_numbers - AC numbers as used in mac80211
 163 * @IEEE80211_AC_VO: voice
 164 * @IEEE80211_AC_VI: video
 165 * @IEEE80211_AC_BE: best effort
 166 * @IEEE80211_AC_BK: background
 167 */
 168enum ieee80211_ac_numbers {
 169	IEEE80211_AC_VO		= 0,
 170	IEEE80211_AC_VI		= 1,
 171	IEEE80211_AC_BE		= 2,
 172	IEEE80211_AC_BK		= 3,
 173};
 174
 175/**
 176 * struct ieee80211_tx_queue_params - transmit queue configuration
 177 *
 178 * The information provided in this structure is required for QoS
 179 * transmit queue configuration. Cf. IEEE 802.11 7.3.2.29.
 180 *
 181 * @aifs: arbitration interframe space [0..255]
 182 * @cw_min: minimum contention window [a value of the form
 183 *	2^n-1 in the range 1..32767]
 184 * @cw_max: maximum contention window [like @cw_min]
 185 * @txop: maximum burst time in units of 32 usecs, 0 meaning disabled
 186 * @acm: is mandatory admission control required for the access category
 187 * @uapsd: is U-APSD mode enabled for the queue
 188 * @mu_edca: is the MU EDCA configured
 189 * @mu_edca_param_rec: MU EDCA Parameter Record for HE
 190 */
 191struct ieee80211_tx_queue_params {
 192	u16 txop;
 193	u16 cw_min;
 194	u16 cw_max;
 195	u8 aifs;
 196	bool acm;
 197	bool uapsd;
 198	bool mu_edca;
 199	struct ieee80211_he_mu_edca_param_ac_rec mu_edca_param_rec;
 200};
 201
 202struct ieee80211_low_level_stats {
 203	unsigned int dot11ACKFailureCount;
 204	unsigned int dot11RTSFailureCount;
 205	unsigned int dot11FCSErrorCount;
 206	unsigned int dot11RTSSuccessCount;
 207};
 208
 209/**
 210 * enum ieee80211_chanctx_change - change flag for channel context
 211 * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_WIDTH: The channel width changed
 212 * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_RX_CHAINS: The number of RX chains changed
 213 * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_RADAR: radar detection flag changed
 214 * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_CHANNEL: switched to another operating channel,
 215 *	this is used only with channel switching with CSA
 216 * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_MIN_WIDTH: The min required channel width changed
 217 */
 218enum ieee80211_chanctx_change {
 219	IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_WIDTH		= BIT(0),
 220	IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_RX_CHAINS	= BIT(1),
 221	IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_RADAR		= BIT(2),
 222	IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_CHANNEL	= BIT(3),
 223	IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_MIN_WIDTH	= BIT(4),
 224};
 225
 226/**
 227 * struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf - channel context that vifs may be tuned to
 228 *
 229 * This is the driver-visible part. The ieee80211_chanctx
 230 * that contains it is visible in mac80211 only.
 231 *
 232 * @def: the channel definition
 233 * @min_def: the minimum channel definition currently required.
 234 * @rx_chains_static: The number of RX chains that must always be
 235 *	active on the channel to receive MIMO transmissions
 236 * @rx_chains_dynamic: The number of RX chains that must be enabled
 237 *	after RTS/CTS handshake to receive SMPS MIMO transmissions;
 238 *	this will always be >= @rx_chains_static.
 239 * @radar_enabled: whether radar detection is enabled on this channel.
 240 * @drv_priv: data area for driver use, will always be aligned to
 241 *	sizeof(void *), size is determined in hw information.
 242 */
 243struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf {
 244	struct cfg80211_chan_def def;
 245	struct cfg80211_chan_def min_def;
 246
 247	u8 rx_chains_static, rx_chains_dynamic;
 248
 249	bool radar_enabled;
 250
 251	u8 drv_priv[] __aligned(sizeof(void *));
 252};
 253
 254/**
 255 * enum ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode - channel context switch mode
 256 * @CHANCTX_SWMODE_REASSIGN_VIF: Both old and new contexts already
 257 *	exist (and will continue to exist), but the virtual interface
 258 *	needs to be switched from one to the other.
 259 * @CHANCTX_SWMODE_SWAP_CONTEXTS: The old context exists but will stop
 260 *      to exist with this call, the new context doesn't exist but
 261 *      will be active after this call, the virtual interface switches
 262 *      from the old to the new (note that the driver may of course
 263 *      implement this as an on-the-fly chandef switch of the existing
 264 *      hardware context, but the mac80211 pointer for the old context
 265 *      will cease to exist and only the new one will later be used
 266 *      for changes/removal.)
 267 */
 268enum ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode {
 269	CHANCTX_SWMODE_REASSIGN_VIF,
 270	CHANCTX_SWMODE_SWAP_CONTEXTS,
 271};
 272
 273/**
 274 * struct ieee80211_vif_chanctx_switch - vif chanctx switch information
 275 *
 276 * This is structure is used to pass information about a vif that
 277 * needs to switch from one chanctx to another.  The
 278 * &ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode defines how the switch should be
 279 * done.
 280 *
 281 * @vif: the vif that should be switched from old_ctx to new_ctx
 282 * @link_conf: the link conf that's switching
 283 * @old_ctx: the old context to which the vif was assigned
 284 * @new_ctx: the new context to which the vif must be assigned
 285 */
 286struct ieee80211_vif_chanctx_switch {
 287	struct ieee80211_vif *vif;
 288	struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf;
 289	struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *old_ctx;
 290	struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *new_ctx;
 291};
 292
 293/**
 294 * enum ieee80211_bss_change - BSS change notification flags
 295 *
 296 * These flags are used with the bss_info_changed(), link_info_changed()
 297 * and vif_cfg_changed() callbacks to indicate which parameter(s) changed.
 298 *
 299 * @BSS_CHANGED_ASSOC: association status changed (associated/disassociated),
 300 *	also implies a change in the AID.
 301 * @BSS_CHANGED_ERP_CTS_PROT: CTS protection changed
 302 * @BSS_CHANGED_ERP_PREAMBLE: preamble changed
 303 * @BSS_CHANGED_ERP_SLOT: slot timing changed
 304 * @BSS_CHANGED_HT: 802.11n parameters changed
 305 * @BSS_CHANGED_BASIC_RATES: Basic rateset changed
 306 * @BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INT: Beacon interval changed
 307 * @BSS_CHANGED_BSSID: BSSID changed, for whatever
 308 *	reason (IBSS and managed mode)
 309 * @BSS_CHANGED_BEACON: Beacon data changed, retrieve
 310 *	new beacon (beaconing modes)
 311 * @BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_ENABLED: Beaconing should be
 312 *	enabled/disabled (beaconing modes)
 313 * @BSS_CHANGED_CQM: Connection quality monitor config changed
 314 * @BSS_CHANGED_IBSS: IBSS join status changed
 315 * @BSS_CHANGED_ARP_FILTER: Hardware ARP filter address list or state changed.
 316 * @BSS_CHANGED_QOS: QoS for this association was enabled/disabled. Note
 317 *	that it is only ever disabled for station mode.
 318 * @BSS_CHANGED_IDLE: Idle changed for this BSS/interface.
 319 * @BSS_CHANGED_SSID: SSID changed for this BSS (AP and IBSS mode)
 320 * @BSS_CHANGED_AP_PROBE_RESP: Probe Response changed for this BSS (AP mode)
 321 * @BSS_CHANGED_PS: PS changed for this BSS (STA mode)
 322 * @BSS_CHANGED_TXPOWER: TX power setting changed for this interface
 323 * @BSS_CHANGED_P2P_PS: P2P powersave settings (CTWindow, opportunistic PS)
 324 *	changed
 325 * @BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INFO: Data from the AP's beacon became available:
 326 *	currently dtim_period only is under consideration.
 327 * @BSS_CHANGED_BANDWIDTH: The bandwidth used by this interface changed,
 328 *	note that this is only called when it changes after the channel
 329 *	context had been assigned.
 330 * @BSS_CHANGED_OCB: OCB join status changed
 331 * @BSS_CHANGED_MU_GROUPS: VHT MU-MIMO group id or user position changed
 332 * @BSS_CHANGED_KEEP_ALIVE: keep alive options (idle period or protected
 333 *	keep alive) changed.
 334 * @BSS_CHANGED_MCAST_RATE: Multicast Rate setting changed for this interface
 335 * @BSS_CHANGED_FTM_RESPONDER: fine timing measurement request responder
 336 *	functionality changed for this BSS (AP mode).
 337 * @BSS_CHANGED_TWT: TWT status changed
 338 * @BSS_CHANGED_HE_OBSS_PD: OBSS Packet Detection status changed.
 339 * @BSS_CHANGED_HE_BSS_COLOR: BSS Color has changed
 340 * @BSS_CHANGED_FILS_DISCOVERY: FILS discovery status changed.
 341 * @BSS_CHANGED_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP: Unsolicited broadcast probe response
 342 *	status changed.
 343 * @BSS_CHANGED_EHT_PUNCTURING: The channel puncturing bitmap changed.
 344 * @BSS_CHANGED_MLD_VALID_LINKS: MLD valid links status changed.
 345 */
 346enum ieee80211_bss_change {
 347	BSS_CHANGED_ASSOC		= 1<<0,
 348	BSS_CHANGED_ERP_CTS_PROT	= 1<<1,
 349	BSS_CHANGED_ERP_PREAMBLE	= 1<<2,
 350	BSS_CHANGED_ERP_SLOT		= 1<<3,
 351	BSS_CHANGED_HT			= 1<<4,
 352	BSS_CHANGED_BASIC_RATES		= 1<<5,
 353	BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INT		= 1<<6,
 354	BSS_CHANGED_BSSID		= 1<<7,
 355	BSS_CHANGED_BEACON		= 1<<8,
 356	BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_ENABLED	= 1<<9,
 357	BSS_CHANGED_CQM			= 1<<10,
 358	BSS_CHANGED_IBSS		= 1<<11,
 359	BSS_CHANGED_ARP_FILTER		= 1<<12,
 360	BSS_CHANGED_QOS			= 1<<13,
 361	BSS_CHANGED_IDLE		= 1<<14,
 362	BSS_CHANGED_SSID		= 1<<15,
 363	BSS_CHANGED_AP_PROBE_RESP	= 1<<16,
 364	BSS_CHANGED_PS			= 1<<17,
 365	BSS_CHANGED_TXPOWER		= 1<<18,
 366	BSS_CHANGED_P2P_PS		= 1<<19,
 367	BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INFO		= 1<<20,
 368	BSS_CHANGED_BANDWIDTH		= 1<<21,
 369	BSS_CHANGED_OCB                 = 1<<22,
 370	BSS_CHANGED_MU_GROUPS		= 1<<23,
 371	BSS_CHANGED_KEEP_ALIVE		= 1<<24,
 372	BSS_CHANGED_MCAST_RATE		= 1<<25,
 373	BSS_CHANGED_FTM_RESPONDER	= 1<<26,
 374	BSS_CHANGED_TWT			= 1<<27,
 375	BSS_CHANGED_HE_OBSS_PD		= 1<<28,
 376	BSS_CHANGED_HE_BSS_COLOR	= 1<<29,
 377	BSS_CHANGED_FILS_DISCOVERY      = 1<<30,
 378	BSS_CHANGED_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP = 1<<31,
 379	BSS_CHANGED_EHT_PUNCTURING	= BIT_ULL(32),
 380	BSS_CHANGED_MLD_VALID_LINKS	= BIT_ULL(33),
 381
 382	/* when adding here, make sure to change ieee80211_reconfig */
 383};
 384
 385/*
 386 * The maximum number of IPv4 addresses listed for ARP filtering. If the number
 387 * of addresses for an interface increase beyond this value, hardware ARP
 388 * filtering will be disabled.
 389 */
 390#define IEEE80211_BSS_ARP_ADDR_LIST_LEN 4
 391
 392/**
 393 * enum ieee80211_event_type - event to be notified to the low level driver
 394 * @RSSI_EVENT: AP's rssi crossed the a threshold set by the driver.
 395 * @MLME_EVENT: event related to MLME
 396 * @BAR_RX_EVENT: a BAR was received
 397 * @BA_FRAME_TIMEOUT: Frames were released from the reordering buffer because
 398 *	they timed out. This won't be called for each frame released, but only
 399 *	once each time the timeout triggers.
 400 */
 401enum ieee80211_event_type {
 402	RSSI_EVENT,
 403	MLME_EVENT,
 404	BAR_RX_EVENT,
 405	BA_FRAME_TIMEOUT,
 406};
 407
 408/**
 409 * enum ieee80211_rssi_event_data - relevant when event type is %RSSI_EVENT
 410 * @RSSI_EVENT_HIGH: AP's rssi went below the threshold set by the driver.
 411 * @RSSI_EVENT_LOW: AP's rssi went above the threshold set by the driver.
 412 */
 413enum ieee80211_rssi_event_data {
 414	RSSI_EVENT_HIGH,
 415	RSSI_EVENT_LOW,
 416};
 417
 418/**
 419 * struct ieee80211_rssi_event - data attached to an %RSSI_EVENT
 420 * @data: See &enum ieee80211_rssi_event_data
 421 */
 422struct ieee80211_rssi_event {
 423	enum ieee80211_rssi_event_data data;
 424};
 425
 426/**
 427 * enum ieee80211_mlme_event_data - relevant when event type is %MLME_EVENT
 428 * @AUTH_EVENT: the MLME operation is authentication
 429 * @ASSOC_EVENT: the MLME operation is association
 430 * @DEAUTH_RX_EVENT: deauth received..
 431 * @DEAUTH_TX_EVENT: deauth sent.
 432 */
 433enum ieee80211_mlme_event_data {
 434	AUTH_EVENT,
 435	ASSOC_EVENT,
 436	DEAUTH_RX_EVENT,
 437	DEAUTH_TX_EVENT,
 438};
 439
 440/**
 441 * enum ieee80211_mlme_event_status - relevant when event type is %MLME_EVENT
 442 * @MLME_SUCCESS: the MLME operation completed successfully.
 443 * @MLME_DENIED: the MLME operation was denied by the peer.
 444 * @MLME_TIMEOUT: the MLME operation timed out.
 445 */
 446enum ieee80211_mlme_event_status {
 447	MLME_SUCCESS,
 448	MLME_DENIED,
 449	MLME_TIMEOUT,
 450};
 451
 452/**
 453 * struct ieee80211_mlme_event - data attached to an %MLME_EVENT
 454 * @data: See &enum ieee80211_mlme_event_data
 455 * @status: See &enum ieee80211_mlme_event_status
 456 * @reason: the reason code if applicable
 457 */
 458struct ieee80211_mlme_event {
 459	enum ieee80211_mlme_event_data data;
 460	enum ieee80211_mlme_event_status status;
 461	u16 reason;
 462};
 463
 464/**
 465 * struct ieee80211_ba_event - data attached for BlockAck related events
 466 * @sta: pointer to the &ieee80211_sta to which this event relates
 467 * @tid: the tid
 468 * @ssn: the starting sequence number (for %BAR_RX_EVENT)
 469 */
 470struct ieee80211_ba_event {
 471	struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
 472	u16 tid;
 473	u16 ssn;
 474};
 475
 476/**
 477 * struct ieee80211_event - event to be sent to the driver
 478 * @type: The event itself. See &enum ieee80211_event_type.
 479 * @u.rssi: relevant if &type is %RSSI_EVENT
 480 * @u.mlme: relevant if &type is %AUTH_EVENT
 481 * @u.ba: relevant if &type is %BAR_RX_EVENT or %BA_FRAME_TIMEOUT
 482 * @u:union holding the fields above
 483 */
 484struct ieee80211_event {
 485	enum ieee80211_event_type type;
 486	union {
 487		struct ieee80211_rssi_event rssi;
 488		struct ieee80211_mlme_event mlme;
 489		struct ieee80211_ba_event ba;
 490	} u;
 491};
 492
 493/**
 494 * struct ieee80211_mu_group_data - STA's VHT MU-MIMO group data
 495 *
 496 * This structure describes the group id data of VHT MU-MIMO
 497 *
 498 * @membership: 64 bits array - a bit is set if station is member of the group
 499 * @position: 2 bits per group id indicating the position in the group
 500 */
 501struct ieee80211_mu_group_data {
 502	u8 membership[WLAN_MEMBERSHIP_LEN];
 503	u8 position[WLAN_USER_POSITION_LEN];
 504};
 505
 506/**
 507 * struct ieee80211_ftm_responder_params - FTM responder parameters
 508 *
 509 * @lci: LCI subelement content
 510 * @civicloc: CIVIC location subelement content
 511 * @lci_len: LCI data length
 512 * @civicloc_len: Civic data length
 513 */
 514struct ieee80211_ftm_responder_params {
 515	const u8 *lci;
 516	const u8 *civicloc;
 517	size_t lci_len;
 518	size_t civicloc_len;
 519};
 520
 521/**
 522 * struct ieee80211_fils_discovery - FILS discovery parameters from
 523 * IEEE Std 802.11ai-2016, Annex C.3 MIB detail.
 524 *
 525 * @min_interval: Minimum packet interval in TUs (0 - 10000)
 526 * @max_interval: Maximum packet interval in TUs (0 - 10000)
 527 */
 528struct ieee80211_fils_discovery {
 529	u32 min_interval;
 530	u32 max_interval;
 531};
 532
 533/**
 534 * struct ieee80211_bss_conf - holds the BSS's changing parameters
 535 *
 536 * This structure keeps information about a BSS (and an association
 537 * to that BSS) that can change during the lifetime of the BSS.
 538 *
 539 * @vif: reference to owning VIF
 540 * @addr: (link) address used locally
 541 * @link_id: link ID, or 0 for non-MLO
 542 * @htc_trig_based_pkt_ext: default PE in 4us units, if BSS supports HE
 543 * @uora_exists: is the UORA element advertised by AP
 544 * @uora_ocw_range: UORA element's OCW Range field
 545 * @frame_time_rts_th: HE duration RTS threshold, in units of 32us
 546 * @he_support: does this BSS support HE
 547 * @twt_requester: does this BSS support TWT requester (relevant for managed
 548 *	mode only, set if the AP advertises TWT responder role)
 549 * @twt_responder: does this BSS support TWT requester (relevant for managed
 550 *	mode only, set if the AP advertises TWT responder role)
 551 * @twt_protected: does this BSS support protected TWT frames
 552 * @twt_broadcast: does this BSS support broadcast TWT
 553 * @use_cts_prot: use CTS protection
 554 * @use_short_preamble: use 802.11b short preamble
 555 * @use_short_slot: use short slot time (only relevant for ERP)
 556 * @dtim_period: num of beacons before the next DTIM, for beaconing,
 557 *	valid in station mode only if after the driver was notified
 558 *	with the %BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INFO flag, will be non-zero then.
 559 * @sync_tsf: last beacon's/probe response's TSF timestamp (could be old
 560 *	as it may have been received during scanning long ago). If the
 561 *	HW flag %IEEE80211_HW_TIMING_BEACON_ONLY is set, then this can
 562 *	only come from a beacon, but might not become valid until after
 563 *	association when a beacon is received (which is notified with the
 564 *	%BSS_CHANGED_DTIM flag.). See also sync_dtim_count important notice.
 565 * @sync_device_ts: the device timestamp corresponding to the sync_tsf,
 566 *	the driver/device can use this to calculate synchronisation
 567 *	(see @sync_tsf). See also sync_dtim_count important notice.
 568 * @sync_dtim_count: Only valid when %IEEE80211_HW_TIMING_BEACON_ONLY
 569 *	is requested, see @sync_tsf/@sync_device_ts.
 570 *	IMPORTANT: These three sync_* parameters would possibly be out of sync
 571 *	by the time the driver will use them. The synchronized view is currently
 572 *	guaranteed only in certain callbacks.
 573 *	Note also that this is not used with MLD associations, mac80211 doesn't
 574 *	know how to track beacons for all of the links for this.
 575 * @beacon_int: beacon interval
 576 * @assoc_capability: capabilities taken from assoc resp
 577 * @basic_rates: bitmap of basic rates, each bit stands for an
 578 *	index into the rate table configured by the driver in
 579 *	the current band.
 580 * @beacon_rate: associated AP's beacon TX rate
 581 * @mcast_rate: per-band multicast rate index + 1 (0: disabled)
 582 * @bssid: The BSSID for this BSS
 583 * @enable_beacon: whether beaconing should be enabled or not
 584 * @chandef: Channel definition for this BSS -- the hardware might be
 585 *	configured a higher bandwidth than this BSS uses, for example.
 586 * @mu_group: VHT MU-MIMO group membership data
 587 * @ht_operation_mode: HT operation mode like in &struct ieee80211_ht_operation.
 588 *	This field is only valid when the channel is a wide HT/VHT channel.
 589 *	Note that with TDLS this can be the case (channel is HT, protection must
 590 *	be used from this field) even when the BSS association isn't using HT.
 591 * @cqm_rssi_thold: Connection quality monitor RSSI threshold, a zero value
 592 *	implies disabled. As with the cfg80211 callback, a change here should
 593 *	cause an event to be sent indicating where the current value is in
 594 *	relation to the newly configured threshold.
 595 * @cqm_rssi_low: Connection quality monitor RSSI lower threshold, a zero value
 596 *	implies disabled.  This is an alternative mechanism to the single
 597 *	threshold event and can't be enabled simultaneously with it.
 598 * @cqm_rssi_high: Connection quality monitor RSSI upper threshold.
 599 * @cqm_rssi_hyst: Connection quality monitor RSSI hysteresis
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 600 * @qos: This is a QoS-enabled BSS.
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 601 * @hidden_ssid: The SSID of the current vif is hidden. Only valid in AP-mode.
 602 * @txpower: TX power in dBm.  INT_MIN means not configured.
 603 * @txpower_type: TX power adjustment used to control per packet Transmit
 604 *	Power Control (TPC) in lower driver for the current vif. In particular
 605 *	TPC is enabled if value passed in %txpower_type is
 606 *	NL80211_TX_POWER_LIMITED (allow using less than specified from
 607 *	userspace), whereas TPC is disabled if %txpower_type is set to
 608 *	NL80211_TX_POWER_FIXED (use value configured from userspace)
 609 * @p2p_noa_attr: P2P NoA attribute for P2P powersave
 610 * @allow_p2p_go_ps: indication for AP or P2P GO interface, whether it's allowed
 611 *	to use P2P PS mechanism or not. AP/P2P GO is not allowed to use P2P PS
 612 *	if it has associated clients without P2P PS support.
 613 * @max_idle_period: the time period during which the station can refrain from
 614 *	transmitting frames to its associated AP without being disassociated.
 615 *	In units of 1000 TUs. Zero value indicates that the AP did not include
 616 *	a (valid) BSS Max Idle Period Element.
 617 * @protected_keep_alive: if set, indicates that the station should send an RSN
 618 *	protected frame to the AP to reset the idle timer at the AP for the
 619 *	station.
 620 * @ftm_responder: whether to enable or disable fine timing measurement FTM
 621 *	responder functionality.
 622 * @ftmr_params: configurable lci/civic parameter when enabling FTM responder.
 623 * @nontransmitted: this BSS is a nontransmitted BSS profile
 624 * @transmitter_bssid: the address of transmitter AP
 625 * @bssid_index: index inside the multiple BSSID set
 626 * @bssid_indicator: 2^bssid_indicator is the maximum number of APs in set
 627 * @ema_ap: AP supports enhancements of discovery and advertisement of
 628 *	nontransmitted BSSIDs
 629 * @profile_periodicity: the least number of beacon frames need to be received
 630 *	in order to discover all the nontransmitted BSSIDs in the set.
 631 * @he_oper: HE operation information of the BSS (AP/Mesh) or of the AP we are
 632 *	connected to (STA)
 633 * @he_obss_pd: OBSS Packet Detection parameters.
 634 * @he_bss_color: BSS coloring settings, if BSS supports HE
 635 * @fils_discovery: FILS discovery configuration
 636 * @unsol_bcast_probe_resp_interval: Unsolicited broadcast probe response
 637 *	interval.
 638 * @beacon_tx_rate: The configured beacon transmit rate that needs to be passed
 639 *	to driver when rate control is offloaded to firmware.
 640 * @power_type: power type of BSS for 6 GHz
 641 * @tx_pwr_env: transmit power envelope array of BSS.
 642 * @tx_pwr_env_num: number of @tx_pwr_env.
 643 * @pwr_reduction: power constraint of BSS.
 644 * @eht_support: does this BSS support EHT
 645 * @eht_puncturing: bitmap to indicate which channels are punctured in this BSS
 646 * @csa_active: marks whether a channel switch is going on.
 647 * @csa_punct_bitmap: new puncturing bitmap for channel switch
 648 * @mu_mimo_owner: indicates interface owns MU-MIMO capability
 649 * @chanctx_conf: The channel context this interface is assigned to, or %NULL
 650 *	when it is not assigned. This pointer is RCU-protected due to the TX
 651 *	path needing to access it; even though the netdev carrier will always
 652 *	be off when it is %NULL there can still be races and packets could be
 653 *	processed after it switches back to %NULL.
 654 * @color_change_active: marks whether a color change is ongoing.
 655 * @color_change_color: the bss color that will be used after the change.
 656 * @ht_ldpc: in AP mode, indicates interface has HT LDPC capability.
 657 * @vht_ldpc: in AP mode, indicates interface has VHT LDPC capability.
 658 * @he_ldpc: in AP mode, indicates interface has HE LDPC capability.
 659 * @vht_su_beamformer: in AP mode, does this BSS support operation as an VHT SU
 660 *	beamformer
 661 * @vht_su_beamformee: in AP mode, does this BSS support operation as an VHT SU
 662 *	beamformee
 663 * @vht_mu_beamformer: in AP mode, does this BSS support operation as an VHT MU
 664 *	beamformer
 665 * @vht_mu_beamformee: in AP mode, does this BSS support operation as an VHT MU
 666 *	beamformee
 667 * @he_su_beamformer: in AP-mode, does this BSS support operation as an HE SU
 668 *	beamformer
 669 * @he_su_beamformee: in AP-mode, does this BSS support operation as an HE SU
 670 *	beamformee
 671 * @he_mu_beamformer: in AP-mode, does this BSS support operation as an HE MU
 672 *	beamformer
 673 * @he_full_ul_mumimo: does this BSS support the reception (AP) or transmission
 674 *	(non-AP STA) of an HE TB PPDU on an RU that spans the entire PPDU
 675 *	bandwidth
 676 * @eht_su_beamformer: in AP-mode, does this BSS enable operation as an EHT SU
 677 *	beamformer
 678 * @eht_su_beamformee: in AP-mode, does this BSS enable operation as an EHT SU
 679 *	beamformee
 680 * @eht_mu_beamformer: in AP-mode, does this BSS enable operation as an EHT MU
 681 *	beamformer
 682 */
 683struct ieee80211_bss_conf {
 684	struct ieee80211_vif *vif;
 685
 686	const u8 *bssid;
 687	unsigned int link_id;
 688	u8 addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
 689	u8 htc_trig_based_pkt_ext;
 690	bool uora_exists;
 691	u8 uora_ocw_range;
 692	u16 frame_time_rts_th;
 693	bool he_support;
 694	bool twt_requester;
 695	bool twt_responder;
 696	bool twt_protected;
 697	bool twt_broadcast;
 698	/* erp related data */
 699	bool use_cts_prot;
 700	bool use_short_preamble;
 701	bool use_short_slot;
 702	bool enable_beacon;
 703	u8 dtim_period;
 704	u16 beacon_int;
 705	u16 assoc_capability;
 706	u64 sync_tsf;
 707	u32 sync_device_ts;
 708	u8 sync_dtim_count;
 709	u32 basic_rates;
 710	struct ieee80211_rate *beacon_rate;
 711	int mcast_rate[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
 712	u16 ht_operation_mode;
 713	s32 cqm_rssi_thold;
 714	u32 cqm_rssi_hyst;
 715	s32 cqm_rssi_low;
 716	s32 cqm_rssi_high;
 717	struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
 718	struct ieee80211_mu_group_data mu_group;
 
 
 719	bool qos;
 
 
 
 
 720	bool hidden_ssid;
 721	int txpower;
 722	enum nl80211_tx_power_setting txpower_type;
 723	struct ieee80211_p2p_noa_attr p2p_noa_attr;
 724	bool allow_p2p_go_ps;
 725	u16 max_idle_period;
 726	bool protected_keep_alive;
 727	bool ftm_responder;
 728	struct ieee80211_ftm_responder_params *ftmr_params;
 729	/* Multiple BSSID data */
 730	bool nontransmitted;
 731	u8 transmitter_bssid[ETH_ALEN];
 732	u8 bssid_index;
 733	u8 bssid_indicator;
 734	bool ema_ap;
 735	u8 profile_periodicity;
 736	struct {
 737		u32 params;
 738		u16 nss_set;
 739	} he_oper;
 740	struct ieee80211_he_obss_pd he_obss_pd;
 741	struct cfg80211_he_bss_color he_bss_color;
 742	struct ieee80211_fils_discovery fils_discovery;
 743	u32 unsol_bcast_probe_resp_interval;
 744	struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask beacon_tx_rate;
 745	enum ieee80211_ap_reg_power power_type;
 746	struct ieee80211_tx_pwr_env tx_pwr_env[IEEE80211_TPE_MAX_IE_COUNT];
 747	u8 tx_pwr_env_num;
 748	u8 pwr_reduction;
 749	bool eht_support;
 750	u16 eht_puncturing;
 751
 752	bool csa_active;
 753	u16 csa_punct_bitmap;
 754
 755	bool mu_mimo_owner;
 756	struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf __rcu *chanctx_conf;
 757
 758	bool color_change_active;
 759	u8 color_change_color;
 760
 761	bool ht_ldpc;
 762	bool vht_ldpc;
 763	bool he_ldpc;
 764	bool vht_su_beamformer;
 765	bool vht_su_beamformee;
 766	bool vht_mu_beamformer;
 767	bool vht_mu_beamformee;
 768	bool he_su_beamformer;
 769	bool he_su_beamformee;
 770	bool he_mu_beamformer;
 771	bool he_full_ul_mumimo;
 772	bool eht_su_beamformer;
 773	bool eht_su_beamformee;
 774	bool eht_mu_beamformer;
 775};
 776
 777/**
 778 * enum mac80211_tx_info_flags - flags to describe transmission information/status
 779 *
 780 * These flags are used with the @flags member of &ieee80211_tx_info.
 781 *
 782 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_REQ_TX_STATUS: require TX status callback for this frame.
 783 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_ASSIGN_SEQ: The driver has to assign a sequence
 784 *	number to this frame, taking care of not overwriting the fragment
 785 *	number and increasing the sequence number only when the
 786 *	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_FIRST_FRAGMENT flag is set. mac80211 will properly
 787 *	assign sequence numbers to QoS-data frames but cannot do so correctly
 788 *	for non-QoS-data and management frames because beacons need them from
 789 *	that counter as well and mac80211 cannot guarantee proper sequencing.
 790 *	If this flag is set, the driver should instruct the hardware to
 791 *	assign a sequence number to the frame or assign one itself. Cf. IEEE
 792 *	802.11-2007 7.1.3.4.1 paragraph 3. This flag will always be set for
 793 *	beacons and always be clear for frames without a sequence number field.
 794 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK: tell the low level not to wait for an ack
 795 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_CLEAR_PS_FILT: clear powersave filter for destination
 796 *	station
 797 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_FIRST_FRAGMENT: this is a first fragment of the frame
 798 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_SEND_AFTER_DTIM: send this frame after DTIM beacon
 799 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_AMPDU: this frame should be sent as part of an A-MPDU
 800 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_INJECTED: Frame was injected, internal to mac80211.
 801 * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_TX_FILTERED: The frame was not transmitted
 802 *	because the destination STA was in powersave mode. Note that to
 803 *	avoid race conditions, the filter must be set by the hardware or
 804 *	firmware upon receiving a frame that indicates that the station
 805 *	went to sleep (must be done on device to filter frames already on
 806 *	the queue) and may only be unset after mac80211 gives the OK for
 807 *	that by setting the IEEE80211_TX_CTL_CLEAR_PS_FILT (see above),
 808 *	since only then is it guaranteed that no more frames are in the
 809 *	hardware queue.
 810 * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_ACK: Frame was acknowledged
 811 * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU: The frame was aggregated, so status
 812 * 	is for the whole aggregation.
 813 * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU_NO_BACK: no block ack was returned,
 814 * 	so consider using block ack request (BAR).
 815 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_RATE_CTRL_PROBE: internal to mac80211, can be
 816 *	set by rate control algorithms to indicate probe rate, will
 817 *	be cleared for fragmented frames (except on the last fragment)
 818 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_OFFCHAN_TX_OK: Internal to mac80211. Used to indicate
 819 *	that a frame can be transmitted while the queues are stopped for
 820 *	off-channel operation.
 821 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_HW_80211_ENCAP: This frame uses hardware encapsulation
 822 *	(header conversion)
 
 823 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_RETRIED: completely internal to mac80211,
 824 *	used to indicate that a frame was already retried due to PS
 825 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_DONT_ENCRYPT: completely internal to mac80211,
 826 *	used to indicate frame should not be encrypted
 827 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER: This frame is a response to a poll
 828 *	frame (PS-Poll or uAPSD) or a non-bufferable MMPDU and must
 829 *	be sent although the station is in powersave mode.
 830 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_MORE_FRAMES: More frames will be passed to the
 831 *	transmit function after the current frame, this can be used
 832 *	by drivers to kick the DMA queue only if unset or when the
 833 *	queue gets full.
 834 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_RETRANSMISSION: This frame is being retransmitted
 835 *	after TX status because the destination was asleep, it must not
 836 *	be modified again (no seqno assignment, crypto, etc.)
 837 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_MLME_CONN_TX: This frame was transmitted by the MLME
 838 *	code for connection establishment, this indicates that its status
 839 *	should kick the MLME state machine.
 840 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_NL80211_FRAME_TX: Frame was requested through nl80211
 841 *	MLME command (internal to mac80211 to figure out whether to send TX
 842 *	status to user space)
 843 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_LDPC: tells the driver to use LDPC for this frame
 844 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_STBC: Enables Space-Time Block Coding (STBC) for this
 845 *	frame and selects the maximum number of streams that it can use.
 846 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_TX_OFFCHAN: Marks this packet to be transmitted on
 847 *	the off-channel channel when a remain-on-channel offload is done
 848 *	in hardware -- normal packets still flow and are expected to be
 849 *	handled properly by the device.
 850 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_TKIP_MIC_FAILURE: Marks this packet to be used for TKIP
 851 *	testing. It will be sent out with incorrect Michael MIC key to allow
 852 *	TKIP countermeasures to be tested.
 853 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_CCK_RATE: This frame will be sent at non CCK rate.
 854 *	This flag is actually used for management frame especially for P2P
 855 *	frames not being sent at CCK rate in 2GHz band.
 856 * @IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP: This packet marks the end of service period,
 857 *	when its status is reported the service period ends. For frames in
 858 *	an SP that mac80211 transmits, it is already set; for driver frames
 859 *	the driver may set this flag. It is also used to do the same for
 860 *	PS-Poll responses.
 861 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_USE_MINRATE: This frame will be sent at lowest rate.
 862 *	This flag is used to send nullfunc frame at minimum rate when
 863 *	the nullfunc is used for connection monitoring purpose.
 864 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_DONTFRAG: Don't fragment this packet even if it
 865 *	would be fragmented by size (this is optional, only used for
 866 *	monitor injection).
 867 * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_NOACK_TRANSMITTED: A frame that was marked with
 868 *	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK has been successfully transmitted without
 869 *	any errors (like issues specific to the driver/HW).
 870 *	This flag must not be set for frames that don't request no-ack
 871 *	behaviour with IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK.
 872 *
 873 * Note: If you have to add new flags to the enumeration, then don't
 874 *	 forget to update %IEEE80211_TX_TEMPORARY_FLAGS when necessary.
 875 */
 876enum mac80211_tx_info_flags {
 877	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_REQ_TX_STATUS		= BIT(0),
 878	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_ASSIGN_SEQ		= BIT(1),
 879	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK			= BIT(2),
 880	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_CLEAR_PS_FILT		= BIT(3),
 881	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_FIRST_FRAGMENT		= BIT(4),
 882	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_SEND_AFTER_DTIM	= BIT(5),
 883	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_AMPDU			= BIT(6),
 884	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_INJECTED		= BIT(7),
 885	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_TX_FILTERED		= BIT(8),
 886	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_ACK			= BIT(9),
 887	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU			= BIT(10),
 888	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU_NO_BACK		= BIT(11),
 889	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_RATE_CTRL_PROBE	= BIT(12),
 890	IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_OFFCHAN_TX_OK	= BIT(13),
 891	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_HW_80211_ENCAP		= BIT(14),
 892	IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_RETRIED		= BIT(15),
 893	IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_DONT_ENCRYPT		= BIT(16),
 894	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER		= BIT(17),
 895	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_MORE_FRAMES		= BIT(18),
 896	IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_RETRANSMISSION	= BIT(19),
 897	IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_MLME_CONN_TX		= BIT(20),
 898	IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_NL80211_FRAME_TX	= BIT(21),
 899	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_LDPC			= BIT(22),
 900	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_STBC			= BIT(23) | BIT(24),
 901	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_TX_OFFCHAN		= BIT(25),
 902	IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_TKIP_MIC_FAILURE	= BIT(26),
 903	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_CCK_RATE		= BIT(27),
 904	IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP		= BIT(28),
 905	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_USE_MINRATE		= BIT(29),
 906	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_DONTFRAG		= BIT(30),
 907	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_NOACK_TRANSMITTED	= BIT(31),
 908};
 909
 910#define IEEE80211_TX_CTL_STBC_SHIFT		23
 911
 912#define IEEE80211_TX_RC_S1G_MCS IEEE80211_TX_RC_VHT_MCS
 913
 914/**
 915 * enum mac80211_tx_control_flags - flags to describe transmit control
 916 *
 917 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_PORT_CTRL_PROTO: this frame is a port control
 918 *	protocol frame (e.g. EAP)
 919 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_PS_RESPONSE: This frame is a response to a poll
 920 *	frame (PS-Poll or uAPSD).
 921 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_RATE_INJECT: This frame is injected with rate information
 922 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_AMSDU: This frame is an A-MSDU frame
 923 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_FAST_XMIT: This frame is going through the fast_xmit path
 924 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_SKIP_MPATH_LOOKUP: This frame skips mesh path lookup
 925 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTCFL_NEED_TXPROCESSING: completely internal to mac80211,
 926 *	used to indicate that a pending frame requires TX processing before
 927 *	it can be sent out.
 928 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_NO_SEQNO: Do not overwrite the sequence number that
 929 *	has already been assigned to this frame.
 930 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_DONT_REORDER: This frame should not be reordered
 931 *	relative to other frames that have this flag set, independent
 932 *	of their QoS TID or other priority field values.
 933 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MCAST_MLO_FIRST_TX: first MLO TX, used mostly internally
 934 *	for sequence number assignment
 935 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MLO_LINK: If not @IEEE80211_LINK_UNSPECIFIED, this
 936 *	frame should be transmitted on the specific link. This really is
 937 *	only relevant for frames that do not have data present, and is
 938 *	also not used for 802.3 format frames. Note that even if the frame
 939 *	is on a specific link, address translation might still apply if
 940 *	it's intended for an MLD.
 941 *
 942 * These flags are used in tx_info->control.flags.
 943 */
 944enum mac80211_tx_control_flags {
 945	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_PORT_CTRL_PROTO	= BIT(0),
 946	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_PS_RESPONSE		= BIT(1),
 947	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_RATE_INJECT		= BIT(2),
 948	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_AMSDU			= BIT(3),
 949	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_FAST_XMIT		= BIT(4),
 950	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_SKIP_MPATH_LOOKUP	= BIT(5),
 951	IEEE80211_TX_INTCFL_NEED_TXPROCESSING	= BIT(6),
 952	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_NO_SEQNO		= BIT(7),
 953	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_DONT_REORDER		= BIT(8),
 954	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MCAST_MLO_FIRST_TX	= BIT(9),
 955	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MLO_LINK		= 0xf0000000,
 956};
 957
 958#define IEEE80211_LINK_UNSPECIFIED	0xf
 959#define IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MLO_LINK_UNSPEC	\
 960	u32_encode_bits(IEEE80211_LINK_UNSPECIFIED, \
 961			IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MLO_LINK)
 962
 963/**
 964 * enum mac80211_tx_status_flags - flags to describe transmit status
 965 *
 966 * @IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_ACK_SIGNAL_VALID: ACK signal is valid
 967 *
 968 * These flags are used in tx_info->status.flags.
 969 */
 970enum mac80211_tx_status_flags {
 971	IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_ACK_SIGNAL_VALID = BIT(0),
 972};
 973
 974/*
 975 * This definition is used as a mask to clear all temporary flags, which are
 976 * set by the tx handlers for each transmission attempt by the mac80211 stack.
 977 */
 978#define IEEE80211_TX_TEMPORARY_FLAGS (IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK |		      \
 979	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_CLEAR_PS_FILT | IEEE80211_TX_CTL_FIRST_FRAGMENT |    \
 980	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_SEND_AFTER_DTIM | IEEE80211_TX_CTL_AMPDU |	      \
 981	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_TX_FILTERED |	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_ACK |		      \
 982	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU | IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU_NO_BACK |	      \
 983	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_RATE_CTRL_PROBE | IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER |    \
 984	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_MORE_FRAMES | IEEE80211_TX_CTL_LDPC |		      \
 985	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_STBC | IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP)
 986
 987/**
 988 * enum mac80211_rate_control_flags - per-rate flags set by the
 989 *	Rate Control algorithm.
 990 *
 991 * These flags are set by the Rate control algorithm for each rate during tx,
 992 * in the @flags member of struct ieee80211_tx_rate.
 993 *
 994 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_RTS_CTS: Use RTS/CTS exchange for this rate.
 995 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_CTS_PROTECT: CTS-to-self protection is required.
 996 *	This is set if the current BSS requires ERP protection.
 997 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_SHORT_PREAMBLE: Use short preamble.
 998 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_MCS: HT rate.
 999 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_VHT_MCS: VHT MCS rate, in this case the idx field is split
1000 *	into a higher 4 bits (Nss) and lower 4 bits (MCS number)
1001 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_GREEN_FIELD: Indicates whether this rate should be used in
1002 *	Greenfield mode.
1003 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_40_MHZ_WIDTH: Indicates if the Channel Width should be 40 MHz.
1004 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_80_MHZ_WIDTH: Indicates 80 MHz transmission
1005 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_160_MHZ_WIDTH: Indicates 160 MHz transmission
1006 *	(80+80 isn't supported yet)
1007 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_DUP_DATA: The frame should be transmitted on both of the
1008 *	adjacent 20 MHz channels, if the current channel type is
1009 *	NL80211_CHAN_HT40MINUS or NL80211_CHAN_HT40PLUS.
1010 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_SHORT_GI: Short Guard interval should be used for this rate.
1011 */
1012enum mac80211_rate_control_flags {
1013	IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_RTS_CTS		= BIT(0),
1014	IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_CTS_PROTECT		= BIT(1),
1015	IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_SHORT_PREAMBLE	= BIT(2),
1016
1017	/* rate index is an HT/VHT MCS instead of an index */
1018	IEEE80211_TX_RC_MCS			= BIT(3),
1019	IEEE80211_TX_RC_GREEN_FIELD		= BIT(4),
1020	IEEE80211_TX_RC_40_MHZ_WIDTH		= BIT(5),
1021	IEEE80211_TX_RC_DUP_DATA		= BIT(6),
1022	IEEE80211_TX_RC_SHORT_GI		= BIT(7),
1023	IEEE80211_TX_RC_VHT_MCS			= BIT(8),
1024	IEEE80211_TX_RC_80_MHZ_WIDTH		= BIT(9),
1025	IEEE80211_TX_RC_160_MHZ_WIDTH		= BIT(10),
1026};
1027
1028
1029/* there are 40 bytes if you don't need the rateset to be kept */
1030#define IEEE80211_TX_INFO_DRIVER_DATA_SIZE 40
1031
1032/* if you do need the rateset, then you have less space */
1033#define IEEE80211_TX_INFO_RATE_DRIVER_DATA_SIZE 24
1034
1035/* maximum number of rate stages */
1036#define IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES	4
1037
1038/* maximum number of rate table entries */
1039#define IEEE80211_TX_RATE_TABLE_SIZE	4
1040
1041/**
1042 * struct ieee80211_tx_rate - rate selection/status
1043 *
1044 * @idx: rate index to attempt to send with
1045 * @flags: rate control flags (&enum mac80211_rate_control_flags)
1046 * @count: number of tries in this rate before going to the next rate
1047 *
1048 * A value of -1 for @idx indicates an invalid rate and, if used
1049 * in an array of retry rates, that no more rates should be tried.
1050 *
1051 * When used for transmit status reporting, the driver should
1052 * always report the rate along with the flags it used.
1053 *
1054 * &struct ieee80211_tx_info contains an array of these structs
1055 * in the control information, and it will be filled by the rate
1056 * control algorithm according to what should be sent. For example,
1057 * if this array contains, in the format { <idx>, <count> } the
1058 * information::
1059 *
1060 *    { 3, 2 }, { 2, 2 }, { 1, 4 }, { -1, 0 }, { -1, 0 }
1061 *
1062 * then this means that the frame should be transmitted
1063 * up to twice at rate 3, up to twice at rate 2, and up to four
1064 * times at rate 1 if it doesn't get acknowledged. Say it gets
1065 * acknowledged by the peer after the fifth attempt, the status
1066 * information should then contain::
1067 *
1068 *   { 3, 2 }, { 2, 2 }, { 1, 1 }, { -1, 0 } ...
1069 *
1070 * since it was transmitted twice at rate 3, twice at rate 2
1071 * and once at rate 1 after which we received an acknowledgement.
1072 */
1073struct ieee80211_tx_rate {
1074	s8 idx;
1075	u16 count:5,
1076	    flags:11;
1077} __packed;
1078
1079#define IEEE80211_MAX_TX_RETRY		31
1080
1081static inline bool ieee80211_rate_valid(struct ieee80211_tx_rate *rate)
1082{
1083	return rate->idx >= 0 && rate->count > 0;
1084}
1085
1086static inline void ieee80211_rate_set_vht(struct ieee80211_tx_rate *rate,
1087					  u8 mcs, u8 nss)
1088{
1089	WARN_ON(mcs & ~0xF);
1090	WARN_ON((nss - 1) & ~0x7);
1091	rate->idx = ((nss - 1) << 4) | mcs;
1092}
1093
1094static inline u8
1095ieee80211_rate_get_vht_mcs(const struct ieee80211_tx_rate *rate)
1096{
1097	return rate->idx & 0xF;
1098}
1099
1100static inline u8
1101ieee80211_rate_get_vht_nss(const struct ieee80211_tx_rate *rate)
1102{
1103	return (rate->idx >> 4) + 1;
1104}
1105
1106/**
1107 * struct ieee80211_tx_info - skb transmit information
1108 *
1109 * This structure is placed in skb->cb for three uses:
1110 *  (1) mac80211 TX control - mac80211 tells the driver what to do
1111 *  (2) driver internal use (if applicable)
1112 *  (3) TX status information - driver tells mac80211 what happened
1113 *
1114 * @flags: transmit info flags, defined above
1115 * @band: the band to transmit on (use e.g. for checking for races),
1116 *	not valid if the interface is an MLD since we won't know which
1117 *	link the frame will be transmitted on
1118 * @hw_queue: HW queue to put the frame on, skb_get_queue_mapping() gives the AC
1119 * @status_data: internal data for TX status handling, assigned privately,
1120 *	see also &enum ieee80211_status_data for the internal documentation
1121 * @status_data_idr: indicates status data is IDR allocated ID for ack frame
1122 * @tx_time_est: TX time estimate in units of 4us, used internally
1123 * @control: union part for control data
1124 * @control.rates: TX rates array to try
1125 * @control.rts_cts_rate_idx: rate for RTS or CTS
1126 * @control.use_rts: use RTS
1127 * @control.use_cts_prot: use RTS/CTS
1128 * @control.short_preamble: use short preamble (CCK only)
1129 * @control.skip_table: skip externally configured rate table
1130 * @control.jiffies: timestamp for expiry on powersave clients
1131 * @control.vif: virtual interface (may be NULL)
1132 * @control.hw_key: key to encrypt with (may be NULL)
1133 * @control.flags: control flags, see &enum mac80211_tx_control_flags
1134 * @control.enqueue_time: enqueue time (for iTXQs)
1135 * @driver_rates: alias to @control.rates to reserve space
1136 * @pad: padding
1137 * @rate_driver_data: driver use area if driver needs @control.rates
1138 * @status: union part for status data
1139 * @status.rates: attempted rates
1140 * @status.ack_signal: ACK signal
1141 * @status.ampdu_ack_len: AMPDU ack length
1142 * @status.ampdu_len: AMPDU length
1143 * @status.antenna: (legacy, kept only for iwlegacy)
1144 * @status.tx_time: airtime consumed for transmission; note this is only
1145 *	used for WMM AC, not for airtime fairness
1146 * @status.flags: status flags, see &enum mac80211_tx_status_flags
1147 * @status.status_driver_data: driver use area
1148 * @ack: union part for pure ACK data
1149 * @ack.cookie: cookie for the ACK
1150 * @driver_data: array of driver_data pointers
 
 
 
 
 
1151 */
1152struct ieee80211_tx_info {
1153	/* common information */
1154	u32 flags;
1155	u32 band:3,
1156	    status_data_idr:1,
1157	    status_data:13,
1158	    hw_queue:4,
1159	    tx_time_est:10;
1160	/* 1 free bit */
1161
1162	union {
1163		struct {
1164			union {
1165				/* rate control */
1166				struct {
1167					struct ieee80211_tx_rate rates[
1168						IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES];
1169					s8 rts_cts_rate_idx;
1170					u8 use_rts:1;
1171					u8 use_cts_prot:1;
1172					u8 short_preamble:1;
1173					u8 skip_table:1;
1174
1175					/* for injection only (bitmap) */
1176					u8 antennas:2;
1177
1178					/* 14 bits free */
1179				};
1180				/* only needed before rate control */
1181				unsigned long jiffies;
1182			};
1183			/* NB: vif can be NULL for injected frames */
1184			struct ieee80211_vif *vif;
1185			struct ieee80211_key_conf *hw_key;
1186			u32 flags;
1187			codel_time_t enqueue_time;
1188		} control;
1189		struct {
1190			u64 cookie;
1191		} ack;
1192		struct {
1193			struct ieee80211_tx_rate rates[IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES];
1194			s32 ack_signal;
1195			u8 ampdu_ack_len;
1196			u8 ampdu_len;
1197			u8 antenna;
1198			u8 pad;
1199			u16 tx_time;
1200			u8 flags;
1201			u8 pad2;
1202			void *status_driver_data[16 / sizeof(void *)];
1203		} status;
1204		struct {
1205			struct ieee80211_tx_rate driver_rates[
1206				IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES];
1207			u8 pad[4];
1208
1209			void *rate_driver_data[
1210				IEEE80211_TX_INFO_RATE_DRIVER_DATA_SIZE / sizeof(void *)];
1211		};
1212		void *driver_data[
1213			IEEE80211_TX_INFO_DRIVER_DATA_SIZE / sizeof(void *)];
1214	};
1215};
1216
1217static inline u16
1218ieee80211_info_set_tx_time_est(struct ieee80211_tx_info *info, u16 tx_time_est)
1219{
1220	/* We only have 10 bits in tx_time_est, so store airtime
1221	 * in increments of 4us and clamp the maximum to 2**12-1
1222	 */
1223	info->tx_time_est = min_t(u16, tx_time_est, 4095) >> 2;
1224	return info->tx_time_est << 2;
1225}
1226
1227static inline u16
1228ieee80211_info_get_tx_time_est(struct ieee80211_tx_info *info)
1229{
1230	return info->tx_time_est << 2;
1231}
1232
1233/***
1234 * struct ieee80211_rate_status - mrr stage for status path
1235 *
1236 * This struct is used in struct ieee80211_tx_status to provide drivers a
1237 * dynamic way to report about used rates and power levels per packet.
1238 *
1239 * @rate_idx The actual used rate.
1240 * @try_count How often the rate was tried.
1241 * @tx_power_idx An idx into the ieee80211_hw->tx_power_levels list of the
1242 * 	corresponding wifi hardware. The idx shall point to the power level
1243 * 	that was used when sending the packet.
1244 */
1245struct ieee80211_rate_status {
1246	struct rate_info rate_idx;
1247	u8 try_count;
1248	u8 tx_power_idx;
1249};
1250
1251/**
1252 * struct ieee80211_tx_status - extended tx status info for rate control
1253 *
1254 * @sta: Station that the packet was transmitted for
1255 * @info: Basic tx status information
1256 * @skb: Packet skb (can be NULL if not provided by the driver)
1257 * @rates: Mrr stages that were used when sending the packet
1258 * @n_rates: Number of mrr stages (count of instances for @rates)
1259 * @free_list: list where processed skbs are stored to be free'd by the driver
1260 * @ack_hwtstamp: Hardware timestamp of the received ack in nanoseconds
1261 *	Only needed for Timing measurement and Fine timing measurement action
1262 *	frames. Only reported by devices that have timestamping enabled.
1263 */
1264struct ieee80211_tx_status {
1265	struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
1266	struct ieee80211_tx_info *info;
1267	struct sk_buff *skb;
1268	struct ieee80211_rate_status *rates;
1269	ktime_t ack_hwtstamp;
1270	u8 n_rates;
1271
1272	struct list_head *free_list;
1273};
1274
1275/**
1276 * struct ieee80211_scan_ies - descriptors for different blocks of IEs
1277 *
1278 * This structure is used to point to different blocks of IEs in HW scan
1279 * and scheduled scan. These blocks contain the IEs passed by userspace
1280 * and the ones generated by mac80211.
1281 *
1282 * @ies: pointers to band specific IEs.
1283 * @len: lengths of band_specific IEs.
1284 * @common_ies: IEs for all bands (especially vendor specific ones)
1285 * @common_ie_len: length of the common_ies
1286 */
1287struct ieee80211_scan_ies {
1288	const u8 *ies[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
1289	size_t len[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
1290	const u8 *common_ies;
1291	size_t common_ie_len;
1292};
1293
1294
1295static inline struct ieee80211_tx_info *IEEE80211_SKB_CB(struct sk_buff *skb)
1296{
1297	return (struct ieee80211_tx_info *)skb->cb;
1298}
1299
1300static inline struct ieee80211_rx_status *IEEE80211_SKB_RXCB(struct sk_buff *skb)
1301{
1302	return (struct ieee80211_rx_status *)skb->cb;
1303}
1304
1305/**
1306 * ieee80211_tx_info_clear_status - clear TX status
1307 *
1308 * @info: The &struct ieee80211_tx_info to be cleared.
1309 *
1310 * When the driver passes an skb back to mac80211, it must report
1311 * a number of things in TX status. This function clears everything
1312 * in the TX status but the rate control information (it does clear
1313 * the count since you need to fill that in anyway).
1314 *
1315 * NOTE: While the rates array is kept intact, this will wipe all of the
1316 *	 driver_data fields in info, so it's up to the driver to restore
1317 *	 any fields it needs after calling this helper.
1318 */
1319static inline void
1320ieee80211_tx_info_clear_status(struct ieee80211_tx_info *info)
1321{
1322	int i;
1323
1324	BUILD_BUG_ON(offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, status.rates) !=
1325		     offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, control.rates));
1326	BUILD_BUG_ON(offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, status.rates) !=
1327		     offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, driver_rates));
1328	BUILD_BUG_ON(offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, status.rates) != 8);
1329	/* clear the rate counts */
1330	for (i = 0; i < IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES; i++)
1331		info->status.rates[i].count = 0;
1332	memset_after(&info->status, 0, rates);
 
 
 
 
 
1333}
1334
1335
1336/**
1337 * enum mac80211_rx_flags - receive flags
1338 *
1339 * These flags are used with the @flag member of &struct ieee80211_rx_status.
1340 * @RX_FLAG_MMIC_ERROR: Michael MIC error was reported on this frame.
1341 *	Use together with %RX_FLAG_MMIC_STRIPPED.
1342 * @RX_FLAG_DECRYPTED: This frame was decrypted in hardware.
1343 * @RX_FLAG_MMIC_STRIPPED: the Michael MIC is stripped off this frame,
1344 *	verification has been done by the hardware.
1345 * @RX_FLAG_IV_STRIPPED: The IV and ICV are stripped from this frame.
1346 *	If this flag is set, the stack cannot do any replay detection
1347 *	hence the driver or hardware will have to do that.
1348 * @RX_FLAG_PN_VALIDATED: Currently only valid for CCMP/GCMP frames, this
1349 *	flag indicates that the PN was verified for replay protection.
1350 *	Note that this flag is also currently only supported when a frame
1351 *	is also decrypted (ie. @RX_FLAG_DECRYPTED must be set)
1352 * @RX_FLAG_DUP_VALIDATED: The driver should set this flag if it did
1353 *	de-duplication by itself.
1354 * @RX_FLAG_FAILED_FCS_CRC: Set this flag if the FCS check failed on
1355 *	the frame.
1356 * @RX_FLAG_FAILED_PLCP_CRC: Set this flag if the PCLP check failed on
1357 *	the frame.
1358 * @RX_FLAG_MACTIME: The timestamp passed in the RX status (@mactime
1359 *	field) is valid if this field is non-zero, and the position
1360 *	where the timestamp was sampled depends on the value.
1361 * @RX_FLAG_MACTIME_START: The timestamp passed in the RX status (@mactime
1362 *	field) is valid and contains the time the first symbol of the MPDU
1363 *	was received. This is useful in monitor mode and for proper IBSS
1364 *	merging.
1365 * @RX_FLAG_MACTIME_END: The timestamp passed in the RX status (@mactime
1366 *	field) is valid and contains the time the last symbol of the MPDU
1367 *	(including FCS) was received.
1368 * @RX_FLAG_MACTIME_PLCP_START: The timestamp passed in the RX status (@mactime
1369 *	field) is valid and contains the time the SYNC preamble was received.
1370 * @RX_FLAG_MACTIME_IS_RTAP_TS64: The timestamp passed in the RX status @mactime
1371 *	is only for use in the radiotap timestamp header, not otherwise a valid
1372 *	@mactime value. Note this is a separate flag so that we continue to see
1373 *	%RX_FLAG_MACTIME as unset. Also note that in this case the timestamp is
1374 *	reported to be 64 bits wide, not just 32.
1375 * @RX_FLAG_NO_SIGNAL_VAL: The signal strength value is not present.
1376 *	Valid only for data frames (mainly A-MPDU)
1377 * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DETAILS: A-MPDU details are known, in particular the reference
1378 *	number (@ampdu_reference) must be populated and be a distinct number for
1379 *	each A-MPDU
1380 * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_LAST_KNOWN: last subframe is known, should be set on all
1381 *	subframes of a single A-MPDU
1382 * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_IS_LAST: this subframe is the last subframe of the A-MPDU
1383 * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DELIM_CRC_ERROR: A delimiter CRC error has been detected
1384 *	on this subframe
1385 * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DELIM_CRC_KNOWN: The delimiter CRC field is known (the CRC
1386 *	is stored in the @ampdu_delimiter_crc field)
1387 * @RX_FLAG_MIC_STRIPPED: The mic was stripped of this packet. Decryption was
1388 *	done by the hardware
1389 * @RX_FLAG_ONLY_MONITOR: Report frame only to monitor interfaces without
1390 *	processing it in any regular way.
1391 *	This is useful if drivers offload some frames but still want to report
1392 *	them for sniffing purposes.
1393 * @RX_FLAG_SKIP_MONITOR: Process and report frame to all interfaces except
1394 *	monitor interfaces.
1395 *	This is useful if drivers offload some frames but still want to report
1396 *	them for sniffing purposes.
1397 * @RX_FLAG_AMSDU_MORE: Some drivers may prefer to report separate A-MSDU
1398 *	subframes instead of a one huge frame for performance reasons.
1399 *	All, but the last MSDU from an A-MSDU should have this flag set. E.g.
1400 *	if an A-MSDU has 3 frames, the first 2 must have the flag set, while
1401 *	the 3rd (last) one must not have this flag set. The flag is used to
1402 *	deal with retransmission/duplication recovery properly since A-MSDU
1403 *	subframes share the same sequence number. Reported subframes can be
1404 *	either regular MSDU or singly A-MSDUs. Subframes must not be
1405 *	interleaved with other frames.
1406 * @RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_TLV_AT_END: This frame contains radiotap TLVs in the
1407 *	skb->data (before the 802.11 header).
1408 *	If used, the SKB's mac_header pointer must be set to point
1409 *	to the 802.11 header after the TLVs, and any padding added after TLV
1410 *	data to align to 4 must be cleared by the driver putting the TLVs
1411 *	in the skb.
1412 * @RX_FLAG_ALLOW_SAME_PN: Allow the same PN as same packet before.
1413 *	This is used for AMSDU subframes which can have the same PN as
1414 *	the first subframe.
1415 * @RX_FLAG_ICV_STRIPPED: The ICV is stripped from this frame. CRC checking must
1416 *	be done in the hardware.
1417 * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_EOF_BIT: Value of the EOF bit in the A-MPDU delimiter for this
1418 *	frame
1419 * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_EOF_BIT_KNOWN: The EOF value is known
1420 * @RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_HE: HE radiotap data is present
1421 *	(&struct ieee80211_radiotap_he, mac80211 will fill in
1422 *	
1423 *	 - DATA3_DATA_MCS
1424 *	 - DATA3_DATA_DCM
1425 *	 - DATA3_CODING
1426 *	 - DATA5_GI
1427 *	 - DATA5_DATA_BW_RU_ALLOC
1428 *	 - DATA6_NSTS
1429 *	 - DATA3_STBC
1430 *	
1431 *	from the RX info data, so leave those zeroed when building this data)
1432 * @RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_HE_MU: HE MU radiotap data is present
1433 *	(&struct ieee80211_radiotap_he_mu)
1434 * @RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_LSIG: L-SIG radiotap data is present
1435 * @RX_FLAG_NO_PSDU: use the frame only for radiotap reporting, with
1436 *	the "0-length PSDU" field included there.  The value for it is
1437 *	in &struct ieee80211_rx_status.  Note that if this value isn't
1438 *	known the frame shouldn't be reported.
1439 * @RX_FLAG_8023: the frame has an 802.3 header (decap offload performed by
1440 *	hardware or driver)
1441 */
1442enum mac80211_rx_flags {
1443	RX_FLAG_MMIC_ERROR		= BIT(0),
1444	RX_FLAG_DECRYPTED		= BIT(1),
1445	RX_FLAG_ONLY_MONITOR		= BIT(2),
1446	RX_FLAG_MMIC_STRIPPED		= BIT(3),
1447	RX_FLAG_IV_STRIPPED		= BIT(4),
1448	RX_FLAG_FAILED_FCS_CRC		= BIT(5),
1449	RX_FLAG_FAILED_PLCP_CRC 	= BIT(6),
1450	RX_FLAG_MACTIME_IS_RTAP_TS64	= BIT(7),
1451	RX_FLAG_NO_SIGNAL_VAL		= BIT(8),
1452	RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DETAILS		= BIT(9),
1453	RX_FLAG_PN_VALIDATED		= BIT(10),
1454	RX_FLAG_DUP_VALIDATED		= BIT(11),
1455	RX_FLAG_AMPDU_LAST_KNOWN	= BIT(12),
1456	RX_FLAG_AMPDU_IS_LAST		= BIT(13),
1457	RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DELIM_CRC_ERROR	= BIT(14),
1458	RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DELIM_CRC_KNOWN	= BIT(15),
1459	RX_FLAG_MACTIME			= BIT(16) | BIT(17),
1460	RX_FLAG_MACTIME_PLCP_START	= 1 << 16,
1461	RX_FLAG_MACTIME_START		= 2 << 16,
1462	RX_FLAG_MACTIME_END		= 3 << 16,
1463	RX_FLAG_SKIP_MONITOR		= BIT(18),
1464	RX_FLAG_AMSDU_MORE		= BIT(19),
1465	RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_TLV_AT_END	= BIT(20),
1466	RX_FLAG_MIC_STRIPPED		= BIT(21),
1467	RX_FLAG_ALLOW_SAME_PN		= BIT(22),
1468	RX_FLAG_ICV_STRIPPED		= BIT(23),
1469	RX_FLAG_AMPDU_EOF_BIT		= BIT(24),
1470	RX_FLAG_AMPDU_EOF_BIT_KNOWN	= BIT(25),
1471	RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_HE		= BIT(26),
1472	RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_HE_MU		= BIT(27),
1473	RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_LSIG		= BIT(28),
1474	RX_FLAG_NO_PSDU			= BIT(29),
1475	RX_FLAG_8023			= BIT(30),
1476};
1477
1478/**
1479 * enum mac80211_rx_encoding_flags - MCS & bandwidth flags
1480 *
1481 * @RX_ENC_FLAG_SHORTPRE: Short preamble was used for this frame
1482 * @RX_ENC_FLAG_SHORT_GI: Short guard interval was used
1483 * @RX_ENC_FLAG_HT_GF: This frame was received in a HT-greenfield transmission,
1484 *	if the driver fills this value it should add
1485 *	%IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_MCS_HAVE_FMT
1486 *	to @hw.radiotap_mcs_details to advertise that fact.
1487 * @RX_ENC_FLAG_LDPC: LDPC was used
1488 * @RX_ENC_FLAG_STBC_MASK: STBC 2 bit bitmask. 1 - Nss=1, 2 - Nss=2, 3 - Nss=3
1489 * @RX_ENC_FLAG_BF: packet was beamformed
1490 */
1491enum mac80211_rx_encoding_flags {
1492	RX_ENC_FLAG_SHORTPRE		= BIT(0),
1493	RX_ENC_FLAG_SHORT_GI		= BIT(2),
1494	RX_ENC_FLAG_HT_GF		= BIT(3),
1495	RX_ENC_FLAG_STBC_MASK		= BIT(4) | BIT(5),
1496	RX_ENC_FLAG_LDPC		= BIT(6),
1497	RX_ENC_FLAG_BF			= BIT(7),
1498};
1499
1500#define RX_ENC_FLAG_STBC_SHIFT		4
1501
1502enum mac80211_rx_encoding {
1503	RX_ENC_LEGACY = 0,
1504	RX_ENC_HT,
1505	RX_ENC_VHT,
1506	RX_ENC_HE,
1507	RX_ENC_EHT,
1508};
1509
1510/**
1511 * struct ieee80211_rx_status - receive status
1512 *
1513 * The low-level driver should provide this information (the subset
1514 * supported by hardware) to the 802.11 code with each received
1515 * frame, in the skb's control buffer (cb).
1516 *
1517 * @mactime: value in microseconds of the 64-bit Time Synchronization Function
1518 * 	(TSF) timer when the first data symbol (MPDU) arrived at the hardware.
1519 * @boottime_ns: CLOCK_BOOTTIME timestamp the frame was received at, this is
1520 *	needed only for beacons and probe responses that update the scan cache.
1521 * @ack_tx_hwtstamp: Hardware timestamp for the ack TX in nanoseconds. Only
1522 *	needed for Timing measurement and Fine timing measurement action frames.
1523 *	Only reported by devices that have timestamping enabled.
1524 * @device_timestamp: arbitrary timestamp for the device, mac80211 doesn't use
1525 *	it but can store it and pass it back to the driver for synchronisation
1526 * @band: the active band when this frame was received
1527 * @freq: frequency the radio was tuned to when receiving this frame, in MHz
1528 *	This field must be set for management frames, but isn't strictly needed
1529 *	for data (other) frames - for those it only affects radiotap reporting.
1530 * @freq_offset: @freq has a positive offset of 500Khz.
1531 * @signal: signal strength when receiving this frame, either in dBm, in dB or
1532 *	unspecified depending on the hardware capabilities flags
1533 *	@IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_*
1534 * @chains: bitmask of receive chains for which separate signal strength
1535 *	values were filled.
1536 * @chain_signal: per-chain signal strength, in dBm (unlike @signal, doesn't
1537 *	support dB or unspecified units)
1538 * @antenna: antenna used
1539 * @rate_idx: index of data rate into band's supported rates or MCS index if
1540 *	HT or VHT is used (%RX_FLAG_HT/%RX_FLAG_VHT)
1541 * @nss: number of streams (VHT, HE and EHT only)
1542 * @flag: %RX_FLAG_\*
1543 * @encoding: &enum mac80211_rx_encoding
1544 * @bw: &enum rate_info_bw
1545 * @enc_flags: uses bits from &enum mac80211_rx_encoding_flags
1546 * @he_ru: HE RU, from &enum nl80211_he_ru_alloc
1547 * @he_gi: HE GI, from &enum nl80211_he_gi
1548 * @he_dcm: HE DCM value
1549 * @eht: EHT specific rate information
1550 * @eht.ru: EHT RU, from &enum nl80211_eht_ru_alloc
1551 * @eht.gi: EHT GI, from &enum nl80211_eht_gi
1552 * @rx_flags: internal RX flags for mac80211
1553 * @ampdu_reference: A-MPDU reference number, must be a different value for
1554 *	each A-MPDU but the same for each subframe within one A-MPDU
1555 * @ampdu_delimiter_crc: A-MPDU delimiter CRC
1556 * @zero_length_psdu_type: radiotap type of the 0-length PSDU
1557 * @link_valid: if the link which is identified by @link_id is valid. This flag
1558 *	is set only when connection is MLO.
1559 * @link_id: id of the link used to receive the packet. This is used along with
1560 *	@link_valid.
1561 */
1562struct ieee80211_rx_status {
1563	u64 mactime;
1564	union {
1565		u64 boottime_ns;
1566		ktime_t ack_tx_hwtstamp;
1567	};
1568	u32 device_timestamp;
1569	u32 ampdu_reference;
1570	u32 flag;
1571	u16 freq: 13, freq_offset: 1;
1572	u8 enc_flags;
1573	u8 encoding:3, bw:4;
1574	union {
1575		struct {
1576			u8 he_ru:3;
1577			u8 he_gi:2;
1578			u8 he_dcm:1;
1579		};
1580		struct {
1581			u8 ru:4;
1582			u8 gi:2;
1583		} eht;
1584	};
1585	u8 rate_idx;
1586	u8 nss;
1587	u8 rx_flags;
1588	u8 band;
1589	u8 antenna;
1590	s8 signal;
1591	u8 chains;
1592	s8 chain_signal[IEEE80211_MAX_CHAINS];
1593	u8 ampdu_delimiter_crc;
1594	u8 zero_length_psdu_type;
1595	u8 link_valid:1, link_id:4;
1596};
1597
1598static inline u32
1599ieee80211_rx_status_to_khz(struct ieee80211_rx_status *rx_status)
1600{
1601	return MHZ_TO_KHZ(rx_status->freq) +
1602	       (rx_status->freq_offset ? 500 : 0);
1603}
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
1604
1605/**
1606 * enum ieee80211_conf_flags - configuration flags
1607 *
1608 * Flags to define PHY configuration options
1609 *
1610 * @IEEE80211_CONF_MONITOR: there's a monitor interface present -- use this
1611 *	to determine for example whether to calculate timestamps for packets
1612 *	or not, do not use instead of filter flags!
1613 * @IEEE80211_CONF_PS: Enable 802.11 power save mode (managed mode only).
1614 *	This is the power save mode defined by IEEE 802.11-2007 section 11.2,
1615 *	meaning that the hardware still wakes up for beacons, is able to
1616 *	transmit frames and receive the possible acknowledgment frames.
1617 *	Not to be confused with hardware specific wakeup/sleep states,
1618 *	driver is responsible for that. See the section "Powersave support"
1619 *	for more.
1620 * @IEEE80211_CONF_IDLE: The device is running, but idle; if the flag is set
1621 *	the driver should be prepared to handle configuration requests but
1622 *	may turn the device off as much as possible. Typically, this flag will
1623 *	be set when an interface is set UP but not associated or scanning, but
1624 *	it can also be unset in that case when monitor interfaces are active.
1625 * @IEEE80211_CONF_OFFCHANNEL: The device is currently not on its main
1626 *	operating channel.
1627 */
1628enum ieee80211_conf_flags {
1629	IEEE80211_CONF_MONITOR		= (1<<0),
1630	IEEE80211_CONF_PS		= (1<<1),
1631	IEEE80211_CONF_IDLE		= (1<<2),
1632	IEEE80211_CONF_OFFCHANNEL	= (1<<3),
1633};
1634
1635
1636/**
1637 * enum ieee80211_conf_changed - denotes which configuration changed
1638 *
1639 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_LISTEN_INTERVAL: the listen interval changed
1640 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_MONITOR: the monitor flag changed
1641 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_PS: the PS flag or dynamic PS timeout changed
1642 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_POWER: the TX power changed
1643 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_CHANNEL: the channel/channel_type changed
1644 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_RETRY_LIMITS: retry limits changed
1645 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_IDLE: Idle flag changed
1646 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_SMPS: Spatial multiplexing powersave mode changed
1647 *	Note that this is only valid if channel contexts are not used,
1648 *	otherwise each channel context has the number of chains listed.
1649 */
1650enum ieee80211_conf_changed {
1651	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_SMPS		= BIT(1),
1652	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_LISTEN_INTERVAL	= BIT(2),
1653	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_MONITOR		= BIT(3),
1654	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_PS		= BIT(4),
1655	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_POWER		= BIT(5),
1656	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_CHANNEL		= BIT(6),
1657	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_RETRY_LIMITS	= BIT(7),
1658	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_IDLE		= BIT(8),
1659};
1660
1661/**
1662 * enum ieee80211_smps_mode - spatial multiplexing power save mode
1663 *
1664 * @IEEE80211_SMPS_AUTOMATIC: automatic
1665 * @IEEE80211_SMPS_OFF: off
1666 * @IEEE80211_SMPS_STATIC: static
1667 * @IEEE80211_SMPS_DYNAMIC: dynamic
1668 * @IEEE80211_SMPS_NUM_MODES: internal, don't use
1669 */
1670enum ieee80211_smps_mode {
1671	IEEE80211_SMPS_AUTOMATIC,
1672	IEEE80211_SMPS_OFF,
1673	IEEE80211_SMPS_STATIC,
1674	IEEE80211_SMPS_DYNAMIC,
1675
1676	/* keep last */
1677	IEEE80211_SMPS_NUM_MODES,
1678};
1679
1680/**
1681 * struct ieee80211_conf - configuration of the device
1682 *
1683 * This struct indicates how the driver shall configure the hardware.
1684 *
1685 * @flags: configuration flags defined above
1686 *
1687 * @listen_interval: listen interval in units of beacon interval
1688 * @ps_dtim_period: The DTIM period of the AP we're connected to, for use
1689 *	in power saving. Power saving will not be enabled until a beacon
1690 *	has been received and the DTIM period is known.
1691 * @dynamic_ps_timeout: The dynamic powersave timeout (in ms), see the
1692 *	powersave documentation below. This variable is valid only when
1693 *	the CONF_PS flag is set.
1694 *
1695 * @power_level: requested transmit power (in dBm), backward compatibility
1696 *	value only that is set to the minimum of all interfaces
1697 *
1698 * @chandef: the channel definition to tune to
1699 * @radar_enabled: whether radar detection is enabled
1700 *
1701 * @long_frame_max_tx_count: Maximum number of transmissions for a "long" frame
1702 *	(a frame not RTS protected), called "dot11LongRetryLimit" in 802.11,
1703 *	but actually means the number of transmissions not the number of retries
1704 * @short_frame_max_tx_count: Maximum number of transmissions for a "short"
1705 *	frame, called "dot11ShortRetryLimit" in 802.11, but actually means the
1706 *	number of transmissions not the number of retries
1707 *
1708 * @smps_mode: spatial multiplexing powersave mode; note that
1709 *	%IEEE80211_SMPS_STATIC is used when the device is not
1710 *	configured for an HT channel.
1711 *	Note that this is only valid if channel contexts are not used,
1712 *	otherwise each channel context has the number of chains listed.
1713 */
1714struct ieee80211_conf {
1715	u32 flags;
1716	int power_level, dynamic_ps_timeout;
1717
1718	u16 listen_interval;
1719	u8 ps_dtim_period;
1720
1721	u8 long_frame_max_tx_count, short_frame_max_tx_count;
1722
1723	struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
1724	bool radar_enabled;
1725	enum ieee80211_smps_mode smps_mode;
1726};
1727
1728/**
1729 * struct ieee80211_channel_switch - holds the channel switch data
1730 *
1731 * The information provided in this structure is required for channel switch
1732 * operation.
1733 *
1734 * @timestamp: value in microseconds of the 64-bit Time Synchronization
1735 *	Function (TSF) timer when the frame containing the channel switch
1736 *	announcement was received. This is simply the rx.mactime parameter
1737 *	the driver passed into mac80211.
1738 * @device_timestamp: arbitrary timestamp for the device, this is the
1739 *	rx.device_timestamp parameter the driver passed to mac80211.
1740 * @block_tx: Indicates whether transmission must be blocked before the
1741 *	scheduled channel switch, as indicated by the AP.
1742 * @chandef: the new channel to switch to
1743 * @count: the number of TBTT's until the channel switch event
1744 * @delay: maximum delay between the time the AP transmitted the last beacon in
1745  *	current channel and the expected time of the first beacon in the new
1746  *	channel, expressed in TU.
1747 */
1748struct ieee80211_channel_switch {
1749	u64 timestamp;
1750	u32 device_timestamp;
1751	bool block_tx;
1752	struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
1753	u8 count;
1754	u32 delay;
1755};
1756
1757/**
1758 * enum ieee80211_vif_flags - virtual interface flags
1759 *
1760 * @IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER: the device performs beacon filtering
1761 *	on this virtual interface to avoid unnecessary CPU wakeups
1762 * @IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_CQM_RSSI: the device can do connection quality
1763 *	monitoring on this virtual interface -- i.e. it can monitor
1764 *	connection quality related parameters, such as the RSSI level and
1765 *	provide notifications if configured trigger levels are reached.
1766 * @IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_UAPSD: The device can do U-APSD for this
1767 *	interface. This flag should be set during interface addition,
1768 *	but may be set/cleared as late as authentication to an AP. It is
1769 *	only valid for managed/station mode interfaces.
1770 * @IEEE80211_VIF_GET_NOA_UPDATE: request to handle NOA attributes
1771 *	and send P2P_PS notification to the driver if NOA changed, even
1772 *	this is not pure P2P vif.
1773 * @IEEE80211_VIF_EML_ACTIVE: The driver indicates that EML operation is
1774 *      enabled for the interface.
1775 */
1776enum ieee80211_vif_flags {
1777	IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER		= BIT(0),
1778	IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_CQM_RSSI		= BIT(1),
1779	IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_UAPSD		= BIT(2),
1780	IEEE80211_VIF_GET_NOA_UPDATE		= BIT(3),
1781	IEEE80211_VIF_EML_ACTIVE	        = BIT(4),
1782};
1783
1784
1785/**
1786 * enum ieee80211_offload_flags - virtual interface offload flags
1787 *
1788 * @IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_ENCAP_ENABLED: tx encapsulation offload is enabled
1789 *	The driver supports sending frames passed as 802.3 frames by mac80211.
1790 *	It must also support sending 802.11 packets for the same interface.
1791 * @IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_ENCAP_4ADDR: support 4-address mode encapsulation offload
1792 * @IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_DECAP_ENABLED: rx encapsulation offload is enabled
1793 *	The driver supports passing received 802.11 frames as 802.3 frames to
1794 *	mac80211.
1795 */
1796
1797enum ieee80211_offload_flags {
1798	IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_ENCAP_ENABLED		= BIT(0),
1799	IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_ENCAP_4ADDR		= BIT(1),
1800	IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_DECAP_ENABLED		= BIT(2),
1801};
1802
1803/**
1804 * struct ieee80211_vif_cfg - interface configuration
1805 * @assoc: association status
1806 * @ibss_joined: indicates whether this station is part of an IBSS or not
1807 * @ibss_creator: indicates if a new IBSS network is being created
1808 * @ps: power-save mode (STA only). This flag is NOT affected by
1809 *	offchannel/dynamic_ps operations.
1810 * @aid: association ID number, valid only when @assoc is true
1811 * @eml_cap: EML capabilities as described in P802.11be_D2.2 Figure 9-1002k.
1812 * @eml_med_sync_delay: Medium Synchronization delay as described in
1813 *	P802.11be_D2.2 Figure 9-1002j.
1814 * @arp_addr_list: List of IPv4 addresses for hardware ARP filtering. The
1815 *	may filter ARP queries targeted for other addresses than listed here.
1816 *	The driver must allow ARP queries targeted for all address listed here
1817 *	to pass through. An empty list implies no ARP queries need to pass.
1818 * @arp_addr_cnt: Number of addresses currently on the list. Note that this
1819 *	may be larger than %IEEE80211_BSS_ARP_ADDR_LIST_LEN (the arp_addr_list
1820 *	array size), it's up to the driver what to do in that case.
1821 * @ssid: The SSID of the current vif. Valid in AP and IBSS mode.
1822 * @ssid_len: Length of SSID given in @ssid.
1823 * @s1g: BSS is S1G BSS (affects Association Request format).
1824 * @idle: This interface is idle. There's also a global idle flag in the
1825 *	hardware config which may be more appropriate depending on what
1826 *	your driver/device needs to do.
1827 * @ap_addr: AP MLD address, or BSSID for non-MLO connections
1828 *	(station mode only)
1829 */
1830struct ieee80211_vif_cfg {
1831	/* association related data */
1832	bool assoc, ibss_joined;
1833	bool ibss_creator;
1834	bool ps;
1835	u16 aid;
1836	u16 eml_cap;
1837	u16 eml_med_sync_delay;
1838
1839	__be32 arp_addr_list[IEEE80211_BSS_ARP_ADDR_LIST_LEN];
1840	int arp_addr_cnt;
1841	u8 ssid[IEEE80211_MAX_SSID_LEN];
1842	size_t ssid_len;
1843	bool s1g;
1844	bool idle;
1845	u8 ap_addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
1846};
1847
1848/**
1849 * struct ieee80211_vif - per-interface data
1850 *
1851 * Data in this structure is continually present for driver
1852 * use during the life of a virtual interface.
1853 *
1854 * @type: type of this virtual interface
1855 * @cfg: vif configuration, see &struct ieee80211_vif_cfg
1856 * @bss_conf: BSS configuration for this interface, either our own
1857 *	or the BSS we're associated to
1858 * @link_conf: in case of MLD, the per-link BSS configuration,
1859 *	indexed by link ID
1860 * @valid_links: bitmap of valid links, or 0 for non-MLO.
1861 * @active_links: The bitmap of active links, or 0 for non-MLO.
1862 *	The driver shouldn't change this directly, but use the
1863 *	API calls meant for that purpose.
1864 * @dormant_links: bitmap of valid but disabled links, or 0 for non-MLO.
1865 *	Must be a subset of valid_links.
1866 * @addr: address of this interface
1867 * @p2p: indicates whether this AP or STA interface is a p2p
1868 *	interface, i.e. a GO or p2p-sta respectively
1869 * @netdev_features: tx netdev features supported by the hardware for this
1870 *	vif. mac80211 initializes this to hw->netdev_features, and the driver
1871 *	can mask out specific tx features. mac80211 will handle software fixup
1872 *	for masked offloads (GSO, CSUM)
1873 * @driver_flags: flags/capabilities the driver has for this interface,
1874 *	these need to be set (or cleared) when the interface is added
1875 *	or, if supported by the driver, the interface type is changed
1876 *	at runtime, mac80211 will never touch this field
1877 * @offload_flags: hardware offload capabilities/flags for this interface.
1878 *	These are initialized by mac80211 before calling .add_interface,
1879 *	.change_interface or .update_vif_offload and updated by the driver
1880 *	within these ops, based on supported features or runtime change
1881 *	restrictions.
1882 * @hw_queue: hardware queue for each AC
1883 * @cab_queue: content-after-beacon (DTIM beacon really) queue, AP mode only
 
 
 
 
 
1884 * @debugfs_dir: debugfs dentry, can be used by drivers to create own per
1885 *	interface debug files. Note that it will be NULL for the virtual
1886 *	monitor interface (if that is requested.)
1887 * @probe_req_reg: probe requests should be reported to mac80211 for this
1888 *	interface.
1889 * @rx_mcast_action_reg: multicast Action frames should be reported to mac80211
1890 *	for this interface.
1891 * @drv_priv: data area for driver use, will always be aligned to
1892 *	sizeof(void \*).
1893 * @txq: the multicast data TX queue
1894 * @offload_flags: 802.3 -> 802.11 enapsulation offload flags, see
1895 *	&enum ieee80211_offload_flags.
1896 * @mbssid_tx_vif: Pointer to the transmitting interface if MBSSID is enabled.
1897 */
1898struct ieee80211_vif {
1899	enum nl80211_iftype type;
1900	struct ieee80211_vif_cfg cfg;
1901	struct ieee80211_bss_conf bss_conf;
1902	struct ieee80211_bss_conf __rcu *link_conf[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS];
1903	u16 valid_links, active_links, dormant_links;
1904	u8 addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
1905	bool p2p;
 
 
1906
1907	u8 cab_queue;
1908	u8 hw_queue[IEEE80211_NUM_ACS];
1909
1910	struct ieee80211_txq *txq;
1911
1912	netdev_features_t netdev_features;
 
1913	u32 driver_flags;
1914	u32 offload_flags;
1915
1916#ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS
1917	struct dentry *debugfs_dir;
1918#endif
1919
1920	bool probe_req_reg;
1921	bool rx_mcast_action_reg;
1922
1923	struct ieee80211_vif *mbssid_tx_vif;
1924
1925	/* must be last */
1926	u8 drv_priv[] __aligned(sizeof(void *));
1927};
1928
1929/**
1930 * ieee80211_vif_usable_links - Return the usable links for the vif
1931 * @vif: the vif for which the usable links are requested
1932 * Return: the usable link bitmap
1933 */
1934static inline u16 ieee80211_vif_usable_links(const struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
1935{
1936	return vif->valid_links & ~vif->dormant_links;
1937}
1938
1939/**
1940 * ieee80211_vif_is_mld - Returns true iff the vif is an MLD one
1941 * @vif: the vif
1942 * Return: %true if the vif is an MLD, %false otherwise.
1943 */
1944static inline bool ieee80211_vif_is_mld(const struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
1945{
1946	/* valid_links != 0 indicates this vif is an MLD */
1947	return vif->valid_links != 0;
1948}
1949
1950#define for_each_vif_active_link(vif, link, link_id)				\
1951	for (link_id = 0; link_id < ARRAY_SIZE((vif)->link_conf); link_id++)	\
1952		if ((!(vif)->active_links ||					\
1953		     (vif)->active_links & BIT(link_id)) &&			\
1954		    (link = link_conf_dereference_check(vif, link_id)))
1955
1956static inline bool ieee80211_vif_is_mesh(struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
1957{
1958#ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_MESH
1959	return vif->type == NL80211_IFTYPE_MESH_POINT;
1960#endif
1961	return false;
1962}
1963
1964/**
1965 * wdev_to_ieee80211_vif - return a vif struct from a wdev
1966 * @wdev: the wdev to get the vif for
1967 *
1968 * This can be used by mac80211 drivers with direct cfg80211 APIs
1969 * (like the vendor commands) that get a wdev.
1970 *
1971 * Note that this function may return %NULL if the given wdev isn't
1972 * associated with a vif that the driver knows about (e.g. monitor
1973 * or AP_VLAN interfaces.)
1974 */
1975struct ieee80211_vif *wdev_to_ieee80211_vif(struct wireless_dev *wdev);
1976
1977/**
1978 * ieee80211_vif_to_wdev - return a wdev struct from a vif
1979 * @vif: the vif to get the wdev for
1980 *
1981 * This can be used by mac80211 drivers with direct cfg80211 APIs
1982 * (like the vendor commands) that needs to get the wdev for a vif.
1983 * This can also be useful to get the netdev associated to a vif.
 
 
 
1984 */
1985struct wireless_dev *ieee80211_vif_to_wdev(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
1986
1987static inline bool lockdep_vif_wiphy_mutex_held(struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
1988{
1989	return lockdep_is_held(&ieee80211_vif_to_wdev(vif)->wiphy->mtx);
1990}
1991
1992#define link_conf_dereference_protected(vif, link_id)		\
1993	rcu_dereference_protected((vif)->link_conf[link_id],	\
1994				  lockdep_vif_wiphy_mutex_held(vif))
1995
1996#define link_conf_dereference_check(vif, link_id)		\
1997	rcu_dereference_check((vif)->link_conf[link_id],	\
1998			      lockdep_vif_wiphy_mutex_held(vif))
1999
2000/**
2001 * enum ieee80211_key_flags - key flags
2002 *
2003 * These flags are used for communication about keys between the driver
2004 * and mac80211, with the @flags parameter of &struct ieee80211_key_conf.
2005 *
2006 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV: This flag should be set by the
2007 *	driver to indicate that it requires IV generation for this
2008 *	particular key. Setting this flag does not necessarily mean that SKBs
2009 *	will have sufficient tailroom for ICV or MIC.
2010 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIC: This flag should be set by
2011 *	the driver for a TKIP key if it requires Michael MIC
2012 *	generation in software.
2013 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PAIRWISE: Set by mac80211, this flag indicates
2014 *	that the key is pairwise rather then a shared key.
2015 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_SW_MGMT_TX: This flag should be set by the driver for a
2016 *	CCMP/GCMP key if it requires CCMP/GCMP encryption of management frames
2017 *	(MFP) to be done in software.
2018 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PUT_IV_SPACE: This flag should be set by the driver
2019 *	if space should be prepared for the IV, but the IV
2020 *	itself should not be generated. Do not set together with
2021 *	@IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV on the same key. Setting this flag does
2022 *	not necessarily mean that SKBs will have sufficient tailroom for ICV or
2023 *	MIC.
2024 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_RX_MGMT: This key will be used to decrypt received
2025 *	management frames. The flag can help drivers that have a hardware
2026 *	crypto implementation that doesn't deal with management frames
2027 *	properly by allowing them to not upload the keys to hardware and
2028 *	fall back to software crypto. Note that this flag deals only with
2029 *	RX, if your crypto engine can't deal with TX you can also set the
2030 *	%IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_SW_MGMT_TX flag to encrypt such frames in SW.
2031 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV_MGMT: This flag should be set by the
2032 *	driver for a CCMP/GCMP key to indicate that is requires IV generation
2033 *	only for management frames (MFP).
2034 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_RESERVE_TAILROOM: This flag should be set by the
2035 *	driver for a key to indicate that sufficient tailroom must always
2036 *	be reserved for ICV or MIC, even when HW encryption is enabled.
2037 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PUT_MIC_SPACE: This flag should be set by the driver for
2038 *	a TKIP key if it only requires MIC space. Do not set together with
2039 *	@IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIC on the same key.
2040 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_NO_AUTO_TX: Key needs explicit Tx activation.
2041 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIE: This flag should be set by the driver
2042 *	for a AES_CMAC key to indicate that it requires sequence number
2043 *	generation only
2044 */
2045enum ieee80211_key_flags {
2046	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV_MGMT	= BIT(0),
2047	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV		= BIT(1),
2048	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIC	= BIT(2),
2049	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PAIRWISE		= BIT(3),
2050	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_SW_MGMT_TX		= BIT(4),
2051	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PUT_IV_SPACE		= BIT(5),
2052	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_RX_MGMT		= BIT(6),
2053	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_RESERVE_TAILROOM	= BIT(7),
2054	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PUT_MIC_SPACE	= BIT(8),
2055	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_NO_AUTO_TX		= BIT(9),
2056	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIE	= BIT(10),
2057};
2058
2059/**
2060 * struct ieee80211_key_conf - key information
2061 *
2062 * This key information is given by mac80211 to the driver by
2063 * the set_key() callback in &struct ieee80211_ops.
2064 *
2065 * @hw_key_idx: To be set by the driver, this is the key index the driver
2066 *	wants to be given when a frame is transmitted and needs to be
2067 *	encrypted in hardware.
2068 * @cipher: The key's cipher suite selector.
2069 * @tx_pn: PN used for TX keys, may be used by the driver as well if it
2070 *	needs to do software PN assignment by itself (e.g. due to TSO)
2071 * @flags: key flags, see &enum ieee80211_key_flags.
2072 * @keyidx: the key index (0-3)
2073 * @keylen: key material length
2074 * @key: key material. For ALG_TKIP the key is encoded as a 256-bit (32 byte)
2075 * 	data block:
2076 * 	- Temporal Encryption Key (128 bits)
2077 * 	- Temporal Authenticator Tx MIC Key (64 bits)
2078 * 	- Temporal Authenticator Rx MIC Key (64 bits)
2079 * @icv_len: The ICV length for this key type
2080 * @iv_len: The IV length for this key type
2081 * @link_id: the link ID for MLO, or -1 for non-MLO or pairwise keys
2082 */
2083struct ieee80211_key_conf {
2084	atomic64_t tx_pn;
2085	u32 cipher;
2086	u8 icv_len;
2087	u8 iv_len;
2088	u8 hw_key_idx;
2089	s8 keyidx;
2090	u16 flags;
2091	s8 link_id;
2092	u8 keylen;
2093	u8 key[];
2094};
2095
2096#define IEEE80211_MAX_PN_LEN	16
2097
2098#define TKIP_PN_TO_IV16(pn) ((u16)(pn & 0xffff))
2099#define TKIP_PN_TO_IV32(pn) ((u32)((pn >> 16) & 0xffffffff))
2100
2101/**
2102 * struct ieee80211_key_seq - key sequence counter
2103 *
2104 * @tkip: TKIP data, containing IV32 and IV16 in host byte order
2105 * @ccmp: PN data, most significant byte first (big endian,
2106 *	reverse order than in packet)
2107 * @aes_cmac: PN data, most significant byte first (big endian,
2108 *	reverse order than in packet)
2109 * @aes_gmac: PN data, most significant byte first (big endian,
2110 *	reverse order than in packet)
2111 * @gcmp: PN data, most significant byte first (big endian,
2112 *	reverse order than in packet)
2113 * @hw: data for HW-only (e.g. cipher scheme) keys
2114 */
2115struct ieee80211_key_seq {
2116	union {
2117		struct {
2118			u32 iv32;
2119			u16 iv16;
2120		} tkip;
2121		struct {
2122			u8 pn[6];
2123		} ccmp;
2124		struct {
2125			u8 pn[6];
2126		} aes_cmac;
2127		struct {
2128			u8 pn[6];
2129		} aes_gmac;
2130		struct {
2131			u8 pn[6];
2132		} gcmp;
2133		struct {
2134			u8 seq[IEEE80211_MAX_PN_LEN];
2135			u8 seq_len;
2136		} hw;
2137	};
2138};
2139
2140/**
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
2141 * enum set_key_cmd - key command
2142 *
2143 * Used with the set_key() callback in &struct ieee80211_ops, this
2144 * indicates whether a key is being removed or added.
2145 *
2146 * @SET_KEY: a key is set
2147 * @DISABLE_KEY: a key must be disabled
2148 */
2149enum set_key_cmd {
2150	SET_KEY, DISABLE_KEY,
2151};
2152
2153/**
2154 * enum ieee80211_sta_state - station state
2155 *
2156 * @IEEE80211_STA_NOTEXIST: station doesn't exist at all,
2157 *	this is a special state for add/remove transitions
2158 * @IEEE80211_STA_NONE: station exists without special state
2159 * @IEEE80211_STA_AUTH: station is authenticated
2160 * @IEEE80211_STA_ASSOC: station is associated
2161 * @IEEE80211_STA_AUTHORIZED: station is authorized (802.1X)
2162 */
2163enum ieee80211_sta_state {
2164	/* NOTE: These need to be ordered correctly! */
2165	IEEE80211_STA_NOTEXIST,
2166	IEEE80211_STA_NONE,
2167	IEEE80211_STA_AUTH,
2168	IEEE80211_STA_ASSOC,
2169	IEEE80211_STA_AUTHORIZED,
2170};
2171
2172/**
2173 * enum ieee80211_sta_rx_bandwidth - station RX bandwidth
2174 * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_20: station can only receive 20 MHz
2175 * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_40: station can receive up to 40 MHz
2176 * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_80: station can receive up to 80 MHz
2177 * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_160: station can receive up to 160 MHz
2178 *	(including 80+80 MHz)
2179 * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_320: station can receive up to 320 MHz
2180 *
2181 * Implementation note: 20 must be zero to be initialized
2182 *	correctly, the values must be sorted.
2183 */
2184enum ieee80211_sta_rx_bandwidth {
2185	IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_20 = 0,
2186	IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_40,
2187	IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_80,
2188	IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_160,
2189	IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_320,
2190};
2191
2192/**
2193 * struct ieee80211_sta_rates - station rate selection table
2194 *
2195 * @rcu_head: RCU head used for freeing the table on update
2196 * @rate: transmit rates/flags to be used by default.
2197 *	Overriding entries per-packet is possible by using cb tx control.
2198 */
2199struct ieee80211_sta_rates {
2200	struct rcu_head rcu_head;
2201	struct {
2202		s8 idx;
2203		u8 count;
2204		u8 count_cts;
2205		u8 count_rts;
2206		u16 flags;
2207	} rate[IEEE80211_TX_RATE_TABLE_SIZE];
2208};
2209
2210/**
2211 * struct ieee80211_sta_txpwr - station txpower configuration
2212 *
2213 * Used to configure txpower for station.
2214 *
2215 * @power: indicates the tx power, in dBm, to be used when sending data frames
2216 *	to the STA.
2217 * @type: In particular if TPC %type is NL80211_TX_POWER_LIMITED then tx power
2218 *	will be less than or equal to specified from userspace, whereas if TPC
2219 *	%type is NL80211_TX_POWER_AUTOMATIC then it indicates default tx power.
2220 *	NL80211_TX_POWER_FIXED is not a valid configuration option for
2221 *	per peer TPC.
2222 */
2223struct ieee80211_sta_txpwr {
2224	s16 power;
2225	enum nl80211_tx_power_setting type;
2226};
2227
2228/**
2229 * struct ieee80211_sta_aggregates - info that is aggregated from active links
2230 *
2231 * Used for any per-link data that needs to be aggregated and updated in the
2232 * main &struct ieee80211_sta when updated or the active links change.
2233 *
2234 * @max_amsdu_len: indicates the maximal length of an A-MSDU in bytes.
2235 *	This field is always valid for packets with a VHT preamble.
2236 *	For packets with a HT preamble, additional limits apply:
2237 *
2238 *	* If the skb is transmitted as part of a BA agreement, the
2239 *	  A-MSDU maximal size is min(max_amsdu_len, 4065) bytes.
2240 *	* If the skb is not part of a BA agreement, the A-MSDU maximal
2241 *	  size is min(max_amsdu_len, 7935) bytes.
2242 *
2243 * Both additional HT limits must be enforced by the low level
2244 * driver. This is defined by the spec (IEEE 802.11-2012 section
2245 * 8.3.2.2 NOTE 2).
2246 * @max_rc_amsdu_len: Maximum A-MSDU size in bytes recommended by rate control.
2247 * @max_tid_amsdu_len: Maximum A-MSDU size in bytes for this TID
2248 */
2249struct ieee80211_sta_aggregates {
2250	u16 max_amsdu_len;
2251
2252	u16 max_rc_amsdu_len;
2253	u16 max_tid_amsdu_len[IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS];
2254};
2255
2256/**
2257 * struct ieee80211_link_sta - station Link specific info
2258 * All link specific info for a STA link for a non MLD STA(single)
2259 * or a MLD STA(multiple entries) are stored here.
2260 *
2261 * @sta: reference to owning STA
2262 * @addr: MAC address of the Link STA. For non-MLO STA this is same as the addr
2263 *	in ieee80211_sta. For MLO Link STA this addr can be same or different
2264 *	from addr in ieee80211_sta (representing MLD STA addr)
2265 * @link_id: the link ID for this link STA (0 for deflink)
2266 * @smps_mode: current SMPS mode (off, static or dynamic)
2267 * @supp_rates: Bitmap of supported rates
2268 * @ht_cap: HT capabilities of this STA; restricted to our own capabilities
2269 * @vht_cap: VHT capabilities of this STA; restricted to our own capabilities
2270 * @he_cap: HE capabilities of this STA
2271 * @he_6ghz_capa: on 6 GHz, holds the HE 6 GHz band capabilities
2272 * @eht_cap: EHT capabilities of this STA
2273 * @agg: per-link data for multi-link aggregation
2274 * @bandwidth: current bandwidth the station can receive with
2275 * @rx_nss: in HT/VHT, the maximum number of spatial streams the
2276 *	station can receive at the moment, changed by operating mode
2277 *	notifications and capabilities. The value is only valid after
2278 *	the station moves to associated state.
2279 * @txpwr: the station tx power configuration
2280 *
2281 */
2282struct ieee80211_link_sta {
2283	struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
2284
2285	u8 addr[ETH_ALEN];
2286	u8 link_id;
2287	enum ieee80211_smps_mode smps_mode;
2288
2289	u32 supp_rates[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
2290	struct ieee80211_sta_ht_cap ht_cap;
2291	struct ieee80211_sta_vht_cap vht_cap;
2292	struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap he_cap;
2293	struct ieee80211_he_6ghz_capa he_6ghz_capa;
2294	struct ieee80211_sta_eht_cap eht_cap;
2295
2296	struct ieee80211_sta_aggregates agg;
2297
2298	u8 rx_nss;
2299	enum ieee80211_sta_rx_bandwidth bandwidth;
2300	struct ieee80211_sta_txpwr txpwr;
2301};
2302
2303/**
2304 * struct ieee80211_sta - station table entry
2305 *
2306 * A station table entry represents a station we are possibly
2307 * communicating with. Since stations are RCU-managed in
2308 * mac80211, any ieee80211_sta pointer you get access to must
2309 * either be protected by rcu_read_lock() explicitly or implicitly,
2310 * or you must take good care to not use such a pointer after a
2311 * call to your sta_remove callback that removed it.
2312 * This also represents the MLD STA in case of MLO association
2313 * and holds pointers to various link STA's
2314 *
2315 * @addr: MAC address
2316 * @aid: AID we assigned to the station if we're an AP
 
 
 
2317 * @max_rx_aggregation_subframes: maximal amount of frames in a single AMPDU
2318 *	that this station is allowed to transmit to us.
2319 *	Can be modified by driver.
2320 * @wme: indicates whether the STA supports QoS/WME (if local devices does,
2321 *	otherwise always false)
2322 * @drv_priv: data area for driver use, will always be aligned to
2323 *	sizeof(void \*), size is determined in hw information.
2324 * @uapsd_queues: bitmap of queues configured for uapsd. Only valid
2325 *	if wme is supported. The bits order is like in
2326 *	IEEE80211_WMM_IE_STA_QOSINFO_AC_*.
2327 * @max_sp: max Service Period. Only valid if wme is supported.
 
 
 
 
 
 
2328 * @rates: rate control selection table
2329 * @tdls: indicates whether the STA is a TDLS peer
2330 * @tdls_initiator: indicates the STA is an initiator of the TDLS link. Only
2331 *	valid if the STA is a TDLS peer in the first place.
2332 * @mfp: indicates whether the STA uses management frame protection or not.
2333 * @mlo: indicates whether the STA is MLO station.
2334 * @max_amsdu_subframes: indicates the maximal number of MSDUs in a single
2335 *	A-MSDU. Taken from the Extended Capabilities element. 0 means
2336 *	unlimited.
2337 * @cur: currently valid data as aggregated from the active links
2338 *	For non MLO STA it will point to the deflink data. For MLO STA
2339 *	ieee80211_sta_recalc_aggregates() must be called to update it.
2340 * @support_p2p_ps: indicates whether the STA supports P2P PS mechanism or not.
2341 * @txq: per-TID data TX queues; note that the last entry (%IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS)
2342 *	is used for non-data frames
2343 * @deflink: This holds the default link STA information, for non MLO STA all link
2344 *	specific STA information is accessed through @deflink or through
2345 *	link[0] which points to address of @deflink. For MLO Link STA
2346 *	the first added link STA will point to deflink.
2347 * @link: reference to Link Sta entries. For Non MLO STA, except 1st link,
2348 *	i.e link[0] all links would be assigned to NULL by default and
2349 *	would access link information via @deflink or link[0]. For MLO
2350 *	STA, first link STA being added will point its link pointer to
2351 *	@deflink address and remaining would be allocated and the address
2352 *	would be assigned to link[link_id] where link_id is the id assigned
2353 *	by the AP.
2354 * @valid_links: bitmap of valid links, or 0 for non-MLO
2355 */
2356struct ieee80211_sta {
 
2357	u8 addr[ETH_ALEN];
2358	u16 aid;
2359	u16 max_rx_aggregation_subframes;
 
 
2360	bool wme;
2361	u8 uapsd_queues;
2362	u8 max_sp;
 
 
 
2363	struct ieee80211_sta_rates __rcu *rates;
2364	bool tdls;
2365	bool tdls_initiator;
2366	bool mfp;
2367	bool mlo;
2368	u8 max_amsdu_subframes;
2369
2370	struct ieee80211_sta_aggregates *cur;
2371
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
2372	bool support_p2p_ps;
 
2373
2374	struct ieee80211_txq *txq[IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS + 1];
2375
2376	u16 valid_links;
2377	struct ieee80211_link_sta deflink;
2378	struct ieee80211_link_sta __rcu *link[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS];
2379
2380	/* must be last */
2381	u8 drv_priv[] __aligned(sizeof(void *));
2382};
2383
2384#ifdef CONFIG_LOCKDEP
2385bool lockdep_sta_mutex_held(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta);
2386#else
2387static inline bool lockdep_sta_mutex_held(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta)
2388{
2389	return true;
2390}
2391#endif
2392
2393#define link_sta_dereference_protected(sta, link_id)		\
2394	rcu_dereference_protected((sta)->link[link_id],		\
2395				  lockdep_sta_mutex_held(sta))
2396
2397#define link_sta_dereference_check(sta, link_id)		\
2398	rcu_dereference_check((sta)->link[link_id],		\
2399			      lockdep_sta_mutex_held(sta))
2400
2401#define for_each_sta_active_link(vif, sta, link_sta, link_id)			\
2402	for (link_id = 0; link_id < ARRAY_SIZE((sta)->link); link_id++)		\
2403		if ((!(vif)->active_links ||					\
2404		     (vif)->active_links & BIT(link_id)) &&			\
2405		    ((link_sta) = link_sta_dereference_check(sta, link_id)))
2406
2407/**
2408 * enum sta_notify_cmd - sta notify command
2409 *
2410 * Used with the sta_notify() callback in &struct ieee80211_ops, this
2411 * indicates if an associated station made a power state transition.
2412 *
2413 * @STA_NOTIFY_SLEEP: a station is now sleeping
2414 * @STA_NOTIFY_AWAKE: a sleeping station woke up
2415 */
2416enum sta_notify_cmd {
2417	STA_NOTIFY_SLEEP, STA_NOTIFY_AWAKE,
2418};
2419
2420/**
2421 * struct ieee80211_tx_control - TX control data
2422 *
2423 * @sta: station table entry, this sta pointer may be NULL and
2424 * 	it is not allowed to copy the pointer, due to RCU.
2425 */
2426struct ieee80211_tx_control {
2427	struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
2428};
2429
2430/**
2431 * struct ieee80211_txq - Software intermediate tx queue
2432 *
2433 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
2434 * @sta: station table entry, %NULL for per-vif queue
2435 * @tid: the TID for this queue (unused for per-vif queue),
2436 *	%IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS for non-data (if enabled)
2437 * @ac: the AC for this queue
2438 * @drv_priv: driver private area, sized by hw->txq_data_size
2439 *
2440 * The driver can obtain packets from this queue by calling
2441 * ieee80211_tx_dequeue().
2442 */
2443struct ieee80211_txq {
2444	struct ieee80211_vif *vif;
2445	struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
2446	u8 tid;
2447	u8 ac;
2448
2449	/* must be last */
2450	u8 drv_priv[] __aligned(sizeof(void *));
2451};
2452
2453/**
2454 * enum ieee80211_hw_flags - hardware flags
2455 *
2456 * These flags are used to indicate hardware capabilities to
2457 * the stack. Generally, flags here should have their meaning
2458 * done in a way that the simplest hardware doesn't need setting
2459 * any particular flags. There are some exceptions to this rule,
2460 * however, so you are advised to review these flags carefully.
2461 *
2462 * @IEEE80211_HW_HAS_RATE_CONTROL:
2463 *	The hardware or firmware includes rate control, and cannot be
2464 *	controlled by the stack. As such, no rate control algorithm
2465 *	should be instantiated, and the TX rate reported to userspace
2466 *	will be taken from the TX status instead of the rate control
2467 *	algorithm.
2468 *	Note that this requires that the driver implement a number of
2469 *	callbacks so it has the correct information, it needs to have
2470 *	the @set_rts_threshold callback and must look at the BSS config
2471 *	@use_cts_prot for G/N protection, @use_short_slot for slot
2472 *	timing in 2.4 GHz and @use_short_preamble for preambles for
2473 *	CCK frames.
2474 *
2475 * @IEEE80211_HW_RX_INCLUDES_FCS:
2476 *	Indicates that received frames passed to the stack include
2477 *	the FCS at the end.
2478 *
2479 * @IEEE80211_HW_HOST_BROADCAST_PS_BUFFERING:
2480 *	Some wireless LAN chipsets buffer broadcast/multicast frames
2481 *	for power saving stations in the hardware/firmware and others
2482 *	rely on the host system for such buffering. This option is used
2483 *	to configure the IEEE 802.11 upper layer to buffer broadcast and
2484 *	multicast frames when there are power saving stations so that
2485 *	the driver can fetch them with ieee80211_get_buffered_bc().
2486 *
2487 * @IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_UNSPEC:
2488 *	Hardware can provide signal values but we don't know its units. We
2489 *	expect values between 0 and @max_signal.
2490 *	If possible please provide dB or dBm instead.
2491 *
2492 * @IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_DBM:
2493 *	Hardware gives signal values in dBm, decibel difference from
2494 *	one milliwatt. This is the preferred method since it is standardized
2495 *	between different devices. @max_signal does not need to be set.
2496 *
2497 * @IEEE80211_HW_SPECTRUM_MGMT:
2498 * 	Hardware supports spectrum management defined in 802.11h
2499 * 	Measurement, Channel Switch, Quieting, TPC
2500 *
2501 * @IEEE80211_HW_AMPDU_AGGREGATION:
2502 *	Hardware supports 11n A-MPDU aggregation.
2503 *
2504 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS:
2505 *	Hardware has power save support (i.e. can go to sleep).
2506 *
2507 * @IEEE80211_HW_PS_NULLFUNC_STACK:
2508 *	Hardware requires nullfunc frame handling in stack, implies
2509 *	stack support for dynamic PS.
2510 *
2511 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_DYNAMIC_PS:
2512 *	Hardware has support for dynamic PS.
2513 *
2514 * @IEEE80211_HW_MFP_CAPABLE:
2515 *	Hardware supports management frame protection (MFP, IEEE 802.11w).
2516 *
2517 * @IEEE80211_HW_REPORTS_TX_ACK_STATUS:
2518 *	Hardware can provide ack status reports of Tx frames to
2519 *	the stack.
2520 *
2521 * @IEEE80211_HW_CONNECTION_MONITOR:
2522 *	The hardware performs its own connection monitoring, including
2523 *	periodic keep-alives to the AP and probing the AP on beacon loss.
2524 *
2525 * @IEEE80211_HW_NEED_DTIM_BEFORE_ASSOC:
2526 *	This device needs to get data from beacon before association (i.e.
2527 *	dtim_period).
2528 *
2529 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PER_STA_GTK: The device's crypto engine supports
2530 *	per-station GTKs as used by IBSS RSN or during fast transition. If
2531 *	the device doesn't support per-station GTKs, but can be asked not
2532 *	to decrypt group addressed frames, then IBSS RSN support is still
2533 *	possible but software crypto will be used. Advertise the wiphy flag
2534 *	only in that case.
2535 *
2536 * @IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS: When operating in AP mode the device
2537 *	autonomously manages the PS status of connected stations. When
2538 *	this flag is set mac80211 will not trigger PS mode for connected
2539 *	stations based on the PM bit of incoming frames.
2540 *	Use ieee80211_start_ps()/ieee8021_end_ps() to manually configure
2541 *	the PS mode of connected stations.
2542 *
2543 * @IEEE80211_HW_TX_AMPDU_SETUP_IN_HW: The device handles TX A-MPDU session
2544 *	setup strictly in HW. mac80211 should not attempt to do this in
2545 *	software.
2546 *
2547 * @IEEE80211_HW_WANT_MONITOR_VIF: The driver would like to be informed of
2548 *	a virtual monitor interface when monitor interfaces are the only
2549 *	active interfaces.
2550 *
2551 * @IEEE80211_HW_NO_AUTO_VIF: The driver would like for no wlanX to
2552 *	be created.  It is expected user-space will create vifs as
2553 *	desired (and thus have them named as desired).
2554 *
2555 * @IEEE80211_HW_SW_CRYPTO_CONTROL: The driver wants to control which of the
2556 *	crypto algorithms can be done in software - so don't automatically
2557 *	try to fall back to it if hardware crypto fails, but do so only if
2558 *	the driver returns 1. This also forces the driver to advertise its
2559 *	supported cipher suites.
2560 *
2561 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORT_FAST_XMIT: The driver/hardware supports fast-xmit,
2562 *	this currently requires only the ability to calculate the duration
2563 *	for frames.
2564 *
2565 * @IEEE80211_HW_QUEUE_CONTROL: The driver wants to control per-interface
2566 *	queue mapping in order to use different queues (not just one per AC)
2567 *	for different virtual interfaces. See the doc section on HW queue
2568 *	control for more details.
2569 *
2570 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_RC_TABLE: The driver supports using a rate
2571 *	selection table provided by the rate control algorithm.
2572 *
2573 * @IEEE80211_HW_P2P_DEV_ADDR_FOR_INTF: Use the P2P Device address for any
2574 *	P2P Interface. This will be honoured even if more than one interface
2575 *	is supported.
2576 *
2577 * @IEEE80211_HW_TIMING_BEACON_ONLY: Use sync timing from beacon frames
2578 *	only, to allow getting TBTT of a DTIM beacon.
2579 *
2580 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_HT_CCK_RATES: Hardware supports mixing HT/CCK rates
2581 *	and can cope with CCK rates in an aggregation session (e.g. by not
2582 *	using aggregation for such frames.)
2583 *
2584 * @IEEE80211_HW_CHANCTX_STA_CSA: Support 802.11h based channel-switch (CSA)
2585 *	for a single active channel while using channel contexts. When support
2586 *	is not enabled the default action is to disconnect when getting the
2587 *	CSA frame.
2588 *
2589 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_CLONED_SKBS: The driver will never modify the payload
2590 *	or tailroom of TX skbs without copying them first.
2591 *
2592 * @IEEE80211_HW_SINGLE_SCAN_ON_ALL_BANDS: The HW supports scanning on all bands
2593 *	in one command, mac80211 doesn't have to run separate scans per band.
2594 *
2595 * @IEEE80211_HW_TDLS_WIDER_BW: The device/driver supports wider bandwidth
2596 *	than then BSS bandwidth for a TDLS link on the base channel.
2597 *
2598 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_AMSDU_IN_AMPDU: The driver supports receiving A-MSDUs
2599 *	within A-MPDU.
2600 *
2601 * @IEEE80211_HW_BEACON_TX_STATUS: The device/driver provides TX status
2602 *	for sent beacons.
2603 *
2604 * @IEEE80211_HW_NEEDS_UNIQUE_STA_ADDR: Hardware (or driver) requires that each
2605 *	station has a unique address, i.e. each station entry can be identified
2606 *	by just its MAC address; this prevents, for example, the same station
2607 *	from connecting to two virtual AP interfaces at the same time.
2608 *
2609 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_REORDERING_BUFFER: Hardware (or driver) manages the
2610 *	reordering buffer internally, guaranteeing mac80211 receives frames in
2611 *	order and does not need to manage its own reorder buffer or BA session
2612 *	timeout.
2613 *
2614 * @IEEE80211_HW_USES_RSS: The device uses RSS and thus requires parallel RX,
2615 *	which implies using per-CPU station statistics.
2616 *
2617 * @IEEE80211_HW_TX_AMSDU: Hardware (or driver) supports software aggregated
2618 *	A-MSDU frames. Requires software tx queueing and fast-xmit support.
2619 *	When not using minstrel/minstrel_ht rate control, the driver must
2620 *	limit the maximum A-MSDU size based on the current tx rate by setting
2621 *	max_rc_amsdu_len in struct ieee80211_sta.
2622 *
2623 * @IEEE80211_HW_TX_FRAG_LIST: Hardware (or driver) supports sending frag_list
2624 *	skbs, needed for zero-copy software A-MSDU.
2625 *
2626 * @IEEE80211_HW_REPORTS_LOW_ACK: The driver (or firmware) reports low ack event
2627 *	by ieee80211_report_low_ack() based on its own algorithm. For such
2628 *	drivers, mac80211 packet loss mechanism will not be triggered and driver
2629 *	is completely depending on firmware event for station kickout.
2630 *
2631 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TX_FRAG: Hardware does fragmentation by itself.
2632 *	The stack will not do fragmentation.
2633 *	The callback for @set_frag_threshold should be set as well.
2634 *
2635 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TDLS_BUFFER_STA: Hardware supports buffer STA on
2636 *	TDLS links.
2637 *
2638 * @IEEE80211_HW_DEAUTH_NEED_MGD_TX_PREP: The driver requires the
2639 *	mgd_prepare_tx() callback to be called before transmission of a
2640 *	deauthentication frame in case the association was completed but no
2641 *	beacon was heard. This is required in multi-channel scenarios, where the
2642 *	virtual interface might not be given air time for the transmission of
2643 *	the frame, as it is not synced with the AP/P2P GO yet, and thus the
2644 *	deauthentication frame might not be transmitted.
2645 *
2646 * @IEEE80211_HW_DOESNT_SUPPORT_QOS_NDP: The driver (or firmware) doesn't
2647 *	support QoS NDP for AP probing - that's most likely a driver bug.
2648 *
2649 * @IEEE80211_HW_BUFF_MMPDU_TXQ: use the TXQ for bufferable MMPDUs, this of
2650 *	course requires the driver to use TXQs to start with.
2651 *
2652 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_VHT_EXT_NSS_BW: (Hardware) rate control supports VHT
2653 *	extended NSS BW (dot11VHTExtendedNSSBWCapable). This flag will be set if
2654 *	the selected rate control algorithm sets %RATE_CTRL_CAPA_VHT_EXT_NSS_BW
2655 *	but if the rate control is built-in then it must be set by the driver.
2656 *	See also the documentation for that flag.
2657 *
2658 * @IEEE80211_HW_STA_MMPDU_TXQ: use the extra non-TID per-station TXQ for all
2659 *	MMPDUs on station interfaces. This of course requires the driver to use
2660 *	TXQs to start with.
2661 *
2662 * @IEEE80211_HW_TX_STATUS_NO_AMPDU_LEN: Driver does not report accurate A-MPDU
2663 *	length in tx status information
2664 *
2665 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_MULTI_BSSID: Hardware supports multi BSSID
2666 *
2667 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_ONLY_HE_MULTI_BSSID: Hardware supports multi BSSID
2668 *	only for HE APs. Applies if @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_MULTI_BSSID is set.
2669 *
2670 * @IEEE80211_HW_AMPDU_KEYBORDER_SUPPORT: The card and driver is only
2671 *	aggregating MPDUs with the same keyid, allowing mac80211 to keep Tx
2672 *	A-MPDU sessions active while rekeying with Extended Key ID.
2673 *
2674 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TX_ENCAP_OFFLOAD: Hardware supports tx encapsulation
2675 *	offload
2676 *
2677 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_RX_DECAP_OFFLOAD: Hardware supports rx decapsulation
2678 *	offload
2679 *
2680 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_CONC_MON_RX_DECAP: Hardware supports concurrent rx
2681 *	decapsulation offload and passing raw 802.11 frames for monitor iface.
2682 *	If this is supported, the driver must pass both 802.3 frames for real
2683 *	usage and 802.11 frames with %RX_FLAG_ONLY_MONITOR set for monitor to
2684 *	the stack.
2685 *
2686 * @IEEE80211_HW_DETECTS_COLOR_COLLISION: HW/driver has support for BSS color
2687 *	collision detection and doesn't need it in software.
2688 *
2689 * @IEEE80211_HW_MLO_MCAST_MULTI_LINK_TX: Hardware/driver handles transmitting
2690 *	multicast frames on all links, mac80211 should not do that.
2691 *
2692 * @IEEE80211_HW_DISALLOW_PUNCTURING: HW requires disabling puncturing in EHT
2693 *	and connecting with a lower bandwidth instead
2694 *
2695 * @NUM_IEEE80211_HW_FLAGS: number of hardware flags, used for sizing arrays
2696 */
2697enum ieee80211_hw_flags {
2698	IEEE80211_HW_HAS_RATE_CONTROL,
2699	IEEE80211_HW_RX_INCLUDES_FCS,
2700	IEEE80211_HW_HOST_BROADCAST_PS_BUFFERING,
2701	IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_UNSPEC,
2702	IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_DBM,
2703	IEEE80211_HW_NEED_DTIM_BEFORE_ASSOC,
2704	IEEE80211_HW_SPECTRUM_MGMT,
2705	IEEE80211_HW_AMPDU_AGGREGATION,
2706	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS,
2707	IEEE80211_HW_PS_NULLFUNC_STACK,
2708	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_DYNAMIC_PS,
2709	IEEE80211_HW_MFP_CAPABLE,
2710	IEEE80211_HW_WANT_MONITOR_VIF,
2711	IEEE80211_HW_NO_AUTO_VIF,
2712	IEEE80211_HW_SW_CRYPTO_CONTROL,
2713	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORT_FAST_XMIT,
2714	IEEE80211_HW_REPORTS_TX_ACK_STATUS,
2715	IEEE80211_HW_CONNECTION_MONITOR,
2716	IEEE80211_HW_QUEUE_CONTROL,
2717	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PER_STA_GTK,
2718	IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS,
2719	IEEE80211_HW_TX_AMPDU_SETUP_IN_HW,
2720	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_RC_TABLE,
2721	IEEE80211_HW_P2P_DEV_ADDR_FOR_INTF,
2722	IEEE80211_HW_TIMING_BEACON_ONLY,
2723	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_HT_CCK_RATES,
2724	IEEE80211_HW_CHANCTX_STA_CSA,
2725	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_CLONED_SKBS,
2726	IEEE80211_HW_SINGLE_SCAN_ON_ALL_BANDS,
2727	IEEE80211_HW_TDLS_WIDER_BW,
2728	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_AMSDU_IN_AMPDU,
2729	IEEE80211_HW_BEACON_TX_STATUS,
2730	IEEE80211_HW_NEEDS_UNIQUE_STA_ADDR,
2731	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_REORDERING_BUFFER,
2732	IEEE80211_HW_USES_RSS,
2733	IEEE80211_HW_TX_AMSDU,
2734	IEEE80211_HW_TX_FRAG_LIST,
2735	IEEE80211_HW_REPORTS_LOW_ACK,
2736	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TX_FRAG,
2737	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TDLS_BUFFER_STA,
2738	IEEE80211_HW_DEAUTH_NEED_MGD_TX_PREP,
2739	IEEE80211_HW_DOESNT_SUPPORT_QOS_NDP,
2740	IEEE80211_HW_BUFF_MMPDU_TXQ,
2741	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_VHT_EXT_NSS_BW,
2742	IEEE80211_HW_STA_MMPDU_TXQ,
2743	IEEE80211_HW_TX_STATUS_NO_AMPDU_LEN,
2744	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_MULTI_BSSID,
2745	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_ONLY_HE_MULTI_BSSID,
2746	IEEE80211_HW_AMPDU_KEYBORDER_SUPPORT,
2747	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TX_ENCAP_OFFLOAD,
2748	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_RX_DECAP_OFFLOAD,
2749	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_CONC_MON_RX_DECAP,
2750	IEEE80211_HW_DETECTS_COLOR_COLLISION,
2751	IEEE80211_HW_MLO_MCAST_MULTI_LINK_TX,
2752	IEEE80211_HW_DISALLOW_PUNCTURING,
2753
2754	/* keep last, obviously */
2755	NUM_IEEE80211_HW_FLAGS
2756};
2757
2758/**
2759 * struct ieee80211_hw - hardware information and state
2760 *
2761 * This structure contains the configuration and hardware
2762 * information for an 802.11 PHY.
2763 *
2764 * @wiphy: This points to the &struct wiphy allocated for this
2765 *	802.11 PHY. You must fill in the @perm_addr and @dev
2766 *	members of this structure using SET_IEEE80211_DEV()
2767 *	and SET_IEEE80211_PERM_ADDR(). Additionally, all supported
2768 *	bands (with channels, bitrates) are registered here.
2769 *
2770 * @conf: &struct ieee80211_conf, device configuration, don't use.
2771 *
2772 * @priv: pointer to private area that was allocated for driver use
2773 *	along with this structure.
2774 *
2775 * @flags: hardware flags, see &enum ieee80211_hw_flags.
2776 *
2777 * @extra_tx_headroom: headroom to reserve in each transmit skb
2778 *	for use by the driver (e.g. for transmit headers.)
2779 *
2780 * @extra_beacon_tailroom: tailroom to reserve in each beacon tx skb.
2781 *	Can be used by drivers to add extra IEs.
2782 *
2783 * @max_signal: Maximum value for signal (rssi) in RX information, used
2784 *	only when @IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_UNSPEC or @IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_DB
2785 *
2786 * @max_listen_interval: max listen interval in units of beacon interval
2787 *	that HW supports
2788 *
2789 * @queues: number of available hardware transmit queues for
2790 *	data packets. WMM/QoS requires at least four, these
2791 *	queues need to have configurable access parameters.
2792 *
2793 * @rate_control_algorithm: rate control algorithm for this hardware.
2794 *	If unset (NULL), the default algorithm will be used. Must be
2795 *	set before calling ieee80211_register_hw().
2796 *
2797 * @vif_data_size: size (in bytes) of the drv_priv data area
2798 *	within &struct ieee80211_vif.
2799 * @sta_data_size: size (in bytes) of the drv_priv data area
2800 *	within &struct ieee80211_sta.
2801 * @chanctx_data_size: size (in bytes) of the drv_priv data area
2802 *	within &struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf.
2803 * @txq_data_size: size (in bytes) of the drv_priv data area
2804 *	within @struct ieee80211_txq.
2805 *
2806 * @max_rates: maximum number of alternate rate retry stages the hw
2807 *	can handle.
2808 * @max_report_rates: maximum number of alternate rate retry stages
2809 *	the hw can report back.
2810 * @max_rate_tries: maximum number of tries for each stage
2811 *
2812 * @max_rx_aggregation_subframes: maximum buffer size (number of
2813 *	sub-frames) to be used for A-MPDU block ack receiver
2814 *	aggregation.
2815 *	This is only relevant if the device has restrictions on the
2816 *	number of subframes, if it relies on mac80211 to do reordering
2817 *	it shouldn't be set.
2818 *
2819 * @max_tx_aggregation_subframes: maximum number of subframes in an
2820 *	aggregate an HT/HE device will transmit. In HT AddBA we'll
2821 *	advertise a constant value of 64 as some older APs crash if
2822 *	the window size is smaller (an example is LinkSys WRT120N
2823 *	with FW v1.0.07 build 002 Jun 18 2012).
2824 *	For AddBA to HE capable peers this value will be used.
2825 *
2826 * @max_tx_fragments: maximum number of tx buffers per (A)-MSDU, sum
2827 *	of 1 + skb_shinfo(skb)->nr_frags for each skb in the frag_list.
2828 *
2829 * @offchannel_tx_hw_queue: HW queue ID to use for offchannel TX
2830 *	(if %IEEE80211_HW_QUEUE_CONTROL is set)
2831 *
2832 * @radiotap_mcs_details: lists which MCS information can the HW
2833 *	reports, by default it is set to _MCS, _GI and _BW but doesn't
2834 *	include _FMT. Use %IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_MCS_HAVE_\* values, only
2835 *	adding _BW is supported today.
2836 *
2837 * @radiotap_vht_details: lists which VHT MCS information the HW reports,
2838 *	the default is _GI | _BANDWIDTH.
2839 *	Use the %IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_VHT_KNOWN_\* values.
2840 *
2841 * @radiotap_timestamp: Information for the radiotap timestamp field; if the
2842 *	@units_pos member is set to a non-negative value then the timestamp
 
 
2843 *	field will be added and populated from the &struct ieee80211_rx_status
2844 *	device_timestamp.
2845 * @radiotap_timestamp.units_pos: Must be set to a combination of a
2846 *	IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_TIMESTAMP_UNIT_* and a
2847 *	IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_TIMESTAMP_SPOS_* value.
2848 * @radiotap_timestamp.accuracy: If non-negative, fills the accuracy in the
2849 *	radiotap field and the accuracy known flag will be set.
2850 *
2851 * @netdev_features: netdev features to be set in each netdev created
2852 *	from this HW. Note that not all features are usable with mac80211,
2853 *	other features will be rejected during HW registration.
2854 *
2855 * @uapsd_queues: This bitmap is included in (re)association frame to indicate
2856 *	for each access category if it is uAPSD trigger-enabled and delivery-
2857 *	enabled. Use IEEE80211_WMM_IE_STA_QOSINFO_AC_* to set this bitmap.
2858 *	Each bit corresponds to different AC. Value '1' in specific bit means
2859 *	that corresponding AC is both trigger- and delivery-enabled. '0' means
2860 *	neither enabled.
2861 *
2862 * @uapsd_max_sp_len: maximum number of total buffered frames the WMM AP may
2863 *	deliver to a WMM STA during any Service Period triggered by the WMM STA.
2864 *	Use IEEE80211_WMM_IE_STA_QOSINFO_SP_* for correct values.
2865 *
 
 
 
2866 * @max_nan_de_entries: maximum number of NAN DE functions supported by the
2867 *	device.
2868 *
2869 * @tx_sk_pacing_shift: Pacing shift to set on TCP sockets when frames from
2870 *	them are encountered. The default should typically not be changed,
2871 *	unless the driver has good reasons for needing more buffers.
2872 *
2873 * @weight_multiplier: Driver specific airtime weight multiplier used while
2874 *	refilling deficit of each TXQ.
2875 *
2876 * @max_mtu: the max mtu could be set.
2877 *
2878 * @tx_power_levels: a list of power levels supported by the wifi hardware.
2879 * 	The power levels can be specified either as integer or fractions.
2880 * 	The power level at idx 0 shall be the maximum positive power level.
2881 *
2882 * @max_txpwr_levels_idx: the maximum valid idx of 'tx_power_levels' list.
2883 */
2884struct ieee80211_hw {
2885	struct ieee80211_conf conf;
2886	struct wiphy *wiphy;
2887	const char *rate_control_algorithm;
2888	void *priv;
2889	unsigned long flags[BITS_TO_LONGS(NUM_IEEE80211_HW_FLAGS)];
2890	unsigned int extra_tx_headroom;
2891	unsigned int extra_beacon_tailroom;
2892	int vif_data_size;
2893	int sta_data_size;
2894	int chanctx_data_size;
2895	int txq_data_size;
2896	u16 queues;
2897	u16 max_listen_interval;
2898	s8 max_signal;
2899	u8 max_rates;
2900	u8 max_report_rates;
2901	u8 max_rate_tries;
2902	u16 max_rx_aggregation_subframes;
2903	u16 max_tx_aggregation_subframes;
2904	u8 max_tx_fragments;
2905	u8 offchannel_tx_hw_queue;
2906	u8 radiotap_mcs_details;
2907	u16 radiotap_vht_details;
2908	struct {
2909		int units_pos;
2910		s16 accuracy;
2911	} radiotap_timestamp;
2912	netdev_features_t netdev_features;
2913	u8 uapsd_queues;
2914	u8 uapsd_max_sp_len;
 
 
2915	u8 max_nan_de_entries;
2916	u8 tx_sk_pacing_shift;
2917	u8 weight_multiplier;
2918	u32 max_mtu;
2919	const s8 *tx_power_levels;
2920	u8 max_txpwr_levels_idx;
2921};
2922
2923static inline bool _ieee80211_hw_check(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
2924				       enum ieee80211_hw_flags flg)
2925{
2926	return test_bit(flg, hw->flags);
2927}
2928#define ieee80211_hw_check(hw, flg)	_ieee80211_hw_check(hw, IEEE80211_HW_##flg)
2929
2930static inline void _ieee80211_hw_set(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
2931				     enum ieee80211_hw_flags flg)
2932{
2933	return __set_bit(flg, hw->flags);
2934}
2935#define ieee80211_hw_set(hw, flg)	_ieee80211_hw_set(hw, IEEE80211_HW_##flg)
2936
2937/**
2938 * struct ieee80211_scan_request - hw scan request
2939 *
2940 * @ies: pointers different parts of IEs (in req.ie)
2941 * @req: cfg80211 request.
2942 */
2943struct ieee80211_scan_request {
2944	struct ieee80211_scan_ies ies;
2945
2946	/* Keep last */
2947	struct cfg80211_scan_request req;
2948};
2949
2950/**
2951 * struct ieee80211_tdls_ch_sw_params - TDLS channel switch parameters
2952 *
2953 * @sta: peer this TDLS channel-switch request/response came from
2954 * @chandef: channel referenced in a TDLS channel-switch request
2955 * @action_code: see &enum ieee80211_tdls_actioncode
2956 * @status: channel-switch response status
2957 * @timestamp: time at which the frame was received
2958 * @switch_time: switch-timing parameter received in the frame
2959 * @switch_timeout: switch-timing parameter received in the frame
2960 * @tmpl_skb: TDLS switch-channel response template
2961 * @ch_sw_tm_ie: offset of the channel-switch timing IE inside @tmpl_skb
2962 */
2963struct ieee80211_tdls_ch_sw_params {
2964	struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
2965	struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef;
2966	u8 action_code;
2967	u32 status;
2968	u32 timestamp;
2969	u16 switch_time;
2970	u16 switch_timeout;
2971	struct sk_buff *tmpl_skb;
2972	u32 ch_sw_tm_ie;
2973};
2974
2975/**
2976 * wiphy_to_ieee80211_hw - return a mac80211 driver hw struct from a wiphy
2977 *
2978 * @wiphy: the &struct wiphy which we want to query
2979 *
2980 * mac80211 drivers can use this to get to their respective
2981 * &struct ieee80211_hw. Drivers wishing to get to their own private
2982 * structure can then access it via hw->priv. Note that mac802111 drivers should
2983 * not use wiphy_priv() to try to get their private driver structure as this
2984 * is already used internally by mac80211.
2985 *
2986 * Return: The mac80211 driver hw struct of @wiphy.
2987 */
2988struct ieee80211_hw *wiphy_to_ieee80211_hw(struct wiphy *wiphy);
2989
2990/**
2991 * SET_IEEE80211_DEV - set device for 802.11 hardware
2992 *
2993 * @hw: the &struct ieee80211_hw to set the device for
2994 * @dev: the &struct device of this 802.11 device
2995 */
2996static inline void SET_IEEE80211_DEV(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct device *dev)
2997{
2998	set_wiphy_dev(hw->wiphy, dev);
2999}
3000
3001/**
3002 * SET_IEEE80211_PERM_ADDR - set the permanent MAC address for 802.11 hardware
3003 *
3004 * @hw: the &struct ieee80211_hw to set the MAC address for
3005 * @addr: the address to set
3006 */
3007static inline void SET_IEEE80211_PERM_ADDR(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, const u8 *addr)
3008{
3009	memcpy(hw->wiphy->perm_addr, addr, ETH_ALEN);
3010}
3011
3012static inline struct ieee80211_rate *
3013ieee80211_get_tx_rate(const struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3014		      const struct ieee80211_tx_info *c)
3015{
3016	if (WARN_ON_ONCE(c->control.rates[0].idx < 0))
3017		return NULL;
3018	return &hw->wiphy->bands[c->band]->bitrates[c->control.rates[0].idx];
3019}
3020
3021static inline struct ieee80211_rate *
3022ieee80211_get_rts_cts_rate(const struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3023			   const struct ieee80211_tx_info *c)
3024{
3025	if (c->control.rts_cts_rate_idx < 0)
3026		return NULL;
3027	return &hw->wiphy->bands[c->band]->bitrates[c->control.rts_cts_rate_idx];
3028}
3029
3030static inline struct ieee80211_rate *
3031ieee80211_get_alt_retry_rate(const struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3032			     const struct ieee80211_tx_info *c, int idx)
3033{
3034	if (c->control.rates[idx + 1].idx < 0)
3035		return NULL;
3036	return &hw->wiphy->bands[c->band]->bitrates[c->control.rates[idx + 1].idx];
3037}
3038
3039/**
3040 * ieee80211_free_txskb - free TX skb
3041 * @hw: the hardware
3042 * @skb: the skb
3043 *
3044 * Free a transmit skb. Use this function when some failure
3045 * to transmit happened and thus status cannot be reported.
3046 */
3047void ieee80211_free_txskb(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct sk_buff *skb);
3048
3049/**
3050 * DOC: Hardware crypto acceleration
3051 *
3052 * mac80211 is capable of taking advantage of many hardware
3053 * acceleration designs for encryption and decryption operations.
3054 *
3055 * The set_key() callback in the &struct ieee80211_ops for a given
3056 * device is called to enable hardware acceleration of encryption and
3057 * decryption. The callback takes a @sta parameter that will be NULL
3058 * for default keys or keys used for transmission only, or point to
3059 * the station information for the peer for individual keys.
3060 * Multiple transmission keys with the same key index may be used when
3061 * VLANs are configured for an access point.
3062 *
3063 * When transmitting, the TX control data will use the @hw_key_idx
3064 * selected by the driver by modifying the &struct ieee80211_key_conf
3065 * pointed to by the @key parameter to the set_key() function.
3066 *
3067 * The set_key() call for the %SET_KEY command should return 0 if
3068 * the key is now in use, -%EOPNOTSUPP or -%ENOSPC if it couldn't be
3069 * added; if you return 0 then hw_key_idx must be assigned to the
3070 * hardware key index. You are free to use the full u8 range.
3071 *
3072 * Note that in the case that the @IEEE80211_HW_SW_CRYPTO_CONTROL flag is
3073 * set, mac80211 will not automatically fall back to software crypto if
3074 * enabling hardware crypto failed. The set_key() call may also return the
3075 * value 1 to permit this specific key/algorithm to be done in software.
3076 *
3077 * When the cmd is %DISABLE_KEY then it must succeed.
3078 *
3079 * Note that it is permissible to not decrypt a frame even if a key
3080 * for it has been uploaded to hardware. The stack will not make any
3081 * decision based on whether a key has been uploaded or not but rather
3082 * based on the receive flags.
3083 *
3084 * The &struct ieee80211_key_conf structure pointed to by the @key
3085 * parameter is guaranteed to be valid until another call to set_key()
3086 * removes it, but it can only be used as a cookie to differentiate
3087 * keys.
3088 *
3089 * In TKIP some HW need to be provided a phase 1 key, for RX decryption
3090 * acceleration (i.e. iwlwifi). Those drivers should provide update_tkip_key
3091 * handler.
3092 * The update_tkip_key() call updates the driver with the new phase 1 key.
3093 * This happens every time the iv16 wraps around (every 65536 packets). The
3094 * set_key() call will happen only once for each key (unless the AP did
3095 * rekeying); it will not include a valid phase 1 key. The valid phase 1 key is
3096 * provided by update_tkip_key only. The trigger that makes mac80211 call this
3097 * handler is software decryption with wrap around of iv16.
3098 *
3099 * The set_default_unicast_key() call updates the default WEP key index
3100 * configured to the hardware for WEP encryption type. This is required
3101 * for devices that support offload of data packets (e.g. ARP responses).
3102 *
3103 * Mac80211 drivers should set the @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CAN_REPLACE_PTK0 flag
3104 * when they are able to replace in-use PTK keys according to the following
3105 * requirements:
3106 * 1) They do not hand over frames decrypted with the old key to mac80211
3107      once the call to set_key() with command %DISABLE_KEY has been completed,
3108   2) either drop or continue to use the old key for any outgoing frames queued
3109      at the time of the key deletion (including re-transmits),
3110   3) never send out a frame queued prior to the set_key() %SET_KEY command
3111      encrypted with the new key when also needing
3112      @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV and
3113   4) never send out a frame unencrypted when it should be encrypted.
3114   Mac80211 will not queue any new frames for a deleted key to the driver.
3115 */
3116
3117/**
3118 * DOC: Powersave support
3119 *
3120 * mac80211 has support for various powersave implementations.
3121 *
3122 * First, it can support hardware that handles all powersaving by itself;
3123 * such hardware should simply set the %IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS hardware
3124 * flag. In that case, it will be told about the desired powersave mode
3125 * with the %IEEE80211_CONF_PS flag depending on the association status.
3126 * The hardware must take care of sending nullfunc frames when necessary,
3127 * i.e. when entering and leaving powersave mode. The hardware is required
3128 * to look at the AID in beacons and signal to the AP that it woke up when
3129 * it finds traffic directed to it.
3130 *
3131 * %IEEE80211_CONF_PS flag enabled means that the powersave mode defined in
3132 * IEEE 802.11-2007 section 11.2 is enabled. This is not to be confused
3133 * with hardware wakeup and sleep states. Driver is responsible for waking
3134 * up the hardware before issuing commands to the hardware and putting it
3135 * back to sleep at appropriate times.
3136 *
3137 * When PS is enabled, hardware needs to wakeup for beacons and receive the
3138 * buffered multicast/broadcast frames after the beacon. Also it must be
3139 * possible to send frames and receive the acknowledment frame.
3140 *
3141 * Other hardware designs cannot send nullfunc frames by themselves and also
3142 * need software support for parsing the TIM bitmap. This is also supported
3143 * by mac80211 by combining the %IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS and
3144 * %IEEE80211_HW_PS_NULLFUNC_STACK flags. The hardware is of course still
3145 * required to pass up beacons. The hardware is still required to handle
3146 * waking up for multicast traffic; if it cannot the driver must handle that
3147 * as best as it can; mac80211 is too slow to do that.
3148 *
3149 * Dynamic powersave is an extension to normal powersave in which the
3150 * hardware stays awake for a user-specified period of time after sending a
3151 * frame so that reply frames need not be buffered and therefore delayed to
3152 * the next wakeup. It's a compromise of getting good enough latency when
3153 * there's data traffic and still saving significantly power in idle
3154 * periods.
3155 *
3156 * Dynamic powersave is simply supported by mac80211 enabling and disabling
3157 * PS based on traffic. Driver needs to only set %IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS
3158 * flag and mac80211 will handle everything automatically. Additionally,
3159 * hardware having support for the dynamic PS feature may set the
3160 * %IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_DYNAMIC_PS flag to indicate that it can support
3161 * dynamic PS mode itself. The driver needs to look at the
3162 * @dynamic_ps_timeout hardware configuration value and use it that value
3163 * whenever %IEEE80211_CONF_PS is set. In this case mac80211 will disable
3164 * dynamic PS feature in stack and will just keep %IEEE80211_CONF_PS
3165 * enabled whenever user has enabled powersave.
3166 *
3167 * Driver informs U-APSD client support by enabling
3168 * %IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_UAPSD flag. The mode is configured through the
3169 * uapsd parameter in conf_tx() operation. Hardware needs to send the QoS
3170 * Nullfunc frames and stay awake until the service period has ended. To
3171 * utilize U-APSD, dynamic powersave is disabled for voip AC and all frames
3172 * from that AC are transmitted with powersave enabled.
3173 *
3174 * Note: U-APSD client mode is not yet supported with
3175 * %IEEE80211_HW_PS_NULLFUNC_STACK.
3176 */
3177
3178/**
3179 * DOC: Beacon filter support
3180 *
3181 * Some hardware have beacon filter support to reduce host cpu wakeups
3182 * which will reduce system power consumption. It usually works so that
3183 * the firmware creates a checksum of the beacon but omits all constantly
3184 * changing elements (TSF, TIM etc). Whenever the checksum changes the
3185 * beacon is forwarded to the host, otherwise it will be just dropped. That
3186 * way the host will only receive beacons where some relevant information
3187 * (for example ERP protection or WMM settings) have changed.
3188 *
3189 * Beacon filter support is advertised with the %IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER
3190 * interface capability. The driver needs to enable beacon filter support
3191 * whenever power save is enabled, that is %IEEE80211_CONF_PS is set. When
3192 * power save is enabled, the stack will not check for beacon loss and the
3193 * driver needs to notify about loss of beacons with ieee80211_beacon_loss().
3194 *
3195 * The time (or number of beacons missed) until the firmware notifies the
3196 * driver of a beacon loss event (which in turn causes the driver to call
3197 * ieee80211_beacon_loss()) should be configurable and will be controlled
3198 * by mac80211 and the roaming algorithm in the future.
3199 *
3200 * Since there may be constantly changing information elements that nothing
3201 * in the software stack cares about, we will, in the future, have mac80211
3202 * tell the driver which information elements are interesting in the sense
3203 * that we want to see changes in them. This will include
3204 *
3205 *  - a list of information element IDs
3206 *  - a list of OUIs for the vendor information element
3207 *
3208 * Ideally, the hardware would filter out any beacons without changes in the
3209 * requested elements, but if it cannot support that it may, at the expense
3210 * of some efficiency, filter out only a subset. For example, if the device
3211 * doesn't support checking for OUIs it should pass up all changes in all
3212 * vendor information elements.
3213 *
3214 * Note that change, for the sake of simplification, also includes information
3215 * elements appearing or disappearing from the beacon.
3216 *
3217 * Some hardware supports an "ignore list" instead. Just make sure nothing
3218 * that was requested is on the ignore list, and include commonly changing
3219 * information element IDs in the ignore list, for example 11 (BSS load) and
3220 * the various vendor-assigned IEs with unknown contents (128, 129, 133-136,
3221 * 149, 150, 155, 156, 173, 176, 178, 179, 219); for forward compatibility
3222 * it could also include some currently unused IDs.
3223 *
3224 *
3225 * In addition to these capabilities, hardware should support notifying the
3226 * host of changes in the beacon RSSI. This is relevant to implement roaming
3227 * when no traffic is flowing (when traffic is flowing we see the RSSI of
3228 * the received data packets). This can consist of notifying the host when
3229 * the RSSI changes significantly or when it drops below or rises above
3230 * configurable thresholds. In the future these thresholds will also be
3231 * configured by mac80211 (which gets them from userspace) to implement
3232 * them as the roaming algorithm requires.
3233 *
3234 * If the hardware cannot implement this, the driver should ask it to
3235 * periodically pass beacon frames to the host so that software can do the
3236 * signal strength threshold checking.
3237 */
3238
3239/**
3240 * DOC: Spatial multiplexing power save
3241 *
3242 * SMPS (Spatial multiplexing power save) is a mechanism to conserve
3243 * power in an 802.11n implementation. For details on the mechanism
3244 * and rationale, please refer to 802.11 (as amended by 802.11n-2009)
3245 * "11.2.3 SM power save".
3246 *
3247 * The mac80211 implementation is capable of sending action frames
3248 * to update the AP about the station's SMPS mode, and will instruct
3249 * the driver to enter the specific mode. It will also announce the
3250 * requested SMPS mode during the association handshake. Hardware
3251 * support for this feature is required, and can be indicated by
3252 * hardware flags.
3253 *
3254 * The default mode will be "automatic", which nl80211/cfg80211
3255 * defines to be dynamic SMPS in (regular) powersave, and SMPS
3256 * turned off otherwise.
3257 *
3258 * To support this feature, the driver must set the appropriate
3259 * hardware support flags, and handle the SMPS flag to the config()
3260 * operation. It will then with this mechanism be instructed to
3261 * enter the requested SMPS mode while associated to an HT AP.
3262 */
3263
3264/**
3265 * DOC: Frame filtering
3266 *
3267 * mac80211 requires to see many management frames for proper
3268 * operation, and users may want to see many more frames when
3269 * in monitor mode. However, for best CPU usage and power consumption,
3270 * having as few frames as possible percolate through the stack is
3271 * desirable. Hence, the hardware should filter as much as possible.
3272 *
3273 * To achieve this, mac80211 uses filter flags (see below) to tell
3274 * the driver's configure_filter() function which frames should be
3275 * passed to mac80211 and which should be filtered out.
3276 *
3277 * Before configure_filter() is invoked, the prepare_multicast()
3278 * callback is invoked with the parameters @mc_count and @mc_list
3279 * for the combined multicast address list of all virtual interfaces.
3280 * It's use is optional, and it returns a u64 that is passed to
3281 * configure_filter(). Additionally, configure_filter() has the
3282 * arguments @changed_flags telling which flags were changed and
3283 * @total_flags with the new flag states.
3284 *
3285 * If your device has no multicast address filters your driver will
3286 * need to check both the %FIF_ALLMULTI flag and the @mc_count
3287 * parameter to see whether multicast frames should be accepted
3288 * or dropped.
3289 *
3290 * All unsupported flags in @total_flags must be cleared.
3291 * Hardware does not support a flag if it is incapable of _passing_
3292 * the frame to the stack. Otherwise the driver must ignore
3293 * the flag, but not clear it.
3294 * You must _only_ clear the flag (announce no support for the
3295 * flag to mac80211) if you are not able to pass the packet type
3296 * to the stack (so the hardware always filters it).
3297 * So for example, you should clear @FIF_CONTROL, if your hardware
3298 * always filters control frames. If your hardware always passes
3299 * control frames to the kernel and is incapable of filtering them,
3300 * you do _not_ clear the @FIF_CONTROL flag.
3301 * This rule applies to all other FIF flags as well.
3302 */
3303
3304/**
3305 * DOC: AP support for powersaving clients
3306 *
3307 * In order to implement AP and P2P GO modes, mac80211 has support for
3308 * client powersaving, both "legacy" PS (PS-Poll/null data) and uAPSD.
3309 * There currently is no support for sAPSD.
3310 *
3311 * There is one assumption that mac80211 makes, namely that a client
3312 * will not poll with PS-Poll and trigger with uAPSD at the same time.
3313 * Both are supported, and both can be used by the same client, but
3314 * they can't be used concurrently by the same client. This simplifies
3315 * the driver code.
3316 *
3317 * The first thing to keep in mind is that there is a flag for complete
3318 * driver implementation: %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS. If this flag is set,
3319 * mac80211 expects the driver to handle most of the state machine for
3320 * powersaving clients and will ignore the PM bit in incoming frames.
3321 * Drivers then use ieee80211_sta_ps_transition() to inform mac80211 of
3322 * stations' powersave transitions. In this mode, mac80211 also doesn't
3323 * handle PS-Poll/uAPSD.
3324 *
3325 * In the mode without %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS, mac80211 will check the
3326 * PM bit in incoming frames for client powersave transitions. When a
3327 * station goes to sleep, we will stop transmitting to it. There is,
3328 * however, a race condition: a station might go to sleep while there is
3329 * data buffered on hardware queues. If the device has support for this
3330 * it will reject frames, and the driver should give the frames back to
3331 * mac80211 with the %IEEE80211_TX_STAT_TX_FILTERED flag set which will
3332 * cause mac80211 to retry the frame when the station wakes up. The
3333 * driver is also notified of powersave transitions by calling its
3334 * @sta_notify callback.
3335 *
3336 * When the station is asleep, it has three choices: it can wake up,
3337 * it can PS-Poll, or it can possibly start a uAPSD service period.
3338 * Waking up is implemented by simply transmitting all buffered (and
3339 * filtered) frames to the station. This is the easiest case. When
3340 * the station sends a PS-Poll or a uAPSD trigger frame, mac80211
3341 * will inform the driver of this with the @allow_buffered_frames
3342 * callback; this callback is optional. mac80211 will then transmit
3343 * the frames as usual and set the %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER
3344 * on each frame. The last frame in the service period (or the only
3345 * response to a PS-Poll) also has %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP set to
3346 * indicate that it ends the service period; as this frame must have
3347 * TX status report it also sets %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_REQ_TX_STATUS.
3348 * When TX status is reported for this frame, the service period is
3349 * marked has having ended and a new one can be started by the peer.
3350 *
3351 * Additionally, non-bufferable MMPDUs can also be transmitted by
3352 * mac80211 with the %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER set in them.
3353 *
3354 * Another race condition can happen on some devices like iwlwifi
3355 * when there are frames queued for the station and it wakes up
3356 * or polls; the frames that are already queued could end up being
3357 * transmitted first instead, causing reordering and/or wrong
3358 * processing of the EOSP. The cause is that allowing frames to be
3359 * transmitted to a certain station is out-of-band communication to
3360 * the device. To allow this problem to be solved, the driver can
3361 * call ieee80211_sta_block_awake() if frames are buffered when it
3362 * is notified that the station went to sleep. When all these frames
3363 * have been filtered (see above), it must call the function again
3364 * to indicate that the station is no longer blocked.
3365 *
3366 * If the driver buffers frames in the driver for aggregation in any
3367 * way, it must use the ieee80211_sta_set_buffered() call when it is
3368 * notified of the station going to sleep to inform mac80211 of any
3369 * TIDs that have frames buffered. Note that when a station wakes up
3370 * this information is reset (hence the requirement to call it when
3371 * informed of the station going to sleep). Then, when a service
3372 * period starts for any reason, @release_buffered_frames is called
3373 * with the number of frames to be released and which TIDs they are
3374 * to come from. In this case, the driver is responsible for setting
3375 * the EOSP (for uAPSD) and MORE_DATA bits in the released frames.
3376 * To help the @more_data parameter is passed to tell the driver if
3377 * there is more data on other TIDs -- the TIDs to release frames
3378 * from are ignored since mac80211 doesn't know how many frames the
3379 * buffers for those TIDs contain.
3380 *
3381 * If the driver also implement GO mode, where absence periods may
3382 * shorten service periods (or abort PS-Poll responses), it must
3383 * filter those response frames except in the case of frames that
3384 * are buffered in the driver -- those must remain buffered to avoid
3385 * reordering. Because it is possible that no frames are released
3386 * in this case, the driver must call ieee80211_sta_eosp()
3387 * to indicate to mac80211 that the service period ended anyway.
3388 *
3389 * Finally, if frames from multiple TIDs are released from mac80211
3390 * but the driver might reorder them, it must clear & set the flags
3391 * appropriately (only the last frame may have %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP)
3392 * and also take care of the EOSP and MORE_DATA bits in the frame.
3393 * The driver may also use ieee80211_sta_eosp() in this case.
3394 *
3395 * Note that if the driver ever buffers frames other than QoS-data
3396 * frames, it must take care to never send a non-QoS-data frame as
3397 * the last frame in a service period, adding a QoS-nulldata frame
3398 * after a non-QoS-data frame if needed.
3399 */
3400
3401/**
3402 * DOC: HW queue control
3403 *
3404 * Before HW queue control was introduced, mac80211 only had a single static
3405 * assignment of per-interface AC software queues to hardware queues. This
3406 * was problematic for a few reasons:
3407 * 1) off-channel transmissions might get stuck behind other frames
3408 * 2) multiple virtual interfaces couldn't be handled correctly
3409 * 3) after-DTIM frames could get stuck behind other frames
3410 *
3411 * To solve this, hardware typically uses multiple different queues for all
3412 * the different usages, and this needs to be propagated into mac80211 so it
3413 * won't have the same problem with the software queues.
3414 *
3415 * Therefore, mac80211 now offers the %IEEE80211_HW_QUEUE_CONTROL capability
3416 * flag that tells it that the driver implements its own queue control. To do
3417 * so, the driver will set up the various queues in each &struct ieee80211_vif
3418 * and the offchannel queue in &struct ieee80211_hw. In response, mac80211 will
3419 * use those queue IDs in the hw_queue field of &struct ieee80211_tx_info and
3420 * if necessary will queue the frame on the right software queue that mirrors
3421 * the hardware queue.
3422 * Additionally, the driver has to then use these HW queue IDs for the queue
3423 * management functions (ieee80211_stop_queue() et al.)
3424 *
3425 * The driver is free to set up the queue mappings as needed; multiple virtual
3426 * interfaces may map to the same hardware queues if needed. The setup has to
3427 * happen during add_interface or change_interface callbacks. For example, a
3428 * driver supporting station+station and station+AP modes might decide to have
3429 * 10 hardware queues to handle different scenarios:
3430 *
3431 * 4 AC HW queues for 1st vif: 0, 1, 2, 3
3432 * 4 AC HW queues for 2nd vif: 4, 5, 6, 7
3433 * after-DTIM queue for AP:   8
3434 * off-channel queue:         9
3435 *
3436 * It would then set up the hardware like this:
3437 *   hw.offchannel_tx_hw_queue = 9
3438 *
3439 * and the first virtual interface that is added as follows:
3440 *   vif.hw_queue[IEEE80211_AC_VO] = 0
3441 *   vif.hw_queue[IEEE80211_AC_VI] = 1
3442 *   vif.hw_queue[IEEE80211_AC_BE] = 2
3443 *   vif.hw_queue[IEEE80211_AC_BK] = 3
3444 *   vif.cab_queue = 8 // if AP mode, otherwise %IEEE80211_INVAL_HW_QUEUE
3445 * and the second virtual interface with 4-7.
3446 *
3447 * If queue 6 gets full, for example, mac80211 would only stop the second
3448 * virtual interface's BE queue since virtual interface queues are per AC.
3449 *
3450 * Note that the vif.cab_queue value should be set to %IEEE80211_INVAL_HW_QUEUE
3451 * whenever the queue is not used (i.e. the interface is not in AP mode) if the
3452 * queue could potentially be shared since mac80211 will look at cab_queue when
3453 * a queue is stopped/woken even if the interface is not in AP mode.
3454 */
3455
3456/**
3457 * enum ieee80211_filter_flags - hardware filter flags
3458 *
3459 * These flags determine what the filter in hardware should be
3460 * programmed to let through and what should not be passed to the
3461 * stack. It is always safe to pass more frames than requested,
3462 * but this has negative impact on power consumption.
3463 *
3464 * @FIF_ALLMULTI: pass all multicast frames, this is used if requested
3465 *	by the user or if the hardware is not capable of filtering by
3466 *	multicast address.
3467 *
3468 * @FIF_FCSFAIL: pass frames with failed FCS (but you need to set the
3469 *	%RX_FLAG_FAILED_FCS_CRC for them)
3470 *
3471 * @FIF_PLCPFAIL: pass frames with failed PLCP CRC (but you need to set
3472 *	the %RX_FLAG_FAILED_PLCP_CRC for them
3473 *
3474 * @FIF_BCN_PRBRESP_PROMISC: This flag is set during scanning to indicate
3475 *	to the hardware that it should not filter beacons or probe responses
3476 *	by BSSID. Filtering them can greatly reduce the amount of processing
3477 *	mac80211 needs to do and the amount of CPU wakeups, so you should
3478 *	honour this flag if possible.
3479 *
3480 * @FIF_CONTROL: pass control frames (except for PS Poll) addressed to this
3481 *	station
3482 *
3483 * @FIF_OTHER_BSS: pass frames destined to other BSSes
3484 *
3485 * @FIF_PSPOLL: pass PS Poll frames
3486 *
3487 * @FIF_PROBE_REQ: pass probe request frames
3488 *
3489 * @FIF_MCAST_ACTION: pass multicast Action frames
3490 */
3491enum ieee80211_filter_flags {
3492	FIF_ALLMULTI		= 1<<1,
3493	FIF_FCSFAIL		= 1<<2,
3494	FIF_PLCPFAIL		= 1<<3,
3495	FIF_BCN_PRBRESP_PROMISC	= 1<<4,
3496	FIF_CONTROL		= 1<<5,
3497	FIF_OTHER_BSS		= 1<<6,
3498	FIF_PSPOLL		= 1<<7,
3499	FIF_PROBE_REQ		= 1<<8,
3500	FIF_MCAST_ACTION	= 1<<9,
3501};
3502
3503/**
3504 * enum ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action - A-MPDU actions
3505 *
3506 * These flags are used with the ampdu_action() callback in
3507 * &struct ieee80211_ops to indicate which action is needed.
3508 *
3509 * Note that drivers MUST be able to deal with a TX aggregation
3510 * session being stopped even before they OK'ed starting it by
3511 * calling ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe, because the peer
3512 * might receive the addBA frame and send a delBA right away!
3513 *
3514 * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START: start RX aggregation
3515 * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_STOP: stop RX aggregation
3516 * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START: start TX aggregation, the driver must either
3517 *	call ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe() or
3518 *	call ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe() with status
3519 *	%IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START_DELAY_ADDBA to delay addba after
3520 *	ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe is called, or just return the special
3521 *	status %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START_IMMEDIATE.
3522 * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL: TX aggregation has become operational
3523 * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_CONT: stop TX aggregation but continue transmitting
3524 *	queued packets, now unaggregated. After all packets are transmitted the
3525 *	driver has to call ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe().
3526 * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_FLUSH: stop TX aggregation and flush all packets,
3527 *	called when the station is removed. There's no need or reason to call
3528 *	ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe() in this case as mac80211 assumes the
3529 *	session is gone and removes the station.
3530 * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_FLUSH_CONT: called when TX aggregation is stopped
3531 *	but the driver hasn't called ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe() yet and
3532 *	now the connection is dropped and the station will be removed. Drivers
3533 *	should clean up and drop remaining packets when this is called.
3534 */
3535enum ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action {
3536	IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START,
3537	IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_STOP,
3538	IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START,
3539	IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_CONT,
3540	IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_FLUSH,
3541	IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_FLUSH_CONT,
3542	IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL,
3543};
3544
3545#define IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START_IMMEDIATE 1
3546#define IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START_DELAY_ADDBA 2
3547
3548/**
3549 * struct ieee80211_ampdu_params - AMPDU action parameters
3550 *
3551 * @action: the ampdu action, value from %ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action.
3552 * @sta: peer of this AMPDU session
3553 * @tid: tid of the BA session
3554 * @ssn: start sequence number of the session. TX/RX_STOP can pass 0. When
3555 *	action is set to %IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START the driver passes back the
3556 *	actual ssn value used to start the session and writes the value here.
3557 * @buf_size: reorder buffer size  (number of subframes). Valid only when the
3558 *	action is set to %IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START or
3559 *	%IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL
3560 * @amsdu: indicates the peer's ability to receive A-MSDU within A-MPDU.
3561 *	valid when the action is set to %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL
3562 * @timeout: BA session timeout. Valid only when the action is set to
3563 *	%IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START
3564 */
3565struct ieee80211_ampdu_params {
3566	enum ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action action;
3567	struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
3568	u16 tid;
3569	u16 ssn;
3570	u16 buf_size;
3571	bool amsdu;
3572	u16 timeout;
3573};
3574
3575/**
3576 * enum ieee80211_frame_release_type - frame release reason
3577 * @IEEE80211_FRAME_RELEASE_PSPOLL: frame released for PS-Poll
3578 * @IEEE80211_FRAME_RELEASE_UAPSD: frame(s) released due to
3579 *	frame received on trigger-enabled AC
3580 */
3581enum ieee80211_frame_release_type {
3582	IEEE80211_FRAME_RELEASE_PSPOLL,
3583	IEEE80211_FRAME_RELEASE_UAPSD,
3584};
3585
3586/**
3587 * enum ieee80211_rate_control_changed - flags to indicate what changed
3588 *
3589 * @IEEE80211_RC_BW_CHANGED: The bandwidth that can be used to transmit
3590 *	to this station changed. The actual bandwidth is in the station
3591 *	information -- for HT20/40 the IEEE80211_HT_CAP_SUP_WIDTH_20_40
3592 *	flag changes, for HT and VHT the bandwidth field changes.
3593 * @IEEE80211_RC_SMPS_CHANGED: The SMPS state of the station changed.
3594 * @IEEE80211_RC_SUPP_RATES_CHANGED: The supported rate set of this peer
3595 *	changed (in IBSS mode) due to discovering more information about
3596 *	the peer.
3597 * @IEEE80211_RC_NSS_CHANGED: N_SS (number of spatial streams) was changed
3598 *	by the peer
3599 */
3600enum ieee80211_rate_control_changed {
3601	IEEE80211_RC_BW_CHANGED		= BIT(0),
3602	IEEE80211_RC_SMPS_CHANGED	= BIT(1),
3603	IEEE80211_RC_SUPP_RATES_CHANGED	= BIT(2),
3604	IEEE80211_RC_NSS_CHANGED	= BIT(3),
3605};
3606
3607/**
3608 * enum ieee80211_roc_type - remain on channel type
3609 *
3610 * With the support for multi channel contexts and multi channel operations,
3611 * remain on channel operations might be limited/deferred/aborted by other
3612 * flows/operations which have higher priority (and vice versa).
3613 * Specifying the ROC type can be used by devices to prioritize the ROC
3614 * operations compared to other operations/flows.
3615 *
3616 * @IEEE80211_ROC_TYPE_NORMAL: There are no special requirements for this ROC.
3617 * @IEEE80211_ROC_TYPE_MGMT_TX: The remain on channel request is required
3618 *	for sending management frames offchannel.
3619 */
3620enum ieee80211_roc_type {
3621	IEEE80211_ROC_TYPE_NORMAL = 0,
3622	IEEE80211_ROC_TYPE_MGMT_TX,
3623};
3624
3625/**
3626 * enum ieee80211_reconfig_type - reconfig type
3627 *
3628 * This enum is used by the reconfig_complete() callback to indicate what
3629 * reconfiguration type was completed.
3630 *
3631 * @IEEE80211_RECONFIG_TYPE_RESTART: hw restart type
3632 *	(also due to resume() callback returning 1)
3633 * @IEEE80211_RECONFIG_TYPE_SUSPEND: suspend type (regardless
3634 *	of wowlan configuration)
3635 */
3636enum ieee80211_reconfig_type {
3637	IEEE80211_RECONFIG_TYPE_RESTART,
3638	IEEE80211_RECONFIG_TYPE_SUSPEND,
3639};
3640
3641/**
3642 * struct ieee80211_prep_tx_info - prepare TX information
3643 * @duration: if non-zero, hint about the required duration,
3644 *	only used with the mgd_prepare_tx() method.
3645 * @subtype: frame subtype (auth, (re)assoc, deauth, disassoc)
3646 * @success: whether the frame exchange was successful, only
3647 *	used with the mgd_complete_tx() method, and then only
3648 *	valid for auth and (re)assoc.
3649 * @link_id: the link id on which the frame will be TX'ed.
3650 *	Only used with the mgd_prepare_tx() method.
3651 */
3652struct ieee80211_prep_tx_info {
3653	u16 duration;
3654	u16 subtype;
3655	u8 success:1;
3656	int link_id;
3657};
3658
3659/**
3660 * struct ieee80211_ops - callbacks from mac80211 to the driver
3661 *
3662 * This structure contains various callbacks that the driver may
3663 * handle or, in some cases, must handle, for example to configure
3664 * the hardware to a new channel or to transmit a frame.
3665 *
3666 * @tx: Handler that 802.11 module calls for each transmitted frame.
3667 *	skb contains the buffer starting from the IEEE 802.11 header.
3668 *	The low-level driver should send the frame out based on
3669 *	configuration in the TX control data. This handler should,
3670 *	preferably, never fail and stop queues appropriately.
3671 *	Must be atomic.
3672 *
3673 * @start: Called before the first netdevice attached to the hardware
3674 *	is enabled. This should turn on the hardware and must turn on
3675 *	frame reception (for possibly enabled monitor interfaces.)
3676 *	Returns negative error codes, these may be seen in userspace,
3677 *	or zero.
3678 *	When the device is started it should not have a MAC address
3679 *	to avoid acknowledging frames before a non-monitor device
3680 *	is added.
3681 *	Must be implemented and can sleep.
3682 *
3683 * @stop: Called after last netdevice attached to the hardware
3684 *	is disabled. This should turn off the hardware (at least
3685 *	it must turn off frame reception.)
3686 *	May be called right after add_interface if that rejects
3687 *	an interface. If you added any work onto the mac80211 workqueue
3688 *	you should ensure to cancel it on this callback.
3689 *	Must be implemented and can sleep.
3690 *
3691 * @suspend: Suspend the device; mac80211 itself will quiesce before and
3692 *	stop transmitting and doing any other configuration, and then
3693 *	ask the device to suspend. This is only invoked when WoWLAN is
3694 *	configured, otherwise the device is deconfigured completely and
3695 *	reconfigured at resume time.
3696 *	The driver may also impose special conditions under which it
3697 *	wants to use the "normal" suspend (deconfigure), say if it only
3698 *	supports WoWLAN when the device is associated. In this case, it
3699 *	must return 1 from this function.
3700 *
3701 * @resume: If WoWLAN was configured, this indicates that mac80211 is
3702 *	now resuming its operation, after this the device must be fully
3703 *	functional again. If this returns an error, the only way out is
3704 *	to also unregister the device. If it returns 1, then mac80211
3705 *	will also go through the regular complete restart on resume.
3706 *
3707 * @set_wakeup: Enable or disable wakeup when WoWLAN configuration is
3708 *	modified. The reason is that device_set_wakeup_enable() is
3709 *	supposed to be called when the configuration changes, not only
3710 *	in suspend().
3711 *
3712 * @add_interface: Called when a netdevice attached to the hardware is
3713 *	enabled. Because it is not called for monitor mode devices, @start
3714 *	and @stop must be implemented.
3715 *	The driver should perform any initialization it needs before
3716 *	the device can be enabled. The initial configuration for the
3717 *	interface is given in the conf parameter.
3718 *	The callback may refuse to add an interface by returning a
3719 *	negative error code (which will be seen in userspace.)
3720 *	Must be implemented and can sleep.
3721 *
3722 * @change_interface: Called when a netdevice changes type. This callback
3723 *	is optional, but only if it is supported can interface types be
3724 *	switched while the interface is UP. The callback may sleep.
3725 *	Note that while an interface is being switched, it will not be
3726 *	found by the interface iteration callbacks.
3727 *
3728 * @remove_interface: Notifies a driver that an interface is going down.
3729 *	The @stop callback is called after this if it is the last interface
3730 *	and no monitor interfaces are present.
3731 *	When all interfaces are removed, the MAC address in the hardware
3732 *	must be cleared so the device no longer acknowledges packets,
3733 *	the mac_addr member of the conf structure is, however, set to the
3734 *	MAC address of the device going away.
3735 *	Hence, this callback must be implemented. It can sleep.
3736 *
3737 * @config: Handler for configuration requests. IEEE 802.11 code calls this
3738 *	function to change hardware configuration, e.g., channel.
3739 *	This function should never fail but returns a negative error code
3740 *	if it does. The callback can sleep.
3741 *
3742 * @bss_info_changed: Handler for configuration requests related to BSS
3743 *	parameters that may vary during BSS's lifespan, and may affect low
3744 *	level driver (e.g. assoc/disassoc status, erp parameters).
3745 *	This function should not be used if no BSS has been set, unless
3746 *	for association indication. The @changed parameter indicates which
3747 *	of the bss parameters has changed when a call is made. The callback
3748 *	can sleep.
3749 *	Note: this callback is called if @vif_cfg_changed or @link_info_changed
3750 *	are not implemented.
3751 *
3752 * @vif_cfg_changed: Handler for configuration requests related to interface
3753 *	(MLD) parameters from &struct ieee80211_vif_cfg that vary during the
3754 *	lifetime of the interface (e.g. assoc status, IP addresses, etc.)
3755 *	The @changed parameter indicates which value changed.
3756 *	The callback can sleep.
3757 *
3758 * @link_info_changed: Handler for configuration requests related to link
3759 *	parameters from &struct ieee80211_bss_conf that are related to an
3760 *	individual link. e.g. legacy/HT/VHT/... rate information.
3761 *	The @changed parameter indicates which value changed, and the @link_id
3762 *	parameter indicates the link ID. Note that the @link_id will be 0 for
3763 *	non-MLO connections.
3764 *	The callback can sleep.
3765 *
3766 * @prepare_multicast: Prepare for multicast filter configuration.
3767 *	This callback is optional, and its return value is passed
3768 *	to configure_filter(). This callback must be atomic.
3769 *
3770 * @configure_filter: Configure the device's RX filter.
3771 *	See the section "Frame filtering" for more information.
3772 *	This callback must be implemented and can sleep.
3773 *
3774 * @config_iface_filter: Configure the interface's RX filter.
3775 *	This callback is optional and is used to configure which frames
3776 *	should be passed to mac80211. The filter_flags is the combination
3777 *	of FIF_* flags. The changed_flags is a bit mask that indicates
3778 *	which flags are changed.
3779 *	This callback can sleep.
3780 *
3781 * @set_tim: Set TIM bit. mac80211 calls this function when a TIM bit
3782 * 	must be set or cleared for a given STA. Must be atomic.
3783 *
3784 * @set_key: See the section "Hardware crypto acceleration"
3785 *	This callback is only called between add_interface and
3786 *	remove_interface calls, i.e. while the given virtual interface
3787 *	is enabled.
3788 *	Returns a negative error code if the key can't be added.
3789 *	The callback can sleep.
3790 *
3791 * @update_tkip_key: See the section "Hardware crypto acceleration"
3792 * 	This callback will be called in the context of Rx. Called for drivers
3793 * 	which set IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_TKIP_REQ_RX_P1_KEY.
3794 *	The callback must be atomic.
3795 *
3796 * @set_rekey_data: If the device supports GTK rekeying, for example while the
3797 *	host is suspended, it can assign this callback to retrieve the data
3798 *	necessary to do GTK rekeying, this is the KEK, KCK and replay counter.
3799 *	After rekeying was done it should (for example during resume) notify
3800 *	userspace of the new replay counter using ieee80211_gtk_rekey_notify().
3801 *
3802 * @set_default_unicast_key: Set the default (unicast) key index, useful for
3803 *	WEP when the device sends data packets autonomously, e.g. for ARP
3804 *	offloading. The index can be 0-3, or -1 for unsetting it.
3805 *
3806 * @hw_scan: Ask the hardware to service the scan request, no need to start
3807 *	the scan state machine in stack. The scan must honour the channel
3808 *	configuration done by the regulatory agent in the wiphy's
3809 *	registered bands. The hardware (or the driver) needs to make sure
3810 *	that power save is disabled.
3811 *	The @req ie/ie_len members are rewritten by mac80211 to contain the
3812 *	entire IEs after the SSID, so that drivers need not look at these
3813 *	at all but just send them after the SSID -- mac80211 includes the
3814 *	(extended) supported rates and HT information (where applicable).
3815 *	When the scan finishes, ieee80211_scan_completed() must be called;
3816 *	note that it also must be called when the scan cannot finish due to
3817 *	any error unless this callback returned a negative error code.
3818 *	This callback is also allowed to return the special return value 1,
3819 *	this indicates that hardware scan isn't desirable right now and a
3820 *	software scan should be done instead. A driver wishing to use this
3821 *	capability must ensure its (hardware) scan capabilities aren't
3822 *	advertised as more capable than mac80211's software scan is.
3823 *	The callback can sleep.
3824 *
3825 * @cancel_hw_scan: Ask the low-level tp cancel the active hw scan.
3826 *	The driver should ask the hardware to cancel the scan (if possible),
3827 *	but the scan will be completed only after the driver will call
3828 *	ieee80211_scan_completed().
3829 *	This callback is needed for wowlan, to prevent enqueueing a new
3830 *	scan_work after the low-level driver was already suspended.
3831 *	The callback can sleep.
3832 *
3833 * @sched_scan_start: Ask the hardware to start scanning repeatedly at
3834 *	specific intervals.  The driver must call the
3835 *	ieee80211_sched_scan_results() function whenever it finds results.
3836 *	This process will continue until sched_scan_stop is called.
3837 *
3838 * @sched_scan_stop: Tell the hardware to stop an ongoing scheduled scan.
3839 *	In this case, ieee80211_sched_scan_stopped() must not be called.
3840 *
3841 * @sw_scan_start: Notifier function that is called just before a software scan
3842 *	is started. Can be NULL, if the driver doesn't need this notification.
3843 *	The mac_addr parameter allows supporting NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_RANDOM_ADDR,
3844 *	the driver may set the NL80211_FEATURE_SCAN_RANDOM_MAC_ADDR flag if it
3845 *	can use this parameter. The callback can sleep.
3846 *
3847 * @sw_scan_complete: Notifier function that is called just after a
3848 *	software scan finished. Can be NULL, if the driver doesn't need
3849 *	this notification.
3850 *	The callback can sleep.
3851 *
3852 * @get_stats: Return low-level statistics.
3853 * 	Returns zero if statistics are available.
3854 *	The callback can sleep.
3855 *
3856 * @get_key_seq: If your device implements encryption in hardware and does
3857 *	IV/PN assignment then this callback should be provided to read the
3858 *	IV/PN for the given key from hardware.
3859 *	The callback must be atomic.
3860 *
3861 * @set_frag_threshold: Configuration of fragmentation threshold. Assign this
3862 *	if the device does fragmentation by itself. Note that to prevent the
3863 *	stack from doing fragmentation IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TX_FRAG
3864 *	should be set as well.
3865 *	The callback can sleep.
3866 *
3867 * @set_rts_threshold: Configuration of RTS threshold (if device needs it)
3868 *	The callback can sleep.
3869 *
3870 * @sta_add: Notifies low level driver about addition of an associated station,
3871 *	AP, IBSS/WDS/mesh peer etc. This callback can sleep.
3872 *
3873 * @sta_remove: Notifies low level driver about removal of an associated
3874 *	station, AP, IBSS/WDS/mesh peer etc. Note that after the callback
3875 *	returns it isn't safe to use the pointer, not even RCU protected;
3876 *	no RCU grace period is guaranteed between returning here and freeing
3877 *	the station. See @sta_pre_rcu_remove if needed.
3878 *	This callback can sleep.
3879 *
3880 * @vif_add_debugfs: Drivers can use this callback to add a debugfs vif
3881 *	directory with its files. This callback should be within a
3882 *	CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS conditional. This callback can sleep.
3883 *
3884 * @link_add_debugfs: Drivers can use this callback to add debugfs files
3885 *	when a link is added to a mac80211 vif. This callback should be within
3886 *	a CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS conditional. This callback can sleep.
3887 *	For non-MLO the callback will be called once for the default bss_conf
3888 *	with the vif's directory rather than a separate subdirectory.
3889 *
3890 * @sta_add_debugfs: Drivers can use this callback to add debugfs files
3891 *	when a station is added to mac80211's station list. This callback
3892 *	should be within a CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS conditional. This
3893 *	callback can sleep.
3894 *
3895 * @link_sta_add_debugfs: Drivers can use this callback to add debugfs files
3896 *	when a link is added to a mac80211 station. This callback
3897 *	should be within a CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS conditional. This
3898 *	callback can sleep.
3899 *	For non-MLO the callback will be called once for the deflink with the
3900 *	station's directory rather than a separate subdirectory.
3901 *
3902 * @sta_notify: Notifies low level driver about power state transition of an
3903 *	associated station, AP,  IBSS/WDS/mesh peer etc. For a VIF operating
3904 *	in AP mode, this callback will not be called when the flag
3905 *	%IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS is set. Must be atomic.
3906 *
3907 * @sta_set_txpwr: Configure the station tx power. This callback set the tx
3908 *	power for the station.
3909 *	This callback can sleep.
3910 *
3911 * @sta_state: Notifies low level driver about state transition of a
3912 *	station (which can be the AP, a client, IBSS/WDS/mesh peer etc.)
3913 *	This callback is mutually exclusive with @sta_add/@sta_remove.
3914 *	It must not fail for down transitions but may fail for transitions
3915 *	up the list of states. Also note that after the callback returns it
3916 *	isn't safe to use the pointer, not even RCU protected - no RCU grace
3917 *	period is guaranteed between returning here and freeing the station.
3918 *	See @sta_pre_rcu_remove if needed.
3919 *	The callback can sleep.
3920 *
3921 * @sta_pre_rcu_remove: Notify driver about station removal before RCU
3922 *	synchronisation. This is useful if a driver needs to have station
3923 *	pointers protected using RCU, it can then use this call to clear
3924 *	the pointers instead of waiting for an RCU grace period to elapse
3925 *	in @sta_state.
3926 *	The callback can sleep.
3927 *
3928 * @sta_rc_update: Notifies the driver of changes to the bitrates that can be
3929 *	used to transmit to the station. The changes are advertised with bits
3930 *	from &enum ieee80211_rate_control_changed and the values are reflected
3931 *	in the station data. This callback should only be used when the driver
3932 *	uses hardware rate control (%IEEE80211_HW_HAS_RATE_CONTROL) since
3933 *	otherwise the rate control algorithm is notified directly.
3934 *	Must be atomic.
3935 * @sta_rate_tbl_update: Notifies the driver that the rate table changed. This
3936 *	is only used if the configured rate control algorithm actually uses
3937 *	the new rate table API, and is therefore optional. Must be atomic.
3938 *
3939 * @sta_statistics: Get statistics for this station. For example with beacon
3940 *	filtering, the statistics kept by mac80211 might not be accurate, so
3941 *	let the driver pre-fill the statistics. The driver can fill most of
3942 *	the values (indicating which by setting the filled bitmap), but not
3943 *	all of them make sense - see the source for which ones are possible.
3944 *	Statistics that the driver doesn't fill will be filled by mac80211.
3945 *	The callback can sleep.
3946 *
3947 * @conf_tx: Configure TX queue parameters (EDCF (aifs, cw_min, cw_max),
3948 *	bursting) for a hardware TX queue.
3949 *	Returns a negative error code on failure.
3950 *	The callback can sleep.
3951 *
3952 * @get_tsf: Get the current TSF timer value from firmware/hardware. Currently,
3953 *	this is only used for IBSS mode BSSID merging and debugging. Is not a
3954 *	required function.
3955 *	The callback can sleep.
3956 *
3957 * @set_tsf: Set the TSF timer to the specified value in the firmware/hardware.
3958 *	Currently, this is only used for IBSS mode debugging. Is not a
3959 *	required function.
3960 *	The callback can sleep.
3961 *
3962 * @offset_tsf: Offset the TSF timer by the specified value in the
3963 *	firmware/hardware.  Preferred to set_tsf as it avoids delay between
3964 *	calling set_tsf() and hardware getting programmed, which will show up
3965 *	as TSF delay. Is not a required function.
3966 *	The callback can sleep.
3967 *
3968 * @reset_tsf: Reset the TSF timer and allow firmware/hardware to synchronize
3969 *	with other STAs in the IBSS. This is only used in IBSS mode. This
3970 *	function is optional if the firmware/hardware takes full care of
3971 *	TSF synchronization.
3972 *	The callback can sleep.
3973 *
3974 * @tx_last_beacon: Determine whether the last IBSS beacon was sent by us.
3975 *	This is needed only for IBSS mode and the result of this function is
3976 *	used to determine whether to reply to Probe Requests.
3977 *	Returns non-zero if this device sent the last beacon.
3978 *	The callback can sleep.
3979 *
3980 * @get_survey: Return per-channel survey information
3981 *
3982 * @rfkill_poll: Poll rfkill hardware state. If you need this, you also
3983 *	need to set wiphy->rfkill_poll to %true before registration,
3984 *	and need to call wiphy_rfkill_set_hw_state() in the callback.
3985 *	The callback can sleep.
3986 *
3987 * @set_coverage_class: Set slot time for given coverage class as specified
3988 *	in IEEE 802.11-2007 section 17.3.8.6 and modify ACK timeout
3989 *	accordingly; coverage class equals to -1 to enable ACK timeout
3990 *	estimation algorithm (dynack). To disable dynack set valid value for
3991 *	coverage class. This callback is not required and may sleep.
3992 *
3993 * @testmode_cmd: Implement a cfg80211 test mode command. The passed @vif may
3994 *	be %NULL. The callback can sleep.
3995 * @testmode_dump: Implement a cfg80211 test mode dump. The callback can sleep.
3996 *
3997 * @flush: Flush all pending frames from the hardware queue, making sure
3998 *	that the hardware queues are empty. The @queues parameter is a bitmap
3999 *	of queues to flush, which is useful if different virtual interfaces
4000 *	use different hardware queues; it may also indicate all queues.
4001 *	If the parameter @drop is set to %true, pending frames may be dropped.
4002 *	Note that vif can be NULL.
4003 *	The callback can sleep.
4004 *
4005 * @flush_sta: Flush or drop all pending frames from the hardware queue(s) for
4006 *	the given station, as it's about to be removed.
4007 *	The callback can sleep.
4008 *
4009 * @channel_switch: Drivers that need (or want) to offload the channel
4010 *	switch operation for CSAs received from the AP may implement this
4011 *	callback. They must then call ieee80211_chswitch_done() to indicate
4012 *	completion of the channel switch.
4013 *
4014 * @set_antenna: Set antenna configuration (tx_ant, rx_ant) on the device.
4015 *	Parameters are bitmaps of allowed antennas to use for TX/RX. Drivers may
4016 *	reject TX/RX mask combinations they cannot support by returning -EINVAL
4017 *	(also see nl80211.h @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_TX).
4018 *
4019 * @get_antenna: Get current antenna configuration from device (tx_ant, rx_ant).
4020 *
4021 * @remain_on_channel: Starts an off-channel period on the given channel, must
4022 *	call back to ieee80211_ready_on_channel() when on that channel. Note
4023 *	that normal channel traffic is not stopped as this is intended for hw
4024 *	offload. Frames to transmit on the off-channel channel are transmitted
4025 *	normally except for the %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_TX_OFFCHAN flag. When the
4026 *	duration (which will always be non-zero) expires, the driver must call
4027 *	ieee80211_remain_on_channel_expired().
4028 *	Note that this callback may be called while the device is in IDLE and
4029 *	must be accepted in this case.
4030 *	This callback may sleep.
4031 * @cancel_remain_on_channel: Requests that an ongoing off-channel period is
4032 *	aborted before it expires. This callback may sleep.
4033 *
4034 * @set_ringparam: Set tx and rx ring sizes.
4035 *
4036 * @get_ringparam: Get tx and rx ring current and maximum sizes.
4037 *
4038 * @tx_frames_pending: Check if there is any pending frame in the hardware
4039 *	queues before entering power save.
4040 *
4041 * @set_bitrate_mask: Set a mask of rates to be used for rate control selection
4042 *	when transmitting a frame. Currently only legacy rates are handled.
4043 *	The callback can sleep.
4044 * @event_callback: Notify driver about any event in mac80211. See
4045 *	&enum ieee80211_event_type for the different types.
4046 *	The callback must be atomic.
4047 *
4048 * @release_buffered_frames: Release buffered frames according to the given
4049 *	parameters. In the case where the driver buffers some frames for
4050 *	sleeping stations mac80211 will use this callback to tell the driver
4051 *	to release some frames, either for PS-poll or uAPSD.
4052 *	Note that if the @more_data parameter is %false the driver must check
4053 *	if there are more frames on the given TIDs, and if there are more than
4054 *	the frames being released then it must still set the more-data bit in
4055 *	the frame. If the @more_data parameter is %true, then of course the
4056 *	more-data bit must always be set.
4057 *	The @tids parameter tells the driver which TIDs to release frames
4058 *	from, for PS-poll it will always have only a single bit set.
4059 *	In the case this is used for a PS-poll initiated release, the
4060 *	@num_frames parameter will always be 1 so code can be shared. In
4061 *	this case the driver must also set %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP flag
4062 *	on the TX status (and must report TX status) so that the PS-poll
4063 *	period is properly ended. This is used to avoid sending multiple
4064 *	responses for a retried PS-poll frame.
4065 *	In the case this is used for uAPSD, the @num_frames parameter may be
4066 *	bigger than one, but the driver may send fewer frames (it must send
4067 *	at least one, however). In this case it is also responsible for
4068 *	setting the EOSP flag in the QoS header of the frames. Also, when the
4069 *	service period ends, the driver must set %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP
4070 *	on the last frame in the SP. Alternatively, it may call the function
4071 *	ieee80211_sta_eosp() to inform mac80211 of the end of the SP.
4072 *	This callback must be atomic.
4073 * @allow_buffered_frames: Prepare device to allow the given number of frames
4074 *	to go out to the given station. The frames will be sent by mac80211
4075 *	via the usual TX path after this call. The TX information for frames
4076 *	released will also have the %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER flag set
4077 *	and the last one will also have %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP set. In case
4078 *	frames from multiple TIDs are released and the driver might reorder
4079 *	them between the TIDs, it must set the %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP flag
4080 *	on the last frame and clear it on all others and also handle the EOSP
4081 *	bit in the QoS header correctly. Alternatively, it can also call the
4082 *	ieee80211_sta_eosp() function.
4083 *	The @tids parameter is a bitmap and tells the driver which TIDs the
4084 *	frames will be on; it will at most have two bits set.
4085 *	This callback must be atomic.
4086 *
4087 * @get_et_sset_count:  Ethtool API to get string-set count.
4088 *	Note that the wiphy mutex is not held for this callback since it's
4089 *	expected to return a static value.
4090 *
4091 * @get_et_stats:  Ethtool API to get a set of u64 stats.
4092 *
4093 * @get_et_strings:  Ethtool API to get a set of strings to describe stats
4094 *	and perhaps other supported types of ethtool data-sets.
4095 *	Note that the wiphy mutex is not held for this callback since it's
4096 *	expected to return a static value.
4097 *
4098 * @mgd_prepare_tx: Prepare for transmitting a management frame for association
4099 *	before associated. In multi-channel scenarios, a virtual interface is
4100 *	bound to a channel before it is associated, but as it isn't associated
4101 *	yet it need not necessarily be given airtime, in particular since any
4102 *	transmission to a P2P GO needs to be synchronized against the GO's
4103 *	powersave state. mac80211 will call this function before transmitting a
4104 *	management frame prior to having successfully associated to allow the
4105 *	driver to give it channel time for the transmission, to get a response
4106 *	and to be able to synchronize with the GO.
4107 *	For drivers that set %IEEE80211_HW_DEAUTH_NEED_MGD_TX_PREP, mac80211
4108 *	would also call this function before transmitting a deauthentication
4109 *	frame in case that no beacon was heard from the AP/P2P GO.
4110 *	The callback will be called before each transmission and upon return
4111 *	mac80211 will transmit the frame right away.
4112 *	Additional information is passed in the &struct ieee80211_prep_tx_info
4113 *	data. If duration there is greater than zero, mac80211 hints to the
4114 *	driver the duration for which the operation is requested.
4115 *	The callback is optional and can (should!) sleep.
4116 * @mgd_complete_tx: Notify the driver that the response frame for a previously
4117 *	transmitted frame announced with @mgd_prepare_tx was received, the data
4118 *	is filled similarly to @mgd_prepare_tx though the duration is not used.
4119 *
4120 * @mgd_protect_tdls_discover: Protect a TDLS discovery session. After sending
4121 *	a TDLS discovery-request, we expect a reply to arrive on the AP's
4122 *	channel. We must stay on the channel (no PSM, scan, etc.), since a TDLS
4123 *	setup-response is a direct packet not buffered by the AP.
4124 *	mac80211 will call this function just before the transmission of a TDLS
4125 *	discovery-request. The recommended period of protection is at least
4126 *	2 * (DTIM period).
4127 *	The callback is optional and can sleep.
4128 *
4129 * @add_chanctx: Notifies device driver about new channel context creation.
4130 *	This callback may sleep.
4131 * @remove_chanctx: Notifies device driver about channel context destruction.
4132 *	This callback may sleep.
4133 * @change_chanctx: Notifies device driver about channel context changes that
4134 *	may happen when combining different virtual interfaces on the same
4135 *	channel context with different settings
4136 *	This callback may sleep.
4137 * @assign_vif_chanctx: Notifies device driver about channel context being bound
4138 *	to vif. Possible use is for hw queue remapping.
4139 *	This callback may sleep.
4140 * @unassign_vif_chanctx: Notifies device driver about channel context being
4141 *	unbound from vif.
4142 *	This callback may sleep.
4143 * @switch_vif_chanctx: switch a number of vifs from one chanctx to
4144 *	another, as specified in the list of
4145 *	@ieee80211_vif_chanctx_switch passed to the driver, according
4146 *	to the mode defined in &ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode.
4147 *	This callback may sleep.
4148 *
4149 * @start_ap: Start operation on the AP interface, this is called after all the
4150 *	information in bss_conf is set and beacon can be retrieved. A channel
4151 *	context is bound before this is called. Note that if the driver uses
4152 *	software scan or ROC, this (and @stop_ap) isn't called when the AP is
4153 *	just "paused" for scanning/ROC, which is indicated by the beacon being
4154 *	disabled/enabled via @bss_info_changed.
4155 * @stop_ap: Stop operation on the AP interface.
4156 *
4157 * @reconfig_complete: Called after a call to ieee80211_restart_hw() and
4158 *	during resume, when the reconfiguration has completed.
4159 *	This can help the driver implement the reconfiguration step (and
4160 *	indicate mac80211 is ready to receive frames).
4161 *	This callback may sleep.
4162 *
4163 * @ipv6_addr_change: IPv6 address assignment on the given interface changed.
4164 *	Currently, this is only called for managed or P2P client interfaces.
4165 *	This callback is optional; it must not sleep.
4166 *
4167 * @channel_switch_beacon: Starts a channel switch to a new channel.
4168 *	Beacons are modified to include CSA or ECSA IEs before calling this
4169 *	function. The corresponding count fields in these IEs must be
4170 *	decremented, and when they reach 1 the driver must call
4171 *	ieee80211_csa_finish(). Drivers which use ieee80211_beacon_get()
4172 *	get the csa counter decremented by mac80211, but must check if it is
4173 *	1 using ieee80211_beacon_counter_is_complete() after the beacon has been
4174 *	transmitted and then call ieee80211_csa_finish().
4175 *	If the CSA count starts as zero or 1, this function will not be called,
4176 *	since there won't be any time to beacon before the switch anyway.
4177 * @pre_channel_switch: This is an optional callback that is called
4178 *	before a channel switch procedure is started (ie. when a STA
4179 *	gets a CSA or a userspace initiated channel-switch), allowing
4180 *	the driver to prepare for the channel switch.
4181 * @post_channel_switch: This is an optional callback that is called
4182 *	after a channel switch procedure is completed, allowing the
4183 *	driver to go back to a normal configuration.
4184 * @abort_channel_switch: This is an optional callback that is called
4185 *	when channel switch procedure was completed, allowing the
4186 *	driver to go back to a normal configuration.
4187 * @channel_switch_rx_beacon: This is an optional callback that is called
4188 *	when channel switch procedure is in progress and additional beacon with
4189 *	CSA IE was received, allowing driver to track changes in count.
4190 * @join_ibss: Join an IBSS (on an IBSS interface); this is called after all
4191 *	information in bss_conf is set up and the beacon can be retrieved. A
4192 *	channel context is bound before this is called.
4193 * @leave_ibss: Leave the IBSS again.
4194 *
4195 * @get_expected_throughput: extract the expected throughput towards the
4196 *	specified station. The returned value is expressed in Kbps. It returns 0
4197 *	if the RC algorithm does not have proper data to provide.
4198 *
4199 * @get_txpower: get current maximum tx power (in dBm) based on configuration
4200 *	and hardware limits.
4201 *
4202 * @tdls_channel_switch: Start channel-switching with a TDLS peer. The driver
4203 *	is responsible for continually initiating channel-switching operations
4204 *	and returning to the base channel for communication with the AP. The
4205 *	driver receives a channel-switch request template and the location of
4206 *	the switch-timing IE within the template as part of the invocation.
4207 *	The template is valid only within the call, and the driver can
4208 *	optionally copy the skb for further re-use.
4209 * @tdls_cancel_channel_switch: Stop channel-switching with a TDLS peer. Both
4210 *	peers must be on the base channel when the call completes.
4211 * @tdls_recv_channel_switch: a TDLS channel-switch related frame (request or
4212 *	response) has been received from a remote peer. The driver gets
4213 *	parameters parsed from the incoming frame and may use them to continue
4214 *	an ongoing channel-switch operation. In addition, a channel-switch
4215 *	response template is provided, together with the location of the
4216 *	switch-timing IE within the template. The skb can only be used within
4217 *	the function call.
4218 *
4219 * @wake_tx_queue: Called when new packets have been added to the queue.
4220 * @sync_rx_queues: Process all pending frames in RSS queues. This is a
4221 *	synchronization which is needed in case driver has in its RSS queues
4222 *	pending frames that were received prior to the control path action
4223 *	currently taken (e.g. disassociation) but are not processed yet.
4224 *
4225 * @start_nan: join an existing NAN cluster, or create a new one.
4226 * @stop_nan: leave the NAN cluster.
4227 * @nan_change_conf: change NAN configuration. The data in cfg80211_nan_conf
4228 *	contains full new configuration and changes specify which parameters
4229 *	are changed with respect to the last NAN config.
4230 *	The driver gets both full configuration and the changed parameters since
4231 *	some devices may need the full configuration while others need only the
4232 *	changed parameters.
4233 * @add_nan_func: Add a NAN function. Returns 0 on success. The data in
4234 *	cfg80211_nan_func must not be referenced outside the scope of
4235 *	this call.
4236 * @del_nan_func: Remove a NAN function. The driver must call
4237 *	ieee80211_nan_func_terminated() with
4238 *	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_USER_REQUEST reason code upon removal.
4239 * @can_aggregate_in_amsdu: Called in order to determine if HW supports
4240 *	aggregating two specific frames in the same A-MSDU. The relation
4241 *	between the skbs should be symmetric and transitive. Note that while
4242 *	skb is always a real frame, head may or may not be an A-MSDU.
4243 * @get_ftm_responder_stats: Retrieve FTM responder statistics, if available.
4244 *	Statistics should be cumulative, currently no way to reset is provided.
4245 *
4246 * @start_pmsr: start peer measurement (e.g. FTM) (this call can sleep)
4247 * @abort_pmsr: abort peer measurement (this call can sleep)
4248 * @set_tid_config: Apply TID specific configurations. This callback may sleep.
4249 * @reset_tid_config: Reset TID specific configuration for the peer.
4250 *	This callback may sleep.
4251 * @update_vif_offload: Update virtual interface offload flags
4252 *	This callback may sleep.
4253 * @sta_set_4addr: Called to notify the driver when a station starts/stops using
4254 *	4-address mode
4255 * @set_sar_specs: Update the SAR (TX power) settings.
4256 * @sta_set_decap_offload: Called to notify the driver when a station is allowed
4257 *	to use rx decapsulation offload
4258 * @add_twt_setup: Update hw with TWT agreement parameters received from the peer.
4259 *	This callback allows the hw to check if requested parameters
4260 *	are supported and if there is enough room for a new agreement.
4261 *	The hw is expected to set agreement result in the req_type field of
4262 *	twt structure.
4263 * @twt_teardown_request: Update the hw with TWT teardown request received
4264 *	from the peer.
4265 * @set_radar_background: Configure dedicated offchannel chain available for
4266 *	radar/CAC detection on some hw. This chain can't be used to transmit
4267 *	or receive frames and it is bounded to a running wdev.
4268 *	Background radar/CAC detection allows to avoid the CAC downtime
4269 *	switching to a different channel during CAC detection on the selected
4270 *	radar channel.
4271 *	The caller is expected to set chandef pointer to NULL in order to
4272 *	disable background CAC/radar detection.
4273 * @net_fill_forward_path: Called from .ndo_fill_forward_path in order to
4274 *	resolve a path for hardware flow offloading
4275 * @can_activate_links: Checks if a specific active_links bitmap is
4276 *	supported by the driver.
4277 * @change_vif_links: Change the valid links on an interface, note that while
4278 *	removing the old link information is still valid (link_conf pointer),
4279 *	but may immediately disappear after the function returns. The old or
4280 *	new links bitmaps may be 0 if going from/to a non-MLO situation.
4281 *	The @old array contains pointers to the old bss_conf structures
4282 *	that were already removed, in case they're needed.
4283 *	This callback can sleep.
4284 * @change_sta_links: Change the valid links of a station, similar to
4285 *	@change_vif_links. This callback can sleep.
4286 *	Note that a sta can also be inserted or removed with valid links,
4287 *	i.e. passed to @sta_add/@sta_state with sta->valid_links not zero.
4288 *	In fact, cannot change from having valid_links and not having them.
4289 * @set_hw_timestamp: Enable/disable HW timestamping of TM/FTM frames. This is
4290 *	not restored at HW reset by mac80211 so drivers need to take care of
4291 *	that.
4292 * @net_setup_tc: Called from .ndo_setup_tc in order to prepare hardware
4293 *	flow offloading for flows originating from the vif.
4294 *	Note that the driver must not assume that the vif driver_data is valid
4295 *	at this point, since the callback can be called during netdev teardown.
4296 */
4297struct ieee80211_ops {
4298	void (*tx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4299		   struct ieee80211_tx_control *control,
4300		   struct sk_buff *skb);
4301	int (*start)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4302	void (*stop)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4303#ifdef CONFIG_PM
4304	int (*suspend)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct cfg80211_wowlan *wowlan);
4305	int (*resume)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4306	void (*set_wakeup)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, bool enabled);
4307#endif
4308	int (*add_interface)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4309			     struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4310	int (*change_interface)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4311				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4312				enum nl80211_iftype new_type, bool p2p);
4313	void (*remove_interface)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4314				 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4315	int (*config)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 changed);
4316	void (*bss_info_changed)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4317				 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4318				 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *info,
4319				 u64 changed);
4320	void (*vif_cfg_changed)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4321				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4322				u64 changed);
4323	void (*link_info_changed)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4324				  struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4325				  struct ieee80211_bss_conf *info,
4326				  u64 changed);
4327
4328	int (*start_ap)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4329			struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf);
4330	void (*stop_ap)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4331			struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf);
4332
4333	u64 (*prepare_multicast)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4334				 struct netdev_hw_addr_list *mc_list);
4335	void (*configure_filter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4336				 unsigned int changed_flags,
4337				 unsigned int *total_flags,
4338				 u64 multicast);
4339	void (*config_iface_filter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4340				    struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4341				    unsigned int filter_flags,
4342				    unsigned int changed_flags);
4343	int (*set_tim)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4344		       bool set);
4345	int (*set_key)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, enum set_key_cmd cmd,
4346		       struct ieee80211_vif *vif, struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4347		       struct ieee80211_key_conf *key);
4348	void (*update_tkip_key)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4349				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4350				struct ieee80211_key_conf *conf,
4351				struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4352				u32 iv32, u16 *phase1key);
4353	void (*set_rekey_data)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4354			       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4355			       struct cfg80211_gtk_rekey_data *data);
4356	void (*set_default_unicast_key)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4357					struct ieee80211_vif *vif, int idx);
4358	int (*hw_scan)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4359		       struct ieee80211_scan_request *req);
4360	void (*cancel_hw_scan)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4361			       struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4362	int (*sched_scan_start)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4363				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4364				struct cfg80211_sched_scan_request *req,
4365				struct ieee80211_scan_ies *ies);
4366	int (*sched_scan_stop)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4367			       struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4368	void (*sw_scan_start)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4369			      struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4370			      const u8 *mac_addr);
4371	void (*sw_scan_complete)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4372				 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4373	int (*get_stats)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4374			 struct ieee80211_low_level_stats *stats);
4375	void (*get_key_seq)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4376			    struct ieee80211_key_conf *key,
4377			    struct ieee80211_key_seq *seq);
4378	int (*set_frag_threshold)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 value);
4379	int (*set_rts_threshold)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 value);
4380	int (*sta_add)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4381		       struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4382	int (*sta_remove)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4383			  struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4384#ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS
4385	void (*vif_add_debugfs)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4386				struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4387	void (*link_add_debugfs)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4388				 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4389				 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf,
4390				 struct dentry *dir);
4391	void (*sta_add_debugfs)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4392				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4393				struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4394				struct dentry *dir);
4395	void (*link_sta_add_debugfs)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4396				     struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4397				     struct ieee80211_link_sta *link_sta,
4398				     struct dentry *dir);
4399#endif
4400	void (*sta_notify)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4401			enum sta_notify_cmd, struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4402	int (*sta_set_txpwr)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4403			     struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4404			     struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4405	int (*sta_state)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4406			 struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4407			 enum ieee80211_sta_state old_state,
4408			 enum ieee80211_sta_state new_state);
4409	void (*sta_pre_rcu_remove)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4410				   struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4411				   struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4412	void (*sta_rc_update)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4413			      struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4414			      struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4415			      u32 changed);
4416	void (*sta_rate_tbl_update)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4417				    struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4418				    struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4419	void (*sta_statistics)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4420			       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4421			       struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4422			       struct station_info *sinfo);
4423	int (*conf_tx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4424		       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4425		       unsigned int link_id, u16 ac,
4426		       const struct ieee80211_tx_queue_params *params);
4427	u64 (*get_tsf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4428	void (*set_tsf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4429			u64 tsf);
4430	void (*offset_tsf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4431			   s64 offset);
4432	void (*reset_tsf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4433	int (*tx_last_beacon)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4434
4435	/**
4436	 * @ampdu_action:
4437	 * Perform a certain A-MPDU action.
4438	 * The RA/TID combination determines the destination and TID we want
4439	 * the ampdu action to be performed for. The action is defined through
4440	 * ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action.
4441	 * When the action is set to %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL the driver
4442	 * may neither send aggregates containing more subframes than @buf_size
4443	 * nor send aggregates in a way that lost frames would exceed the
4444	 * buffer size. If just limiting the aggregate size, this would be
4445	 * possible with a buf_size of 8:
4446	 *
4447	 * - ``TX: 1.....7``
4448	 * - ``RX:  2....7`` (lost frame #1)
4449	 * - ``TX:        8..1...``
4450	 *
4451	 * which is invalid since #1 was now re-transmitted well past the
4452	 * buffer size of 8. Correct ways to retransmit #1 would be:
4453	 *
4454	 * - ``TX:        1   or``
4455	 * - ``TX:        18  or``
4456	 * - ``TX:        81``
4457	 *
4458	 * Even ``189`` would be wrong since 1 could be lost again.
4459	 *
4460	 * Returns a negative error code on failure. The driver may return
4461	 * %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START_IMMEDIATE for %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START
4462	 * if the session can start immediately.
4463	 *
4464	 * The callback can sleep.
4465	 */
4466	int (*ampdu_action)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4467			    struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4468			    struct ieee80211_ampdu_params *params);
4469	int (*get_survey)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int idx,
4470		struct survey_info *survey);
4471	void (*rfkill_poll)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4472	void (*set_coverage_class)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, s16 coverage_class);
4473#ifdef CONFIG_NL80211_TESTMODE
4474	int (*testmode_cmd)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4475			    void *data, int len);
4476	int (*testmode_dump)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct sk_buff *skb,
4477			     struct netlink_callback *cb,
4478			     void *data, int len);
4479#endif
4480	void (*flush)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4481		      u32 queues, bool drop);
4482	void (*flush_sta)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4483			  struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4484	void (*channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4485			       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4486			       struct ieee80211_channel_switch *ch_switch);
4487	int (*set_antenna)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 tx_ant, u32 rx_ant);
4488	int (*get_antenna)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 *tx_ant, u32 *rx_ant);
4489
4490	int (*remain_on_channel)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4491				 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4492				 struct ieee80211_channel *chan,
4493				 int duration,
4494				 enum ieee80211_roc_type type);
4495	int (*cancel_remain_on_channel)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4496					struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4497	int (*set_ringparam)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 tx, u32 rx);
4498	void (*get_ringparam)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4499			      u32 *tx, u32 *tx_max, u32 *rx, u32 *rx_max);
4500	bool (*tx_frames_pending)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4501	int (*set_bitrate_mask)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4502				const struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask *mask);
4503	void (*event_callback)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4504			       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4505			       const struct ieee80211_event *event);
4506
4507	void (*allow_buffered_frames)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4508				      struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4509				      u16 tids, int num_frames,
4510				      enum ieee80211_frame_release_type reason,
4511				      bool more_data);
4512	void (*release_buffered_frames)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4513					struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4514					u16 tids, int num_frames,
4515					enum ieee80211_frame_release_type reason,
4516					bool more_data);
4517
4518	int	(*get_et_sset_count)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4519				     struct ieee80211_vif *vif, int sset);
4520	void	(*get_et_stats)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4521				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4522				struct ethtool_stats *stats, u64 *data);
4523	void	(*get_et_strings)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4524				  struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4525				  u32 sset, u8 *data);
4526
4527	void	(*mgd_prepare_tx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4528				  struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4529				  struct ieee80211_prep_tx_info *info);
4530	void	(*mgd_complete_tx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4531				   struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4532				   struct ieee80211_prep_tx_info *info);
4533
4534	void	(*mgd_protect_tdls_discover)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4535					     struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4536					     unsigned int link_id);
4537
4538	int (*add_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4539			   struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx);
4540	void (*remove_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4541			       struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx);
4542	void (*change_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4543			       struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx,
4544			       u32 changed);
4545	int (*assign_vif_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4546				  struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4547				  struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf,
4548				  struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx);
4549	void (*unassign_vif_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4550				     struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4551				     struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf,
4552				     struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx);
4553	int (*switch_vif_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4554				  struct ieee80211_vif_chanctx_switch *vifs,
4555				  int n_vifs,
4556				  enum ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode mode);
4557
4558	void (*reconfig_complete)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4559				  enum ieee80211_reconfig_type reconfig_type);
4560
4561#if IS_ENABLED(CONFIG_IPV6)
4562	void (*ipv6_addr_change)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4563				 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4564				 struct inet6_dev *idev);
4565#endif
4566	void (*channel_switch_beacon)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4567				      struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4568				      struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
4569	int (*pre_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4570				  struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4571				  struct ieee80211_channel_switch *ch_switch);
4572
4573	int (*post_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4574				   struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4575				   struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf);
4576	void (*abort_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4577				     struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4578	void (*channel_switch_rx_beacon)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4579					 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4580					 struct ieee80211_channel_switch *ch_switch);
4581
4582	int (*join_ibss)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4583	void (*leave_ibss)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4584	u32 (*get_expected_throughput)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4585				       struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4586	int (*get_txpower)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4587			   int *dbm);
4588
4589	int (*tdls_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4590				   struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4591				   struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 oper_class,
4592				   struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
4593				   struct sk_buff *tmpl_skb, u32 ch_sw_tm_ie);
4594	void (*tdls_cancel_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4595					   struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4596					   struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4597	void (*tdls_recv_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4598					 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4599					 struct ieee80211_tdls_ch_sw_params *params);
4600
4601	void (*wake_tx_queue)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4602			      struct ieee80211_txq *txq);
4603	void (*sync_rx_queues)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4604
4605	int (*start_nan)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4606			 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4607			 struct cfg80211_nan_conf *conf);
4608	int (*stop_nan)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4609			struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4610	int (*nan_change_conf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4611			       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4612			       struct cfg80211_nan_conf *conf, u32 changes);
4613	int (*add_nan_func)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4614			    struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4615			    const struct cfg80211_nan_func *nan_func);
4616	void (*del_nan_func)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4617			    struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4618			    u8 instance_id);
4619	bool (*can_aggregate_in_amsdu)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4620				       struct sk_buff *head,
4621				       struct sk_buff *skb);
4622	int (*get_ftm_responder_stats)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4623				       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4624				       struct cfg80211_ftm_responder_stats *ftm_stats);
4625	int (*start_pmsr)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4626			  struct cfg80211_pmsr_request *request);
4627	void (*abort_pmsr)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4628			   struct cfg80211_pmsr_request *request);
4629	int (*set_tid_config)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4630			      struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4631			      struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4632			      struct cfg80211_tid_config *tid_conf);
4633	int (*reset_tid_config)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4634				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4635				struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 tids);
4636	void (*update_vif_offload)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4637				   struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4638	void (*sta_set_4addr)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4639			      struct ieee80211_sta *sta, bool enabled);
4640	int (*set_sar_specs)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4641			     const struct cfg80211_sar_specs *sar);
4642	void (*sta_set_decap_offload)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4643				      struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4644				      struct ieee80211_sta *sta, bool enabled);
4645	void (*add_twt_setup)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4646			      struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4647			      struct ieee80211_twt_setup *twt);
4648	void (*twt_teardown_request)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4649				     struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 flowid);
4650	int (*set_radar_background)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4651				    struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
4652	int (*net_fill_forward_path)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4653				     struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4654				     struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4655				     struct net_device_path_ctx *ctx,
4656				     struct net_device_path *path);
4657	bool (*can_activate_links)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4658				   struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4659				   u16 active_links);
4660	int (*change_vif_links)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4661				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4662				u16 old_links, u16 new_links,
4663				struct ieee80211_bss_conf *old[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS]);
4664	int (*change_sta_links)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4665				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4666				struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4667				u16 old_links, u16 new_links);
4668	int (*set_hw_timestamp)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4669				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4670				struct cfg80211_set_hw_timestamp *hwts);
4671	int (*net_setup_tc)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4672			    struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4673			    struct net_device *dev,
4674			    enum tc_setup_type type,
4675			    void *type_data);
4676};
4677
4678/**
4679 * ieee80211_alloc_hw_nm - Allocate a new hardware device
4680 *
4681 * This must be called once for each hardware device. The returned pointer
4682 * must be used to refer to this device when calling other functions.
4683 * mac80211 allocates a private data area for the driver pointed to by
4684 * @priv in &struct ieee80211_hw, the size of this area is given as
4685 * @priv_data_len.
4686 *
4687 * @priv_data_len: length of private data
4688 * @ops: callbacks for this device
4689 * @requested_name: Requested name for this device.
4690 *	NULL is valid value, and means use the default naming (phy%d)
4691 *
4692 * Return: A pointer to the new hardware device, or %NULL on error.
4693 */
4694struct ieee80211_hw *ieee80211_alloc_hw_nm(size_t priv_data_len,
4695					   const struct ieee80211_ops *ops,
4696					   const char *requested_name);
4697
4698/**
4699 * ieee80211_alloc_hw - Allocate a new hardware device
4700 *
4701 * This must be called once for each hardware device. The returned pointer
4702 * must be used to refer to this device when calling other functions.
4703 * mac80211 allocates a private data area for the driver pointed to by
4704 * @priv in &struct ieee80211_hw, the size of this area is given as
4705 * @priv_data_len.
4706 *
4707 * @priv_data_len: length of private data
4708 * @ops: callbacks for this device
4709 *
4710 * Return: A pointer to the new hardware device, or %NULL on error.
4711 */
4712static inline
4713struct ieee80211_hw *ieee80211_alloc_hw(size_t priv_data_len,
4714					const struct ieee80211_ops *ops)
4715{
4716	return ieee80211_alloc_hw_nm(priv_data_len, ops, NULL);
4717}
4718
4719/**
4720 * ieee80211_register_hw - Register hardware device
4721 *
4722 * You must call this function before any other functions in
4723 * mac80211. Note that before a hardware can be registered, you
4724 * need to fill the contained wiphy's information.
4725 *
4726 * @hw: the device to register as returned by ieee80211_alloc_hw()
4727 *
4728 * Return: 0 on success. An error code otherwise.
4729 */
4730int ieee80211_register_hw(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4731
4732/**
4733 * struct ieee80211_tpt_blink - throughput blink description
4734 * @throughput: throughput in Kbit/sec
4735 * @blink_time: blink time in milliseconds
4736 *	(full cycle, ie. one off + one on period)
4737 */
4738struct ieee80211_tpt_blink {
4739	int throughput;
4740	int blink_time;
4741};
4742
4743/**
4744 * enum ieee80211_tpt_led_trigger_flags - throughput trigger flags
4745 * @IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_RADIO: enable blinking with radio
4746 * @IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_WORK: enable blinking when working
4747 * @IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_CONNECTED: enable blinking when at least one
4748 *	interface is connected in some way, including being an AP
4749 */
4750enum ieee80211_tpt_led_trigger_flags {
4751	IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_RADIO		= BIT(0),
4752	IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_WORK		= BIT(1),
4753	IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_CONNECTED	= BIT(2),
4754};
4755
4756#ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
4757const char *__ieee80211_get_tx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4758const char *__ieee80211_get_rx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4759const char *__ieee80211_get_assoc_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4760const char *__ieee80211_get_radio_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4761const char *
4762__ieee80211_create_tpt_led_trigger(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4763				   unsigned int flags,
4764				   const struct ieee80211_tpt_blink *blink_table,
4765				   unsigned int blink_table_len);
4766#endif
4767/**
4768 * ieee80211_get_tx_led_name - get name of TX LED
4769 *
4770 * mac80211 creates a transmit LED trigger for each wireless hardware
4771 * that can be used to drive LEDs if your driver registers a LED device.
4772 * This function returns the name (or %NULL if not configured for LEDs)
4773 * of the trigger so you can automatically link the LED device.
4774 *
4775 * @hw: the hardware to get the LED trigger name for
4776 *
4777 * Return: The name of the LED trigger. %NULL if not configured for LEDs.
4778 */
4779static inline const char *ieee80211_get_tx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw)
4780{
4781#ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
4782	return __ieee80211_get_tx_led_name(hw);
4783#else
4784	return NULL;
4785#endif
4786}
4787
4788/**
4789 * ieee80211_get_rx_led_name - get name of RX LED
4790 *
4791 * mac80211 creates a receive LED trigger for each wireless hardware
4792 * that can be used to drive LEDs if your driver registers a LED device.
4793 * This function returns the name (or %NULL if not configured for LEDs)
4794 * of the trigger so you can automatically link the LED device.
4795 *
4796 * @hw: the hardware to get the LED trigger name for
4797 *
4798 * Return: The name of the LED trigger. %NULL if not configured for LEDs.
4799 */
4800static inline const char *ieee80211_get_rx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw)
4801{
4802#ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
4803	return __ieee80211_get_rx_led_name(hw);
4804#else
4805	return NULL;
4806#endif
4807}
4808
4809/**
4810 * ieee80211_get_assoc_led_name - get name of association LED
4811 *
4812 * mac80211 creates a association LED trigger for each wireless hardware
4813 * that can be used to drive LEDs if your driver registers a LED device.
4814 * This function returns the name (or %NULL if not configured for LEDs)
4815 * of the trigger so you can automatically link the LED device.
4816 *
4817 * @hw: the hardware to get the LED trigger name for
4818 *
4819 * Return: The name of the LED trigger. %NULL if not configured for LEDs.
4820 */
4821static inline const char *ieee80211_get_assoc_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw)
4822{
4823#ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
4824	return __ieee80211_get_assoc_led_name(hw);
4825#else
4826	return NULL;
4827#endif
4828}
4829
4830/**
4831 * ieee80211_get_radio_led_name - get name of radio LED
4832 *
4833 * mac80211 creates a radio change LED trigger for each wireless hardware
4834 * that can be used to drive LEDs if your driver registers a LED device.
4835 * This function returns the name (or %NULL if not configured for LEDs)
4836 * of the trigger so you can automatically link the LED device.
4837 *
4838 * @hw: the hardware to get the LED trigger name for
4839 *
4840 * Return: The name of the LED trigger. %NULL if not configured for LEDs.
4841 */
4842static inline const char *ieee80211_get_radio_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw)
4843{
4844#ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
4845	return __ieee80211_get_radio_led_name(hw);
4846#else
4847	return NULL;
4848#endif
4849}
4850
4851/**
4852 * ieee80211_create_tpt_led_trigger - create throughput LED trigger
4853 * @hw: the hardware to create the trigger for
4854 * @flags: trigger flags, see &enum ieee80211_tpt_led_trigger_flags
4855 * @blink_table: the blink table -- needs to be ordered by throughput
4856 * @blink_table_len: size of the blink table
4857 *
4858 * Return: %NULL (in case of error, or if no LED triggers are
4859 * configured) or the name of the new trigger.
4860 *
4861 * Note: This function must be called before ieee80211_register_hw().
4862 */
4863static inline const char *
4864ieee80211_create_tpt_led_trigger(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, unsigned int flags,
4865				 const struct ieee80211_tpt_blink *blink_table,
4866				 unsigned int blink_table_len)
4867{
4868#ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
4869	return __ieee80211_create_tpt_led_trigger(hw, flags, blink_table,
4870						  blink_table_len);
4871#else
4872	return NULL;
4873#endif
4874}
4875
4876/**
4877 * ieee80211_unregister_hw - Unregister a hardware device
4878 *
4879 * This function instructs mac80211 to free allocated resources
4880 * and unregister netdevices from the networking subsystem.
4881 *
4882 * @hw: the hardware to unregister
4883 */
4884void ieee80211_unregister_hw(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4885
4886/**
4887 * ieee80211_free_hw - free hardware descriptor
4888 *
4889 * This function frees everything that was allocated, including the
4890 * private data for the driver. You must call ieee80211_unregister_hw()
4891 * before calling this function.
4892 *
4893 * @hw: the hardware to free
4894 */
4895void ieee80211_free_hw(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4896
4897/**
4898 * ieee80211_restart_hw - restart hardware completely
4899 *
4900 * Call this function when the hardware was restarted for some reason
4901 * (hardware error, ...) and the driver is unable to restore its state
4902 * by itself. mac80211 assumes that at this point the driver/hardware
4903 * is completely uninitialised and stopped, it starts the process by
4904 * calling the ->start() operation. The driver will need to reset all
4905 * internal state that it has prior to calling this function.
4906 *
4907 * @hw: the hardware to restart
4908 */
4909void ieee80211_restart_hw(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4910
4911/**
4912 * ieee80211_rx_list - receive frame and store processed skbs in a list
4913 *
4914 * Use this function to hand received frames to mac80211. The receive
4915 * buffer in @skb must start with an IEEE 802.11 header. In case of a
4916 * paged @skb is used, the driver is recommended to put the ieee80211
4917 * header of the frame on the linear part of the @skb to avoid memory
4918 * allocation and/or memcpy by the stack.
4919 *
4920 * This function may not be called in IRQ context. Calls to this function
4921 * for a single hardware must be synchronized against each other. Calls to
4922 * this function, ieee80211_rx_ni() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() may not be
4923 * mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with
4924 * ieee80211_tx_status_skb() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni().
4925 *
4926 * This function must be called with BHs disabled and RCU read lock
4927 *
4928 * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on
4929 * @sta: the station the frame was received from, or %NULL
4930 * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call
4931 * @list: the destination list
4932 */
4933void ieee80211_rx_list(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4934		       struct sk_buff *skb, struct list_head *list);
4935
4936/**
4937 * ieee80211_rx_napi - receive frame from NAPI context
4938 *
4939 * Use this function to hand received frames to mac80211. The receive
4940 * buffer in @skb must start with an IEEE 802.11 header. In case of a
4941 * paged @skb is used, the driver is recommended to put the ieee80211
4942 * header of the frame on the linear part of the @skb to avoid memory
4943 * allocation and/or memcpy by the stack.
4944 *
4945 * This function may not be called in IRQ context. Calls to this function
4946 * for a single hardware must be synchronized against each other. Calls to
4947 * this function, ieee80211_rx_ni() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() may not be
4948 * mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with
4949 * ieee80211_tx_status_skb() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni().
4950 *
4951 * This function must be called with BHs disabled.
4952 *
4953 * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on
4954 * @sta: the station the frame was received from, or %NULL
4955 * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call
4956 * @napi: the NAPI context
4957 */
4958void ieee80211_rx_napi(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4959		       struct sk_buff *skb, struct napi_struct *napi);
4960
4961/**
4962 * ieee80211_rx - receive frame
4963 *
4964 * Use this function to hand received frames to mac80211. The receive
4965 * buffer in @skb must start with an IEEE 802.11 header. In case of a
4966 * paged @skb is used, the driver is recommended to put the ieee80211
4967 * header of the frame on the linear part of the @skb to avoid memory
4968 * allocation and/or memcpy by the stack.
4969 *
4970 * This function may not be called in IRQ context. Calls to this function
4971 * for a single hardware must be synchronized against each other. Calls to
4972 * this function, ieee80211_rx_ni() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() may not be
4973 * mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with
4974 * ieee80211_tx_status_skb() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni().
4975 *
4976 * In process context use instead ieee80211_rx_ni().
4977 *
4978 * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on
4979 * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call
4980 */
4981static inline void ieee80211_rx(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct sk_buff *skb)
4982{
4983	ieee80211_rx_napi(hw, NULL, skb, NULL);
4984}
4985
4986/**
4987 * ieee80211_rx_irqsafe - receive frame
4988 *
4989 * Like ieee80211_rx() but can be called in IRQ context
4990 * (internally defers to a tasklet.)
4991 *
4992 * Calls to this function, ieee80211_rx() or ieee80211_rx_ni() may not
4993 * be mixed for a single hardware.Must not run concurrently with
4994 * ieee80211_tx_status_skb() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni().
4995 *
4996 * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on
4997 * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call
4998 */
4999void ieee80211_rx_irqsafe(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct sk_buff *skb);
5000
5001/**
5002 * ieee80211_rx_ni - receive frame (in process context)
5003 *
5004 * Like ieee80211_rx() but can be called in process context
5005 * (internally disables bottom halves).
5006 *
5007 * Calls to this function, ieee80211_rx() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() may
5008 * not be mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with
5009 * ieee80211_tx_status_skb() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni().
5010 *
5011 * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on
5012 * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call
5013 */
5014static inline void ieee80211_rx_ni(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5015				   struct sk_buff *skb)
5016{
5017	local_bh_disable();
5018	ieee80211_rx(hw, skb);
5019	local_bh_enable();
5020}
5021
5022/**
5023 * ieee80211_sta_ps_transition - PS transition for connected sta
5024 *
5025 * When operating in AP mode with the %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS
5026 * flag set, use this function to inform mac80211 about a connected station
5027 * entering/leaving PS mode.
5028 *
5029 * This function may not be called in IRQ context or with softirqs enabled.
5030 *
5031 * Calls to this function for a single hardware must be synchronized against
5032 * each other.
5033 *
5034 * @sta: currently connected sta
5035 * @start: start or stop PS
5036 *
5037 * Return: 0 on success. -EINVAL when the requested PS mode is already set.
5038 */
5039int ieee80211_sta_ps_transition(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, bool start);
5040
5041/**
5042 * ieee80211_sta_ps_transition_ni - PS transition for connected sta
5043 *                                  (in process context)
5044 *
5045 * Like ieee80211_sta_ps_transition() but can be called in process context
5046 * (internally disables bottom halves). Concurrent call restriction still
5047 * applies.
5048 *
5049 * @sta: currently connected sta
5050 * @start: start or stop PS
5051 *
5052 * Return: Like ieee80211_sta_ps_transition().
5053 */
5054static inline int ieee80211_sta_ps_transition_ni(struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
5055						  bool start)
5056{
5057	int ret;
5058
5059	local_bh_disable();
5060	ret = ieee80211_sta_ps_transition(sta, start);
5061	local_bh_enable();
5062
5063	return ret;
5064}
5065
5066/**
5067 * ieee80211_sta_pspoll - PS-Poll frame received
5068 * @sta: currently connected station
5069 *
5070 * When operating in AP mode with the %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS flag set,
5071 * use this function to inform mac80211 that a PS-Poll frame from a
5072 * connected station was received.
5073 * This must be used in conjunction with ieee80211_sta_ps_transition()
5074 * and possibly ieee80211_sta_uapsd_trigger(); calls to all three must
5075 * be serialized.
5076 */
5077void ieee80211_sta_pspoll(struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
5078
5079/**
5080 * ieee80211_sta_uapsd_trigger - (potential) U-APSD trigger frame received
5081 * @sta: currently connected station
5082 * @tid: TID of the received (potential) trigger frame
5083 *
5084 * When operating in AP mode with the %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS flag set,
5085 * use this function to inform mac80211 that a (potential) trigger frame
5086 * from a connected station was received.
5087 * This must be used in conjunction with ieee80211_sta_ps_transition()
5088 * and possibly ieee80211_sta_pspoll(); calls to all three must be
5089 * serialized.
5090 * %IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS can be passed as the tid if the tid is unknown.
5091 * In this case, mac80211 will not check that this tid maps to an AC
5092 * that is trigger enabled and assume that the caller did the proper
5093 * checks.
5094 */
5095void ieee80211_sta_uapsd_trigger(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 tid);
5096
5097/*
5098 * The TX headroom reserved by mac80211 for its own tx_status functions.
5099 * This is enough for the radiotap header.
5100 */
5101#define IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_HEADROOM	ALIGN(14, 4)
5102
5103/**
5104 * ieee80211_sta_set_buffered - inform mac80211 about driver-buffered frames
5105 * @sta: &struct ieee80211_sta pointer for the sleeping station
5106 * @tid: the TID that has buffered frames
5107 * @buffered: indicates whether or not frames are buffered for this TID
5108 *
5109 * If a driver buffers frames for a powersave station instead of passing
5110 * them back to mac80211 for retransmission, the station may still need
5111 * to be told that there are buffered frames via the TIM bit.
5112 *
5113 * This function informs mac80211 whether or not there are frames that are
5114 * buffered in the driver for a given TID; mac80211 can then use this data
5115 * to set the TIM bit (NOTE: This may call back into the driver's set_tim
5116 * call! Beware of the locking!)
5117 *
5118 * If all frames are released to the station (due to PS-poll or uAPSD)
5119 * then the driver needs to inform mac80211 that there no longer are
5120 * frames buffered. However, when the station wakes up mac80211 assumes
5121 * that all buffered frames will be transmitted and clears this data,
5122 * drivers need to make sure they inform mac80211 about all buffered
5123 * frames on the sleep transition (sta_notify() with %STA_NOTIFY_SLEEP).
5124 *
5125 * Note that technically mac80211 only needs to know this per AC, not per
5126 * TID, but since driver buffering will inevitably happen per TID (since
5127 * it is related to aggregation) it is easier to make mac80211 map the
5128 * TID to the AC as required instead of keeping track in all drivers that
5129 * use this API.
5130 */
5131void ieee80211_sta_set_buffered(struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
5132				u8 tid, bool buffered);
5133
5134/**
5135 * ieee80211_get_tx_rates - get the selected transmit rates for a packet
5136 *
5137 * Call this function in a driver with per-packet rate selection support
5138 * to combine the rate info in the packet tx info with the most recent
5139 * rate selection table for the station entry.
5140 *
5141 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5142 * @sta: the receiver station to which this packet is sent.
5143 * @skb: the frame to be transmitted.
5144 * @dest: buffer for extracted rate/retry information
5145 * @max_rates: maximum number of rates to fetch
5146 */
5147void ieee80211_get_tx_rates(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5148			    struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
5149			    struct sk_buff *skb,
5150			    struct ieee80211_tx_rate *dest,
5151			    int max_rates);
5152
5153/**
5154 * ieee80211_sta_set_expected_throughput - set the expected tpt for a station
5155 *
5156 * Call this function to notify mac80211 about a change in expected throughput
5157 * to a station. A driver for a device that does rate control in firmware can
5158 * call this function when the expected throughput estimate towards a station
5159 * changes. The information is used to tune the CoDel AQM applied to traffic
5160 * going towards that station (which can otherwise be too aggressive and cause
5161 * slow stations to starve).
5162 *
5163 * @pubsta: the station to set throughput for.
5164 * @thr: the current expected throughput in kbps.
5165 */
5166void ieee80211_sta_set_expected_throughput(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta,
5167					   u32 thr);
5168
5169/**
5170 * ieee80211_tx_rate_update - transmit rate update callback
5171 *
5172 * Drivers should call this functions with a non-NULL pub sta
5173 * This function can be used in drivers that does not have provision
5174 * in updating the tx rate in data path.
5175 *
5176 * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
5177 * @pubsta: the station to update the tx rate for.
5178 * @info: tx status information
5179 */
5180void ieee80211_tx_rate_update(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5181			      struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta,
5182			      struct ieee80211_tx_info *info);
5183
5184/**
5185 * ieee80211_tx_status_skb - transmit status callback
5186 *
5187 * Call this function for all transmitted frames after they have been
5188 * transmitted. It is permissible to not call this function for
5189 * multicast frames but this can affect statistics.
5190 *
5191 * This function may not be called in IRQ context. Calls to this function
5192 * for a single hardware must be synchronized against each other. Calls
5193 * to this function, ieee80211_tx_status_ni() and ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe()
5194 * may not be mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with
5195 * ieee80211_rx() or ieee80211_rx_ni().
5196 *
5197 * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
5198 * @skb: the frame that was transmitted, owned by mac80211 after this call
5199 */
5200void ieee80211_tx_status_skb(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5201			     struct sk_buff *skb);
5202
5203/**
5204 * ieee80211_tx_status_ext - extended transmit status callback
5205 *
5206 * This function can be used as a replacement for ieee80211_tx_status_skb()
5207 * in drivers that may want to provide extra information that does not
5208 * fit into &struct ieee80211_tx_info.
5209 *
5210 * Calls to this function for a single hardware must be synchronized
5211 * against each other. Calls to this function, ieee80211_tx_status_ni()
5212 * and ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe() may not be mixed for a single hardware.
5213 *
5214 * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
5215 * @status: tx status information
5216 */
5217void ieee80211_tx_status_ext(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5218			     struct ieee80211_tx_status *status);
5219
5220/**
5221 * ieee80211_tx_status_noskb - transmit status callback without skb
5222 *
5223 * This function can be used as a replacement for ieee80211_tx_status_skb()
5224 * in drivers that cannot reliably map tx status information back to
5225 * specific skbs.
5226 *
5227 * Calls to this function for a single hardware must be synchronized
5228 * against each other. Calls to this function, ieee80211_tx_status_ni()
5229 * and ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe() may not be mixed for a single hardware.
5230 *
5231 * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
5232 * @sta: the receiver station to which this packet is sent
5233 *	(NULL for multicast packets)
5234 * @info: tx status information
5235 */
5236static inline void ieee80211_tx_status_noskb(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5237					     struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
5238					     struct ieee80211_tx_info *info)
5239{
5240	struct ieee80211_tx_status status = {
5241		.sta = sta,
5242		.info = info,
5243	};
5244
5245	ieee80211_tx_status_ext(hw, &status);
5246}
5247
5248/**
5249 * ieee80211_tx_status_ni - transmit status callback (in process context)
5250 *
5251 * Like ieee80211_tx_status_skb() but can be called in process context.
5252 *
5253 * Calls to this function, ieee80211_tx_status_skb() and
5254 * ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe() may not be mixed
5255 * for a single hardware.
5256 *
5257 * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
5258 * @skb: the frame that was transmitted, owned by mac80211 after this call
5259 */
5260static inline void ieee80211_tx_status_ni(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5261					  struct sk_buff *skb)
5262{
5263	local_bh_disable();
5264	ieee80211_tx_status_skb(hw, skb);
5265	local_bh_enable();
5266}
5267
5268/**
5269 * ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe - IRQ-safe transmit status callback
5270 *
5271 * Like ieee80211_tx_status_skb() but can be called in IRQ context
5272 * (internally defers to a tasklet.)
5273 *
5274 * Calls to this function, ieee80211_tx_status_skb() and
5275 * ieee80211_tx_status_ni() may not be mixed for a single hardware.
5276 *
5277 * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
5278 * @skb: the frame that was transmitted, owned by mac80211 after this call
5279 */
5280void ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5281				 struct sk_buff *skb);
5282
5283/**
5284 * ieee80211_report_low_ack - report non-responding station
5285 *
5286 * When operating in AP-mode, call this function to report a non-responding
5287 * connected STA.
5288 *
5289 * @sta: the non-responding connected sta
5290 * @num_packets: number of packets sent to @sta without a response
5291 */
5292void ieee80211_report_low_ack(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u32 num_packets);
5293
5294#define IEEE80211_MAX_CNTDWN_COUNTERS_NUM 2
5295
5296/**
5297 * struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets - mutable beacon offsets
5298 * @tim_offset: position of TIM element
5299 * @tim_length: size of TIM element
5300 * @cntdwn_counter_offs: array of IEEE80211_MAX_CNTDWN_COUNTERS_NUM offsets
5301 *	to countdown counters.  This array can contain zero values which
5302 *	should be ignored.
5303 * @mbssid_off: position of the multiple bssid element
5304 */
5305struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets {
5306	u16 tim_offset;
5307	u16 tim_length;
5308
5309	u16 cntdwn_counter_offs[IEEE80211_MAX_CNTDWN_COUNTERS_NUM];
5310	u16 mbssid_off;
5311};
5312
5313/**
5314 * ieee80211_beacon_get_template - beacon template generation function
5315 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5316 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5317 * @offs: &struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets pointer to struct that will
5318 *	receive the offsets that may be updated by the driver.
5319 * @link_id: the link id to which the beacon belongs (or 0 for an AP STA
5320 *	that is not associated with AP MLD).
5321 *
5322 * If the driver implements beaconing modes, it must use this function to
5323 * obtain the beacon template.
5324 *
5325 * This function should be used if the beacon frames are generated by the
5326 * device, and then the driver must use the returned beacon as the template
5327 * The driver or the device are responsible to update the DTIM and, when
5328 * applicable, the CSA count.
5329 *
5330 * The driver is responsible for freeing the returned skb.
5331 *
5332 * Return: The beacon template. %NULL on error.
5333 */
5334struct sk_buff *
5335ieee80211_beacon_get_template(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5336			      struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5337			      struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets *offs,
5338			      unsigned int link_id);
5339
5340/**
5341 * ieee80211_beacon_get_template_ema_index - EMA beacon template generation
5342 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5343 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5344 * @offs: &struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets pointer to struct that will
5345 *	receive the offsets that may be updated by the driver.
5346 * @link_id: the link id to which the beacon belongs (or 0 for a non-MLD AP).
5347 * @ema_index: index of the beacon in the EMA set.
5348 *
5349 * This function follows the same rules as ieee80211_beacon_get_template()
5350 * but returns a beacon template which includes multiple BSSID element at the
5351 * requested index.
5352 *
5353 * Return: The beacon template. %NULL indicates the end of EMA templates.
5354 */
5355struct sk_buff *
5356ieee80211_beacon_get_template_ema_index(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5357					struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5358					struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets *offs,
5359					unsigned int link_id, u8 ema_index);
5360
5361/**
5362 * struct ieee80211_ema_beacons - List of EMA beacons
5363 * @cnt: count of EMA beacons.
5364 *
5365 * @bcn: array of EMA beacons.
5366 * @bcn.skb: the skb containing this specific beacon
5367 * @bcn.offs: &struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets pointer to struct that will
5368 *	receive the offsets that may be updated by the driver.
5369 */
5370struct ieee80211_ema_beacons {
5371	u8 cnt;
5372	struct {
5373		struct sk_buff *skb;
5374		struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets offs;
5375	} bcn[];
5376};
5377
5378/**
5379 * ieee80211_beacon_get_template_ema_list - EMA beacon template generation
5380 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5381 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5382 * @link_id: the link id to which the beacon belongs (or 0 for a non-MLD AP)
5383 *
5384 * This function follows the same rules as ieee80211_beacon_get_template()
5385 * but allocates and returns a pointer to list of all beacon templates required
5386 * to cover all profiles in the multiple BSSID set. Each template includes only
5387 * one multiple BSSID element.
5388 *
5389 * Driver must call ieee80211_beacon_free_ema_list() to free the memory.
5390 *
5391 * Return: EMA beacon templates of type struct ieee80211_ema_beacons *.
5392 *	%NULL on error.
5393 */
5394struct ieee80211_ema_beacons *
5395ieee80211_beacon_get_template_ema_list(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5396				       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5397				       unsigned int link_id);
5398
5399/**
5400 * ieee80211_beacon_free_ema_list - free an EMA beacon template list
5401 * @ema_beacons: list of EMA beacons of type &struct ieee80211_ema_beacons pointers.
5402 *
5403 * This function will free a list previously acquired by calling
5404 * ieee80211_beacon_get_template_ema_list()
5405 */
5406void ieee80211_beacon_free_ema_list(struct ieee80211_ema_beacons *ema_beacons);
5407
5408/**
5409 * ieee80211_beacon_get_tim - beacon generation function
5410 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5411 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5412 * @tim_offset: pointer to variable that will receive the TIM IE offset.
5413 *	Set to 0 if invalid (in non-AP modes).
5414 * @tim_length: pointer to variable that will receive the TIM IE length,
5415 *	(including the ID and length bytes!).
5416 *	Set to 0 if invalid (in non-AP modes).
5417 * @link_id: the link id to which the beacon belongs (or 0 for an AP STA
5418 *	that is not associated with AP MLD).
5419 *
5420 * If the driver implements beaconing modes, it must use this function to
5421 * obtain the beacon frame.
5422 *
5423 * If the beacon frames are generated by the host system (i.e., not in
5424 * hardware/firmware), the driver uses this function to get each beacon
5425 * frame from mac80211 -- it is responsible for calling this function exactly
5426 * once before the beacon is needed (e.g. based on hardware interrupt).
5427 *
5428 * The driver is responsible for freeing the returned skb.
5429 *
5430 * Return: The beacon template. %NULL on error.
5431 */
5432struct sk_buff *ieee80211_beacon_get_tim(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5433					 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5434					 u16 *tim_offset, u16 *tim_length,
5435					 unsigned int link_id);
5436
5437/**
5438 * ieee80211_beacon_get - beacon generation function
5439 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5440 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5441 * @link_id: the link id to which the beacon belongs (or 0 for an AP STA
5442 *	that is not associated with AP MLD).
5443 *
5444 * See ieee80211_beacon_get_tim().
5445 *
5446 * Return: See ieee80211_beacon_get_tim().
5447 */
5448static inline struct sk_buff *ieee80211_beacon_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5449						   struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5450						   unsigned int link_id)
5451{
5452	return ieee80211_beacon_get_tim(hw, vif, NULL, NULL, link_id);
5453}
5454
5455/**
5456 * ieee80211_beacon_update_cntdwn - request mac80211 to decrement the beacon countdown
5457 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5458 *
5459 * The beacon counter should be updated after each beacon transmission.
5460 * This function is called implicitly when
5461 * ieee80211_beacon_get/ieee80211_beacon_get_tim are called, however if the
5462 * beacon frames are generated by the device, the driver should call this
5463 * function after each beacon transmission to sync mac80211's beacon countdown.
5464 *
5465 * Return: new countdown value
5466 */
5467u8 ieee80211_beacon_update_cntdwn(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
5468
5469/**
5470 * ieee80211_beacon_set_cntdwn - request mac80211 to set beacon countdown
5471 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5472 * @counter: the new value for the counter
5473 *
5474 * The beacon countdown can be changed by the device, this API should be
5475 * used by the device driver to update csa counter in mac80211.
5476 *
5477 * It should never be used together with ieee80211_beacon_update_cntdwn(),
5478 * as it will cause a race condition around the counter value.
5479 */
5480void ieee80211_beacon_set_cntdwn(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, u8 counter);
5481
5482/**
5483 * ieee80211_csa_finish - notify mac80211 about channel switch
5484 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5485 *
5486 * After a channel switch announcement was scheduled and the counter in this
5487 * announcement hits 1, this function must be called by the driver to
5488 * notify mac80211 that the channel can be changed.
5489 */
5490void ieee80211_csa_finish(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
5491
5492/**
5493 * ieee80211_beacon_cntdwn_is_complete - find out if countdown reached 1
5494 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5495 *
5496 * This function returns whether the countdown reached zero.
5497 */
5498bool ieee80211_beacon_cntdwn_is_complete(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
5499
5500/**
5501 * ieee80211_color_change_finish - notify mac80211 about color change
5502 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5503 *
5504 * After a color change announcement was scheduled and the counter in this
5505 * announcement hits 1, this function must be called by the driver to
5506 * notify mac80211 that the color can be changed
5507 */
5508void ieee80211_color_change_finish(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
5509
5510/**
5511 * ieee80211_proberesp_get - retrieve a Probe Response template
5512 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5513 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5514 *
5515 * Creates a Probe Response template which can, for example, be uploaded to
5516 * hardware. The destination address should be set by the caller.
5517 *
5518 * Can only be called in AP mode.
5519 *
5520 * Return: The Probe Response template. %NULL on error.
5521 */
5522struct sk_buff *ieee80211_proberesp_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5523					struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
5524
5525/**
5526 * ieee80211_pspoll_get - retrieve a PS Poll template
5527 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5528 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5529 *
5530 * Creates a PS Poll a template which can, for example, uploaded to
5531 * hardware. The template must be updated after association so that correct
5532 * AID, BSSID and MAC address is used.
5533 *
5534 * Note: Caller (or hardware) is responsible for setting the
5535 * &IEEE80211_FCTL_PM bit.
5536 *
5537 * Return: The PS Poll template. %NULL on error.
5538 */
5539struct sk_buff *ieee80211_pspoll_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5540				     struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
5541
5542/**
5543 * ieee80211_nullfunc_get - retrieve a nullfunc template
5544 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5545 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5546 * @link_id: If the vif is an MLD, get a frame with the link addresses
5547 *	for the given link ID. For a link_id < 0 you get a frame with
5548 *	MLD addresses, however useful that might be.
5549 * @qos_ok: QoS NDP is acceptable to the caller, this should be set
5550 *	if at all possible
5551 *
5552 * Creates a Nullfunc template which can, for example, uploaded to
5553 * hardware. The template must be updated after association so that correct
5554 * BSSID and address is used.
5555 *
5556 * If @qos_ndp is set and the association is to an AP with QoS/WMM, the
5557 * returned packet will be QoS NDP.
5558 *
5559 * Note: Caller (or hardware) is responsible for setting the
5560 * &IEEE80211_FCTL_PM bit as well as Duration and Sequence Control fields.
5561 *
5562 * Return: The nullfunc template. %NULL on error.
5563 */
5564struct sk_buff *ieee80211_nullfunc_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5565				       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5566				       int link_id, bool qos_ok);
5567
5568/**
5569 * ieee80211_probereq_get - retrieve a Probe Request template
5570 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5571 * @src_addr: source MAC address
5572 * @ssid: SSID buffer
5573 * @ssid_len: length of SSID
5574 * @tailroom: tailroom to reserve at end of SKB for IEs
5575 *
5576 * Creates a Probe Request template which can, for example, be uploaded to
5577 * hardware.
5578 *
5579 * Return: The Probe Request template. %NULL on error.
5580 */
5581struct sk_buff *ieee80211_probereq_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5582				       const u8 *src_addr,
5583				       const u8 *ssid, size_t ssid_len,
5584				       size_t tailroom);
5585
5586/**
5587 * ieee80211_rts_get - RTS frame generation function
5588 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5589 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5590 * @frame: pointer to the frame that is going to be protected by the RTS.
5591 * @frame_len: the frame length (in octets).
5592 * @frame_txctl: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame.
5593 * @rts: The buffer where to store the RTS frame.
5594 *
5595 * If the RTS frames are generated by the host system (i.e., not in
5596 * hardware/firmware), the low-level driver uses this function to receive
5597 * the next RTS frame from the 802.11 code. The low-level is responsible
5598 * for calling this function before and RTS frame is needed.
5599 */
5600void ieee80211_rts_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5601		       const void *frame, size_t frame_len,
5602		       const struct ieee80211_tx_info *frame_txctl,
5603		       struct ieee80211_rts *rts);
5604
5605/**
5606 * ieee80211_rts_duration - Get the duration field for an RTS frame
5607 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5608 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5609 * @frame_len: the length of the frame that is going to be protected by the RTS.
5610 * @frame_txctl: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame.
5611 *
5612 * If the RTS is generated in firmware, but the host system must provide
5613 * the duration field, the low-level driver uses this function to receive
5614 * the duration field value in little-endian byteorder.
5615 *
5616 * Return: The duration.
5617 */
5618__le16 ieee80211_rts_duration(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5619			      struct ieee80211_vif *vif, size_t frame_len,
5620			      const struct ieee80211_tx_info *frame_txctl);
5621
5622/**
5623 * ieee80211_ctstoself_get - CTS-to-self frame generation function
5624 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5625 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5626 * @frame: pointer to the frame that is going to be protected by the CTS-to-self.
5627 * @frame_len: the frame length (in octets).
5628 * @frame_txctl: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame.
5629 * @cts: The buffer where to store the CTS-to-self frame.
5630 *
5631 * If the CTS-to-self frames are generated by the host system (i.e., not in
5632 * hardware/firmware), the low-level driver uses this function to receive
5633 * the next CTS-to-self frame from the 802.11 code. The low-level is responsible
5634 * for calling this function before and CTS-to-self frame is needed.
5635 */
5636void ieee80211_ctstoself_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5637			     struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5638			     const void *frame, size_t frame_len,
5639			     const struct ieee80211_tx_info *frame_txctl,
5640			     struct ieee80211_cts *cts);
5641
5642/**
5643 * ieee80211_ctstoself_duration - Get the duration field for a CTS-to-self frame
5644 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5645 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5646 * @frame_len: the length of the frame that is going to be protected by the CTS-to-self.
5647 * @frame_txctl: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame.
5648 *
5649 * If the CTS-to-self is generated in firmware, but the host system must provide
5650 * the duration field, the low-level driver uses this function to receive
5651 * the duration field value in little-endian byteorder.
5652 *
5653 * Return: The duration.
5654 */
5655__le16 ieee80211_ctstoself_duration(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5656				    struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5657				    size_t frame_len,
5658				    const struct ieee80211_tx_info *frame_txctl);
5659
5660/**
5661 * ieee80211_generic_frame_duration - Calculate the duration field for a frame
5662 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5663 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5664 * @band: the band to calculate the frame duration on
5665 * @frame_len: the length of the frame.
5666 * @rate: the rate at which the frame is going to be transmitted.
5667 *
5668 * Calculate the duration field of some generic frame, given its
5669 * length and transmission rate (in 100kbps).
5670 *
5671 * Return: The duration.
5672 */
5673__le16 ieee80211_generic_frame_duration(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5674					struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5675					enum nl80211_band band,
5676					size_t frame_len,
5677					struct ieee80211_rate *rate);
5678
5679/**
5680 * ieee80211_get_buffered_bc - accessing buffered broadcast and multicast frames
5681 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5682 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5683 *
5684 * Function for accessing buffered broadcast and multicast frames. If
5685 * hardware/firmware does not implement buffering of broadcast/multicast
5686 * frames when power saving is used, 802.11 code buffers them in the host
5687 * memory. The low-level driver uses this function to fetch next buffered
5688 * frame. In most cases, this is used when generating beacon frame.
5689 *
5690 * Return: A pointer to the next buffered skb or NULL if no more buffered
5691 * frames are available.
5692 *
5693 * Note: buffered frames are returned only after DTIM beacon frame was
5694 * generated with ieee80211_beacon_get() and the low-level driver must thus
5695 * call ieee80211_beacon_get() first. ieee80211_get_buffered_bc() returns
5696 * NULL if the previous generated beacon was not DTIM, so the low-level driver
5697 * does not need to check for DTIM beacons separately and should be able to
5698 * use common code for all beacons.
5699 */
5700struct sk_buff *
5701ieee80211_get_buffered_bc(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
5702
5703/**
5704 * ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k_iv - get a TKIP phase 1 key for IV32
5705 *
5706 * This function returns the TKIP phase 1 key for the given IV32.
5707 *
5708 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5709 * @iv32: IV32 to get the P1K for
5710 * @p1k: a buffer to which the key will be written, as 5 u16 values
5711 */
5712void ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k_iv(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
5713			       u32 iv32, u16 *p1k);
5714
5715/**
5716 * ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k - get a TKIP phase 1 key
5717 *
5718 * This function returns the TKIP phase 1 key for the IV32 taken
5719 * from the given packet.
5720 *
5721 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5722 * @skb: the packet to take the IV32 value from that will be encrypted
5723 *	with this P1K
5724 * @p1k: a buffer to which the key will be written, as 5 u16 values
5725 */
5726static inline void ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
5727					  struct sk_buff *skb, u16 *p1k)
5728{
5729	struct ieee80211_hdr *hdr = (struct ieee80211_hdr *)skb->data;
5730	const u8 *data = (u8 *)hdr + ieee80211_hdrlen(hdr->frame_control);
5731	u32 iv32 = get_unaligned_le32(&data[4]);
5732
5733	ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k_iv(keyconf, iv32, p1k);
5734}
5735
5736/**
5737 * ieee80211_get_tkip_rx_p1k - get a TKIP phase 1 key for RX
5738 *
5739 * This function returns the TKIP phase 1 key for the given IV32
5740 * and transmitter address.
5741 *
5742 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5743 * @ta: TA that will be used with the key
5744 * @iv32: IV32 to get the P1K for
5745 * @p1k: a buffer to which the key will be written, as 5 u16 values
5746 */
5747void ieee80211_get_tkip_rx_p1k(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
5748			       const u8 *ta, u32 iv32, u16 *p1k);
5749
5750/**
5751 * ieee80211_get_tkip_p2k - get a TKIP phase 2 key
5752 *
5753 * This function computes the TKIP RC4 key for the IV values
5754 * in the packet.
5755 *
5756 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5757 * @skb: the packet to take the IV32/IV16 values from that will be
5758 *	encrypted with this key
5759 * @p2k: a buffer to which the key will be written, 16 bytes
5760 */
5761void ieee80211_get_tkip_p2k(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
5762			    struct sk_buff *skb, u8 *p2k);
5763
5764/**
5765 * ieee80211_tkip_add_iv - write TKIP IV and Ext. IV to pos
5766 *
5767 * @pos: start of crypto header
5768 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5769 * @pn: PN to add
5770 *
5771 * Returns: pointer to the octet following IVs (i.e. beginning of
5772 * the packet payload)
5773 *
5774 * This function writes the tkip IV value to pos (which should
5775 * point to the crypto header)
5776 */
5777u8 *ieee80211_tkip_add_iv(u8 *pos, struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf, u64 pn);
5778
5779/**
5780 * ieee80211_get_key_rx_seq - get key RX sequence counter
5781 *
5782 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5783 * @tid: The TID, or -1 for the management frame value (CCMP/GCMP only);
5784 *	the value on TID 0 is also used for non-QoS frames. For
5785 *	CMAC, only TID 0 is valid.
5786 * @seq: buffer to receive the sequence data
5787 *
5788 * This function allows a driver to retrieve the current RX IV/PNs
5789 * for the given key. It must not be called if IV checking is done
5790 * by the device and not by mac80211.
5791 *
5792 * Note that this function may only be called when no RX processing
5793 * can be done concurrently.
5794 */
5795void ieee80211_get_key_rx_seq(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
5796			      int tid, struct ieee80211_key_seq *seq);
5797
5798/**
5799 * ieee80211_set_key_rx_seq - set key RX sequence counter
5800 *
5801 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5802 * @tid: The TID, or -1 for the management frame value (CCMP/GCMP only);
5803 *	the value on TID 0 is also used for non-QoS frames. For
5804 *	CMAC, only TID 0 is valid.
5805 * @seq: new sequence data
5806 *
5807 * This function allows a driver to set the current RX IV/PNs for the
5808 * given key. This is useful when resuming from WoWLAN sleep and GTK
5809 * rekey may have been done while suspended. It should not be called
5810 * if IV checking is done by the device and not by mac80211.
5811 *
5812 * Note that this function may only be called when no RX processing
5813 * can be done concurrently.
5814 */
5815void ieee80211_set_key_rx_seq(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
5816			      int tid, struct ieee80211_key_seq *seq);
5817
5818/**
5819 * ieee80211_remove_key - remove the given key
5820 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5821 *
5822 * Context: Must be called with the wiphy mutex held.
5823 *
5824 * Remove the given key. If the key was uploaded to the hardware at the
5825 * time this function is called, it is not deleted in the hardware but
5826 * instead assumed to have been removed already.
 
 
 
5827 */
5828void ieee80211_remove_key(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf);
5829
5830/**
5831 * ieee80211_gtk_rekey_add - add a GTK key from rekeying during WoWLAN
5832 * @vif: the virtual interface to add the key on
5833 * @keyconf: new key data
5834 *
5835 * When GTK rekeying was done while the system was suspended, (a) new
5836 * key(s) will be available. These will be needed by mac80211 for proper
5837 * RX processing, so this function allows setting them.
5838 *
5839 * The function returns the newly allocated key structure, which will
5840 * have similar contents to the passed key configuration but point to
5841 * mac80211-owned memory. In case of errors, the function returns an
5842 * ERR_PTR(), use IS_ERR() etc.
5843 *
5844 * Note that this function assumes the key isn't added to hardware
5845 * acceleration, so no TX will be done with the key. Since it's a GTK
5846 * on managed (station) networks, this is true anyway. If the driver
5847 * calls this function from the resume callback and subsequently uses
5848 * the return code 1 to reconfigure the device, this key will be part
5849 * of the reconfiguration.
5850 *
5851 * Note that the driver should also call ieee80211_set_key_rx_seq()
5852 * for the new key for each TID to set up sequence counters properly.
5853 *
5854 * IMPORTANT: If this replaces a key that is present in the hardware,
5855 * then it will attempt to remove it during this call. In many cases
5856 * this isn't what you want, so call ieee80211_remove_key() first for
5857 * the key that's being replaced.
5858 */
5859struct ieee80211_key_conf *
5860ieee80211_gtk_rekey_add(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5861			struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf);
5862
5863/**
5864 * ieee80211_gtk_rekey_notify - notify userspace supplicant of rekeying
5865 * @vif: virtual interface the rekeying was done on
5866 * @bssid: The BSSID of the AP, for checking association
5867 * @replay_ctr: the new replay counter after GTK rekeying
5868 * @gfp: allocation flags
5869 */
5870void ieee80211_gtk_rekey_notify(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *bssid,
5871				const u8 *replay_ctr, gfp_t gfp);
5872
5873/**
5874 * ieee80211_key_mic_failure - increment MIC failure counter for the key
5875 *
5876 * Note: this is really only safe if no other RX function is called
5877 * at the same time.
5878 *
5879 * @keyconf: the key in question
5880 */
5881void ieee80211_key_mic_failure(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf);
5882
5883/**
5884 * ieee80211_key_replay - increment replay counter for the key
5885 *
5886 * Note: this is really only safe if no other RX function is called
5887 * at the same time.
5888 *
5889 * @keyconf: the key in question
5890 */
5891void ieee80211_key_replay(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf);
5892
5893/**
5894 * ieee80211_wake_queue - wake specific queue
5895 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5896 * @queue: queue number (counted from zero).
5897 *
5898 * Drivers must use this function instead of netif_wake_queue.
5899 */
5900void ieee80211_wake_queue(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int queue);
5901
5902/**
5903 * ieee80211_stop_queue - stop specific queue
5904 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5905 * @queue: queue number (counted from zero).
5906 *
5907 * Drivers must use this function instead of netif_stop_queue.
5908 */
5909void ieee80211_stop_queue(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int queue);
5910
5911/**
5912 * ieee80211_queue_stopped - test status of the queue
5913 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5914 * @queue: queue number (counted from zero).
5915 *
5916 * Drivers must use this function instead of netif_queue_stopped.
5917 *
5918 * Return: %true if the queue is stopped. %false otherwise.
5919 */
5920
5921int ieee80211_queue_stopped(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int queue);
5922
5923/**
5924 * ieee80211_stop_queues - stop all queues
5925 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5926 *
5927 * Drivers must use this function instead of netif_tx_stop_all_queues.
5928 */
5929void ieee80211_stop_queues(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
5930
5931/**
5932 * ieee80211_wake_queues - wake all queues
5933 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5934 *
5935 * Drivers must use this function instead of netif_tx_wake_all_queues.
5936 */
5937void ieee80211_wake_queues(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
5938
5939/**
5940 * ieee80211_scan_completed - completed hardware scan
5941 *
5942 * When hardware scan offload is used (i.e. the hw_scan() callback is
5943 * assigned) this function needs to be called by the driver to notify
5944 * mac80211 that the scan finished. This function can be called from
5945 * any context, including hardirq context.
5946 *
5947 * @hw: the hardware that finished the scan
5948 * @info: information about the completed scan
5949 */
5950void ieee80211_scan_completed(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5951			      struct cfg80211_scan_info *info);
5952
5953/**
5954 * ieee80211_sched_scan_results - got results from scheduled scan
5955 *
5956 * When a scheduled scan is running, this function needs to be called by the
5957 * driver whenever there are new scan results available.
5958 *
5959 * @hw: the hardware that is performing scheduled scans
5960 */
5961void ieee80211_sched_scan_results(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
5962
5963/**
5964 * ieee80211_sched_scan_stopped - inform that the scheduled scan has stopped
5965 *
5966 * When a scheduled scan is running, this function can be called by
5967 * the driver if it needs to stop the scan to perform another task.
5968 * Usual scenarios are drivers that cannot continue the scheduled scan
5969 * while associating, for instance.
5970 *
5971 * @hw: the hardware that is performing scheduled scans
5972 */
5973void ieee80211_sched_scan_stopped(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
5974
5975/**
5976 * enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags - interface iteration flags
5977 * @IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_NORMAL: Iterate over all interfaces that have
5978 *	been added to the driver; However, note that during hardware
5979 *	reconfiguration (after restart_hw) it will iterate over a new
5980 *	interface and over all the existing interfaces even if they
5981 *	haven't been re-added to the driver yet.
5982 * @IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_RESUME_ALL: During resume, iterate over all
5983 *	interfaces, even if they haven't been re-added to the driver yet.
5984 * @IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_ACTIVE: Iterate only active interfaces (netdev is up).
5985 * @IEEE80211_IFACE_SKIP_SDATA_NOT_IN_DRIVER: Skip any interfaces where SDATA
5986 *	is not in the driver.  This may fix crashes during firmware recovery
5987 *	for instance.
5988 */
5989enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags {
5990	IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_NORMAL	= 0,
5991	IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_RESUME_ALL	= BIT(0),
5992	IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_ACTIVE	= BIT(1),
5993	IEEE80211_IFACE_SKIP_SDATA_NOT_IN_DRIVER	= BIT(2),
5994};
5995
5996/**
5997 * ieee80211_iterate_interfaces - iterate interfaces
5998 *
5999 * This function iterates over the interfaces associated with a given
6000 * hardware and calls the callback for them. This includes active as well as
6001 * inactive interfaces. This function allows the iterator function to sleep.
6002 * Will iterate over a new interface during add_interface().
6003 *
6004 * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over
6005 * @iter_flags: iteration flags, see &enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags
6006 * @iterator: the iterator function to call
6007 * @data: first argument of the iterator function
6008 */
6009void ieee80211_iterate_interfaces(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 iter_flags,
6010				  void (*iterator)(void *data, u8 *mac,
6011						   struct ieee80211_vif *vif),
6012				  void *data);
6013
6014/**
6015 * ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces - iterate active interfaces
6016 *
6017 * This function iterates over the interfaces associated with a given
6018 * hardware that are currently active and calls the callback for them.
6019 * This function allows the iterator function to sleep, when the iterator
6020 * function is atomic @ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_atomic can
6021 * be used.
6022 * Does not iterate over a new interface during add_interface().
6023 *
6024 * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over
6025 * @iter_flags: iteration flags, see &enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags
6026 * @iterator: the iterator function to call
6027 * @data: first argument of the iterator function
6028 */
6029static inline void
6030ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 iter_flags,
6031				    void (*iterator)(void *data, u8 *mac,
6032						     struct ieee80211_vif *vif),
6033				    void *data)
6034{
6035	ieee80211_iterate_interfaces(hw,
6036				     iter_flags | IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_ACTIVE,
6037				     iterator, data);
6038}
6039
6040/**
6041 * ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_atomic - iterate active interfaces
6042 *
6043 * This function iterates over the interfaces associated with a given
6044 * hardware that are currently active and calls the callback for them.
6045 * This function requires the iterator callback function to be atomic,
6046 * if that is not desired, use @ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces instead.
6047 * Does not iterate over a new interface during add_interface().
6048 *
6049 * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over
6050 * @iter_flags: iteration flags, see &enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags
6051 * @iterator: the iterator function to call, cannot sleep
6052 * @data: first argument of the iterator function
6053 */
6054void ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_atomic(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6055						u32 iter_flags,
6056						void (*iterator)(void *data,
6057						    u8 *mac,
6058						    struct ieee80211_vif *vif),
6059						void *data);
6060
6061/**
6062 * ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_mtx - iterate active interfaces
6063 *
6064 * This function iterates over the interfaces associated with a given
6065 * hardware that are currently active and calls the callback for them.
6066 * This version can only be used while holding the wiphy mutex.
6067 *
6068 * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over
6069 * @iter_flags: iteration flags, see &enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags
6070 * @iterator: the iterator function to call, cannot sleep
6071 * @data: first argument of the iterator function
6072 */
6073void ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_mtx(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6074					     u32 iter_flags,
6075					     void (*iterator)(void *data,
6076						u8 *mac,
6077						struct ieee80211_vif *vif),
6078					     void *data);
6079
6080/**
6081 * ieee80211_iterate_stations_atomic - iterate stations
6082 *
6083 * This function iterates over all stations associated with a given
6084 * hardware that are currently uploaded to the driver and calls the callback
6085 * function for them.
6086 * This function requires the iterator callback function to be atomic,
6087 *
6088 * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over
6089 * @iterator: the iterator function to call, cannot sleep
6090 * @data: first argument of the iterator function
6091 */
6092void ieee80211_iterate_stations_atomic(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6093				       void (*iterator)(void *data,
6094						struct ieee80211_sta *sta),
6095				       void *data);
6096/**
6097 * ieee80211_queue_work - add work onto the mac80211 workqueue
6098 *
6099 * Drivers and mac80211 use this to add work onto the mac80211 workqueue.
6100 * This helper ensures drivers are not queueing work when they should not be.
6101 *
6102 * @hw: the hardware struct for the interface we are adding work for
6103 * @work: the work we want to add onto the mac80211 workqueue
6104 */
6105void ieee80211_queue_work(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct work_struct *work);
6106
6107/**
6108 * ieee80211_queue_delayed_work - add work onto the mac80211 workqueue
6109 *
6110 * Drivers and mac80211 use this to queue delayed work onto the mac80211
6111 * workqueue.
6112 *
6113 * @hw: the hardware struct for the interface we are adding work for
6114 * @dwork: delayable work to queue onto the mac80211 workqueue
6115 * @delay: number of jiffies to wait before queueing
6116 */
6117void ieee80211_queue_delayed_work(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6118				  struct delayed_work *dwork,
6119				  unsigned long delay);
6120
6121/**
6122 * ieee80211_refresh_tx_agg_session_timer - Refresh a tx agg session timer.
6123 * @sta: the station for which to start a BA session
6124 * @tid: the TID to BA on.
6125 *
6126 * This function allows low level driver to refresh tx agg session timer
6127 * to maintain BA session, the session level will still be managed by the
6128 * mac80211.
6129 *
6130 * Note: must be called in an RCU critical section.
6131 */
6132void ieee80211_refresh_tx_agg_session_timer(struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
6133					    u16 tid);
6134
6135/**
6136 * ieee80211_start_tx_ba_session - Start a tx Block Ack session.
6137 * @sta: the station for which to start a BA session
6138 * @tid: the TID to BA on.
6139 * @timeout: session timeout value (in TUs)
6140 *
6141 * Return: success if addBA request was sent, failure otherwise
6142 *
6143 * Although mac80211/low level driver/user space application can estimate
6144 * the need to start aggregation on a certain RA/TID, the session level
6145 * will be managed by the mac80211.
6146 */
6147int ieee80211_start_tx_ba_session(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u16 tid,
6148				  u16 timeout);
6149
6150/**
6151 * ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe - low level driver ready to aggregate.
6152 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
6153 * @ra: receiver address of the BA session recipient.
6154 * @tid: the TID to BA on.
6155 *
6156 * This function must be called by low level driver once it has
6157 * finished with preparations for the BA session. It can be called
6158 * from any context.
6159 */
6160void ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *ra,
6161				      u16 tid);
6162
6163/**
6164 * ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_session - Stop a Block Ack session.
6165 * @sta: the station whose BA session to stop
6166 * @tid: the TID to stop BA.
6167 *
6168 * Return: negative error if the TID is invalid, or no aggregation active
6169 *
6170 * Although mac80211/low level driver/user space application can estimate
6171 * the need to stop aggregation on a certain RA/TID, the session level
6172 * will be managed by the mac80211.
6173 */
6174int ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_session(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u16 tid);
6175
6176/**
6177 * ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe - low level driver ready to stop aggregate.
6178 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
6179 * @ra: receiver address of the BA session recipient.
6180 * @tid: the desired TID to BA on.
6181 *
6182 * This function must be called by low level driver once it has
6183 * finished with preparations for the BA session tear down. It
6184 * can be called from any context.
6185 */
6186void ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *ra,
6187				     u16 tid);
6188
6189/**
6190 * ieee80211_find_sta - find a station
6191 *
6192 * @vif: virtual interface to look for station on
6193 * @addr: station's address
6194 *
6195 * Return: The station, if found. %NULL otherwise.
6196 *
6197 * Note: This function must be called under RCU lock and the
6198 * resulting pointer is only valid under RCU lock as well.
6199 */
6200struct ieee80211_sta *ieee80211_find_sta(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6201					 const u8 *addr);
6202
6203/**
6204 * ieee80211_find_sta_by_ifaddr - find a station on hardware
6205 *
6206 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6207 * @addr: remote station's address
6208 * @localaddr: local address (vif->sdata->vif.addr). Use NULL for 'any'.
6209 *
6210 * Return: The station, if found. %NULL otherwise.
6211 *
6212 * Note: This function must be called under RCU lock and the
6213 * resulting pointer is only valid under RCU lock as well.
6214 *
6215 * NOTE: You may pass NULL for localaddr, but then you will just get
6216 *      the first STA that matches the remote address 'addr'.
6217 *      We can have multiple STA associated with multiple
6218 *      logical stations (e.g. consider a station connecting to another
6219 *      BSSID on the same AP hardware without disconnecting first).
6220 *      In this case, the result of this method with localaddr NULL
6221 *      is not reliable.
6222 *
6223 * DO NOT USE THIS FUNCTION with localaddr NULL if at all possible.
6224 */
6225struct ieee80211_sta *ieee80211_find_sta_by_ifaddr(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6226					       const u8 *addr,
6227					       const u8 *localaddr);
6228
6229/**
6230 * ieee80211_find_sta_by_link_addrs - find STA by link addresses
6231 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6232 * @addr: remote station's link address
6233 * @localaddr: local link address, use %NULL for any (but avoid that)
6234 * @link_id: pointer to obtain the link ID if the STA is found,
6235 *	may be %NULL if the link ID is not needed
6236 *
6237 * Obtain the STA by link address, must use RCU protection.
6238 */
6239struct ieee80211_sta *
6240ieee80211_find_sta_by_link_addrs(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6241				 const u8 *addr,
6242				 const u8 *localaddr,
6243				 unsigned int *link_id);
6244
6245/**
6246 * ieee80211_sta_block_awake - block station from waking up
6247 * @hw: the hardware
6248 * @pubsta: the station
6249 * @block: whether to block or unblock
6250 *
6251 * Some devices require that all frames that are on the queues
6252 * for a specific station that went to sleep are flushed before
6253 * a poll response or frames after the station woke up can be
6254 * delivered to that it. Note that such frames must be rejected
6255 * by the driver as filtered, with the appropriate status flag.
6256 *
6257 * This function allows implementing this mode in a race-free
6258 * manner.
6259 *
6260 * To do this, a driver must keep track of the number of frames
6261 * still enqueued for a specific station. If this number is not
6262 * zero when the station goes to sleep, the driver must call
6263 * this function to force mac80211 to consider the station to
6264 * be asleep regardless of the station's actual state. Once the
6265 * number of outstanding frames reaches zero, the driver must
6266 * call this function again to unblock the station. That will
6267 * cause mac80211 to be able to send ps-poll responses, and if
6268 * the station queried in the meantime then frames will also
6269 * be sent out as a result of this. Additionally, the driver
6270 * will be notified that the station woke up some time after
6271 * it is unblocked, regardless of whether the station actually
6272 * woke up while blocked or not.
6273 */
6274void ieee80211_sta_block_awake(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6275			       struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta, bool block);
6276
6277/**
6278 * ieee80211_sta_eosp - notify mac80211 about end of SP
6279 * @pubsta: the station
6280 *
6281 * When a device transmits frames in a way that it can't tell
6282 * mac80211 in the TX status about the EOSP, it must clear the
6283 * %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP bit and call this function instead.
6284 * This applies for PS-Poll as well as uAPSD.
6285 *
6286 * Note that just like with _tx_status() and _rx() drivers must
6287 * not mix calls to irqsafe/non-irqsafe versions, this function
6288 * must not be mixed with those either. Use the all irqsafe, or
6289 * all non-irqsafe, don't mix!
6290 *
6291 * NB: the _irqsafe version of this function doesn't exist, no
6292 *     driver needs it right now. Don't call this function if
6293 *     you'd need the _irqsafe version, look at the git history
6294 *     and restore the _irqsafe version!
6295 */
6296void ieee80211_sta_eosp(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta);
6297
6298/**
6299 * ieee80211_send_eosp_nullfunc - ask mac80211 to send NDP with EOSP
6300 * @pubsta: the station
6301 * @tid: the tid of the NDP
6302 *
6303 * Sometimes the device understands that it needs to close
6304 * the Service Period unexpectedly. This can happen when
6305 * sending frames that are filling holes in the BA window.
6306 * In this case, the device can ask mac80211 to send a
6307 * Nullfunc frame with EOSP set. When that happens, the
6308 * driver must have called ieee80211_sta_set_buffered() to
6309 * let mac80211 know that there are no buffered frames any
6310 * more, otherwise mac80211 will get the more_data bit wrong.
6311 * The low level driver must have made sure that the frame
6312 * will be sent despite the station being in power-save.
6313 * Mac80211 won't call allow_buffered_frames().
6314 * Note that calling this function, doesn't exempt the driver
6315 * from closing the EOSP properly, it will still have to call
6316 * ieee80211_sta_eosp when the NDP is sent.
6317 */
6318void ieee80211_send_eosp_nullfunc(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta, int tid);
6319
6320/**
6321 * ieee80211_sta_recalc_aggregates - recalculate aggregate data after a change
6322 * @pubsta: the station
6323 *
6324 * Call this function after changing a per-link aggregate data as referenced in
6325 * &struct ieee80211_sta_aggregates by accessing the agg field of
6326 * &struct ieee80211_link_sta.
6327 *
6328 * With non MLO the data in deflink will be referenced directly. In that case
6329 * there is no need to call this function.
6330 */
6331void ieee80211_sta_recalc_aggregates(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta);
6332
6333/**
6334 * ieee80211_sta_register_airtime - register airtime usage for a sta/tid
6335 *
6336 * Register airtime usage for a given sta on a given tid. The driver must call
6337 * this function to notify mac80211 that a station used a certain amount of
6338 * airtime. This information will be used by the TXQ scheduler to schedule
6339 * stations in a way that ensures airtime fairness.
6340 *
6341 * The reported airtime should as a minimum include all time that is spent
6342 * transmitting to the remote station, including overhead and padding, but not
6343 * including time spent waiting for a TXOP. If the time is not reported by the
6344 * hardware it can in some cases be calculated from the rate and known frame
6345 * composition. When possible, the time should include any failed transmission
6346 * attempts.
6347 *
6348 * The driver can either call this function synchronously for every packet or
6349 * aggregate, or asynchronously as airtime usage information becomes available.
6350 * TX and RX airtime can be reported together, or separately by setting one of
6351 * them to 0.
6352 *
6353 * @pubsta: the station
6354 * @tid: the TID to register airtime for
6355 * @tx_airtime: airtime used during TX (in usec)
6356 * @rx_airtime: airtime used during RX (in usec)
6357 */
6358void ieee80211_sta_register_airtime(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta, u8 tid,
6359				    u32 tx_airtime, u32 rx_airtime);
6360
6361/**
6362 * ieee80211_txq_airtime_check - check if a txq can send frame to device
6363 *
6364 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6365 * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface
6366 *
6367 * Return true if the AQL's airtime limit has not been reached and the txq can
6368 * continue to send more packets to the device. Otherwise return false.
6369 */
6370bool
6371ieee80211_txq_airtime_check(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_txq *txq);
6372
6373/**
6374 * ieee80211_iter_keys - iterate keys programmed into the device
6375 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6376 * @vif: virtual interface to iterate, may be %NULL for all
6377 * @iter: iterator function that will be called for each key
6378 * @iter_data: custom data to pass to the iterator function
6379 *
6380 * Context: Must be called with wiphy mutex held; can sleep.
6381 *
6382 * This function can be used to iterate all the keys known to
6383 * mac80211, even those that weren't previously programmed into
6384 * the device. This is intended for use in WoWLAN if the device
6385 * needs reprogramming of the keys during suspend.
 
 
6386 *
6387 * The order in which the keys are iterated matches the order
6388 * in which they were originally installed and handed to the
6389 * set_key callback.
6390 */
6391void ieee80211_iter_keys(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6392			 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6393			 void (*iter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6394				      struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6395				      struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
6396				      struct ieee80211_key_conf *key,
6397				      void *data),
6398			 void *iter_data);
6399
6400/**
6401 * ieee80211_iter_keys_rcu - iterate keys programmed into the device
6402 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6403 * @vif: virtual interface to iterate, may be %NULL for all
6404 * @iter: iterator function that will be called for each key
6405 * @iter_data: custom data to pass to the iterator function
6406 *
6407 * This function can be used to iterate all the keys known to
6408 * mac80211, even those that weren't previously programmed into
6409 * the device. Note that due to locking reasons, keys of station
6410 * in removal process will be skipped.
6411 *
6412 * This function requires being called in an RCU critical section,
6413 * and thus iter must be atomic.
6414 */
6415void ieee80211_iter_keys_rcu(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6416			     struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6417			     void (*iter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6418					  struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6419					  struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
6420					  struct ieee80211_key_conf *key,
6421					  void *data),
6422			     void *iter_data);
6423
6424/**
6425 * ieee80211_iter_chan_contexts_atomic - iterate channel contexts
6426 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
6427 * @iter: iterator function
6428 * @iter_data: data passed to iterator function
6429 *
6430 * Iterate all active channel contexts. This function is atomic and
6431 * doesn't acquire any locks internally that might be held in other
6432 * places while calling into the driver.
6433 *
6434 * The iterator will not find a context that's being added (during
6435 * the driver callback to add it) but will find it while it's being
6436 * removed.
6437 *
6438 * Note that during hardware restart, all contexts that existed
6439 * before the restart are considered already present so will be
6440 * found while iterating, whether they've been re-added already
6441 * or not.
6442 */
6443void ieee80211_iter_chan_contexts_atomic(
6444	struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6445	void (*iter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6446		     struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *chanctx_conf,
6447		     void *data),
6448	void *iter_data);
6449
6450/**
6451 * ieee80211_ap_probereq_get - retrieve a Probe Request template
6452 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
6453 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6454 *
6455 * Creates a Probe Request template which can, for example, be uploaded to
6456 * hardware. The template is filled with bssid, ssid and supported rate
6457 * information. This function must only be called from within the
6458 * .bss_info_changed callback function and only in managed mode. The function
6459 * is only useful when the interface is associated, otherwise it will return
6460 * %NULL.
6461 *
6462 * Return: The Probe Request template. %NULL on error.
6463 */
6464struct sk_buff *ieee80211_ap_probereq_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6465					  struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
6466
6467/**
6468 * ieee80211_beacon_loss - inform hardware does not receive beacons
6469 *
6470 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6471 *
6472 * When beacon filtering is enabled with %IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER and
6473 * %IEEE80211_CONF_PS is set, the driver needs to inform whenever the
6474 * hardware is not receiving beacons with this function.
6475 */
6476void ieee80211_beacon_loss(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
6477
6478/**
6479 * ieee80211_connection_loss - inform hardware has lost connection to the AP
6480 *
6481 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6482 *
6483 * When beacon filtering is enabled with %IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER, and
6484 * %IEEE80211_CONF_PS and %IEEE80211_HW_CONNECTION_MONITOR are set, the driver
6485 * needs to inform if the connection to the AP has been lost.
6486 * The function may also be called if the connection needs to be terminated
6487 * for some other reason, even if %IEEE80211_HW_CONNECTION_MONITOR isn't set.
6488 *
6489 * This function will cause immediate change to disassociated state,
6490 * without connection recovery attempts.
6491 */
6492void ieee80211_connection_loss(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
6493
6494/**
6495 * ieee80211_disconnect - request disconnection
6496 *
6497 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6498 * @reconnect: immediate reconnect is desired
6499 *
6500 * Request disconnection from the current network and, if enabled, send a
6501 * hint to the higher layers that immediate reconnect is desired.
6502 */
6503void ieee80211_disconnect(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, bool reconnect);
6504
6505/**
6506 * ieee80211_resume_disconnect - disconnect from AP after resume
6507 *
6508 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6509 *
6510 * Instructs mac80211 to disconnect from the AP after resume.
6511 * Drivers can use this after WoWLAN if they know that the
6512 * connection cannot be kept up, for example because keys were
6513 * used while the device was asleep but the replay counters or
6514 * similar cannot be retrieved from the device during resume.
6515 *
6516 * Note that due to implementation issues, if the driver uses
6517 * the reconfiguration functionality during resume the interface
6518 * will still be added as associated first during resume and then
6519 * disconnect normally later.
6520 *
6521 * This function can only be called from the resume callback and
6522 * the driver must not be holding any of its own locks while it
6523 * calls this function, or at least not any locks it needs in the
6524 * key configuration paths (if it supports HW crypto).
6525 */
6526void ieee80211_resume_disconnect(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
6527
6528/**
6529 * ieee80211_hw_restart_disconnect - disconnect from AP after
6530 * hardware restart
6531 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6532 *
6533 * Instructs mac80211 to disconnect from the AP after
6534 * hardware restart.
6535 */
6536void ieee80211_hw_restart_disconnect(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
6537
6538/**
6539 * ieee80211_cqm_rssi_notify - inform a configured connection quality monitoring
6540 *	rssi threshold triggered
6541 *
6542 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6543 * @rssi_event: the RSSI trigger event type
6544 * @rssi_level: new RSSI level value or 0 if not available
6545 * @gfp: context flags
6546 *
6547 * When the %IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_CQM_RSSI is set, and a connection quality
6548 * monitoring is configured with an rssi threshold, the driver will inform
6549 * whenever the rssi level reaches the threshold.
6550 */
6551void ieee80211_cqm_rssi_notify(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6552			       enum nl80211_cqm_rssi_threshold_event rssi_event,
6553			       s32 rssi_level,
6554			       gfp_t gfp);
6555
6556/**
6557 * ieee80211_cqm_beacon_loss_notify - inform CQM of beacon loss
6558 *
6559 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6560 * @gfp: context flags
6561 */
6562void ieee80211_cqm_beacon_loss_notify(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, gfp_t gfp);
6563
6564/**
6565 * ieee80211_radar_detected - inform that a radar was detected
6566 *
6567 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6568 */
6569void ieee80211_radar_detected(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
6570
6571/**
6572 * ieee80211_chswitch_done - Complete channel switch process
6573 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6574 * @success: make the channel switch successful or not
6575 * @link_id: the link_id on which the switch was done. Ignored if success is
6576 *	false.
6577 *
6578 * Complete the channel switch post-process: set the new operational channel
6579 * and wake up the suspended queues.
6580 */
6581void ieee80211_chswitch_done(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, bool success,
6582			     unsigned int link_id);
6583
6584/**
6585 * ieee80211_channel_switch_disconnect - disconnect due to channel switch error
6586 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6587 * @block_tx: if %true, do not send deauth frame.
6588 *
6589 * Instruct mac80211 to disconnect due to a channel switch error. The channel
6590 * switch can request to block the tx and so, we need to make sure we do not send
6591 * a deauth frame in this case.
6592 */
6593void ieee80211_channel_switch_disconnect(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6594					 bool block_tx);
6595
6596/**
6597 * ieee80211_request_smps - request SM PS transition
6598 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6599 * @link_id: link ID for MLO, or 0
6600 * @smps_mode: new SM PS mode
6601 *
6602 * This allows the driver to request an SM PS transition in managed
6603 * mode. This is useful when the driver has more information than
6604 * the stack about possible interference, for example by bluetooth.
6605 */
6606void ieee80211_request_smps(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, unsigned int link_id,
6607			    enum ieee80211_smps_mode smps_mode);
6608
6609/**
6610 * ieee80211_ready_on_channel - notification of remain-on-channel start
6611 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6612 */
6613void ieee80211_ready_on_channel(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
6614
6615/**
6616 * ieee80211_remain_on_channel_expired - remain_on_channel duration expired
6617 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6618 */
6619void ieee80211_remain_on_channel_expired(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
6620
6621/**
6622 * ieee80211_stop_rx_ba_session - callback to stop existing BA sessions
6623 *
6624 * in order not to harm the system performance and user experience, the device
6625 * may request not to allow any rx ba session and tear down existing rx ba
6626 * sessions based on system constraints such as periodic BT activity that needs
6627 * to limit wlan activity (eg.sco or a2dp)."
6628 * in such cases, the intention is to limit the duration of the rx ppdu and
6629 * therefore prevent the peer device to use a-mpdu aggregation.
6630 *
6631 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6632 * @ba_rx_bitmap: Bit map of open rx ba per tid
6633 * @addr: & to bssid mac address
6634 */
6635void ieee80211_stop_rx_ba_session(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, u16 ba_rx_bitmap,
6636				  const u8 *addr);
6637
6638/**
6639 * ieee80211_mark_rx_ba_filtered_frames - move RX BA window and mark filtered
6640 * @pubsta: station struct
6641 * @tid: the session's TID
6642 * @ssn: starting sequence number of the bitmap, all frames before this are
6643 *	assumed to be out of the window after the call
6644 * @filtered: bitmap of filtered frames, BIT(0) is the @ssn entry etc.
6645 * @received_mpdus: number of received mpdus in firmware
6646 *
6647 * This function moves the BA window and releases all frames before @ssn, and
6648 * marks frames marked in the bitmap as having been filtered. Afterwards, it
6649 * checks if any frames in the window starting from @ssn can now be released
6650 * (in case they were only waiting for frames that were filtered.)
6651 * (Only work correctly if @max_rx_aggregation_subframes <= 64 frames)
6652 */
6653void ieee80211_mark_rx_ba_filtered_frames(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta, u8 tid,
6654					  u16 ssn, u64 filtered,
6655					  u16 received_mpdus);
6656
6657/**
6658 * ieee80211_send_bar - send a BlockAckReq frame
6659 *
6660 * can be used to flush pending frames from the peer's aggregation reorder
6661 * buffer.
6662 *
6663 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6664 * @ra: the peer's destination address
6665 * @tid: the TID of the aggregation session
6666 * @ssn: the new starting sequence number for the receiver
6667 */
6668void ieee80211_send_bar(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, u8 *ra, u16 tid, u16 ssn);
6669
6670/**
6671 * ieee80211_manage_rx_ba_offl - helper to queue an RX BA work
6672 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
6673 * @addr: station mac address
6674 * @tid: the rx tid
6675 */
6676void ieee80211_manage_rx_ba_offl(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *addr,
6677				 unsigned int tid);
6678
6679/**
6680 * ieee80211_start_rx_ba_session_offl - start a Rx BA session
6681 *
6682 * Some device drivers may offload part of the Rx aggregation flow including
6683 * AddBa/DelBa negotiation but may otherwise be incapable of full Rx
6684 * reordering.
6685 *
6686 * Create structures responsible for reordering so device drivers may call here
6687 * when they complete AddBa negotiation.
6688 *
6689 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
6690 * @addr: station mac address
6691 * @tid: the rx tid
6692 */
6693static inline void ieee80211_start_rx_ba_session_offl(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6694						      const u8 *addr, u16 tid)
6695{
6696	if (WARN_ON(tid >= IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS))
6697		return;
6698	ieee80211_manage_rx_ba_offl(vif, addr, tid);
6699}
6700
6701/**
6702 * ieee80211_stop_rx_ba_session_offl - stop a Rx BA session
6703 *
6704 * Some device drivers may offload part of the Rx aggregation flow including
6705 * AddBa/DelBa negotiation but may otherwise be incapable of full Rx
6706 * reordering.
6707 *
6708 * Destroy structures responsible for reordering so device drivers may call here
6709 * when they complete DelBa negotiation.
6710 *
6711 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
6712 * @addr: station mac address
6713 * @tid: the rx tid
6714 */
6715static inline void ieee80211_stop_rx_ba_session_offl(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6716						     const u8 *addr, u16 tid)
6717{
6718	if (WARN_ON(tid >= IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS))
6719		return;
6720	ieee80211_manage_rx_ba_offl(vif, addr, tid + IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS);
6721}
6722
6723/**
6724 * ieee80211_rx_ba_timer_expired - stop a Rx BA session due to timeout
6725 *
6726 * Some device drivers do not offload AddBa/DelBa negotiation, but handle rx
6727 * buffer reording internally, and therefore also handle the session timer.
6728 *
6729 * Trigger the timeout flow, which sends a DelBa.
6730 *
6731 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
6732 * @addr: station mac address
6733 * @tid: the rx tid
6734 */
6735void ieee80211_rx_ba_timer_expired(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6736				   const u8 *addr, unsigned int tid);
6737
6738/* Rate control API */
6739
6740/**
6741 * struct ieee80211_tx_rate_control - rate control information for/from RC algo
6742 *
6743 * @hw: The hardware the algorithm is invoked for.
6744 * @sband: The band this frame is being transmitted on.
6745 * @bss_conf: the current BSS configuration
6746 * @skb: the skb that will be transmitted, the control information in it needs
6747 *	to be filled in
6748 * @reported_rate: The rate control algorithm can fill this in to indicate
6749 *	which rate should be reported to userspace as the current rate and
6750 *	used for rate calculations in the mesh network.
6751 * @rts: whether RTS will be used for this frame because it is longer than the
6752 *	RTS threshold
6753 * @short_preamble: whether mac80211 will request short-preamble transmission
6754 *	if the selected rate supports it
6755 * @rate_idx_mask: user-requested (legacy) rate mask
6756 * @rate_idx_mcs_mask: user-requested MCS rate mask (NULL if not in use)
6757 * @bss: whether this frame is sent out in AP or IBSS mode
6758 */
6759struct ieee80211_tx_rate_control {
6760	struct ieee80211_hw *hw;
6761	struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband;
6762	struct ieee80211_bss_conf *bss_conf;
6763	struct sk_buff *skb;
6764	struct ieee80211_tx_rate reported_rate;
6765	bool rts, short_preamble;
6766	u32 rate_idx_mask;
6767	u8 *rate_idx_mcs_mask;
6768	bool bss;
6769};
6770
6771/**
6772 * enum rate_control_capabilities - rate control capabilities
6773 */
6774enum rate_control_capabilities {
6775	/**
6776	 * @RATE_CTRL_CAPA_VHT_EXT_NSS_BW:
6777	 * Support for extended NSS BW support (dot11VHTExtendedNSSCapable)
6778	 * Note that this is only looked at if the minimum number of chains
6779	 * that the AP uses is < the number of TX chains the hardware has,
6780	 * otherwise the NSS difference doesn't bother us.
6781	 */
6782	RATE_CTRL_CAPA_VHT_EXT_NSS_BW = BIT(0),
6783	/**
6784	 * @RATE_CTRL_CAPA_AMPDU_TRIGGER:
6785	 * mac80211 should start A-MPDU sessions on tx
6786	 */
6787	RATE_CTRL_CAPA_AMPDU_TRIGGER = BIT(1),
6788};
6789
6790struct rate_control_ops {
6791	unsigned long capa;
6792	const char *name;
6793	void *(*alloc)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
6794	void (*add_debugfs)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, void *priv,
6795			    struct dentry *debugfsdir);
6796	void (*free)(void *priv);
6797
6798	void *(*alloc_sta)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_sta *sta, gfp_t gfp);
6799	void (*rate_init)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
6800			  struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
6801			  struct ieee80211_sta *sta, void *priv_sta);
6802	void (*rate_update)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
6803			    struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
6804			    struct ieee80211_sta *sta, void *priv_sta,
6805			    u32 changed);
6806	void (*free_sta)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
6807			 void *priv_sta);
6808
6809	void (*tx_status_ext)(void *priv,
6810			      struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
6811			      void *priv_sta, struct ieee80211_tx_status *st);
6812	void (*tx_status)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
6813			  struct ieee80211_sta *sta, void *priv_sta,
6814			  struct sk_buff *skb);
6815	void (*get_rate)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_sta *sta, void *priv_sta,
6816			 struct ieee80211_tx_rate_control *txrc);
6817
6818	void (*add_sta_debugfs)(void *priv, void *priv_sta,
6819				struct dentry *dir);
 
6820
6821	u32 (*get_expected_throughput)(void *priv_sta);
6822};
6823
6824static inline int rate_supported(struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
6825				 enum nl80211_band band,
6826				 int index)
6827{
6828	return (sta == NULL || sta->deflink.supp_rates[band] & BIT(index));
6829}
6830
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
6831static inline s8
6832rate_lowest_index(struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
6833		  struct ieee80211_sta *sta)
6834{
6835	int i;
6836
6837	for (i = 0; i < sband->n_bitrates; i++)
6838		if (rate_supported(sta, sband->band, i))
6839			return i;
6840
6841	/* warn when we cannot find a rate. */
6842	WARN_ON_ONCE(1);
6843
6844	/* and return 0 (the lowest index) */
6845	return 0;
6846}
6847
6848static inline
6849bool rate_usable_index_exists(struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
6850			      struct ieee80211_sta *sta)
6851{
6852	unsigned int i;
6853
6854	for (i = 0; i < sband->n_bitrates; i++)
6855		if (rate_supported(sta, sband->band, i))
6856			return true;
6857	return false;
6858}
6859
6860/**
6861 * rate_control_set_rates - pass the sta rate selection to mac80211/driver
6862 *
6863 * When not doing a rate control probe to test rates, rate control should pass
6864 * its rate selection to mac80211. If the driver supports receiving a station
6865 * rate table, it will use it to ensure that frames are always sent based on
6866 * the most recent rate control module decision.
6867 *
6868 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6869 * @pubsta: &struct ieee80211_sta pointer to the target destination.
6870 * @rates: new tx rate set to be used for this station.
6871 */
6872int rate_control_set_rates(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6873			   struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta,
6874			   struct ieee80211_sta_rates *rates);
6875
6876int ieee80211_rate_control_register(const struct rate_control_ops *ops);
6877void ieee80211_rate_control_unregister(const struct rate_control_ops *ops);
6878
6879static inline bool
6880conf_is_ht20(struct ieee80211_conf *conf)
6881{
6882	return conf->chandef.width == NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20;
6883}
6884
6885static inline bool
6886conf_is_ht40_minus(struct ieee80211_conf *conf)
6887{
6888	return conf->chandef.width == NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_40 &&
6889	       conf->chandef.center_freq1 < conf->chandef.chan->center_freq;
6890}
6891
6892static inline bool
6893conf_is_ht40_plus(struct ieee80211_conf *conf)
6894{
6895	return conf->chandef.width == NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_40 &&
6896	       conf->chandef.center_freq1 > conf->chandef.chan->center_freq;
6897}
6898
6899static inline bool
6900conf_is_ht40(struct ieee80211_conf *conf)
6901{
6902	return conf->chandef.width == NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_40;
6903}
6904
6905static inline bool
6906conf_is_ht(struct ieee80211_conf *conf)
6907{
6908	return (conf->chandef.width != NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_5) &&
6909		(conf->chandef.width != NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_10) &&
6910		(conf->chandef.width != NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20_NOHT);
6911}
6912
6913static inline enum nl80211_iftype
6914ieee80211_iftype_p2p(enum nl80211_iftype type, bool p2p)
6915{
6916	if (p2p) {
6917		switch (type) {
6918		case NL80211_IFTYPE_STATION:
6919			return NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_CLIENT;
6920		case NL80211_IFTYPE_AP:
6921			return NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_GO;
6922		default:
6923			break;
6924		}
6925	}
6926	return type;
6927}
6928
6929static inline enum nl80211_iftype
6930ieee80211_vif_type_p2p(struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
6931{
6932	return ieee80211_iftype_p2p(vif->type, vif->p2p);
6933}
6934
6935/**
6936 * ieee80211_get_he_iftype_cap_vif - return HE capabilities for sband/vif
6937 * @sband: the sband to search for the iftype on
6938 * @vif: the vif to get the iftype from
6939 *
6940 * Return: pointer to the struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap, or %NULL is none found
6941 */
6942static inline const struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap *
6943ieee80211_get_he_iftype_cap_vif(const struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
6944				struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
6945{
6946	return ieee80211_get_he_iftype_cap(sband, ieee80211_vif_type_p2p(vif));
6947}
6948
6949/**
6950 * ieee80211_get_he_6ghz_capa_vif - return HE 6 GHz capabilities
6951 * @sband: the sband to search for the STA on
6952 * @vif: the vif to get the iftype from
6953 *
6954 * Return: the 6GHz capabilities
6955 */
6956static inline __le16
6957ieee80211_get_he_6ghz_capa_vif(const struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
6958			       struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
6959{
6960	return ieee80211_get_he_6ghz_capa(sband, ieee80211_vif_type_p2p(vif));
6961}
6962
6963/**
6964 * ieee80211_get_eht_iftype_cap_vif - return ETH capabilities for sband/vif
6965 * @sband: the sband to search for the iftype on
6966 * @vif: the vif to get the iftype from
6967 *
6968 * Return: pointer to the struct ieee80211_sta_eht_cap, or %NULL is none found
6969 */
6970static inline const struct ieee80211_sta_eht_cap *
6971ieee80211_get_eht_iftype_cap_vif(const struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
6972				 struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
6973{
6974	return ieee80211_get_eht_iftype_cap(sband, ieee80211_vif_type_p2p(vif));
6975}
6976
6977/**
6978 * ieee80211_update_mu_groups - set the VHT MU-MIMO groud data
6979 *
6980 * @vif: the specified virtual interface
6981 * @link_id: the link ID for MLO, otherwise 0
6982 * @membership: 64 bits array - a bit is set if station is member of the group
6983 * @position: 2 bits per group id indicating the position in the group
6984 *
6985 * Note: This function assumes that the given vif is valid and the position and
6986 * membership data is of the correct size and are in the same byte order as the
6987 * matching GroupId management frame.
6988 * Calls to this function need to be serialized with RX path.
6989 */
6990void ieee80211_update_mu_groups(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, unsigned int link_id,
6991				const u8 *membership, const u8 *position);
6992
6993void ieee80211_enable_rssi_reports(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6994				   int rssi_min_thold,
6995				   int rssi_max_thold);
6996
6997void ieee80211_disable_rssi_reports(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
6998
6999/**
7000 * ieee80211_ave_rssi - report the average RSSI for the specified interface
7001 *
7002 * @vif: the specified virtual interface
7003 *
7004 * Note: This function assumes that the given vif is valid.
7005 *
7006 * Return: The average RSSI value for the requested interface, or 0 if not
7007 * applicable.
7008 */
7009int ieee80211_ave_rssi(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
7010
7011/**
7012 * ieee80211_report_wowlan_wakeup - report WoWLAN wakeup
7013 * @vif: virtual interface
7014 * @wakeup: wakeup reason(s)
7015 * @gfp: allocation flags
7016 *
7017 * See cfg80211_report_wowlan_wakeup().
7018 */
7019void ieee80211_report_wowlan_wakeup(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
7020				    struct cfg80211_wowlan_wakeup *wakeup,
7021				    gfp_t gfp);
7022
7023/**
7024 * ieee80211_tx_prepare_skb - prepare an 802.11 skb for transmission
7025 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7026 * @vif: virtual interface
7027 * @skb: frame to be sent from within the driver
7028 * @band: the band to transmit on
7029 * @sta: optional pointer to get the station to send the frame to
7030 *
7031 * Note: must be called under RCU lock
7032 */
7033bool ieee80211_tx_prepare_skb(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7034			      struct ieee80211_vif *vif, struct sk_buff *skb,
7035			      int band, struct ieee80211_sta **sta);
7036
7037/**
7038 * ieee80211_parse_tx_radiotap - Sanity-check and parse the radiotap header
7039 *				 of injected frames.
7040 *
7041 * To accurately parse and take into account rate and retransmission fields,
7042 * you must initialize the chandef field in the ieee80211_tx_info structure
7043 * of the skb before calling this function.
7044 *
7045 * @skb: packet injected by userspace
7046 * @dev: the &struct device of this 802.11 device
7047 */
7048bool ieee80211_parse_tx_radiotap(struct sk_buff *skb,
7049				 struct net_device *dev);
7050
7051/**
7052 * struct ieee80211_noa_data - holds temporary data for tracking P2P NoA state
7053 *
7054 * @next_tsf: TSF timestamp of the next absent state change
7055 * @has_next_tsf: next absent state change event pending
7056 *
7057 * @absent: descriptor bitmask, set if GO is currently absent
7058 *
7059 * private:
7060 *
7061 * @count: count fields from the NoA descriptors
7062 * @desc: adjusted data from the NoA
7063 */
7064struct ieee80211_noa_data {
7065	u32 next_tsf;
7066	bool has_next_tsf;
7067
7068	u8 absent;
7069
7070	u8 count[IEEE80211_P2P_NOA_DESC_MAX];
7071	struct {
7072		u32 start;
7073		u32 duration;
7074		u32 interval;
7075	} desc[IEEE80211_P2P_NOA_DESC_MAX];
7076};
7077
7078/**
7079 * ieee80211_parse_p2p_noa - initialize NoA tracking data from P2P IE
7080 *
7081 * @attr: P2P NoA IE
7082 * @data: NoA tracking data
7083 * @tsf: current TSF timestamp
7084 *
7085 * Return: number of successfully parsed descriptors
7086 */
7087int ieee80211_parse_p2p_noa(const struct ieee80211_p2p_noa_attr *attr,
7088			    struct ieee80211_noa_data *data, u32 tsf);
7089
7090/**
7091 * ieee80211_update_p2p_noa - get next pending P2P GO absent state change
7092 *
7093 * @data: NoA tracking data
7094 * @tsf: current TSF timestamp
7095 */
7096void ieee80211_update_p2p_noa(struct ieee80211_noa_data *data, u32 tsf);
7097
7098/**
7099 * ieee80211_tdls_oper_request - request userspace to perform a TDLS operation
7100 * @vif: virtual interface
7101 * @peer: the peer's destination address
7102 * @oper: the requested TDLS operation
7103 * @reason_code: reason code for the operation, valid for TDLS teardown
7104 * @gfp: allocation flags
7105 *
7106 * See cfg80211_tdls_oper_request().
7107 */
7108void ieee80211_tdls_oper_request(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *peer,
7109				 enum nl80211_tdls_operation oper,
7110				 u16 reason_code, gfp_t gfp);
7111
7112/**
7113 * ieee80211_reserve_tid - request to reserve a specific TID
7114 *
7115 * There is sometimes a need (such as in TDLS) for blocking the driver from
7116 * using a specific TID so that the FW can use it for certain operations such
7117 * as sending PTI requests. To make sure that the driver doesn't use that TID,
7118 * this function must be called as it flushes out packets on this TID and marks
7119 * it as blocked, so that any transmit for the station on this TID will be
7120 * redirected to the alternative TID in the same AC.
7121 *
7122 * Note that this function blocks and may call back into the driver, so it
7123 * should be called without driver locks held. Also note this function should
7124 * only be called from the driver's @sta_state callback.
7125 *
7126 * @sta: the station to reserve the TID for
7127 * @tid: the TID to reserve
7128 *
7129 * Returns: 0 on success, else on failure
7130 */
7131int ieee80211_reserve_tid(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 tid);
7132
7133/**
7134 * ieee80211_unreserve_tid - request to unreserve a specific TID
7135 *
7136 * Once there is no longer any need for reserving a certain TID, this function
7137 * should be called, and no longer will packets have their TID modified for
7138 * preventing use of this TID in the driver.
7139 *
7140 * Note that this function blocks and acquires a lock, so it should be called
7141 * without driver locks held. Also note this function should only be called
7142 * from the driver's @sta_state callback.
7143 *
7144 * @sta: the station
7145 * @tid: the TID to unreserve
7146 */
7147void ieee80211_unreserve_tid(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 tid);
7148
7149/**
7150 * ieee80211_tx_dequeue - dequeue a packet from a software tx queue
7151 *
7152 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7153 * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface, or from
7154 *	ieee80211_next_txq()
7155 *
7156 * Returns the skb if successful, %NULL if no frame was available.
7157 *
7158 * Note that this must be called in an rcu_read_lock() critical section,
7159 * which can only be released after the SKB was handled. Some pointers in
7160 * skb->cb, e.g. the key pointer, are protected by RCU and thus the
7161 * critical section must persist not just for the duration of this call
7162 * but for the duration of the frame handling.
7163 * However, also note that while in the wake_tx_queue() method,
7164 * rcu_read_lock() is already held.
7165 *
7166 * softirqs must also be disabled when this function is called.
7167 * In process context, use ieee80211_tx_dequeue_ni() instead.
7168 */
7169struct sk_buff *ieee80211_tx_dequeue(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7170				     struct ieee80211_txq *txq);
7171
7172/**
7173 * ieee80211_tx_dequeue_ni - dequeue a packet from a software tx queue
7174 * (in process context)
7175 *
7176 * Like ieee80211_tx_dequeue() but can be called in process context
7177 * (internally disables bottom halves).
7178 *
7179 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7180 * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface, or from
7181 *	ieee80211_next_txq()
7182 */
7183static inline struct sk_buff *ieee80211_tx_dequeue_ni(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7184						      struct ieee80211_txq *txq)
7185{
7186	struct sk_buff *skb;
7187
7188	local_bh_disable();
7189	skb = ieee80211_tx_dequeue(hw, txq);
7190	local_bh_enable();
7191
7192	return skb;
7193}
7194
7195/**
7196 * ieee80211_handle_wake_tx_queue - mac80211 handler for wake_tx_queue callback
7197 *
7198 * @hw: pointer as obtained from wake_tx_queue() callback().
7199 * @txq: pointer as obtained from wake_tx_queue() callback().
7200 *
7201 * Drivers can use this function for the mandatory mac80211 wake_tx_queue
7202 * callback in struct ieee80211_ops. They should not call this function.
7203 */
7204void ieee80211_handle_wake_tx_queue(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7205				    struct ieee80211_txq *txq);
7206
7207/**
7208 * ieee80211_next_txq - get next tx queue to pull packets from
7209 *
7210 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7211 * @ac: AC number to return packets from.
7212 *
7213 * Returns the next txq if successful, %NULL if no queue is eligible. If a txq
7214 * is returned, it should be returned with ieee80211_return_txq() after the
7215 * driver has finished scheduling it.
7216 */
7217struct ieee80211_txq *ieee80211_next_txq(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u8 ac);
7218
7219/**
7220 * ieee80211_txq_schedule_start - start new scheduling round for TXQs
7221 *
7222 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7223 * @ac: AC number to acquire locks for
7224 *
7225 * Should be called before ieee80211_next_txq() or ieee80211_return_txq().
7226 * The driver must not call multiple TXQ scheduling rounds concurrently.
7227 */
7228void ieee80211_txq_schedule_start(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u8 ac);
7229
7230/* (deprecated) */
7231static inline void ieee80211_txq_schedule_end(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u8 ac)
7232{
7233}
7234
7235void __ieee80211_schedule_txq(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7236			      struct ieee80211_txq *txq, bool force);
7237
7238/**
7239 * ieee80211_schedule_txq - schedule a TXQ for transmission
7240 *
7241 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7242 * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface
7243 *
7244 * Schedules a TXQ for transmission if it is not already scheduled,
7245 * even if mac80211 does not have any packets buffered.
7246 *
7247 * The driver may call this function if it has buffered packets for
7248 * this TXQ internally.
7249 */
7250static inline void
7251ieee80211_schedule_txq(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_txq *txq)
7252{
7253	__ieee80211_schedule_txq(hw, txq, true);
7254}
7255
7256/**
7257 * ieee80211_return_txq - return a TXQ previously acquired by ieee80211_next_txq()
7258 *
7259 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7260 * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface
7261 * @force: schedule txq even if mac80211 does not have any buffered packets.
7262 *
7263 * The driver may set force=true if it has buffered packets for this TXQ
7264 * internally.
7265 */
7266static inline void
7267ieee80211_return_txq(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_txq *txq,
7268		     bool force)
7269{
7270	__ieee80211_schedule_txq(hw, txq, force);
7271}
7272
7273/**
7274 * ieee80211_txq_may_transmit - check whether TXQ is allowed to transmit
7275 *
7276 * This function is used to check whether given txq is allowed to transmit by
7277 * the airtime scheduler, and can be used by drivers to access the airtime
7278 * fairness accounting without using the scheduling order enforced by
7279 * next_txq().
7280 *
7281 * Returns %true if the airtime scheduler thinks the TXQ should be allowed to
7282 * transmit, and %false if it should be throttled. This function can also have
7283 * the side effect of rotating the TXQ in the scheduler rotation, which will
7284 * eventually bring the deficit to positive and allow the station to transmit
7285 * again.
7286 *
7287 * The API ieee80211_txq_may_transmit() also ensures that TXQ list will be
7288 * aligned against driver's own round-robin scheduler list. i.e it rotates
7289 * the TXQ list till it makes the requested node becomes the first entry
7290 * in TXQ list. Thus both the TXQ list and driver's list are in sync. If this
7291 * function returns %true, the driver is expected to schedule packets
7292 * for transmission, and then return the TXQ through ieee80211_return_txq().
7293 *
7294 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7295 * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface
7296 */
7297bool ieee80211_txq_may_transmit(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7298				struct ieee80211_txq *txq);
7299
7300/**
7301 * ieee80211_txq_get_depth - get pending frame/byte count of given txq
7302 *
7303 * The values are not guaranteed to be coherent with regard to each other, i.e.
7304 * txq state can change half-way of this function and the caller may end up
7305 * with "new" frame_cnt and "old" byte_cnt or vice-versa.
7306 *
7307 * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface
7308 * @frame_cnt: pointer to store frame count
7309 * @byte_cnt: pointer to store byte count
7310 */
7311void ieee80211_txq_get_depth(struct ieee80211_txq *txq,
7312			     unsigned long *frame_cnt,
7313			     unsigned long *byte_cnt);
7314
7315/**
7316 * ieee80211_nan_func_terminated - notify about NAN function termination.
7317 *
7318 * This function is used to notify mac80211 about NAN function termination.
7319 * Note that this function can't be called from hard irq.
7320 *
7321 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
7322 * @inst_id: the local instance id
7323 * @reason: termination reason (one of the NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_*)
7324 * @gfp: allocation flags
7325 */
7326void ieee80211_nan_func_terminated(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
7327				   u8 inst_id,
7328				   enum nl80211_nan_func_term_reason reason,
7329				   gfp_t gfp);
7330
7331/**
7332 * ieee80211_nan_func_match - notify about NAN function match event.
7333 *
7334 * This function is used to notify mac80211 about NAN function match. The
7335 * cookie inside the match struct will be assigned by mac80211.
7336 * Note that this function can't be called from hard irq.
7337 *
7338 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
7339 * @match: match event information
7340 * @gfp: allocation flags
7341 */
7342void ieee80211_nan_func_match(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
7343			      struct cfg80211_nan_match_params *match,
7344			      gfp_t gfp);
7345
7346/**
7347 * ieee80211_calc_rx_airtime - calculate estimated transmission airtime for RX.
7348 *
7349 * This function calculates the estimated airtime usage of a frame based on the
7350 * rate information in the RX status struct and the frame length.
7351 *
7352 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7353 * @status: &struct ieee80211_rx_status containing the transmission rate
7354 *          information.
7355 * @len: frame length in bytes
7356 */
7357u32 ieee80211_calc_rx_airtime(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7358			      struct ieee80211_rx_status *status,
7359			      int len);
7360
7361/**
7362 * ieee80211_calc_tx_airtime - calculate estimated transmission airtime for TX.
7363 *
7364 * This function calculates the estimated airtime usage of a frame based on the
7365 * rate information in the TX info struct and the frame length.
7366 *
7367 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7368 * @info: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame.
7369 * @len: frame length in bytes
7370 */
7371u32 ieee80211_calc_tx_airtime(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7372			      struct ieee80211_tx_info *info,
7373			      int len);
7374/**
7375 * ieee80211_set_hw_80211_encap - enable hardware encapsulation offloading.
7376 *
7377 * This function is used to notify mac80211 that a vif can be passed raw 802.3
7378 * frames. The driver needs to then handle the 802.11 encapsulation inside the
7379 * hardware or firmware.
7380 *
7381 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
7382 * @enable: indicate if the feature should be turned on or off
7383 */
7384bool ieee80211_set_hw_80211_encap(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, bool enable);
7385
7386/**
7387 * ieee80211_get_fils_discovery_tmpl - Get FILS discovery template.
7388 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
7389 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
7390 *
7391 * The driver is responsible for freeing the returned skb.
7392 *
7393 * Return: FILS discovery template. %NULL on error.
7394 */
7395struct sk_buff *ieee80211_get_fils_discovery_tmpl(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7396						  struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
7397
7398/**
7399 * ieee80211_get_unsol_bcast_probe_resp_tmpl - Get unsolicited broadcast
7400 *	probe response template.
7401 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
7402 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
7403 *
7404 * The driver is responsible for freeing the returned skb.
7405 *
7406 * Return: Unsolicited broadcast probe response template. %NULL on error.
7407 */
7408struct sk_buff *
7409ieee80211_get_unsol_bcast_probe_resp_tmpl(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7410					  struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
7411
7412/**
7413 * ieee80211_obss_color_collision_notify - notify userland about a BSS color
7414 * collision.
7415 *
7416 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
7417 * @color_bitmap: a 64 bit bitmap representing the colors that the local BSS is
7418 *	aware of.
7419 * @gfp: allocation flags
7420 */
7421void
7422ieee80211_obss_color_collision_notify(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
7423				      u64 color_bitmap, gfp_t gfp);
7424
7425/**
7426 * ieee80211_is_tx_data - check if frame is a data frame
7427 *
7428 * The function is used to check if a frame is a data frame. Frames with
7429 * hardware encapsulation enabled are data frames.
7430 *
7431 * @skb: the frame to be transmitted.
7432 */
7433static inline bool ieee80211_is_tx_data(struct sk_buff *skb)
7434{
7435	struct ieee80211_tx_info *info = IEEE80211_SKB_CB(skb);
7436	struct ieee80211_hdr *hdr = (void *) skb->data;
7437
7438	return info->flags & IEEE80211_TX_CTL_HW_80211_ENCAP ||
7439	       ieee80211_is_data(hdr->frame_control);
7440}
7441
7442/**
7443 * ieee80211_set_active_links - set active links in client mode
7444 * @vif: interface to set active links on
7445 * @active_links: the new active links bitmap
7446 *
7447 * Context: Must be called with wiphy mutex held; may sleep; calls
7448 *	back into the driver.
7449 *
7450 * This changes the active links on an interface. The interface
7451 * must be in client mode (in AP mode, all links are always active),
7452 * and @active_links must be a subset of the vif's valid_links.
7453 *
7454 * If a link is switched off and another is switched on at the same
7455 * time (e.g. active_links going from 0x1 to 0x10) then you will get
7456 * a sequence of calls like
7457 *
7458 *  - change_vif_links(0x11)
7459 *  - unassign_vif_chanctx(link_id=0)
7460 *  - change_sta_links(0x11) for each affected STA (the AP)
7461 *    (TDLS connections on now inactive links should be torn down)
7462 *  - remove group keys on the old link (link_id 0)
7463 *  - add new group keys (GTK/IGTK/BIGTK) on the new link (link_id 4)
7464 *  - change_sta_links(0x10) for each affected STA (the AP)
7465 *  - assign_vif_chanctx(link_id=4)
7466 *  - change_vif_links(0x10)
7467 */
7468int ieee80211_set_active_links(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, u16 active_links);
7469
7470/**
7471 * ieee80211_set_active_links_async - asynchronously set active links
7472 * @vif: interface to set active links on
7473 * @active_links: the new active links bitmap
7474 *
7475 * See ieee80211_set_active_links() for more information, the only
7476 * difference here is that the link change is triggered async and
7477 * can be called in any context, but the link switch will only be
7478 * completed after it returns.
7479 */
7480void ieee80211_set_active_links_async(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
7481				      u16 active_links);
7482
7483#endif /* MAC80211_H */